Owner’s Manual
2020 HR-V
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
0 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
3 WARNING
California Proposition 65 Warning
Operating, servicing and maintaining a
passenger vehicle or off-highway motor
vehicle can expose you to chemicals including
engine exhaust, carbon monoxide,
phthalates, and lead, which are known to the
State of California to cause cancer and birth
defects or other reproductive harm. To
minimize exposure, avoid breathing exhaust,
do not idle the engine except as necessary,
service your vehicle in a well-ventilated area
and wear gloves or wash your hands
frequently when servicing your vehicle. For
more information go to
www.P65Warnings.ca.gov/passenger-vehicle.
Event Data Recorders
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR).
The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near
crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a
road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle’s
systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related
to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is
designed to record such data as:
• How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
• Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were
buckled/fastened;
• How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator
and/or brake pedal; and,
• How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the
circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data
are recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation
occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving
conditions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and
crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law
enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of
personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash
investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required,
and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the
vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that
have the special equipment, can read the information if they have
access to the vehicle or the EDR.
The data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by
anyone else except as legally required or with the permission of the
vehicle owner.
Service Diagnostic Recorders
This vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record
information about powertrain performance. The data can be used
to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians
diagnose and solve service problems. It may also be combined with
data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains
confidential. Some diagnostic and maintenance information is
uploaded to Honda upon vehicle start up.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
1 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
California Perchlorate Contamination Prevention Act
The airbags, seat belt tensioners, and CR type batteries in this
vehicle may contain perchlorate materials - special handling may
apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate/
To help you make informed decisions about safety, we have
provided operating procedures and other information on labels and
in this manual. This information alerts you to potential hazards that
could hurt you or others.
As you read this manual, you will find information that is preceded
by a NOTICE symbol. This information is intended to help you avoid
damage to your vehicle, other property, or the environment.
Of course, it is not practical or possible to warn you about all the
hazards associated with operating or maintaining your vehicle. You
must use your own good judgment.
Software End User License Agreement
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,
including:
Your vehicle comes equipped with software, which is governed by
the End User License Agreement in Owner’s Manual, and which
contains a binding arbitration clause. Please refer to the End User
License Agreement for the terms and conditions governing your
use of the installed software, as well as the applications, services,
functions, and content provided through the software. Your use of
the installed software will serve as your consent to the terms and
conditions of the End User License Agreement.
You may opt out within 30 days of your initial use of the Software
by sending a signed, written notice to HONDA at American Honda
Motor Co., Inc. Honda Automobile Customer Services Mail Stop
100-5E-8A, 1919 Torrance Blvd. Torrance, CA 90501-2746.
Privacy Notice
This vehicle may share location and usage information. To manage
this setting, visit www.hondalink.com/vehicle-data-choices.
A Few Words About Safety
Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. And
operating this vehicle safely is an important responsibility.
● Safety Labels - on the vehicle.
● Safety Messages - preceded by a safety alert symbol 3 and
one of three signal words: DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION.
These signal words mean:
3DANGER
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don’t follow instructions.
3WARNING
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don’t follow instructions.
3CAUTION
You CAN be HURT if you don’t follow
instructions.
● Safety Headings - such as Important Safety Precautions.
● Safety Section - such as Safe Driving.
● Instructions - how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.
This entire book is filled with important safety information - please
read it carefully.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
2 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Contents
This owner’s manual should be considered a permanent part of the
vehicle and should remain with the vehicle when it is sold.
This owner’s manual covers all models of your vehicle. You may find
descriptions of equipment and features that are not on your
particular model.
Images throughout this owner’s manual (including the front cover)
represent features and equipment that are available on some, but
not all, models. Your particular model may not have some of these
features.
This owner’s manual is for vehicles sold in the United States and
Canada.
2 Safe Driving P. 33
For Safe Driving P. 34
Airbags P. 50
2 Instrument Panel P. 79
Indicators P. 80
Gauges and Displays P. 113
2 Controls P. 133
Clock P. 134
Locking and Unlocking the Doors P. 136
Opening and Closing the Windows P. 162
Moonroof * P. 164
Adjusting the Seats P. 190
Climate Control System * P. 216
2 Features P. 227
Audio System P. 228
Audio System Basic Operation P. 234, 255
Customized Features P. 345, 352
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver * P. 367
2 Driving P. 423
Before Driving P. 424
Braking P. 503
The information and specifications included in this publication were
in effect at the time of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co., Ltd.
reserves the right, however, to discontinue or change specifications
or design at any time without notice and without incurring any
obligation.
Seat Belts P. 40
Towing a Trailer P. 429
Parking Your Vehicle P. 510
2 Maintenance P. 517
Before Performing Maintenance P. 518
Maintenance MinderTM P. 521
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 551
Heating and Cooling System */Climate Control System * Maintenance P. 570
2 Handling the Unexpected P. 579
Tools P. 580
Overheating P. 597
If a Tire Goes Flat P. 582
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking P. 599
Fuses P. 604
2 Information P. 613
Specifications P. 614
Emissions Testing P. 619
Identification Numbers P. 616
Warranty Coverages P. 621
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
3 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Contents
Quick Reference Guide
Child Safety P. 64
Exhaust Gas Hazard P. 77
Tailgate P. 156
Security System P. 159
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel P. 165
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items P. 201
P. 4
Safety Labels P. 78
Safe Driving
P. 33
Instrument Panel
P. 79
Adjusting the Mirrors P. 187
Heating and Cooling System * P. 212
Audio Error Messages P. 323
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 370, 393
General Information on the Audio System P. 329
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines P. 430
Multi-View Rear Camera P. 511
When Driving P. 432
Refueling P. 513
Maintenance Under the Hood P. 529
Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 555
Cleaning P. 571
Replacing Light Bulbs P. 541
Battery P. 566
Accessories and Modifications P. 576
Engine Does Not Start P. 591
Emergency Towing P. 609
Jump Starting P. 594
Shift Lever Does Not Move P. 596
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate P. 610
Devices that Emit Radio Waves P. 617
Authorized Manuals P. 623
Reporting Safety Defects P. 618
Customer Service Information P. 624
Honda Sensing® * P. 460
Fuel Economy and CO2 Emissions P. 515
Controls
P. 133
Features
P. 227
Driving
P. 423
Maintenance
P. 517
Handling the Unexpected
P. 579
Information
P. 613
Index
P. 626
Remote Transmitter Care P. 568
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
4 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Quick Reference Guide
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❙ System Indicators (P80)
❙ Gauges (P113)
❙ Information Display * (P115)
❙ Multi-Information Display * (P118)
❙ Hazard Warning Button
❙ Audio/Information Screen (P235, 256)
❙ Audio System (P228)
❙ Navigation System *
() See the Navigation System Manual
❙ Heating and Cooling System * (P212)
❙ Climate Control System * (P216)
❙ Rear Defogger (P182)
❙ Heated Mirror Icon * (P182)
❙ ENGINE START/STOP Button*1 (P166)
❙ Ignition Switch * (P165)
❙ Steering Wheel Adjustments (P186)
❙ ECON Button (P446)
❙ Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Button * (P456)
❙ (Vehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®) System OFF) Button (P451)
❙ Heated Windshield Button * (P183)
❙ Road Departure Mitigation Button * (P495)
❙ Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) OFF Button * (P463)
*1 : Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
4
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
5 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Headlights/Turn Signals (P170)
❙ Fog Lights * (P174)
❙ LaneWatchTM* (P452)
❙ Paddle Shifter (Shift Down) * (P 445)
❙
(Display) Button * (P235)
❙ (Select/Reset) Knob (P115, 119)
❙ Brightness Control (P184)
❙ Horn (Press an area around
.)
❙ MAIN Button (P474)
❙ Paddle Shifter (Shift Up) * (P445)
❙ Wipers/Washers (P179)
❙ Cruise Control Buttons * (P447)
❙ Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Buttons *
(P474)
❙ Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) Button *
(P488)
❙
(Information) Buttons * (P118)
❙ SEL/RESET Button * (P119)
❙ Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® System
(P370, 393)
❙ Voice Control Buttons (P370, 393)
❙ Navigation System Voice Control Buttons *
() See the Navigation System Manual
❙ Audio Remote Control Buttons (P231)
* Not available on all models
5
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
6 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Power Window Switches (P162)
❙ Power Door Lock Master Switch (P150)
❙ Door Mirror Controls (P189)
❙ Interior Fuse Boxes (P606)
❙ Driver’s Front Airbag (P53)
❙ Passenger’s Front Airbag (P53)
❙ Seat Heater Icons * (P211)
❙ Glove Box (P203)
❙ Shift Lever
Continuously Variable
Transmission (P440, 442)
❙ Accessory Power Socket (P207)
❙ USB Port(s) (P229)
❙ Electric Parking Brake Switch (P503)
❙ Automatic Brake Hold Button (P506)
❙ Hood Release Handle (P530)
❙ Fuel Fill Door Release Handle (P514)
6
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
7 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor (P47)
❙ Seat Belts (P40)
❙ Seat Belts (Installing a Child Seat) (P71)
❙ Seat Belt to Secure a Child Seat (P73)
❙ Grab Handle
❙ Coat Hook (P208)
❙ Interior Lights (P201)
❙ Map Lights (P202)
❙ Moonroof Switch * (P164)
❙ Rearview Mirror (P187)
❙ HomeLink® Buttons * (P368)
❙ Sun Visors
❙ Vanity Mirrors
❙ Side Curtain Airbags (P59)
❙ Side Airbags (P57)
❙ Front Seat (P190)
❙ Accessory Power Socket
❙ Rear Seat (P193)
❙ LATCH to Secure a Child Seat (P69)
❙ Cargo Area Light (P202)
❙ Cargo Cover * (P210)
❙ Cargo Floor Box (P206)
❙ Accessory Power Socket * (P207)
(P207)
* Not available on all models
7
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
8 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Maintenance Under the Hood (P529)
❙ Windshield Wipers (P179, 551)
❙ Power Door Mirrors (P189)
❙ Side Turn Signal Lights * (P170, 546)
❙ Door Lock/Unlock Control (P139)
❙ Headlights (P171, 541)
❙ Front Turn Signal Lights (P170, 543)
❙ Front Side Marker Lights (P171, 544)
❙ Parking/Daytime Running Lights (P544)
❙ Tires (P555, 582)
❙ Fog Lights * (P174, 545)
❙ How to Refuel (P514)
❙ High-Mount Brake Light (P549)
❙ Rear Wiper (P181, 553)
❙ Rear License Plate Lights (P550)
❙ Opening/Closing the Tailgate (P156)
❙ Tailgate Release Button (P157)
❙ Lock Button * (P140)
❙ Multi-View Rear Camera (P511)
❙ Back-Up Lights (P548)
❙ Brake/Tail/Rear Side Marker Lights (P549)
❙ Rear Turn Signal Lights (P547)
8
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
9 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Eco Assist® System
Quick Reference Guide
Models with multi-information display
The message is displayed for a few
seconds when the ECON button is
pressed.
Ambient Meter
The color of the ambient meter changes to green to
indicate that the vehicle is being driven in a fuel
efficient manner.
ECON Mode Indicator (P93)
Comes on when ECON button is pressed.
ECON Button (P446)
Helps maximize fuel economy.
* Not available on all models
9
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
10 ページ
Safe Driving
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
(P 33)
Quick Reference Guide
Airbags (P50)
● Your vehicle is fitted with airbags to help protect you and
your passengers during a moderate-to-severe collision.
Child Safety (P64)
● All children 12 and younger should be seated in the rear seat.
● Smaller children should be properly restrained in a forward-facing child seat.
● Infants must be properly restrained in a rear-facing child seat.
Exhaust Gas Hazard (P77)
● Your vehicle emits dangerous exhaust gases that contain
carbon monoxide. Do not run the engine in confined spaces
where carbon monoxide gas can accumulate.
Seat Belts (P40)
● Fasten your seat belt and sit upright well
back in the seat.
● Check that your passengers are wearing
their seat belts correctly.
Before Driving Checklist (P38)
● Before driving, check that the front seats, head
restraints, steering wheel, and mirrors have been
properly adjusted.
10
Fasten your lap belt as
low as possible.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
11 ページ
2019年8月8日
Instrument Panel
木曜日
午後3時52分
(P79)
Models with information display
System Indicators
Tachometer
Speedometer
Information Display
Fog Light Indicator *
Malfunction Indicator
Lamp
High Beam Indicator
Charging System
Indicator
Lights On Indicator
Low Oil Pressure
Indicator
System Indicators
Supplemental Restraint
System Indicator
High Temperature
Indicator (Red)/Low
Temperature Indicator
(Blue)
Vehicle Stability AssistTM
(VSA®) System Indicator
VSA® OFF Indicator
Electric Power Steering
(EPS) System Indicator
Automatic Brake Hold
System Indicator
Automatic Brake Hold
Indicator
Electric Parking Brake
System Indicator
Electric Parking Brake
Indicator
Lights Indicators
Quick Reference Guide
Gauges (P113)/Information Display * (P115)/Multi-Information Display *(P118)/
System Indicators (P80)
Security System Alarm Indicator
M (7-speed manual shift mode)
Indicator/Shift Indicator *
Immobilizer System
Indicator
Fuel Gauge
Shift Lever Position Indicator/
Transmission System Indicator
System Indicators
Maintenance Minder
Indicator
Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning
Indicators
ECON Mode Indicator
System Indicators
CRUISE MAIN Indicator
CRUISE CONTROL
Indicator
Seat Belt Reminder
Indicator
Door and Tailgate
Open Indicator
Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS) Indicator
Brake System Indicator
(Red)
Brake System Indicator
(Amber)
Low Tire Pressure/
TPMS Indicator
Low Fuel Indicator
All-Wheel Drive (AWD)
System Indicator *
Brake Depressing
Indicator
* Not available on all models
11
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
12 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Models with multi-information display
System Indicators
Quick Reference Guide
Malfunction Indicator
Lamp
System Indicators
Shift Lever Position Indicator/
Transmission System Indicator
Speedometer
Low Oil Pressure
Indicator
Multi-Information Display
Charging System
Indicator
Vehicle Stability AssistTM
(VSA®) System Indicator
VSA® OFF Indicator
Canada
U.S.
Canada
Automatic Brake Hold
Indicator
Canada
Electric Parking Brake
System Indicator
U.S.
Canada
12
Security System Alarm Indicator
Fuel Gauge
M (7-speed manual shift mode) Indicator/Shift Indicator *
Automatic Brake Hold
System Indicator
U.S.
002300
Parking Brake and
Brake System Indicator
(Red)
Parking Brake and
Brake System Indicator
(Amber)
Electric Parking Brake
Indicator
Electric Power
Steering (EPS) System
Indicator
Immobilizer System
Indicator
Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS) Indicator
U.S.
Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning
Indicators
Tachometer
System Indicators
High Temperature
Indicator (Red)/Low
Temperature Indicator
(Blue)
Smart Entry System
Indicator *
Lights Indicators
ECON Mode Indicator
Lights On Indicator
System Message
Indicator
High Beam Indicator
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS
Indicator *
Fog Light Indicator *
Seat Belt Reminder
Indicator
Supplemental
Restraint System
Indicator
Adaptive Cruise
Control (ACC)
Indicator (Amber/
Green)
Road Departure
Mitigation (RDM)
Indicator
Collision Mitigation
Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) Indicator
Lane Keeping Assist
System (LKAS)
Indicator (Amber/
Green)
Auto High-Beam
Indicator
All-Wheel Drive (AWD)
System Indicator *
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
Controls
13 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
(P133)
Models with display audio system
Models with color audio system
Quick Reference Guide
Clock (P134)
Models with navigation system
The navigation system receives signals from
GPS satellites, updating the clock
automatically.
Models without navigation system
The clock in the multi-information display */
information display * is automatically
updated along with the audio system’s clock
display.
a
Select the
Settings.
a
Press and hold the MENU/CLOCK
button.
b
Select Clock/Info, then Clock
Adjustment.
b
Rotate
.
to change hour, then press
c
Adjust the hours and minutes by
selecting 3 / 4 .
c
Rotate
press .
to change minute, then
d
Select OK.
d
Select SET, then press
(HOME) icon, then select
.
These indications are used to show how to
operate the LIST/SELECT (List/Selector) knob.
• Rotate
to select.
• Press to enter.
* Not available on all models
13
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
14 ページ
2019年8月8日
ENGINE START/STOP
Button * (P166)
Quick Reference Guide
Press the button to change the vehicle’s
power mode.
木曜日
午後3時52分
Lights (P171)
Wipers and Washers
Light Control Switches
(P179)
U.S. models
Wiper/Washer Control Lever
High Beam
Low Beam
Adjustment Ring *
(- : Low Sensitivity*1
(- : Lower speed, fewer sweeps*2
(+ : High Sensitivity*1
(+ : Higher speed, more sweeps*2
Flashing
Canadian models
Pull toward
you to spray
washer fluid.
High Beams
Turn Signals (P170)
Turn Signal Control Lever
Right
Flashing the
high beams
Low Beams
MIST
OFF
AUTO*1: Wiper speed varies automatically
INT*2: Low speed with intermittent
LO: Low speed wipe
HI: High speed wipe
Left
*1 : Models with automatic intermittent wipers
*2 : Models without automatic intermittent wipers
14
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
15 ページ
2019年8月8日
Steering Wheel (P186)
To adjust
午後3時52分
Unlocking the Front
Doors from the Inside
Tailgate (P156)
(P149)
● Pull either front door inner handle to
unlock and open it in one motion.
To lock
Models without smart entry system
Quick Reference Guide
To adjust, pull the adjustment lever towards
you, adjust to the desired position, then lock
the lever back in place.
木曜日
● With all the doors unlocked, press the
tailgate release button and lift open the
tailgate.
Models with smart entry system
● Unlocking and opening the driver’s door
from the inner handle unlocks all the
other doors.
● Press the tailgate release button to
unlock and open the tailgate when you
carry the smart entry remote.
* Not available on all models
15
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
16 ページ
2019年8月8日
Power Door Mirrors
(P189)
Quick Reference Guide
● With the ignition switch in ON (w *1, move
the selector switch to L or R.
● Push the appropriate edge of the
adjustment switch to adjust the mirror.
Selector Switch
木曜日
午後3時52分
Power Windows (P162)
● With the ignition switch in ON (w *1, open
and close the power windows.
● If the power window lock button is in the
off position, each passenger’s window
can be opened and closed with its own
switch.
● If the power window lock button is in the
on position (indicator on), each
passenger’s window switch is disabled.
Power Window Lock Button
Adjustment Switch
Window Switch
*1 : Models with the smart entry system have an
ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition
switch.
16
Indicator
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
17 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Heating and Cooling System * (P212)
Rotate the fan control dial to adjust the fan speed.
Rotate the mode control dial (
/
/
/
/
) to select the vents air flows from.
Rotate the temperature control dial to adjust the temperature.
Rotate the fan control dial to OFF to turn the system off.
Rotate the mode control dial to
to defrost the windshield.
Air flows
from
dashboard
vents.
Air flows from
floor and
dashboard
vents.
Air flows
from floor
vents.
Air flows from
floor and
windshield
defroster vents.
Quick Reference Guide
●
●
●
●
●
Air flows from
windshield
defroster
vents.
Fan Control Dial
Temperature Control Dial
Mode Control Dial
A/C (Air Conditioning) Button
(Recirculation) Button
* Not available on all models
17
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
18 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Climate Control System * (P216)
Quick Reference Guide
● Select the AUTO icon to activate the climate control system.
● Select the
icon to turn the system on or off.
● Select the
icon to defrost the windshield.
Models without SYNC icon
Air flows from
dashboard
vents.
Air flows from
floor and
dashboard vents.
Air flows from
floor vents.
Air flows from
floor and
windshield
defroster vents.
Temperature Control Icons
Fan Control Icons
AUTO Icon
(On/Off) Icon
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
(Recirculation) Icon
18
(Windshield Defroster) Icon
(Fresh Air) Icon
Mode Control Icon
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
19 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Models with SYNC icon
Fan Control Icons
Air flows from
floor and
dashboard vents.
Air flows from
floor vents.
Quick Reference Guide
Air flows from
dashboard
vents.
Air flows from
floor and
windshield
defroster vents.
Mode Control Icon
Driver Side Temperature
Control Icons
Passenger Side
Temperature Control
Icons
AUTO Icon
(On/Off) Icon
(Windshield Defroster) Icon
SYNC (Synchronization) Icon
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
(Recirculation) Icon
* Not available on all models
19
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
Features
20 ページ
2019年8月8日
Quick Reference Guide
(P231)
/
Buttons
SOURCE Button
● (+ / (- Button
Press to adjust the volume up/down.
● SOURCE Button
Models with color audio system
Press to change the audio mode: FM/AM/
CD/USB/iPod/Bluetooth® Audio.
Models with display audio system
Press to change the audio mode: FM/AM/
SiriusXM® */USB/iPod/Bluetooth® Audio/
Pandora® */Apps/Apple CarPlayTM/Android
AutoTM.
20
午後3時52分
(P227)
Audio Remote Controls
(+ / (- /
木曜日
●
/
Button
Radio:Press to change the preset station.
Press and hold to select the next or
previous strong station.
CD */USB device:
Press to skip to the beginning of
the next song or return to the
beginning of the current song.
Press and hold to change a folder.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
21 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Audio System (P228)
For navigation system operation () See the Navigation System Manual
Audio/Information Screen
(Day/Night)
Button
CD Slot
Quick Reference Guide
Models with color audio system (P234)
(CD Eject) Button
(Phone) Button
RADIO Button
MEDIA Button
(Sound) Button
LIST/SELECT Knob
VOL /
(Volume/Power)
Knob
MENU/CLOCK Button
(Back) Button
/
(Skip/Seek) Buttons
Preset Buttons (1-6)
* Not available on all models
21
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
22 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Models with display audio system (P255)
Quick Reference Guide
(Day/Night) Button
(Home) Icon
(Menu) Icon
(Back) Icon
VOL /
22
(Volume/Power) Knob
Audio/Information Screen
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
Driving
23 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
(P423)
(P440, 442)
● Shift to (P and depress the brake pedal when starting the engine.
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode * (P444)
● Allows you to manually shift the transmission up or
down without removing your hands from the steering
wheel.
When the shift lever is in (S
Shifting
Models with
paddle shifters
Models without
paddle shifters
Depress the brake pedal and press
the release button to move out of (P .
Move the shift lever without
pressing the release button.
Press the release button to move
the shift lever.
● Pulling a paddle shifter changes the mode from
continuously variable transmission to 7-speed manual
shift mode.
● The M indicator and the selected speed number are
displayed in the shift indicator.
When the shift lever is in (D
● Pulling a paddle shifter temporarily changes the mode
from continuously variable transmission to 7-speed
manual shift mode. The selected speed number is
displayed in the shift indicator.
M Indicator
Shift Lever
Park
Turn off or start the engine.
Transmission is locked.
Reverse
Used when reversing.
Neutral
Transmission is not locked.
Drive
Normal driving.
On models with paddle shifters,
7-speed mode can be used
temporarily.
Models with paddle shifters
Drive (S)
7-speed manual shift mode can
be used.
Quick Reference Guide
Continuously Variable Transmission
Release
Button
Shift Down (Paddle Shifter
Shift Up (+
Paddle Shifter
Shift Indicator
Models without paddle shifters
Drive (S)
● Better acceleration
● Used to increase engine braking
● Used when going up or down hills
Models without paddle shifters
Low
● Used to further increase engine braking
● Used when going up or down hills
* Not available on all models
23
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
24 ページ
2019年8月8日
午後3時52分
Quick Reference Guide
VSA® On and Off (P451)
CMBSTM On and Off *
● The Vehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®)
system helps stabilize the vehicle during
cornering, and helps maintain traction
while accelerating on loose or slippery
road surfaces.
● VSA® comes on automatically every time
you start the engine.
● To partially disable or fully restore VSA®
function, press and hold the button until
you hear a beep.
(P466)
Cruise Control *
(P447)
● Cruise control allows you to maintain a
set speed without keeping your foot on
the accelerator pedal.
● To use cruise control, press the CRUISE
button, then press the -/SET button once
you have achieved the desired speed
(above 25 mph or 40 km/h).
U.S. models only
Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) (P455)
● Detects a change in tire conditions and
overall dimensions due to decrease in tire
pressures.
● TPMS is turned on automatically every
time you start the engine.
● A calibration procedure must be
performed when certain conditions arise.
24
木曜日
● When a possible collision is likely
unavoidable, the CMBSTM can help you to
reduce the vehicle speed and the severity
of the collision.
● The CMBSTM is turned on every time you
start the engine.
● To turn the CMBSTM on or off, press and
hold the button until you hear a beep.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
25 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Refueling (P513)
a
Pull the fuel fill door
release handle.
b
Turn the fuel fill cap
slowly to remove the
cap.
c
Place the cap in the
holder on the fuel fill
door.
d
After refueling, screw
the cap back on until it
clicks at least once.
Quick Reference Guide
Fuel recommendation: Unleaded gasoline, pump octane number 87 or higher
Fuel tank capacity: 13.2 US gal (50 L)
* Not available on all models
25
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
26 ページ
2019年8月8日
Honda Sensing® *
Quick Reference Guide
Honda Sensing® is a driver support system
which employs the use of two distinctly
different kinds of sensors, a radar sensor
located in the front grille and a front sensor
camera mounted to the interior side of the
windshield, behind the rearview mirror.
The camera is located
behind the rearview
mirror.
Front Sensor
Camera
木曜日
午後3時52分
(P 460)
Collision Mitigation
Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) (P 463)
Can assist you when there is a possibility of
your vehicle colliding with a vehicle or a
pedestrian detected in front of yours. The
CMBSTM is designed to alert you when a
potential collision is determined, as well as
to reduce your vehicle speed to help
minimize collision severity when a collision is
deemed unavoidable.
Adaptive Cruise Control
(ACC) (P 473)
Helps maintain a constant vehicle speed and
a set following interval behind a vehicle
detected ahead of yours, without you
having to keep your foot on the brake or
the accelerator.
Radar Sensor
The radar sensor is in
the front grille.
26
Lane Keeping Assist
System (LKAS) (P 486)
Provides steering input to help keep the
vehicle in the middle of a detected lane and
provides tactile and visual alerts if the
vehicle is detected drifting out of its lane.
Road Departure
Mitigation (RDM) System
(P 495)
Alerts and helps to assist you when the
system detects a possibility of your vehicle
unintentionally crossing over detected lane
markings and/or leaving the roadway
altogether.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
27 ページ
Maintenance
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
(P517)
a
Pull the hood release handle under the corner of the
dashboard.
b
Locate the hood latch lever, push it to the side, and then
raise the hood. Once you have raised the hood slightly,
you can release the lever.
c
When finished, close the hood and make sure it is firmly
locked in place.
Quick Reference Guide
Under the Hood (P529)
● Check engine oil, engine coolant, and window washer fluid.
Add when necessary.
● Check brake fluid.
● Check the battery condition monthly.
Wiper Blades (P551)
● Replace blades if they leave streaks
across the windshield.
Tires (P555)
Lights (P541)
● Inspect tires and wheels regularly.
● Check tire pressures regularly.
● Install snow tires for winter driving.
● Inspect all lights regularly.
* Not available on all models
27
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
28 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Handling the Unexpected
Quick Reference Guide
Flat Tire (P582)
Engine Won’t Start (P591) Overheating (P597)
● Park in a safe location and replace the
flat tire with the compact spare tire in the
cargo area.
● If the battery is dead, jump start using a
booster battery.
● Park in a safe location. If you do not see
steam under the hood, open the hood,
and let the engine cool down.
Indicators Come On
Blown Fuse (P604)
Emergency Towing
(P599)
● Check for a blown fuse if an electrical
device does not operate.
(P609)
● Identify the indicator and consult the
owner’s manual.
28
(P579)
● Call a professional towing service if you
need to tow your vehicle.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
29 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
What to Do If
Canadian models with smart entry
system
The power mode does not
change from VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) to ACCESSORY.
Why?
Models without smart entry system
• The steering wheel may be locked.
Models without smart entry system
• Try to turn the steering wheel left and
right while turning the ignition key.
Models with smart entry system
• Move the steering wheel left and right
after pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button.
Quick Reference Guide
Models without smart entry system
The ignition switch does
not turn from (0 to (q .
Why?
The shift lever should be moved to (P .
The ignition switch does
not turn from (q to (0 and
I cannot remove the key.
Why?
Models with smart entry system
The power mode does not
change from ACCESSORY
to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
Why?
29
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
30 ページ
2019年8月8日
Quick Reference Guide
Why does the brake pedal
pulsate slightly when
applying the brakes?
木曜日
午後3時52分
This can occur when the ABS activates and does not indicate a
problem. Apply firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. Never
pump the brake pedal.
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) (P508)
The rear door cannot be
opened from inside the
vehicle. Why?
Check if the childproof lock is in the lock
position. If so, open the rear door with the
outside door handle.
To cancel this function, push the lever to
the unlock position.
Why do the doors lock
after I unlocked the doors?
If you do not open the doors within 30 seconds, the doors are
relocked automatically for security.
Why does the beeper
sound when I open the
driver’s door?
The beeper sounds when:
• The exterior lights are left on.
Models without smart entry system
• The key is left in the ignition switch.
Models with smart entry system
• The power mode is in ACCESSORY.
30
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
31 ページ
2019年8月8日
Models with smart entry system
午後3時52分
The beeper sounds if you move outside the walk away auto lock
operating range before the door completely closes.
2 Locking the doors and tailgate (Walk away auto lock®) (P142)
Why does the beeper
sound when I start driving?
The beeper sounds when the driver and/or front passenger are
not wearing their seat belts.
Why do I hear a screeching
sound when I apply the
brake pedal?
The brake pads may need to be replaced. Have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
Pressing the electric
parking brake switch does
not release the parking
brake. Why?
Press the electric parking brake switch with the brake pedal
depressed.
Depressing the accelerator
pedal does not release the
parking brake
automatically. Why?
• Fasten the driver’s seat belt.
• Check if the transmission is in (P or (N . If so, select any other
Quick Reference Guide
Why does a beeper sound
when I walk away from the
vehicle after I close the
door?
木曜日
position.
31
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
32 ページ
2019年8月8日
U.S. models only
Quick Reference Guide
32
I’m seeing an amber
indicator of a tire with an
exclamation point. What is
that?
木曜日
午後3時52分
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) needs attention. If
you recently inflated or changed a tire, you have to recalibrate
the system.
2 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (P455)
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
33 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Safe Driving
You can find many safety recommendations throughout this chapter, and throughout this manual.
For Safe Driving
Important Safety Precautions.............. 34
Important Handling Information......... 36
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features............ 37
Safety Checklist ................................. 38
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts ........................ 40
Fastening a Seat Belt .......................... 44
Seat Belt Inspection............................ 49
Airbags
Airbag System Components ............... 50
Types of Airbags ................................ 53
Front Airbags (SRS) ............................ 53
Side Airbags....................................... 57
Side Curtain Airbags .......................... 59
Airbag System Indicators.................... 61
Airbag Care ....................................... 63
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers ............... 64
Safety of Infants and Small Children... 66
Safety of Larger Children ................... 75
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas ....................... 77
Safety Labels
Label Locations .................................. 78
33
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
34 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
For Safe Driving
The following pages explain your vehicle’s safety features and how to use them
properly. The safety precautions below are ones that we consider to be among the
most important.
Safe Driving
Important Safety Precautions
■ Always wear your seat belt
A seat belt is your best protection in all types of collisions. Airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. So even though your vehicle is equipped
with airbags, make sure you and your passengers always wear your seat belts, and
wear them properly.
■ Restrain all children
Children ages 12 and under should ride properly restrained in a back seat, not the
front seat. Infants and small children should be restrained in a child seat. Larger
children should use a booster seat and a lap/shoulder seat belt until they can use the
belt properly without a booster seat.
■ Be aware of airbag hazards
While airbags can save lives, they can cause serious or fatal injuries to occupants
who sit too close to them, or are not properly restrained. Infants, young children,
and short adults are at the greatest risk. Be sure to follow all instructions and
warnings in this manual.
■ Don’t drink and drive
Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Even one drink can reduce your ability to respond to
changing conditions, and your reaction time gets worse with every additional drink.
So don’t drink and drive, and don’t let your friends drink and drive, either.
34
1Important Safety Precautions
Some states, provinces and territories prohibit the use
of cell phones other than hands-free devices by the
driver while driving.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
35 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuFor Safe DrivinguImportant Safety Precautions
■ Control your speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in crash injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher
the speed, the greater the risk, but serious injuries can also occur at lower speeds.
Never drive faster than is safe for current conditions, regardless of the maximum
speed posted.
Safe Driving
■ Pay appropriate attention to the task of driving safely
Engaging in cell phone conversation or other activities that keep you from paying
close attention to the road, other vehicles, and pedestrians could lead to a crash.
Remember, situations can change quickly, and only you can decide when it is safe to
divert some attention away from driving.
■ Keep your vehicle in safe condition
Having a tire blowout or a mechanical failure can be extremely hazardous.
To reduce the possibility of such problems, check your tire pressures and condition
frequently, and perform all regularly scheduled maintenance.
■ Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle
Children, pets and people needing assistance left unattended in the vehicle may be
injured if they activate one or more of the vehicle controls. They may also cause the
vehicle to move, resulting in a crash in which they and/or another person(s) can be
injured or killed. Also, depending on the ambient temperature, the temperature of
the interior may reach extreme levels, which can result in harm or death. Even if the
heating and cooling system */climate control system * is on, never leave them in the
vehicle unattended as the heating and cooling system */climate control system * can
shut off at any time.
* Not available on all models
35
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
36 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuFor Safe DrivinguImportant Handling Information
Important Handling Information
Safe Driving
36
Your vehicle has higher ground clearance than a passenger vehicle designed for use
only on pavement. Higher ground clearance has many advantages for off-highway
driving. It allows you to travel over bumps, obstacles, and rough terrain. It also
provides good visibility so you can anticipate problems earlier.
These advantages come at some cost. Because your vehicle is taller and rides higher
off the ground, it has a higher center gravity making it more susceptible to tipping
or roll over if you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles have a significantly higher
rollover rate than other types of vehicles. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt. As a reminder,
make sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts.
1Important Handling Information
For information on how to reduce the risk of rollover,
read:
2 Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
P. 438
2 Off-Highway Driving Guidelines P. 430
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
37 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuFor Safe DrivinguYour Vehicle’s Safety Features
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
1Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
9
8
6
10
7
8
10
11
7
6
7
8
9
10
11
Safety Cage
Crush Zones
Seats and Seat-Backs
Head Restraints
Collapsible Steering Column
Seat Belts
Front Airbags
Side Airbags
Side Curtain Airbags
Door Locks
Seat Belt Tensioners
Some features do not require any action on your part.
These include a strong steel framework that forms a
safety cage around the passenger compartment,
front and rear crush zones, a collapsible steering
column, and tensioners that tighten the front seat
belts in a sufficient crash.
Safe Driving
Your vehicle is equipped with many features that
work together to help protect you and your
passengers during a crash.
9
However, you and your passengers cannot take full
advantage of these features unless you remain seated
in the correct position and always wear your seat
belts. In fact, some safety features can contribute to
injuries if they are not used properly.
The following checklist will help you take an active role in protecting yourself and
your passengers.
37
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
38 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuFor Safe DrivinguSafety Checklist
Safety Checklist
Safe Driving
For the safety of you and your passengers, make a habit of checking these items
each time before you drive.
• After everyone has entered the vehicle, be sure all doors and the tailgate are
closed and locked. Locking the doors and the tailgate helps prevent an occupant
from being ejected and an outsider from unexpectedly opening a door or the
tailgate.
2 Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside P. 148
• Adjust your seat to a position suitable for driving. Be sure the front seats are
adjusted as far to the rear as possible while allowing the driver to control the
vehicle. Sitting too close to a front airbag can result in serious or fatal injury in a
crash.
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 190
• Adjust head restraints to the proper position. Head restraints are most effective
when the center of the head restraint aligns with the center of your head. Taller
persons should adjust their head restraint to the highest position.
2 Adjusting the front head restraint positions P. 197
• Always wear your seat belt, and make sure you wear it properly. Confirm that any
passengers are properly belted as well.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 44
• Protect children by using seat belts or child seats according to a child’s age, height
and weight.
2 Child Safety P. 64
38
* Not available on all models
1Safety Checklist
Models with information display
If the door and tailgate open indicator is on, a door
and/or the tailgate is not completely closed. Close all
doors and the tailgate tightly until the indicator goes
off.
2 Door and Tailgate Open Indicator * P. 89
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
39 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuFor Safe DrivinguSafety Checklist
1Safety Checklist
Models with multi-information display
* Not available on all models
Safe Driving
If the door and/or tailgate open message appears on
the multi-information display, a door and/or the
tailgate is not completely closed. Close all doors and
the tailgate tightly until the message disappears.
2 Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages * P. 100
39
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
40 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts
Safe Driving
Seat belts are the single most effective safety device because they keep you
connected to the vehicle so that you can take advantage of many built-in safety
features. They also help keep you from being thrown against the inside of the
vehicle, against any passengers, or out of the vehicle. When worn properly, seat
belts also keep your body properly positioned in a crash so that you can take full
advantage of the additional protection provided by the airbags.
In addition, seat belts help protect you in almost every type of crash, including:
- frontal impacts
- side impacts
- rear impacts
- rollovers
■ Lap/shoulder seat belts
All five seating positions are equipped with lap/shoulder seat belts with emergency
locking retractors. In normal driving the retractor lets you move freely while keeping
some tension on the belt. During a collision or sudden stop the retractor locks to
restrain your body. The front passenger’s and rear seat belts also have a lockable
retractor for use with child seats.
2 Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt P. 71
40
1About Your Seat Belts
3 WARNING
Not wearing a seat belt properly increases
the chance of serious injury or death in a
crash, even though your vehicle has
airbags.
Be sure you and your passengers always
wear seat belts and wear them properly.
Seat belts cannot completely protect you in every
crash. But in most cases, seat belts can reduce your
risk of serious injury.
Most states and all Canadian provinces and territories
require you to wear seat belts.
If you extend the seat belt too quickly, it will lock in
place. If this happens, slightly retract the seat belt,
then extend it slowly.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
41 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
Continued
1About Your Seat Belts
If a rear seat passenger moves around and extends
the seat belt, the lockable retractor may activate. If
this happens, release the retractor by unfastening the
seat belt and allow the belt to retract completely.
Then refasten the belt.
Safe Driving
■ Proper use of seat belts
Follow these guidelines for proper use:
• All occupants should sit upright, well back in the seat, and remain in that position
for the duration of the trip. Slouching and leaning reduce the effectiveness of the
belt and can increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
• Never place the shoulder part of a lap/shoulder seat belt under your arm or
behind your back. This could cause very serious injuries in a crash.
• Two people should never use the same seat belt. If they do, they could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
• Do not put any accessories on the seat belts. Devices intended to improve comfort
or reposition the shoulder part of a seat belt can reduce the protective capability
and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
41
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
42 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
■ Seat Belt Reminder
Models with information display
Safe Driving
Models with multi-information
display
1Seat Belt Reminder
The seat belt system includes an indicator on
the instrument panel to remind the driver or a
front passenger or both to fasten their seat
belts.
If the ignition switch is turned to ON (w *1 and
a seat belt is not fastened, a beeper will sound
and the indicator will blink. After a few
seconds, the beeper will stop and the
indicator will come on and remain illuminated
until the seat belt is fastened.
The beeper will periodically sound and the
indicator will blink while the vehicle is moving
until the seat belt is fastened.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
42
The indicator will also come on if a front passenger
does not fasten their seat belt within six seconds after
the ignition switch is turned to ON (w *1.
When no one is sitting in the front passenger’s seat,
the indicator will not come on and the beeper will not
sound.
The indicator also may not come on and the beeper
may not sound when the occupant is not heavy
enough to trigger the weight sensor. Such occupants
(e.g., infants and smaller children) should be moved
to the rear seat as a deploying front airbag likely will
injure or kill them.
2 Protecting Child Passengers P. 64
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
43 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
■ Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
The front seats are equipped with automatic seat belt tensioners to enhance safety.
The seat belt tensioners can only operate once.
If a tensioner is activated, the SRS indicator will come
on. Have a dealer replace the tensioner and
thoroughly inspect the seat belt system as it may not
offer protection in a subsequent crash.
During a moderate-to-severe side impact, the
tensioner on that side of the vehicle also activates.
Safe Driving
The tensioners automatically tighten the front seat belts during a moderate-tosevere frontal collision, sometimes even if the collision is not severe enough to
inflate the front airbags.
1Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
43
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
44 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
Fastening a Seat Belt
After adjusting a front seat to the proper position, and while sitting upright and well
back in the seat:
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 190
Safe Driving
Pull out slowly.
Correct
Seated
Posture.
Buckle
No one should sit in a seat with an inoperative seat
belt or one that does not appear to be working
correctly. Using a seat belt that is not working
properly may not protect the occupant in a crash.
Have a dealer check the belt as soon as possible.
Never insert any foreign objects into the buckle or
retractor mechanism.
2. Insert the latch plate into the buckle, then
tug on the belt to make sure the buckle is
secure.
u Make sure that the belt is not twisted or
caught on anything.
Latch
Plate
44
1. Pull the seat belt out slowly.
1Fastening a Seat Belt
If the seat belt appears to be locked in a fully
retracted position, firmly pull out on the shoulder belt
once, then push it back in.
Then smoothly pull it out of the retractor and fasten.
If you are unable to release the seat belt from a fully
retracted position, do not allow anyone to sit in the
seat, and take your vehicle to a dealer for repair.
2 About Your Seat Belts P. 40
2 Seat Belt Inspection P. 49
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
45 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
Continued
1Fastening a Seat Belt
3 WARNING
Improperly positioning the seat belts can
cause serious injury or death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts are properly
positioned before driving.
Safe Driving
Lap belt
as low as
possible
3. Position the lap part of the belt as low as
possible across your hips, then pull up on
the shoulder part of the belt so the lap part
fits snugly. This lets your strong pelvic
bones take the force of a crash and reduces
the chance of internal injuries.
4. If necessary, pull up on the belt again to
remove any slack, then check that the belt
rests across the center of your chest and
over your shoulder. This spreads the forces
of a crash over the strongest bones in your
upper body.
To release the belt, push the red PRESS button and
then guide the belt by hand until it has retracted
completely.
When exiting the vehicle, be sure the belt is properly
stowed so that it will not get caught in the closing
door.
45
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
46 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
Safe Driving
The front seats have adjustable shoulder anchors to accommodate taller and shorter
occupants.
1. Move the anchor up and down while
pulling the shoulder anchor outward.
2. Position the anchor so that the belt rests
across the center of your chest and over
your shoulder.
Pull outward
46
1Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
The shoulder anchor height can be adjusted to four
levels. If the belt contacts your neck, lower the height
one level at a time.
After an adjustment, make sure that the shoulder
anchor position is secure.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
47 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor
1Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor
3 WARNING
Using the seat belt with the detachable
anchor unlatched increases the chance of
serious injury or death in a crash.
Before using the seat belt, make sure the
detachable anchor is correctly latched.
Small Latch Plate
2. Line up the triangle marks on the small
latch plate and anchor buckle. Make sure
the seat belt is not twisted. Attach the belt
to the anchor buckle.
Safe Driving
1. Pull out the seat belt’s small latch plate and
the latch plate from each holding slot in the
ceiling.
Latch Plate
To unlatch the detachable anchor, insert the latch
plate into the slot on the side of the anchor buckle.
Anchor
Buckle
Latch Plate
3. Insert the latch plate into the buckle.
Properly fasten the seat belt the same way
you fasten the lap/shoulder seat belt.
Anchor
Buckle
Latch Plate
Buckle
Continued
47
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
48 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Advice for Pregnant Women
Safe Driving
If you are pregnant, the best way to protect yourself and your unborn child when
driving or riding in a vehicle is to always wear a seat belt and keep the lap part of the
belt as low as possible across the hips.
Wear the shoulder belt
across the chest avoiding
the abdomen.
Wear the lap part of the
belt as low as possible
across the hips.
48
1Advice for Pregnant Women
Each time you have a checkup, ask your doctor if it is
okay for you to drive.
To reduce the risk of injuries to both you and your
unborn child that can be caused by an inflating front
airbag:
• When driving, sit upright and adjust the seat as far
back as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle.
• When sitting in the front passenger’s seat, adjust
the seat as far back as possible.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
49 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSeat BeltsuSeat Belt Inspection
Seat Belt Inspection
Regularly check the condition of your seat belts as follows:
3 WARNING
Not checking or maintaining seat belts can
result in serious injury or death if the seat
belts do not work properly when needed.
Check your seat belts regularly and have
any problem corrected as soon as possible.
Safe Driving
• Pull each belt out fully, and look for frays, cuts, burns, and wear.
• Check that the latch plates and buckles work smoothly and the belts retract
easily.
u If a belt does not retract easily, cleaning the belt may correct the problem. Only
use a mild soap and warm water. Do not use bleach or cleaning solvents. Make
sure the belt is completely dry before allowing it to retract.
1Seat Belt Inspection
Any belt that is not in good condition or working properly will not provide proper
protection and should be replaced as soon as possible.
A belt that has been worn during a crash may not provide the same level of
protection in a subsequent crash. Have your seat belts inspected by a dealer after
any collision.
49
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
50 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Airbags
Airbag System Components
Safe Driving
8
10
8
7
12
9
6
8
8
8
11
8
50
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
51 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Components
a Two SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
front airbags. The driver’s airbag is stored
in the center of the steering wheel; the
front passenger’s airbag is stored in the
dashboard. Both are marked SRS
AIRBAG.
b Two
side airbags, one for the driver and
one for a front passenger. The airbags are
stored in the outer edges of the seatbacks. Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
side curtain airbags, one for each
side of the vehicle. The airbags are stored
in the ceiling, above the side windows.
The front and rear pillars are marked
SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG.
d An
electronic control unit that, when the
vehicle is on, continually monitors
information about the various impact
sensors, seat and buckle sensors, rollover
sensor, airbag activators, seat belt
tensioners, and other vehicle
information. During a crash event the
unit can record such information.
e Automatic
front seat belt tensioners. In
addition, the driver’s and front
passenger’s seat belt buckles incorporate
sensors that detect whether or not the
belts are fastened.
fA
driver’s seat position sensor. This
sensor determines the optimal force at
which the airbag will deploy in a crash.
h Impact
sensors that can detect a
moderate-to-severe front or side impact.
i An
indicator near the shift lever that
alerts you that the front passenger’s front
airbag has been turned off.
j An indicator on the instrument panel that
Safe Driving
The front, front side, and side curtain
airbags are deployed according to the
direction and severity of impact. Both side
curtain airbags are deployed in a rollover.
The airbag system includes:
alerts you to a possible problem with your
airbag system or seat belt tensioners.
k Safing
Sensor
lA
rollover sensor that detects if your
vehicle is about to roll over and signal the
control unit to deploy both side curtain
airbags.
c Two
g Weight
sensors in the front passenger’s
seat. The front passenger’s airbag will be
turned off if the weight on the seat is
approximately 65 lbs (29 kg) or less (the
weight of an infant or small child).
Continued
51
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
52 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Components
■ Important Facts About Your Airbags
Safe Driving
Airbags can pose serious hazards. To do their job, airbags must inflate with
tremendous force. So, while airbags help save lives, they can cause burns, bruises,
and other minor injuries, sometimes even fatal ones if occupants are not wearing
their seat belts properly and sitting correctly.
What you should do: Always wear your seat belt properly, and sit upright and as
far back from the steering wheel as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle. A front passenger should move their seat as far back from the dashboard as
possible.
Remember, however, that no safety system can prevent all injuries or deaths that
can occur in a severe crash, even when seat belts are properly worn and the airbags
deploy.
Do not place hard or sharp objects between yourself and a front airbag.
Carrying hard or sharp objects on your lap, or driving with a pipe or other sharp
object in your mouth, can result in injuries if your front airbag inflates.
Do not attach or place objects on the front airbag covers. Objects on the
covers marked SRS AIRBAG could interfere with the proper operation of the airbags
or be propelled inside the vehicle and hurt someone if the airbags inflate.
52
1Important Facts About Your Airbags
Do not attempt to deactivate your airbags. Together,
airbags and seat belts provide the best protection.
When driving, keep hands and arms out of the
deployment path of the front airbag by holding each
side of the steering wheel. Do not cross an arm over
the airbag cover.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
53 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuTypes of Airbags
Types of Airbags
1Types of Airbags
The airbags can inflate whenever the ignition switch
is in ON (w *1.
After an airbag inflates in a crash, you may see a
small amount of smoke. This is from the combustion
process of the inflator material and is not harmful.
People with respiratory problems may experience
some temporary discomfort. If this occurs, get out of
the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so.
Safe Driving
Your vehicle is equipped with three types of airbags:
• Front airbags: Airbags in front of the driver’s and front passenger’s seats.
• Side airbags: Airbags in the driver’s and front passenger’s seat-backs.
• Side curtain airbags: Airbags above the side windows.
Each is discussed in the following pages.
Front Airbags (SRS)
The front SRS airbags inflate in a moderate-to-severe frontal collision to help protect
the head and chest of the driver and/or front passenger.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) indicates that the airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. Seat belts are the occupant’s primary
restraint system.
■ Housing Locations
1Front Airbags (SRS)
During a frontal crash severe enough to cause one or
both front airbags to deploy, the airbags can inflate
at different rates, depending on the severity of the
crash, whether or not the seat belts are latched, and/
or other factors. Frontal airbags are designed to
supplement the seat belts to help reduce the
likelihood of head and chest injuries in frontal
crashes.
The front airbags are housed in the center of the steering wheel for the driver, and
in the dashboard for the front passenger. Both airbags are marked SRS AIRBAG.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
53
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
54 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ Operation
Safe Driving
Front airbags are designed to inflate during moderate-to-severe frontal collisions.
When the vehicle decelerates suddenly, the sensors send information to the control
unit which signals one or both front airbags to inflate.
A frontal collision can be either head-on or angled between two vehicles, or when a
vehicle crashes into a stationary object, such as a concrete wall.
■ How the Front Airbags Work
While your seat belt restrains your torso, the
front airbag provides supplemental protection
for your head and chest.
The front airbags deflate immediately so that
they won’t interfere with the driver’s visibility
or the ability to steer or operate other
controls.
The total time for inflation and deflation is so fast that most occupants are not
aware that the airbags deployed until they see them lying in front of them.
54
1How the Front Airbags Work
Although the driver’s and front passenger’s airbags
normally inflate within a split second of each other, it
is possible for only one airbag to deploy. This can
happen if the severity of a collision is at the margin,
or threshold, that determines whether or not the
airbags will deploy. In such cases, the seat belt will
provide sufficient protection, and the supplemental
protection offered by the airbag would be minimal.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
55 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
Continued
Safe Driving
■ When front airbags should not deploy
Minor frontal crashes: Front airbags were designed to supplement seat belts and
help save lives, not to prevent minor scrapes, or even broken bones that might occur
during a less than moderate-to-severe frontal crash.
Side impacts: Front airbags can provide protection when a sudden deceleration
causes a driver or front passenger to move toward the front of the vehicle. Side
airbags and side curtain airbags have been specifically designed to help reduce the
severity of injuries that can occur during a moderate-to-severe side impact which
can cause the driver or passenger to move toward the side of the vehicle.
Rear impacts: Head restraints and seat belts are your best protection during a rear
impact. Front airbags cannot provide any significant protection and are not designed
to deploy in such collisions.
Rollovers: In a rollover, your best form of protection is a seat belt or, if your vehicle
is equipped with a rollover sensor, both a seat belt and a side curtain airbag. Front
airbags, however, are not designed to deploy in a rollover as they would provide
little if any protection.
■ When front airbags deploy with little or no visible damage
Because the airbag system senses sudden deceleration, a strong impact to the
vehicle framework or suspension might cause one or more of the airbags to deploy.
Examples include running into a curb, the edge of a hole, or other low fixed object
that causes a sudden deceleration in the vehicle chassis. Since the impact is
underneath the vehicle, damage may not be readily apparent.
■ When front airbags may not deploy, even though exterior damage
appears severe
Since crushable body parts absorb crash energy during an impact, the amount of
visible damage does not always indicate proper airbag operation. In fact, some
collisions can result in severe damage but no airbag deployment because the airbags
would not have been needed or would not have provided protection even if they
had deployed.
55
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
56 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ Advanced Airbags
1Advanced Airbags
Safe Driving
The airbags have advanced features to help reduce the likelihood of airbag related
injuries to smaller occupants.
The driver’s advanced airbag system includes a
seat position sensor.
If there is a problem with the driver’s seat position
sensor, the SRS indicator will come on, and in the
event of a crash, the airbag will deploy (regardless of
the driver’s seating position) with a force
corresponding to the severity of the impact.
Based on information from this sensor and the
severity of the impact, the advanced airbag
system determines the optimal deployment of
the driver’s airbag.
• Do not spill any liquid on or under the seats.
• Do not put any object under the passenger’s seat.
• Make sure any objects are positioned properly on
Driver’s
Seat
Position
Sensor
The front passenger’s advanced airbag system
has weight sensors.
Passenger’s
Seat Weight
Sensors
56
We advise against allowing a child age 12 or
under to ride in the front passenger’s seat.
However, if you do allow a child age 12 or
under to ride in the front passenger’s
seat, note that the system will automatically
turn off the front passenger’s airbag if the
sensors detect that the child is approximately
65 lbs (29 kg) or less.
For the advanced airbags to work properly:
the floor. Improperly positioned objects can
interfere with the advanced airbag sensors.
• All occupants should sit upright and wear their seat
belts properly.
• Do not cover the passenger’s side dashboard with
a cloth, towel, cover, etc.
2 Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator
P. 62
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
57 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
Side Airbags
The side airbags help protect the torso and pelvis of the driver or a front passenger
during a moderate-to-severe side impact.
The side airbags are housed in the outside
edge of the driver’s and passenger’s seatbacks.
Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
Make sure you and your front seat passenger always
sit upright. Leaning into the path of a side airbag can
prevent the airbag from deploying properly and
increases your risk of serious injury.
Do not attach accessories on or near the side airbags.
They can interfere with the proper operation of the
airbags, or hurt someone if an airbag inflates.
Safe Driving
■ Housing Locations
1Side Airbags
Do not cover or replace the front seat-back covers
without consulting a dealer.
Improperly replacing or covering front seat-back
covers can prevent your side airbags from properly
deploying during a side impact.
Housing Location
■ Operation
When
inflated
When the sensors detect a moderate-tosevere side impact, the control unit signals the
side airbag on the impact side to immediately
inflate.
Side Airbag
Continued
57
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
58 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
■ When a side airbag deploys with little or no visible damage
Safe Driving
58
Because the airbag system senses sudden acceleration, a strong impact to the side
of the vehicle’s framework can cause a side airbag to deploy. In such cases, there
may be little or no damage, but the side impact sensors detected a severe enough
impact to deploy the airbag.
■ When a side airbag may not deploy, even though visible damage appears
severe
It is possible for a side airbag not to deploy during an impact that results in
apparently severe damage. This can occur when the point of impact was toward the
far front or rear of the vehicle, or when the vehicle’s crushable body parts absorbed
most of the crash energy. In either case, the side airbag would not have been
needed nor provided protection even if it had deployed.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
59 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuSide Curtain Airbags
Side Curtain Airbags
■ Housing Locations
The side curtain airbags are located in the
ceiling above the side windows on both sides
of the vehicle.
1Side Curtain Airbags
If the SRS control unit senses that your vehicle is
about to rollover, it immediately deploys both side
curtain airbags and activates both front seat belt
tensioners.
If the impact is on the passenger’s side, the
passenger’s side curtain airbag deploys even if there
are no occupants on that side of the vehicle.
Safe Driving
The side curtain airbags help protect the heads of the driver and passengers in the
outer seating positions during a moderate-to-severe side impact. The side curtain
airbags equipped in this vehicle are also designed to help reduce the likelihood of
partial and complete ejection of vehicle occupants through side windows in crashes,
particularly rollover crashes.
To get the best protection from the side curtain
airbags, occupants should wear their seat belts
properly and sit upright and well back in their seats.
Do not attach any objects to the side windows or roof
pillars as they can interfere with the proper operation
of the side curtain airbags.
Side Curtain Airbag Storage
■ Operation
The side curtain airbag is designed to deploy
in a rollover or a moderate-to-severe side
impact.
Deployed Side Curtain Airbag
Continued
59
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
60 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuSide Curtain Airbags
■ When side curtain airbags deploy in a frontal collision
One or both side curtain airbags may also inflate in a moderate-to-severe angled
frontal collision.
Safe Driving
60
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
61 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
Airbag System Indicators
If a problem occurs in the airbag system, the SRS indicator will come on and a
message appears on the multi-information display *.
Models with information display
■ When the ignition switch is turned to
ON (w *1
The indicator comes on for a few seconds,
then goes off. This tells you the system is
working properly.
Models with multi-information display
3 WARNING
Ignoring the SRS indicator can result in
serious injury or death if the airbag systems
or tensioners do not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer as
soon as possible if the SRS indicator alerts
you to a possible problem.
Safe Driving
■ Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator
1Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator
If the indicator comes on at any other time, or
does not come on at all, have the system
checked by a dealer as soon as possible. If you
don’t, your airbags and seat belt tensioners
may not work properly when they are needed.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
61
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
62 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
■ Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator
■ When the passenger front airbag off
Safe Driving
indicator comes on
The indicator comes on to alert you that the
passenger’s front airbag has been turned off.
This occurs when the weight sensors detect
about 65 lbs (29 kg) or less, the weight of an
infant or small child, on the seat.
U.S. models
1Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator
If the indicator comes on with no front passenger and
no objects on the passenger’s seat, or with an adult
riding there, something may be interfering with the
weight sensors, such as:
• An object hanging on the seat or in the seat-back
pocket.
• A child seat or other object pressing against the
rear of the seat-back.
• A rear passenger pushing or pulling on the back of
the front passenger’s seat.
• The front seat or seat-back is forced back against
an object on the seat or floor behind it.
• An object placed under the front passenger’s seat.
If none of these conditions exist, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
Canadian models
Children age 12 or under should always ride properly restrained in a back seat.
2 Child Safety P. 64
Objects placed on the seat can also cause the indicator to come on.
If the front passenger’s seat is empty, the passenger’s front airbag will not deploy
and the indicator will not come on.
62
The passenger front airbag off indicator may come
on and go off repeatedly if the total weight on the
seat is near the airbag cutoff threshold.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
63 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAirbagsuAirbag Care
Airbag Care
You do not need to, and should not, perform any maintenance on or replace any
airbag system components yourself. However, you should have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer in the following situations:
We recommend against the use of salvaged airbag
system components, including the airbag, tensioners,
sensors, and control unit.
Safe Driving
■ When the airbags have deployed
If an airbag has inflated, the control unit and other related parts must be replaced.
Similarly, once an automatic seat belt tensioner has been activated, it must be
replaced.
1Airbag Care
■ When the vehicle has been in a moderate-to-severe collision
Even if the airbags did not inflate, have your dealer inspect the following: the driver’s
seat position sensor, weight sensors in the passenger’s seat, front seat belt
tensioners, and each seat belt that was worn during the crash.
■ Do not remove or modify a front seat without consulting a dealer
This would likely disable or affect the proper operation of the driver’s seat position
sensor or the weight sensors in the passenger’s seat. If it is necessary to remove or
modify a front seat to accommodate a person with disabilities, contact a Honda
dealer, or for U.S. vehicles, American Honda Automobile Customer Service at 1-800999-1009 and for Canadian vehicles, Honda Canada Customer Relations at 1-8889-HONDA-9.
63
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
64 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers
Each year, many children are injured or killed in vehicle crashes because they are
either unrestrained or not properly restrained. In fact, vehicle crashes are the
number one cause of death of children ages 12 and under.
Safe Driving
To reduce the number of child deaths and injuries, every state, Canadian province
and territory requires that infants and children be properly restrained when they ride
in a vehicle.
Children should sit properly restrained in a rear seat. This is because:
• An inflating front or side airbag can injure
or kill a child sitting in the front seat.
• A child in the front seat is more likely to
interfere with the driver’s ability to safely
control the vehicle.
• Statistics show that children of all sizes and
ages are safer when they are properly
restrained in a rear seat.
64
1Protecting Child Passengers
3 WARNING
Children who are unrestrained or
improperly restrained can be seriously
injured or killed in a crash.
Any child too small for a seat belt should be
properly restrained in a child seat. A larger
child should be properly restrained with a
seat belt, using a booster seat if necessary.
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
and Transport Canada recommend that all children
ages 12 and under be properly restrained in a rear
seat. Some states or provinces/territories have laws
restricting where children may ride.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
65 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuProtecting Child Passengers
• Any child who is too small to wear a seat belt correctly must be restrained in an
approved child seat that is properly secured to the vehicle using either the seat
belt or the lower anchors of the LATCH system.
• Never put a seat belt over yourself and a child. During a crash, the belt would
likely press deep into the child and cause serious or fatal injuries.
• Never let two children use the same seat belt. Both children could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
• Do not allow children to operate the doors, windows or seat adjustments.
• Do not leave children in the vehicle unattended, especially in hot weather when
the inside of the vehicle can get hot enough to kill them. They could also activate
vehicle controls causing it to move unexpectedly.
3 WARNING
Allowing a child to play with a seat belt or
wrap one around their neck can result in
serious injury or death.
Instruct children not to play with any seat
belt and make sure any unused seat belt a
child can reach is buckled, fully retracted,
and locked.
Safe Driving
• Never hold a child on your lap because it is impossible to protect them in the
event of a collision.
1Protecting Child Passengers
To deactivate a lockable retractor, release the buckle
and allow the seat belt to wind up all the way.
To remind you of the passenger’s front airbag
hazards and child safety, your vehicle has warning
labels on the dashboard (U.S. models) and on the
front visors. Please read and follow the instructions
on these labels.
2 Safety Labels P. 78
65
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
66 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safety of Infants and Small Children
■ Protecting Infants
Safe Driving
An infant must be properly restrained in a rear-facing, reclining child seat until the
infant reaches the seat manufacturer’s weight or height limit for the seat, and the
infant is at least one year old.
■ Positioning a rear-facing child seat
Child seats must be placed and secured in a
rear seating position.
1Protecting Infants
3 WARNING
Placing a rear-facing child seat in the front
seat can result in serious injury or death
during a crash.
Always place a rear-facing child seat in the
rear seat, not the front.
Rear-facing child seats should never be installed in a
forward-facing position.
Always refer to the child seat manufacturer’s
instructions before installation.
When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent the driver or a front
passenger from moving their seat all the way back, or from locking their seat-back
in the desired position. Make sure that there is no contact between the child seat
and the seat in front of it.
It can also interfere with proper operation of the passenger’s advanced front airbag
system.
2 Airbags P. 50
If this occurs, we recommend that you install the child seat directly behind the front
passenger’s seat, move the seat as far forward as needed, and leave it unoccupied.
Or, you may wish to get a smaller rear-facing child seat.
66
Do not allow a front seat to rest against a child seat
installed in a rear seating position:
The weight sensor in the front seat may not correctly
detect the actual weight of the occupant.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
67 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Protecting Smaller Children
1Protecting Smaller Children
3 WARNING
Placing a forward-facing child seat in the
front seat can result in serious injury or
death if the front airbag inflates.
If you must place a forward-facing child
seat in front, move the vehicle seat as far
back as possible, and properly restrain the
child.
Safe Driving
If a child is at least one year old and has exceeded the weight and height limitations
of a rearward-facing child seat, the child should be properly restrained in a firmly
secured forward-facing child seat until they exceed the weight and height
limitations for the forward-facing child seat.
■ Forward-facing child seat placement
We strongly recommend placing a forwardfacing child seat in a rear seating position.
Educate yourself about the laws and regulations
regarding child seat use where you are driving, and
follow the child seat manufacturer’s instructions.
Placing a forward-facing child seat in the front seat can be hazardous, even with
advanced front airbags that automatically turn the passenger’s front airbag off. A
rear seat is the safest place for a child.
Continued
Many experts recommend use of a rear-facing seat
for a child up to two years old if the child’s height and
weight are appropriate for a rear-facing seat.
67
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
68 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Selecting a Child Seat
Safe Driving
Most child seats are LATCH-compatible (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren).
Some have a rigid-type connector while others have a flexible-type connector. Both
are equally easy to use. Some existing and previously owned child seats can only be
installed using the seat belt. Whichever type you choose, follow the child seat
manufacturer’s use and care instructions including recommended expiration dates
as well as the instructions in this manual. Proper installation is key to maximizing
your child’s safety.
In seating positions and vehicles not equipped with LATCH, a LATCH-compatible
child seat can be installed using the seat belt and a top tether for added security.
This is because all child seats are required to be designed so that they can be secured
with a lap belt or the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt. In addition, the child seat
manufacturer may advise that a seat belt be used to attach a LATCH-compatible seat
once a child reaches a specified weight. Please read the child seat owner’s manual
for proper installation instructions.
■ Important consideration when selecting a child seat
Make sure the child seat meets the following three requirements:
• The child seat is the correct type and size for the child.
• The child seat is the correct type for the seating position.
• The child seat is compliant with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.
68
1Selecting a Child Seat
Installation of a LATCH-compatible child seat is
simple.
LATCH-compatible child seats have been developed
to simplify the installation process and reduce the
likelihood of injuries caused by incorrect installation.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
69 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Installing a LATCH-Compatible Child Seat
1Installing a LATCH-Compatible Child Seat
Rigid Type
3. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat, then
attach the child seat to the lower anchors
according to the instructions that came
with the child seat.
u When installing the child seat, make sure
that the lower anchors are not
obstructed by the seat belt or any other
object.
3 WARNING
Never attach two child seats to the same
anchor. In a collision, one anchor may not
be strong enough to hold two child seat
attachments and may break, causing
serious injury or death.
Safe Driving
A LATCH-compatible child seat can be installed in either of the two outer rear seats.
A child seat is attached to the lower anchors with either the rigid or flexible type of
connectors.
1. Locate the lower anchors under the marks.
Marks
2. Raise the head restraint to its highest
position.
For your child’s safety, when using a child seat
installed using the LATCH system, make sure that the
child seat is properly secured to the vehicle. A child
seat that is not properly secured will not adequately
protect a child in a crash and may cause injury to the
child or other vehicle occupants.
Lower Anchors
Continued
69
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
70 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
1Installing a LATCH-Compatible Child Seat
3 WARNING
Safe Driving
Do not use the lower inner anchors of the
outer rear seats to secure a LATCHcompatible child seat to the rear center
seat, unless the manufacturer’s instructions
for that system permit the use of inner
anchors with the stated spacing.
Flexible Type
4. Remove the cargo cover *.
Anchor
Tether Strap Hook
70
* Not available on all models
2 Cargo Cover P. 210
5. Route the tether strap between the head
restraint legs, and secure the tether strap
hook to the anchor.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
6. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
7. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured by
rocking it forward and back and side to
side; little movement should be felt.
8. Make sure any unused seat belt that a child
can reach is buckled, the lockable retractor
is activated, and the belt is fully retracted
and locked.
9. Reinstall the cargo cover *.
Installing a LATCH-compatible child seat in the
rear center seat
Each outer rear seat is equipped with a pair of lower
anchors which are used to secure a LATCHcompatible child seat. The rear center seat, however,
is not equipped with anchors of any kind.
The inner and outer anchors are spaced apart at a
standard distance of 11 inches (280 mm). The
distance between the two inner anchors is 14.1
inches (357.8 mm).
LATCH-compatible restraint systems that are fitted
with rigid-type attachments cannot be installed in the
rear center seat. However, a system fitted with
flexible-type attachments can be installed in the
center seat, provided that the manufacturer’s
instructions for that system permit the use of the
inner anchors with the stated spacing.
Before seating a child, make sure that the system is
properly attached to both the lower anchors and
tether anchors.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
71 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
1Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
A child seat that is not properly secured will not
adequately protect a child in a crash and may cause
injury to the child or other vehicle occupants.
Safe Driving
A child seat can be installed with a lap/shoulder belt in any rear seat or, if absolutely
necessary, the front passenger seat.
1. Raise the head restraint to its highest
position.
2. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat.
3. Route the seat belt through the child seat
according to the seat manufacturer’s
instructions, and insert the latch plate into
the buckle.
u Insert the latch plate fully until it clicks.
4. Slowly pull the shoulder part of the belt all
the way out until it stops. This activates the
lockable retractor.
5. Let the seat belt completely wind up into
the retractor, then try to pull it out to make
sure the retractor is locked.
u If you are able to pull the shoulder belt
out, the lockable retractor is not
activated. Pull the seat belt all the way
out, and repeat steps 4 – 5.
Continued
71
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
72 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safe Driving
6. Grab the shoulder part of the seat belt near
the buckle, and pull up to remove any slack
from the lap part of the belt.
u When doing this, place your weight on
the child seat and push it into the vehicle
seat.
7. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured by
rocking it forward and back and side to
side; less than one inch of movement
should occur near the seat belt.
8. Make sure any unused seat belt that a child
can reach is buckled, the lockable retractor
is activated, and the belt is fully retracted
and locked.
72
1Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
To deactivate a lockable retractor, release the buckle
and allow the seat belt to wind up all the way.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
73 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Adding Security with a Tether
A tether anchorage point is provided behind
the rear outer seating positions and in the
ceiling for the rear center. If you have a child
seat that comes with a tether but can be
installed with a seat belt, the tether may be
used for additional security.
Always use a tether for forward-facing child seats
when using the seat belt or lower anchors.
Safe Driving
Tether
Anchorage
Points
1Adding Security with a Tether
Tether
Anchorage
Point
Continued
73
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
74 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Using an outer anchor
Anchor
1. Remove the cargo cover *.
2 Cargo Cover P. 210
Safe Driving
2. Put the outer head restraint to its upper
most position, then route the tether strap
through the head restraint legs, and secure
the tether strap hook to the anchor.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
3. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
4. Reinstall the cargo cover *.
Tether Strap Hook
Anchor
Anchor Cover
74
* Not available on all models
■ Using the center anchor
1. Lower the head restraint to its lowest
position.
2. Open the anchor cover.
3. Route the tether strap over the head
restraint.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
4. Secure the tether strap hook to the anchor.
5. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
75 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
Safety of Larger Children
■ Protecting Larger Children
1Safety of Larger Children
■ Checking Seat Belt Fit
When a child is too big for a child seat, secure the child in a rear seat using the lap/
shoulder seat belt. Have the child sit upright and all the way back, then answer the
following questions.
■ Checklist
• Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over
the edge of the seat?
• Does the shoulder belt cross between the
child’s neck and arm?
• Is the lap part of the seat belt as low as
possible, touching the child’s thighs?
• Will the child be able to stay seated like this
for the whole trip?
If you answer yes to all these questions, the child is ready to wear the lap/shoulder
seat belt correctly. If you answer no to any question, the child needs to ride on a
booster seat until the seat belt fits properly without a booster seat.
Continued
3 WARNING
Allowing a child age 12 or under to sit in
front can result in injury or death if the
passenger’s front airbag inflates.
If a larger child must ride in front, move the
vehicle seat as far to the rear as possible,
have the child sit up properly and wear the
seat belt properly, using a booster seat if
needed.
Safe Driving
The following pages give instructions on how to check proper seat belt fit, what kind
of booster seat to use if one is needed, and important precautions for a child who
must sit in front.
75
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
76 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
■ Booster Seats
1Booster Seats
Safe Driving
If a lap/shoulder seat belt cannot be used
properly, position the child in a booster seat in
a rear seating position. For the child’s safety,
check that the child meets the booster seat
manufacturer’s recommendations.
When installing a booster seat, make sure to read the
instructions that came with it, and install the seat
accordingly.
There are high- and low-type booster seats. Choose a
booster seat that allows the child to wear the seat
belt correctly.
Some U.S. states, and Canadian provinces and
territories require children to use a booster seat until
they reach a given age or weight (e.g. 6 years or 60
lbs). Be sure to check current laws in the state or
province, or territory where you intend to drive.
■ Protecting Larger Children-Final Checks
Your vehicle has a rear seat where children can be properly restrained. If you ever
have to carry a group of children, and a child must ride in front:
• Make sure you read and fully understand the instructions and safety information
in this manual.
• Move the front passenger seat as far back as possible.
• Have the child sit upright and well back in the seat.
• Check that the seat belt is properly positioned so that the child is secure in the
seat.
■ Monitoring child passengers
We strongly recommend that you keep an eye on child passengers. Even older, more
mature children sometimes need to be reminded to fasten their seat belts and sit up
properly.
76
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
77 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas
The engine exhaust from this vehicle contains carbon monoxide, a colorless,
odorless, and highly toxic gas. As long as you properly maintain your vehicle, carbon
monoxide gas will not get into the interior.
• The exhaust system is making an unusual noise.
• The exhaust system may have been damaged.
• The vehicle is raised for an oil change.
When you operate a vehicle with the tailgate open, airflow can pull exhaust gas into
the interior and create a hazardous condition. If you must drive with the tailgate
open, open all the windows and set the heating and cooling system */climate control
system * as shown below.
1. Select the fresh air mode.
2. Select the
mode.
3. Set the fan speed to high.
4. Set the temperature control to a comfortable setting.
3 WARNING
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.
Breathing it can cause unconsciousness and
even kill you.
Avoid any enclosed areas or activities that
expose you to carbon monoxide.
Safe Driving
■ Have the exhaust system inspected for leaks whenever
1Carbon Monoxide Gas
An enclosed area such as a garage can quickly fill up
with carbon monoxide gas.
Do not run the engine with the garage door closed.
Even when the garage door is open, drive out of the
garage immediately after starting the engine.
Adjust the heating and cooling system */climate control system * in the same manner
if you sit in your parked vehicle with the engine running.
* Not available on all models
77
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
78 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Safety Labels
Label Locations
These labels are in the locations shown. They warn you of potential hazards that can cause serious injury or death. Read these labels
carefully.
Safe Driving
If a label comes off or becomes hard to read (except for the U.S. dashboard label which may be removed by the owner), contact a dealer
for a replacement.
Sun Visor
U.S. models
Canadian models
Dashboard
U.S. models only
Sun Visor
U.S. models only
Air Conditioner System
U.S. models
78
Canadian models
Radiator Cap
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
79 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Instrument Panel
This chapter describes the buttons, indicators, and gauges that are used while driving.
Indicators ............................................ 80
Information Display Warning and
Information Messages * .................... 99
Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages * .................. 100
Gauges and Displays
Gauges............................................ 113
Information Display * ........................ 115
Multi-Information Display *............... 118
* Not available on all models
79
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
80 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Indicators
Indicator
Name
U.S.
Canada
Explanation
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Comes on while driving - Check the
brake fluid level.
you turn the ignition switch to ON
2 What to do when the indicator
(w *1, then goes off.
comes on while driving P. 601
• Comes on when the brake fluid
•
Comes
on along with the ABS
level is low.
indicator
- Have your vehicle checked by
• Comes on if there is a problem
a dealer.
with the brake system.
2 If the Brake System Indicator (Red)
Instrument Panel
Brake System
Indicator
(Red)
On/Blinking
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
80
* Not available on all models
(Red)
Comes On P. 601
Message *
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
81 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Canada
Brake System
Indicator
(Amber)
Explanation
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle
you turn the ignition switch to ON
checked by a dealer.
(w *1, then goes off.
• Comes on if there is a problem
with a system related to braking
other than the conventional brake
system.
• Comes on if there is a problem
with an automatic brake hold
system.
Message *
U.S.
Canada
Instrument Panel
U.S.
On/Blinking
(Amber)
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
81
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
82 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Instrument Panel
U.S.
Canada
Electric
Parking Brake
Indicator
Electric
Parking Brake
System
Indicator
82
On/Blinking
Explanation
Message *
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Blinks and the electric parking brake
you turn the ignition switch to ON
system indicator comes on at the
(w *1, then goes off if the parking
same time - There is a problem with the
brake has been released.
electric parking brake system. The
• Comes on when the parking brake
parking brake may not be set.
is applied, and goes off when it is
released.
• Comes on for about 15 seconds
when you pull the electric parking
brake switch while the ignition
switch is in LOCK (0 *1.
• Stays on for about 15 seconds
when you turn the ignition switch
to LOCK (0 *1 while the electric
parking brake is set.
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Comes on while driving - Avoid using
you turn the ignition switch to ON
the parking brake and have your vehicle
(w *1, then goes off.
checked by a dealer immediately.
2 If the Electric Parking Brake System
• Comes on if there is a problem
Indicator Comes On P. 602
with the electric parking brake
system.
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
U.S.
Canada
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
83 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
U.S.
Canada
Automatic
Brake Hold
Indicator
• Comes on for a few seconds when
you turn the ignition switch to ON
(w *1, then goes off.
• Comes on when the automatic
brake hold system is on.
• Comes on for a few seconds when
you turn the ignition switch to ON
(w *1, then goes off.
• Comes on when the automatic
brake hold is activated.
Explanation
Message *
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 506
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 506
Instrument Panel
Automatic
Brake Hold
System
Indicator
On/Blinking
—
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
83
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
84 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Explanation
Message *
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Comes on while driving - Press the
you turn the ignition switch to ON
electric parking brake switch with the
(w *1, then goes off.
brake pedal depressed.
Electric Parking Brake System
Instrument Panel
Brake
Depressing
Indicator *
2 Parking Brake P. 503
—
• Comes on when the electric
parking brake switch is pressed
without depressing the brake
pedal while the electric parking
brake is in operation.
Automatic Brake Hold System
●
• Comes on when the automatic
brake hold button is pressed
without depressing the brake
pedal while the automatic brake
hold is in operation.
• Blinks if the automatic brake hold •
is automatically canceled while it is
in operation. The beeper sounds.
Comes on while driving - Press the
automatic brake hold button with the
brake pedal depressed.
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 506
Immediately depress the brake pedal.
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
84
* Not available on all models
—
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
85 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Low Oil
Pressure
Indicator
On/Blinking
Message *
• Comes on while driving - Immediately
stop in a safe place.
2 If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator
Comes On P. 599
Instrument Panel
• Comes on when you turn the
ignition switch to ON (w *1, and
goes off when the engine starts.
• Comes on when the engine oil
pressure is low.
Explanation
• Comes on when you turn the
• Readiness codes are part of the on board
ignition switch to ON (w *1, and
diagnostics for the emissions control
goes off either when the engine
systems.
starts or after several seconds if
2 Testing of Readiness Codes P. 619
the engine did not start. If
• Comes on while driving - Have your
“readiness codes” have not been
vehicle checked by a dealer.
Malfunction
set, it blinks five times before it
• Blinks while driving - Stop in a safe
Indicator Lamp
goes off.
place where there are no flammable
• Comes on if there is a problem
objects. Stop the engine for 10 minutes
with the emissions control system.
or more, and wait for it to cool down.
• Blinks when a misfire in the
Then, take your vehicle to a dealer.
engine’s cylinders is detected.
2 If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Comes On or Blinks P. 600
Charging
System
Indicator
• Comes on when you turn the
• Comes on while driving - Turn off the
ignition switch to ON (w *1, and
heating and cooling system */climate
goes off when the engine starts.
control system * and rear defogger in
• Comes on when the battery is not
order to reduce electricity consumption.
2 If the Charging System Indicator
charging.
Comes On P. 599
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
85
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
86 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Shift Lever
Position
Indicator
Instrument Panel
Transmission
System
Indicator
On/Blinking
• Indicates the current shift lever
position.
• Blinks if the transmission system
has a problem.
M (7-speed
• Comes on when 7-speed manual
manual shift
shift mode is applied.
mode)
Indicator/Shift
Indicator *
Seat Belt
Reminder
Indicator
Explanation
2 Shifting P. 440, 442
* Not available on all models
—
• Blinks while driving - Avoid sudden
starts and acceleration and have your
vehicle checked by a dealer immediately.
2 7-Speed Manual Shift Mode P. 444
• Comes on and the beeper sounds • The beeper stops and the indicator goes
if you are not wearing a seat belt
off when you and the front passenger
when you turn the ignition switch
fasten their seat belts.
to ON (w *1.
• Stays on after you or the front
• If the front passenger is not
passenger has fastened the seat belt
wearing a seat belt, the indicator
- A detection error may have occurred in
comes on a few seconds later.
the sensor. Have your vehicle checked by
• Blinks while driving if either you or
a dealer.
2 Seat Belt Reminder P. 42
the front passenger has not
fastened a seat belt. The beeper
sounds and the indicator blinks at
regular intervals.
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
86
Message *
—
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
87 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Explanation
Anti-lock
Brake System
(ABS)
Indicator
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle
you turn the ignition switch to ON
checked by a dealer. With this indicator
(w *1, then goes off.
on, your vehicle still has normal braking
• If it comes on at any other time,
ability but no anti-lock function.
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 508
there is a problem with the ABS.
Supplemental
Restraint
System
Indicator
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly or does not come
you turn the ignition switch to ON
on at all - Have your vehicle checked by
(w *1, then goes off.
a dealer.
• Comes on if a problem with any of
the following is detected:
- Supplemental restraint system
- Side airbag system
- Side curtain airbag system
- Seat belt tensioner
—
Instrument Panel
Low Fuel
Indicator *
• Comes on when the fuel reserve is • Comes on - Refuel your vehicle as soon
running low (approximately 1.98
as possible.
U.S. gal./7.5 Liter left).
• Blinks - Have your vehicle checked by a
• Blinks if there is a problem with
dealer.
the fuel gauge.
Message *
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
87
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
88 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Instrument Panel
High
Temperature
Indicator
(Red)
On/Blinking
Explanation
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Goes off, then comes on in blue when
you turn the ignition switch to ON
the engine coolant temperature is low.
(w *1, then goes off.
• Blinks while driving - Drive slowly to
• Blinks when the engine coolant
prevent overheating.
temperature goes up, and stays on • Stays on while driving - Immediately
if the temperature continues to
stop in a safe place and allow the engine
rise.
to cool.
2 Overheating P. 597
Low
Temperature
Indicator
(Blue)
Auto HighBeam
Indicator *
• Comes on while the engine
coolant temperature is low, then
goes off once the engine reaches
normal operating temperature.
• Comes on when all the operating
conditions of the auto high-beam
are met.
• If the indicator stays on after the engine
has reached normal operating
temperature, there may be a problem
with the temperature sensors. Have your
vehicle inspected by a dealer.
2 Auto High-Beam * P. 176
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
88
Message *
* Not available on all models
—
—
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
89 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Explanation
Message *
•
Vehicle
Stability
AssistTM (VSA®)
•
OFF Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you turn the ignition switch to ON
(w *1, then goes off.
Comes on when you deactivate
VSA®.
2 VSA® On and Off P. 451
• Comes on for a few seconds if you • Goes off when all doors and the tailgate
turn the ignition switch to ON
are closed.
(w *1, then goes off.
Door and
• Comes on if any door or the
Tailgate Open
tailgate is not completely closed.
Indicator *
• The beeper sounds and the
indicator comes on if any door or
the tailgate is opened while
driving.
Instrument Panel
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle
you turn the ignition switch to ON
checked by a dealer.
Vehicle
2 Vehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®), aka
(w *1, then goes off.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC),
Stability
• Blinks when VSA® is active.
System P. 450
AssistTM (VSA®) • Comes on if there is a problem
System
with the VSA® system or hill start
Indicator
assist system.
—
—
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
89
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
90 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Instrument Panel
•
Electric Power
Steering (EPS)
System
•
Indicator
U.S.
models
only
On/Blinking
Explanation
Comes on when you turn the
ignition switch to ON (w *1, and
goes off when the engine starts.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the EPS system.
• Stays on constantly or does not come
on at all - Have your vehicle checked by
a dealer.
2 If the Electric Power Steering (EPS)
System Indicator Comes On P. 601
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Comes on while driving - Stop in a safe
you turn the ignition switch to ON
place, check tire pressures, and inflate
(w *1, then goes off.
the tire(s) if necessary.
• May come on briefly if the ignition • Stays on after the tires are inflated to
switch is turned to ON (w *1 and
the recommended pressures - The
the vehicle is not moved within 45
system needs to be calibrated.
2 TPMS Calibration P. 455
seconds, to indicate the calibration
process is not yet complete.
• Comes on and stays on when:
Low Tire
- One or more tires’ pressures are
Pressure/TPMS
determined to be significantly
Indicator
low.
- The system has not been
calibrated.
• Blinks for about one minute, and • Blinks and remains on - Have your
then stays on if there is a problem
vehicle checked by a dealer. If the vehicle
with the TPMS, or when a
is fitted with a compact spare, get your
compact spare tire is temporarily
regular tire repaired or replaced and put
installed.
back on your vehicle as soon as you can.
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
90
* Not available on all models
Message *
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
91 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Explanation
Message *
System
Message
Indicator *
• Comes on for a few seconds when • While the indicator is on, press the
you turn the ignition switch to ON
(information) button to see the
message again.
(w *1, then goes off.
• Refer to the Indicators information in this
• Comes on along with a beep
chapter when a system message appears
when a problem is detected. A
on the multi-information display. Take
system message on the multithe appropriate action for the message.
information display appears at the
• The multi-information display does not
same time.
return to the normal screen unless the
warning is canceled, or the
button is pressed.
—
Turn Signal
and Hazard
Warning
Indicators
• Blinks when you operate the turn
signal lever.
• Blink if you press the hazard
warning button.
—
High Beam
Indicator
• Comes on when the high beam
headlights are on.
• Does not blink or blinks rapidly - A
turn signal light bulb has blown. Change
the bulb immediately.
Instrument Panel
Smart Entry
System
Indicator *
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly or does not come
you set the power mode to ON,
on at all - Have your vehicle checked by
then goes off.
a dealer.
• Comes on as soon as a problem is
detected in the smart entry system
or push button starting system.
2 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 543, 546, 547
—
—
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
91
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
92 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Lights On
Indicator
Instrument Panel
Fog Light
Indicator *
On/Blinking
• Comes on whenever the light
switch is on, or in AUTO * when
the exterior lights are on.
—
* Not available on all models
—
• Blinks Models without smart entry system
You cannot start the engine. Turn the
ignition switch to LOCK (0 , pull the key
out, and then insert the key and turn it to
ON (w again.
Models with smart entry system
You cannot start the engine. Set the
power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK),
then select the ON mode again.
• Repeatedly blinks - The system may be
malfunctioning. Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
• Do not attempt to alter this system or add
other devices to it. Electrical problems
can occur.
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
92
Message *
• If you remove the key from the ignition
switch *, or set the power mode * to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) while the exterior
lights are on, a chime sounds when the
driver’s door is opened.
• Comes on when the fog lights are
on.
• Comes on briefly when you turn
the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
• Comes on if the immobilizer
system cannot recognize the key
information.
Immobilizer
System
Indicator
Explanation
—
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
93 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
ECON Mode
Indicator
On/Blinking
Message *
2 ECON Button P. 446
Instrument Panel
• Comes on for a few seconds when
you turn the ignition switch to ON
(w *1, then goes off.
• Comes on when you press the
ECON button.
Explanation
• Blinks when the security system
alarm has been set.
Indicator
Security
System Alarm
Indicator
2 Security System Alarm P. 159
—
CRUISE MAIN • Comes on when you press the
CRUISE button.
Indicator *
2 Cruise Control * P. 447
—
CRUISE
CONTROL
Indicator *
• Comes on if you have set a speed
for cruise control.
2 Cruise Control * P. 447
—
Maintenance
Minder
Indicator *
• Comes on when the scheduled
maintenance is due soon.
2 Maintenance MinderTM P. 521
—
Indicator
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
93
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
94 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Instrument Panel
All-Wheel
Drive (AWD)
System
Indicator *
On/Blinking
Explanation
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly - the engine drives
you turn the ignition switch to ON
only the front wheels in this state. Have
(w *1, then goes off.
your vehicle checked by a dealer.
• Comes on if there is a problem
• Blinks while driving - the engine drives
with the AWD.
only the front wheels in this state. Stop in
• Blinks when the AWD system is
a safe place, shift to (P , and idle the
engine until the indicator goes off. If the
overheated. The system is inactive.
indicator does not stop blinking, take
your vehicle to a dealer.
2 Real Time AWD with Intelligent
Control SystemTM * P. 454
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
94
* Not available on all models
Message *
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
95 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Explanation
Message *
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle
you turn the ignition switch to ON
checked by a dealer.
(w *1, then goes off.
• Comes on if there is a problem
with the RDM system.
Road
Departure
Mitigation
(RDM)
Indicator *
Instrument Panel
• Comes on when the RDM system
shuts itself off.
• Stays on - The temperature inside the
camera is too high.
Use the climate control system to cool
down the camera.
The system activates when the
temperature inside the camera cools
down.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
• Stays on - The area around the camera is
blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your
vehicle in a safe place, and wipe it off
with a soft cloth.
• Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if
the indicator and message come back on
after you cleaned the area around the
camera.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
• Comes on if anything covers the
• When the radar sensor gets dirty, stop your
vehicle in a safe place, and wipe off dirt using
radar sensor cover and prevents
a soft cloth. Indicator may take some time to
the sensor from detecting a
go off after the radar sensor is cleaned.
vehicle in front.
• Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if
• May come on when driving in bad
the indicator does not go off even after
you clean the sensor cover.
weather (rain, snow, fog, etc.)
2 Radar Sensor P. 502
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
95
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
96 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Explanation
Instrument Panel
Adaptive
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Comes on while driving - Have your
Cruise Control
you turn the ignition switch to ON
vehicle checked by a dealer.
(w *1, then goes off.
(ACC)
• Comes on if there is a problem
Indicator
with ACC.
(Amber) *
Adaptive
• Comes on when you press the
Cruise Control
MAIN button.
(ACC)
Indicator
(Green) *
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) P. 473
Lane Keeping
Assist System
(LKAS)
Indicator
(Amber) *
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle
you turn the ignition switch to ON
checked by a dealer.
(w *1, then goes off.
• Comes on if there is a problem
with the LKAS.
Lane Keeping
Assist System
(LKAS)
Indicator
(Green) *
• Comes on when you press the
MAIN button.
2 Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
P. 486
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
96
Message *
* Not available on all models
—
—
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
97 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Explanation
Message *
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly without the
you turn the ignition switch to ON
CMBSTM off - Have your vehicle checked
*1
(w , then goes off.
by a dealer.
2 Collision Mitigation Braking
• Comes on when you deactivate
SystemTM (CMBSTM) P. 463
the CMBSTM. A multi-information
display message appears for five
seconds.
• Comes on if there is a problem
with the CMBSTM.
Instrument Panel
Collision
Mitigation
Braking
SystemTM
(CMBSTM)
Indicator *
On/Blinking
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
97
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
98 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
• Comes on when the CMBSTM
system shuts itself off.
Explanation
• Stays on - The area around the camera is
blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your
vehicle in a safe place, and wipe it off
with a soft cloth.
Instrument Panel
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
Collision
Mitigation
Braking
SystemTM
(CMBSTM)
Indicator *
• When the radar sensor gets dirty, stop
your vehicle in a safe place, and wipe off
dirt using a soft cloth. Indicator may take
some time to go off after the radar sensor
is cleaned.
• Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if
the message does not disappear even
after you clean the sensor cover.
2 Collision Mitigation Braking
SystemTM (CMBSTM) P. 463
2 Radar Sensor P. 502
• Stays on - The temperature inside the
camera is too high. Use the climate
control system to cool down the camera.
The system activates when the
temperature inside the camera cools
down.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
*1:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
98
* Not available on all models
Message *
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
99 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuInformation Display Warning and Information Messages *
Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
The following messages appear only on the information display.
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Appears when the fuel fill cap is loose or is not
installed.
• Appears when there is a problem with the sensor on • Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle checked
the battery.
by a dealer.
* Not available on all models
Instrument Panel
2 Check/Tighten Fuel Cap Message P. 600
99
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
100 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
The following messages appear only on the multi-information display. Press the
with the system message indicator on.
Message
Condition
(information) button to see the message again
Explanation
• Appears when the fuel fill cap is loose or is not
installed.
Instrument Panel
2 Check/Tighten Fuel Cap Message P. 600
• Appears when the scheduled maintenance is due
soon.
u Consequently, Maintenance Due Now and
Maintenance Past Due follow.
Canadian models
• Appears when the washer fluid is low.
2 Maintenance Minder Messages on the MultiInformation Display P. 526
• Refill the washer fluid.
2 Refilling Window Washer Fluid P. 540
• Appears while you are customizing the settings and
the shift lever is moved out of (P .
2 Customized Features P. 123
100
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
101 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Appears if the automatic brake hold is automatically • Immediately depress the brake pedal.
canceled while it is in operation.
Instrument Panel
• Appears when the automatic brake hold system is
turned off.
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 506
• Appears when the automatic brake hold button is
pressed without wearing the driver’s seat belt.
• Fasten the driver’s seat belt.
• Appears when the automatic brake hold button is
pressed without depressing the brake pedal while
the automatic brake hold is in operation.
• Press the automatic brake hold button with the brake
pedal depressed.
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 506
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 506
Continued
101
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
102 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Message
Condition
• Appears when the parking brake is applied
automatically while it is in operation.
Instrument Panel
102
• Appears when the electric parking brake switch is
pressed without depressing the brake pedal while
the electric parking brake is in operation.
Explanation
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 506
2 Parking Brake P. 503
• Press the electric parking brake switch with the brake
pedal depressed.
2 Parking Brake P. 503
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
103 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Models without smart entry system
Message
Condition
• Appears when the ignition key is turned to
ACCESSORY (q from ON (w . (The driver’s door is
closed.)
Explanation
—
Instrument Panel
• Appears when you open the driver’s door while the • Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 , then remove the
ignition key is in ACCESSORY (q .
key.
• Appears when you open the driver’s door while the • Remove the key from the ignition switch.
ignition key is in LOCK (0 .
Continued
103
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
104 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Models with smart entry system
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Appears after you unlock and open the driver’s
door.
2 Starting the Engine P. 435
Instrument Panel
Canadian models
• Appears when the steering wheel is locked.
• Move the steering wheel left and right while pressing
the ENGINE START/STOP button.
• Appears if you push the ENGINE START/STOP
• Move the shift lever to (P . The power mode changes
button to turn the engine off without the shift lever
to VEHICLE OFF.
in (P .
• Appears when the power mode is in ACCESSORY.
—
104
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
105 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Models with smart entry system
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Appears after the driver’s door is opened when the • Change the power mode to VEHICLE OFF.
2 ENGINE START/STOP Button P. 166
power mode is in ACCESSORY.
• Goes off when you bring the smart entry remote back
inside the vehicle and close the door.
• Appears when the smart entry remote battery
becomes weak.
• Replace the battery as soon as possible.
• Appears if the smart entry remote battery is too
weak to start the engine or the key is not within
operating range to start the engine. A beeper
sounds six times.
• Bring the smart entry remote in front of the ENGINE
START/STOP button to be touched with.
2 Smart Entry Remote Reminder P. 168
Instrument Panel
• Appears when you close the door with the power
mode in ON without the smart entry remote inside
the vehicle.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 568
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak P. 592
Continued
105
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
106 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Appears when there is a problem with the sensor on • Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 Checking the Battery P. 566
the battery.
Instrument Panel
U.S. models
Canadian models
106
• Appears when the starter system has a problem.
• As a temporary measure, press and hold the ENGINE
START/STOP button for up to 15 seconds while
pressing the brake pedal, and manually start the
engine.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
107 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Message
Condition
• Appears for about three seconds when ACC has
been automatically canceled.
Explanation
• You can resume the set speed after the condition that
caused ACC to cancel improves. Press the RES/+
button.
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) P. 473
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) P. 473
2 Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
P. 463
Instrument Panel
• Flashes when the system senses a likely collision with • Take appropriate action to prevent a collision (apply
a vehicle in front of you.
the brakes, change lanes, etc.).
• Appears when the LKAS is in operation, or the LKAS • If any other system indicators come on, such as the
button is pressed, but there is a problem with a
VSA®, ABS and brake system, take appropriate action.
2 Indicators P. 80
system related to the LKAS. The LKAS cancels
automatically. The beeper sounds simultaneously.
• Appears when the camera has been cooled down
and LKAS is available.
• Pressing the MAIN/LKAS button can resume the
system.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
Continued
107
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
108 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Message
Condition
Explanation
Instrument Panel
• Appears if there is a problem with the auto highbeam.
• Manually operate the headlight switch.
• If you are driving with the high beam headlights when
this happens, the headlights are changed to low
beams.
• Appears if anything covers the radar sensor cover
and prevents the sensor from detecting a vehicle in
front.
• May appear when driving in bad weather (rain,
snow, fog, etc.)
• When the radar sensor gets dirty, stop your vehicle in a
safe place, and wipe off dirt using a soft cloth.
• Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the message
does not disappear even after you clean the sensor
cover.
2 Radar Sensor P. 502
2 Honda Sensing® * P. 460
• Appears if the temperature inside the front sensor
camera is too high and some driver assist systems
cannot be activated.
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
camera.
• Disappears - The camera has been cooled down and
the systems are activated normally.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
2 Honda Sensing® * P. 460
• Appears if the area around the front sensor camera • When the front window gets dirty, stop your vehicle in
is blocked by dirt, mud, etc. and be prevented from
a safe place, and wipe it off with a soft cloth.
detecting a vehicle in front.
• Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the message
• May appear when driving in bad weather (rain,
does not disappear even after you cleaned the area
snow, fog, etc.)
around the camera.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
2 Honda Sensing® * P. 460
108
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
109 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Message
Condition
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
• Appears when the vehicle is driving out of a
detected line. The steering wheel vibrates rapidly.
When you selected Warning Only
- The steering wheel vibrates rapidly when the
vehicle is drifting out of a detected line.
• Keep the vehicle within the lane you are driving.
2 Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) P. 486
• Keep the vehicle within the lane you are driving.
2 Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System P. 495
• You can change the setting for the road departure
mitigation system. Narrow, Normal, Wide, and
Warning Only can be selected.
2 Customized Features P. 123
Instrument Panel
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
• Appears when the vehicle is driving out of a
detected line.
Explanation
When you selected Narrow, Normal or Wide
- The steering wheel vibrates rapidly when the
vehicle is drifting out of a detected line. The system
also steers the vehicle to help you remain within
your driving lane.
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
When you selected Narrow
• Appears when the vehicle is likely to drive out of a
detected line.
- The system steers the vehicle to help you remain
within your driving lane.
—
• Blinks when you fail to steer the vehicle. The beeper • Operate the steering wheel to resume the LKAS.
sounds simultaneously.
Continued
109
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
110 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Appears if not wearing a seat belt when you set the • Goes off after you or the front passenger or both of
power mode to ON.
you have fastened your seat belts.
Instrument Panel
110
• Appears if there is a problem with the fuel gauge.
• Blinks - Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
• Appears when the fuel reserve is running low
(approximately 1.98 U.S. gal./7.5 Liter left).
• Appears - Refuel your vehicle as soon as possible.
2 Fuel Gauge P. 117
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
111 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Goes off when all doors are closed.
• Appears if the tailgate is not completely closed.
• Goes off when the tailgate is closed.
Instrument Panel
• Appears if any door is not completely closed.
• The beeper sounds and the message appears on if
any door or the tailgate is opened while driving.
• Appears if any door or the tailgate is not completely • Goes off when all doors and the tailgate are closed.
closed.
Continued
111
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
112 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages *
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Appears when ECON mode is turned off by pressing
ECON button.
2 ECON Button P. 446
Instrument Panel
Models with navigation system
• Appears when approaching a intersection during
route guidance.
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
• Appears when set the power mode to ON while
driving.
2 Emergency Engine Stop P. 593
• Appears if there is a problem with the automatic
lighting control system.
Models with LED headlights
• Appears if there is a problem with the headlights.
112
• Appears while driving - Manually turn the lights on,
and have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
• Appears while driving - The headlights may not be
on. When conditions allow you to drive safety, have
your vehicle checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
113 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Gauges and Displays
Gauges
Gauges include the speedometer, tachometer and related indicators. They are
displayed when the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
■ Changing the color of the meter
Models with information display
Models with multi-information display
Instrument Panel
You can change the color of the meter.
Press the
(select/reset) knob when the ignition switch is in ACCESSORY (q or
LOCK (0 *1 and the ambient meter is lit up. Each time you press the knob, the color
changes.
The colors change in the following order:
white blue purple pink red amber yellow
You can change the white to some colors.
2 Customized Features P. 123
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
113
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
114 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuGauges
■ Speedometer
Displays your driving speed in mph and km/h.
■ Tachometer
Instrument Panel
Shows the number of engine revolutions per minute.
■ Outside Temperature
Shows the outside temperature in Fahrenheit (U.S.) or Celsius (Canada).
■ Adjusting the outside temperature display
Adjust the temperature reading up to ±5°F or ±3°C if the temperature reading
seems incorrect.
1Outside Temperature
The temperature sensor is in the front bumper.
Road heat and exhaust from another vehicle can
affect the temperature reading when your vehicle
speed is less than 19 mph (30 km/h).
It may take several minutes for the display to be
updated after the temperature reading has stabilized.
Use the multi-information display's customized
features to correct the temperature.
2 Customized Features P. 123
114
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
115 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuInformation Display *
Information Display *
1Switching the Display
The information display shows the fuel gauge, odometer, trip meter, engine oil life
and maintenance service item codes, and other gauges.
■ Switching the Display
Models with display audio system
Some of the items on the information display also
appear on the audio/information screen. They also
change along with the information display changes
while the fuel consumption is shown.
Select/Reset Knob
Instant Fuel Economy
Clock
Odometer
Trip Meter A
Outside Temperature
Fuel Gauge
* Not available on all models
Instant Fuel Economy
Clock
Range
Trip Meter A
Outside Temperature
Fuel Gauge
Instant Fuel Economy
Clock
Average Fuel Economy A
Trip Meter A
Outside Temperature
Fuel Gauge
Continued
Instant Fuel Economy
Clock
Average Fuel Economy B
Trip Meter B
Outside Temperature
Fuel Gauge
Instrument Panel
Press the
(select/reset) knob to change the display.
Each time you press the
(select/reset) knob, the information display changes as follows:
Instant Fuel Economy
Clock
Engine Oil Life
Fuel Gauge
115
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
116 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuInformation Display *
■ Instant Fuel Economy
1Trip Meter
Switch between trip meter A and trip meter B by
pressing the
knob.
Shows the instant fuel economy as a bar graph in mpg.
■ Odometer
Instrument Panel
Shows the total number of miles that your vehicle has accumulated.
■ Trip Meter
Shows the total number of miles driven since the last reset. TRIP A and B can be used
to measure two separate trips.
■ Resetting a trip meter
To reset a trip meter, display it, then press and hold the
reset to 0.0.
knob. The trip meter is
■ Range
Shows the estimated distance you can travel on the remaining fuel. This distance is
estimated from the fuel economy of your trips in the past.
■ Average Fuel Economy
Shows the estimated average fuel economy of each trip meter in mpg. The display
is updated at set intervals. When a trip meter is reset, the average fuel economy is
also reset.
116
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
117 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuInformation Display *
■ Outside Temperature
Shows the outside temperature in Fahrenheit.
The temperature sensor is in the front bumper.
Road heat and exhaust from another vehicle can
affect the temperature reading when your vehicle
speed is less than 19 mph (30 km/h).
It may take several minutes for the display to be
updated after the temperature reading has stabilized.
When the engine oil life is shown on the information
display, you cannot adjust the outside temperature.
Push the
knob to select the other display.
Instrument Panel
■ Adjusting the outside temperature indicator
Adjust the temperature reading up to ± 5°F if the temperature reading seems
incorrect.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w .
2. Press and hold the
(select/reset) knob for 10 seconds or more while the outside
temperature is shown on the information display.
u The information display goes into temperature adjustment mode. The display
starts showing from -5°F to +5°F.
3. Release the
knob when the right adjustment amount is shown.
u The adjustment is complete.
1Outside Temperature
■ Engine Oil Life and Maintenance Items
Shows the remaining oil life and Maintenance MinderTM.
2 Maintenance MinderTM P. 521
■ Fuel Gauge
Displays the amount of fuel left in the fuel tank.
1Fuel Gauge
NOTICE
You should refuel when the reading approaches E .
Running out of fuel can cause the engine to misfire,
damaging the catalytic converter.
The actual amount of remaining fuel may differ from
the fuel gauge reading.
117
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
118 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
Multi-Information Display *
The multi-information display shows the odometer, trip meter, and other gauges.
It also displays important messages such as warnings and other helpful information.
■ Switching the Display
■ Main displays
Instrument Panel
Press the
(information) button to change the display.
Range/Average
Fuel/Instant Fuel
Blank Screen
User Customize
Compass *
Button
Average Speed/
Elapsed Time
Turn By Turn
Screen
118
* Not available on all models
AWD Torque
Distribution
Monitor *
Engine Oil Life
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
119 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
■ Lower displays
Press the SEL/RESET button or
(select/reset) knob to change the display.
(Select/Reset)
Knob
Instrument Panel
Fuel Gauge / Odometer
Fuel Gauge / Trip Meter A
Fuel Gauge / Trip Meter B
SEL/RESET
Button
Continued
119
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
120 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
■ Odometer
1Trip Meter
Shows the total number of miles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada) that your vehicle has
accumulated.
Switch between trip meter A and trip meter B by
pressing the SEL/RESET button.
■ Trip Meter
Instrument Panel
Shows the total number of miles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada) driven since the last
reset. Meters A and B can be used to measure two separate trips.
■ Resetting a trip meter
To reset a trip meter, display it, then press and hold the SEL/RESET button. The trip
meter is reset to 0.0.
■ Fuel Gauge
1Fuel Gauge
Displays the amount of fuel left in the fuel tank.
Low Fuel Indicator Icon
Fuel Gauge
■ Fuel Low warning
When the remaining fuel is running low, the
display color will change to orange and warns
you to refuel as soon as possible.
The actual amount of remaining fuel may differ from
the fuel gauge reading.
The icon will start to blink when the fuel
gauge is malfunctioning.
2 Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages * P. 100
120
* Not available on all models
NOTICE
You should refuel when the reading approaches E .
Running out of fuel can cause the engine to misfire,
damaging the catalytic converter.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
121 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
■ Average Fuel Economy
1Average Fuel Economy
Shows the estimated average fuel economy of each trip meter in mpg (U.S.) or l/100
km (Canada). The display is updated at set intervals. When a trip meter is reset, the
average fuel economy is also reset.
You can change when to reset the average fuel
economy.
2 Customized Features P. 123
Shows the estimated distance you can travel on the remaining fuel. This distance is
estimated from the fuel economy of your previous trips.
■ Elapsed Time
1Elapsed Time
You can change when to reset the elapsed time.
2 Customized Features P. 123
Shows the time elapsed since Trip A or Trip B was reset.
■ Average Speed
Instrument Panel
■ Range
1Average Speed
Shows the average speed in mph (U.S.) or km/h (Canada) since Trip A or Trip B was
reset.
You can change when to reset the average speed.
2 Customized Features P. 123
■ Instant Fuel Economy
Shows the instant fuel economy as a bar graph in mpg (U.S.) or l/100 km (Canada).
■ Engine Oil Life
Shows the remaining oil life and Maintenance MinderTM.
2 Maintenance MinderTM P. 521
Continued
121
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
122 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
■ Navigation
1Navigation
You can select whether to have the turn-by-turn
display come on or not during the route guidance.
2 Customized Features P. 123
■ Compass *
Shows the compass screen.
■ Turn-by-Turn Directions
Instrument Panel
When driving guidance is provided by the navigation system * or Android Auto, turnby-turn directions to your destination appear.
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
2 Android AutoTM P. 316
■ AWD Torque Distribution Monitor *
The indicators on the display show the
amount of torque being transferred to the
right front, left front, right rear, and left rear
wheels.
2 Real Time AWD with Intelligent Control
SystemTM * P. 454
122
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
123 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
■ Customized Features
1Customized Features
Use the multi-information display to customize certain features.
When you customize settings, shift to (P .
Instrument Panel
■ How to customize
Select the Vehicle Settings screen by pressing the
button while the
ignition switch is in ON (w *1, the vehicle is at a complete stop, and the shift lever is
in (P . Press the SEL/RESET button to enter the customizing mode.
To customize other features, press the
button.
2 List of customizable options P. 126
2 Example of customization settings P. 130
Multi-Information
Display: Goes to
Vehicle Settings.
Button:
Changes the customize
menus and items.
SEL/RESET Button:
Enters the selected item.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
123
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
124 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
■ Customization flow
Press the
button.
Vehicle
Settings
SEL/RESET
TPMS Calibration *
Instrument Panel
Forward Collision Warning Distance
4
ACC Forward Vehicle Detect Beep
Driver Assist System Setup
SEL/RESET
4
Road Departure Mitigation Setting
Lane Keeping Assist Suspend Beep
4
Meter Setup
SEL/RESET
4
SEL/RESET
4
4
Keyless Access Setup *
Language Selection
Adjust Outside Temp. Display
“Trip A” Reset Timing
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Fuel Efficiency Backlight Color
Fuel Efficiency Backlight
Turn By Turn Auto Display
Speed/Distance Units
Door Unlock Mode
SEL/RESET
4
Keyless Access Light Flash
Keyless Access Beep
4
124
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
125 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
Interior Light Dimming Time
4
Lighting Setup
SEL/RESET
4
Headlight Auto OFF Timer
Auto Door Lock
4
Auto Door Unlock
Door Setup
Key And Remote Unlock Mode
SEL/RESET
4
Walk Away Auto Lock *
Instrument Panel
Auto Light Sensitivity *
Keyless Lock Answer Back
Security Relock Timer
4
Cancel
4
Maintenance Info.
SEL/RESET
4
Reset
4
Default All
4
SEL/RESET
* Not available on all models
Exit
Continued
125
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
126 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
■ List of customizable options
Setup Group
Customizable Features
TPMS
Calibration *
—
Instrument Panel
Driver Assist
System
Setup
Selectable Settings
Calibrates the TPMS.
Cancel/Calibrate
Forward Collision
Warning Distance
Changes at which distance the CMBSTM alerts.
Long/Normal*1/Short
ACC Forward Vehicle
Detect Beep
Causes the system to beep when the system detects
a vehicle, or when the vehicle goes out of ACC
range.
ON/OFF*1
Road Departure
Mitigation Setting
Changes the setting for the road departure
mitigation system.
Narrow/Normal*1/Wide/
Warning Only
Lane Keeping Assist
Suspend Beep
Causes the system to beep when the LKAS is
suspended.
ON/OFF*1
*1: Default Setting
126
Description
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
127 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
Setup Group
Customizable Features
Description
Selectable Settings
Changes the displayed language.
English*1/Français/Español
Adjust Outside Temp.
Display
Adjusts the temperature reading by a few degrees.
-5°F ~ ±0°F*1 ~ +5°F (U.S.)
-3°C ~ ±0°C*1 ~ +3°C (Canada)
“Trip A” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter A,
average fuel economy A, average speed A, and
elapsed time A.
When Refueled/IGN OFF/
Manually Reset*1
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter B,
average fuel economy B, average speed B, and
elapsed time B.
When Refueled/IGN OFF/
Manually Reset*1
Fuel Efficiency Backlight
Color
Changes the ambient meter color.
White*1/Blue/Violet/Pink/
Red/Amber/Yellow/Random
Fuel Efficiency Backlight
Turns the ambient meter feature on and off.
ON*1/OFF
Turn By Turn Auto
Display
Selects whether the turn-by-turn display comes on
during the route guidance.
ON*1/OFF
Speed/Distance Units
Selects the trip computer units.
mph∙miles*1/km/h∙km (U.S.)
mph∙miles/km/h∙km*1
(Canada)
Meter Setup
Instrument Panel
Language Selection
*1:Default Setting
Continued
127
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
128 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
Setup Group
Instrument Panel
Keyless
Access
Setup *
Lighting
Setup
Customizable Features
Selectable Settings
Door Unlock Mode
Changes which doors unlock when you grab the
driver’s door handle.
Driver Door Only*1/All Doors
Keyless Access Light
Flash
Causes some exterior lights to flash when you
unlock/lock the doors.
ON*1/OFF
Keyless Access Beep
Causes the beeper to sound when you unlock/lock
the doors.
ON*1/OFF
Interior Light Dimming
Time
Changes the length of time the interior lights stay on
after you close the doors.
60sec/30sec*1/15sec
Headlight Auto OFF
Timer
Changes the length of time the exterior lights stay
on after you close the driver’s door.
60sec/30sec/15sec*1/0sec
Auto Light Sensitivity *
Changes the timing for the headlights to come on.
Max/High/Mid*1/Low/Min
*1:Default Setting
128
Description
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
129 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
Setup Group
Customizable Features
Selectable Settings
With Vehicle Speed*1/
Shift From P/OFF
Auto Door Unlock
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically unlock.
All Doors When Driver's
Door Opens*1/
All Doors When Shifted To
Park/
All Doors When Ignition
Switched OFF/
OFF
Key And Remote Unlock
Mode
Sets up either the driver’s door or all doors to unlock
on the first operation of the remote or built-in key.
Driver Door*1/All Doors
Walk Away Auto Lock *
Changes the settings for the auto lock function
when you walk away from the vehicle.
ON/OFF*1
Keyless Lock Answer
Back
LOCK/UNLOCK- The exterior lights flash.
LOCK (2nd push)- The beeper sounds.
ON*1/OFF
Security Relock Timer
Changes the time it takes for the doors to relock and
the security system to set after you unlock the
vehicle without opening any door.
90sec/60sec/30sec*1
Maintenance
Info.
—
Resets or cancels the engine oil life display when you
have performed the maintenance service.
Cancel/Reset
Default All
—
Cancels/Resets all the customized settings as
default.
Cancel/Set
Instrument Panel
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically lock.
Auto Door Lock
Door Setup
Description
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
129
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
130 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
■ Example of customization settings
The steps for changing the “Trip A” Reset Timing setting to When Refueled are
shown below. The default setting for “Trip A” Reset Timing is Manually Reset.
1. Press the
button until Vehicle
Settings appears on the display, then press
the SEL/RESET button.
Instrument Panel
2. Press the
button until Meter
Setup appears on the display.
3. Press the SEL/RESET button.
130
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
131 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display *
5. Press the
button and select When
Refueled, then press the SEL/RESET
button.
u The When Refueled Setup screen
appears, then the display returns to the
customization menu screen.
Instrument Panel
4. Press the
button until “Trip A”
Reset Timing appears on the display, then
press the SEL/RESET button.
u The display switches to the
customization setup screen, where you
can select When Refueled, IGN OFF,
Manually Reset, or Exit.
6. Press the
button until Exit appears
on the display, then press the SEL/RESET
button.
7. Repeat Step 6 until you return to the
normal screen.
131
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
132
132 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
133 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Controls
This chapter explains how to operate the various controls necessary for driving.
Clock.................................................................. 134
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key................................................................. 136
Low Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength * ...... 138
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside ... 139
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside.. 148
Childproof Door Locks.................................... 151
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking......................... 152
Customizing the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
Setting * ....................................................... 153
Tailgate ............................................................. 156
Opening/Closing the Tailgate.......................... 157
Security System
Immobilizer System......................................... 159
Security System Alarm .................................... 159
Opening and Closing the Windows................ 162
Moonroof * ........................................................ 164
* Not available on all models
Operating the Switches Around the Steering
Wheel
Models without smart entry system
Ignition Switch ............................................... 165
Models with smart entry system
ENGINE START/STOP Button ........................... 166
Ignition Switch and Power Mode Comparison .....169
Turn Signals ................................................... 170
Light Switches ................................................ 171
Fog Lights * ..................................................... 174
Daytime Running Lights.................................. 175
Auto High-Beam * ........................................... 176
Wipers and Washers....................................... 179
Defogger/Heated Door Mirror */Heated Windshield * .....182
Brightness Control.......................................... 184
Adjusting the Steering Wheel ......................... 186
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror.................................. 187
Power Door Mirrors........................................ 189
Adjusting the Seats
Front Seats ..................................................... 190
Rear Seats ...................................................... 193
Maintain a Proper Sitting Position................... 196
Head Restraints .............................................. 197
Armrest.......................................................... 200
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items
Interior Lights ................................................. 201
Interior Convenience Items ............................. 203
Heating and Cooling System *
Using Vents, Heating and A/C ........................ 212
Climate Control System *
Using Automatic Climate Control ................... 216
Automatic Climate Control Sensors ................ 225
133
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
134 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Clock
Adjusting the Clock
Models without navigation system
1Adjusting the Time
You can adjust the time in the clock display with the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
■ Adjusting the Time
Models with display audio system
The clock in the multi-information display */
information display * is automatically adjusted along
with the audio system’s clock display.
Models with navigation system
■ Using the Settings menu on the audio/information screen
Controls
1. Select the
(HOME) icon, then select
Settings.
2. Select Clock/Info, then Clock
Adjustment.
3. Adjust the hours and minutes by selecting
3/4.
4. Select OK to set the time.
The clock is automatically updated through the
navigation system, so the time does not need to be
adjusted.
Models without navigation system
You can customize the clock display to show the 12
hour clock or 24 hour clock.
2 Customized Features P. 352
Models with display audio system
You can turn the clock display on and off.
2 Customized Features P. 352
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
134
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
135 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuClockuAdjusting the Clock
Models with color audio system
1Adjusting the Time
■ Using the MENU/CLOCK button
Models with color audio system
1. Press and hold the MENU/CLOCK button.
u Adjust Clock is selected.
2. Rotate
to change hour, then press .
3. Rotate
to change minute, then press
.
4. To enter the selection, rotate
and select
Set, then press .
These indications are used to show how to operate
the LIST/SELECT (List/Selector) knob.
Rotate
to select.
Press
to enter.
You can also select Adjust Clock by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Adjust Clock, then press .
Controls
135
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
136 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key
This vehicle comes with the following keys:
Use the keys to start and stop the engine, and
Smart Entry
to lock and unlock all the doors and tailgate.
Remote *
All the keys have an immobilizer system. The
immobilizer system helps to protect against vehicle
theft.
2 Immobilizer System P. 159
Controls
Follow the advice below to prevent damage to the
keys:
• Do not leave the keys in direct sunlight, or in
locations with high temperature or high humidity.
• Do not drop the keys or set heavy objects on them.
• Keep the keys away from liquids, dust and sand.
• Do not take the keys apart except for replacing the
battery.
If the circuits in the keys are damaged, the engine
may not start, and the remote transmitter/smart entry
system * may not work.
If the keys do not work properly, have them
inspected by a dealer.
Ignition Key
with Remote
Transmitter *
■ Built-in Key *
Release Knob
Built-in Key
136
1Key
* Not available on all models
The built-in key can be used to lock/unlock the
doors when the smart entry remote battery
becomes weak and the power door lock/
unlock operation is disabled.
To remove the built-in key, slide the release
knob and then pull out the key. To reinstall
the built-in key, push the built-in key into the
smart entry remote until it clicks.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
137 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuKey
■ Key Number Tag
1Key Number Tag
Contains a number that you will need if you
purchase a replacement key.
Keep the key number tag separate from the key in a
safe place outside of your vehicle.
If you wish to purchase an additional key, contact a
dealer.
If you lose your key and you cannot start the engine,
contact a dealer.
Controls
137
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
138 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLow Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength *
Low Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength *
The vehicle transmits radio waves to locate the smart entry remote when locking/
unlocking the doors and tailgate, or to start the engine.
In the following cases, locking/unlocking the doors and tailgate, or starting the
engine may be inhibited or operation may be unstable:
• Strong radio waves are being transmitted by nearby equipment.
• You are carrying the smart entry remote together with telecommunications
equipment, laptop computers, cell phones, or wireless devices.
• A metallic object is touching or covering the smart entry remote.
Controls
138
* Not available on all models
1Low Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength *
Communication between the smart entry remote and
the vehicle consumes the smart entry remote’s
battery.
Battery life is about two years, but this varies
depending on regularity of use.
The battery is consumed whenever the smart entry
remote is receiving strong radio waves. Avoid placing
it near electrical appliances such as televisions and
personal computers.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
139 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System *
When you carry the smart entry remote, you
can lock/unlock the doors and the tailgate.
You can lock/unlock the doors and the
tailgate within a radius of about 32 inches (80
cm) of the outside door or tailgate outer
handle.
1Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
If the interior light switch is in the door activated
position, the interior light comes on when you unlock
the doors and tailgate.
No doors opened: The light fades out after 30
seconds.
Doors and tailgate relocked: The light goes off
immediately.
2 Interior Lights P. 201
If you do not open a door or the tailgate within 30
seconds of unlocking the vehicle with the smart entry
system, the doors and tailgate will automatically
relock.
Controls
1Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System *
You can lock or unlock doors using the smart entry
system only when the power mode is in VEHICLE OFF.
• Do not leave the smart entry remote in the vehicle
when you get out. Carry it with you.
• Even if you are not carrying the smart entry remote,
you can lock/unlock the doors and the tailgate
while someone else with the remote is within
range.
• The door may be unlocked if the door handle is
covered with water in heavy rain or in a car wash if
the smart entry remote is within range.
* Not available on all models
Continued
139
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
140 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Door Lock
Button
■ Locking the doors and tailgate
Press the door lock button on the front door
or the tailgate.
u Some exterior lights flash; the beeper
sounds; all the doors and tailgate lock;
and the security system sets.
1Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System *
• If you grip a front door handle wearing gloves, the
•
•
Controls
•
•
Lock Button
140
* Not available on all models
door sensor may be slow to respond or may not
respond by unlocking the doors.
After locking the door, wait at least two seconds
before unlocking it by gripping the handle.
The door might not open if you pull it immediately
after gripping the door handle. Grip the handle
again and confirm that the door is unlocked before
pulling the handle.
Even within the 32 inches (80 cm) radius, you may
not be able to lock/unlock the doors and the
tailgate with the smart entry remote if it is above or
below the outside handle.
The smart entry remote may not operate if it is too
close to the door and door glass.
The light flash, beep, and door unlock mode settings
can be customized using the multi-information
display.
2 Customized Features P. 123
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
141 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Controls
■ Unlocking the doors and tailgate
Grab the driver’s door handle:
u The driver’s door unlocks.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
Grab the front passenger’s door handle:
u All the doors and the tailgate unlock.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
Press the tailgate release button:
u The tailgate unlocks.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
2 Opening/Closing the Tailgate P. 157
Tailgate Release
Button
Continued
141
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
142 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Locking the doors and tailgate (Walk
Controls
The activation range of
the auto lock function is
about 5 feet (1.5 m)
1
away auto lock®)
When you walk away from the vehicle while
carrying the smart entry remote, the doors
and tailgate will automatically lock.
The auto lock function activates when all
doors and tailgate are closed, and the smart
entry remote is within about 5 feet (1.5 m)
radius of the outside door handle.
Exit vehicle while carrying smart entry remote
and close door(s) and tailgate.
1. While within about 5 feet (1.5 m) radius of
the vehicle.
u The beeper sounds; the auto lock
function will be activated.
2. Carry the smart entry remote beyond about
5 feet (1.5 m) from the vehicle and remain
outside this range for 2 or more seconds.
u Some exterior lights flash; the beeper
sounds; all doors and tailgate will then
lock.
1Locking the doors and tailgate (Walk away auto lock®)
The auto lock function is set to OFF as the factory
default setting. The auto lock function can be set to
ON using the multi-information display.
If you set the auto lock function to ON using the
multi-information display, only the remote
transmitter that was used to unlock the driver’s door
prior to the setting change can activate auto lock.
2 Customized Features P. 123
After the auto lock function has been activated,
when you stay within the locking/unlocking
operation range, the indicator on the smart entry
remote will continue to flash until the doors and
tailgate are locked.
When you stay beside the vehicle within the
operation range, the doors and tailgate will
automatically lock approximately 30 seconds after
the auto lock function activating beeper sounds.
When you open a door or tailgate after the auto lock
function activating beeper sounds, the auto lock
function will be delayed until all doors and tailgate
are closed.
Under the following circumstances, the auto-lock
function will not activate:
• The smart entry remote is inside the vehicle.
uThe beeper will not sound.
• The remote is taken out of its operational range
before all the doors are closed.
uThe beeper will sound.
142
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
143 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
To temporarily deactivate the function:
1. Set the power mode to OFF.
2. Open the driver’s door.
3. Using the master door lock switch, operate
the lock as follows:
LockUnlockLockUnlock.
u The beeper sounds and the function is
deactivated.
Continued
The auto lock function does not operate when any of
the following conditions are met.
• The smart entry remote is inside the vehicle.
• A door, tailgate or the hood is not closed.
• The power mode is set to any mode other than
OFF.
• The smart entry remote is not located within a
radius of about 5 feet (1.5 m) from the vehicle
when you get out of the vehicle and close the
doors and tailgate.
Auto lock function operation stop beeper
After the auto lock function has been activated, the
auto lock operation stop beeper sounds for
approximately two seconds in the following cases.
• The smart entry remote is put inside the vehicle
through a window.
• You are located too close to the vehicle.
• The smart entry remote is put inside the tailgate.
If the warning beeper sounds, check that you are
carrying the smart entry remote. Then, open/close a
door and confirm the auto lock activation beeper
sounds once.
Controls
To restore the function:
• Set the power mode to ON.
• Lock the vehicle without using the auto lock
function
• With the smart entry remote on you, move
out of the auto lock function operation
range.
• Open any door.
1Locking the doors and tailgate (Walk away auto lock®)
143
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
144 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Using the Remote Transmitter
Unlock Button
Lock Button
LED
Controls
LED
Unlock Button
Lock Button
■ Locking the doors
Press the lock button.
Once:
u Some exterior lights flash, all the doors
and tailgate lock, and the security system
sets.
Twice (within five seconds after the first
push):
u A beeper sounds and verifies the security
system is set.
1Using the Remote Transmitter
If you do not open a door within 30 seconds of
unlocking the vehicle with the remote transmitter,
the doors will automatically relock.
Models with multi-information display
You can change the relock timer setting.
2 Customized Features P. 123
The remote transmitter uses low-power signals, so
the operating range may vary depending on the
surroundings.
The remote transmitter will not lock the vehicle when
a door is open.
Models without smart entry system
The remote transmitter will not work when the key is
in the ignition switch.
Models with smart entry system
You can lock or unlock doors using the remote
transmitter or smart entry system only when the
power mode is in VEHICLE OFF.
144
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
145 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Unlocking the doors
Press the unlock button.
Once:
u Some exterior lights flash twice, and the driver’s door unlocks.
Twice:
u The remaining doors and the tailgate unlock.
1Using the Remote Transmitter
If the distance at which the remote transmitter works
varies, the battery is probably low.
If the LED does not come on when you press a
button, the battery is dead.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 568
Models with multi-information display
You can customize the door unlock mode setting.
2 Customized Features P. 123
Controls
Continued
145
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
146 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
If the lock or unlock button of the remote does not work, use the key instead.
If the lock or unlock button of the remote
does not work, use the key instead.
Fully insert the key and turn it.
Controls
146
Lock
1Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
If you unlock the doors with the key, the alarm
activates when you open the hood or move the shift
lever out of (P .
When you lock the driver’s door with a key, all the
other doors and tailgate lock at the same time. When
unlocking, the driver’s door unlocks first. Turn the
key a second time within a few seconds to unlock the
remaining doors and the tailgate.
Unlock
Models with multi-information display
You can customize the door unlock mode setting.
2 Customized Features P. 123
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
147 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Locking a Door Without Using a Key
If you do not have the key on you, or if for some reason you cannot lock a door using
the key, you can lock the door without it.
■ Locking the driver’s door
Push the lock tab forward a or push the
master door lock switch in the lock direction
b, and close the door.
When you lock the driver’s door, all the other doors
and tailgate lock at the same time.
Before locking a door, make sure that the key is not
inside the vehicle.
Controls
■ Locking the passengers’ doors
Push the lock tab forward and close the door.
1Locking a Door Without Using a Key
■ Lockout prevention system
Models without smart entry system
The doors and the tailgate cannot be locked when the key is in the ignition switch.
Models with smart entry system
The doors and the tailgate cannot be locked when the smart entry remote is inside
the vehicle.
147
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
148 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
■ Using the Lock Tab
To lock
Lock Tab
1Using the Lock Tab
■ Locking a door
Push the lock tab forward.
■ Unlocking a door
To unlock
Controls
148
Pull the lock tab rearward.
When you lock the door using the lock tab on the
driver’s door, all of the other doors and the tailgate
lock at the same time.
When you unlock the door using the lock tab on the
driver’s door, only the driver’s door will unlock.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
149 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
■ Unlocking Using the Front Door Inner Handle
1Unlocking Using the Front Door Inner Handle
Pull the front door inner handle.
u The door unlocks and opens in one
motion.
The front door inner handles are designed to allow
front seat occupants to open the door in one motion.
However, this feature requires that front seat
occupants never pull a front door inner handle while
the vehicle is in motion.
Children should always ride in a rear seat where
childproof door locks are provided.
2 Childproof Door Locks P. 151
Inner Handle
Controls
Unlocking and opening the driver’s door from the inner handle unlocks all the other
doors.
To avoid all the doors to be unlocked, use the lock tab on the driver’s door to unlock,
then lock again before opening the door.
u This setting works for one time only.
Models with multi-information display
If you do not want all the doors to be unlocked all the time, customize the Auto
Door Unlock setting to OFF using the multi-information display.
2 Customized Features P. 123
Models without multi-information display
If you do not want all the doors to unlock all the time, customize the Auto Door
Unlock setting to Off using the master door lock switch.
2 Customizing the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Setting * P. 153
* Not available on all models
Continued
149
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
150 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
■ Using the Master Door Lock Switch
Press the master door lock switch in as shown
to lock or unlock all the doors and the tailgate.
To lock
Controls
150
To unlock
Master Door
Lock Switch
1Using the Master Door Lock Switch
When you lock/unlock the driver’s door using the
master door lock switch, all the other doors and the
tailgate lock/unlock at the same time.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
151 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuChildproof Door Locks
Childproof Door Locks
The childproof door locks prevent the rear doors from being opened from the inside
regardless of the position of the lock tab.
■ Setting the Childproof Door Locks
Slide the lever in the rear door to the lock
position, and close the door.
Unlock
To open the door from the inside when the
childproof door lock is on, put the lock tab in the
unlock position, lower the rear window, put your
hand out of the window, and pull the outside door
handle.
Controls
Lock
■ When opening the door
Open the door using the outside door handle.
1Childproof Door Locks
151
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
152 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuAuto Door Locking/Unlocking
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
Your vehicle locks and unlocks all doors automatically when a certain condition is
met.
■ Auto Door Locking
■ Drive lock mode
1Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
You can turn off or change to another auto door
locking/unlocking setting using the master door lock
switch.
2 Customizing the Auto Door Locking/
Unlocking Setting * P. 153
All doors lock when the vehicle’s speed reaches about 10 mph (15 km/h).
Models with multi-information display
■ Auto Door Unlocking
Controls
■ Driver’s door open mode
152
* Not available on all models
All doors and the tailgate unlock when the driver’s door is opened.
You can turn off or change to another auto door
locking/unlocking setting using the multi-information
display.
2 Customized Features P. 123
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
153 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuCustomizing the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Setting *
Customizing the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Setting *
You can customize the auto door locking/unlocking setting to your liking using the master door lock switch.
■ List of the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Customizable
Options
■ Auto door locking
Mode
Description
All doors lock when the vehicle’s speed reaches about 10 mph (15 km/h).
Off
The auto door locking is deactivated all the time.
Controls
Drive Lock Mode*1
■ Auto door unlocking
Mode
Description
Driver’s Door Open
Mode*1
All doors and the tailgate unlock when the driver’s door is opened.
Park Unlock Mode
All doors unlock when the transmission is put into (P with the brake pedal depressed.
Off
The auto door unlocking is deactivated all the time.
*1:Default setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
153
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
154 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuCustomizing the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Setting *
■ Customizing Flow for Auto Door Locking Options
Steps
Drive Lock Mode*1
1
Apply the parking brake.
2
The driver’s door must be closed at this stage.
3
Turn the ignition switch to ON (w .
Off
Open the driver’s door.
*2
Controls
Press and hold the front of the master door lock switch on the driver’s door. You will hear a click more than five seconds elapsed.
Release the switch.
4
5
Turn the ignition switch to OFF (0 within 20 seconds*2.
u Customization is completed.
u All doors unlock and all turn signals blink three times.
*1:Default setting
*2:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
154
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
155 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuCustomizing the Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Setting *
■ Customizing Flow for Auto Door Unlocking Options
Steps
Driver Door Open Unlock Mode*1
Park Unlock Mode
Apply the parking brake.
Move the shift lever out of (P with the
brake pedal depressed.
2
The driver’s door must be closed at this stage.
3
Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *2.
Apply the parking brake.
Move the shift lever to (P .
Apply the parking brake.
Move the shift lever to (P .
Open the driver’s door.
Press and hold the rear of the master door lock switch on the driver’s door. You will hear a click more than five seconds elapsed.
Release the switch.
Controls
1
Off
4
5
Turn the ignition switch to OFF (0 within 20 seconds*2.
u Customization is completed.
u All doors lock and all turn signals blink three times.
*1:Default setting
*2:Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
155
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
156 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Tailgate
Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
Always make sure individuals and objects are clear of the tailgate before opening or
closing it.
• Open the tailgate all the way.
u If it is not fully opened, the tailgate may begin to close under its own weight.
• Be careful when it is windy. The wind may cause the tailgate to close.
Keep the tailgate closed while driving to:
u Avoid possible damage.
u Prevent exhaust gas from leaking into the vehicle.
1Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
3 WARNING
Anyone caught in the path of a tailgate
that is being opened or closed can be
seriously injured.
Make sure that all people are clear of the
tailgate before opening or closing it.
2 Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 77
Controls
Be careful not to hit your head on the tailgate or to
put your hands between the tailgate and the cargo
area when closing the tailgate.
When you are storing or picking up luggage from the
cargo area while the engine is idling, do not stand in
front of the exhaust pipe. You may get burned.
Do not allow any passenger in the cargo space. They
may get hurt during hard braking, a sudden
acceleration, or a crash.
156
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
157 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuTailgateuOpening/Closing the Tailgate
Opening/Closing the Tailgate
Tailgate
Release
Button
When all the doors are unlocked or press the
tailgate unlock button on the remote
transmitter, the tailgate is unlocked. Press the
tailgate release button and lift open the
tailgate.
Inner
Handle
Models with smart entry system
• Do not leave the smart entry remote in the vehicle
when you get out. Carry it with you.
• Even if you are not carrying the smart entry remote,
you can unlock the tailgate while someone else
with the remote is within range.
• Do not leave the smart entry remote inside the
cargo area and close the tailgate. The beeper
sounds and the tailgate cannot be closed.
If you are carrying the smart entry remote, you do not
have to unlock the tailgate before opening it.
Controls
To close the tailgate, grab the inner handle,
pull the tailgate down, and push it closed
from outside.
1Opening/Closing the Tailgate
If you close the tailgate when all the doors are
locked, the tailgate locks automatically.
u Some exterior lights flash.
Continued
157
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
158 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuTailgateuOpening/Closing the Tailgate
■ Using the Remote Transmitter
Press the tailgate unlock button to unlock the
tailgate.
Controls
Tailgate
Unlock
Button
Tailgate
Unlock
Button
158
1Using the Remote Transmitter
If you have unlocked and opened the tailgate using
the remote transmitter or smart entry remote, when
closing, the tailgate locks automatically.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
159 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Security System
Immobilizer System
The immobilizer system prevents a key that has not been pre-registered from
starting the engine. Each key contains electronic transmitters that use electronic
signals to verify the key.
NOTICE
Leaving the key in the vehicle can result in theft or
accidental movement of the vehicle.
Always take the key with you whenever you leave the
vehicle unattended.
Do not alter the system or add other devices to it.
Doing so may damage the system and make your
vehicle inoperable.
Controls
Pay attention to the following when inserting the key into the ignition switch or
pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button:
• Do not allow objects that emit strong radio waves near the ignition switch or the
ENGINE START/STOP button.
• Make sure the key is not covered by or touching a metal object.
• Do not bring a key from another vehicle’s immobilizer system near the ignition
switch or the ENGINE START/STOP button.
• Do not put the key near magnetic items. Electronic device, such as televisions and
audio systems emit strong magnetic fields. Note that even a key chain can
become magnetic.
1Immobilizer System
Security System Alarm
The security system alarm activates when the tailgate, hood or doors are forcibly
opened. The alarm does not activate if the tailgate or doors are opened with the key,
remote transmitter or smart entry system *.
However, the alarm activates if a door is opened with the key and then the
transmission is taken out of (P or the hood is opened before the ignition switch is
turned to ON (w *1.
1Security System Alarm
The security alarm continues for a maximum of two
minutes until the security system alarm deactivates.
■ When the security system alarm activates
The horn sounds intermittently and all of the exterior lights flash.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
159
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
160 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSecurity SystemuSecurity System Alarm
■ To deactivate the security system alarm
Unlock the vehicle using the remote transmitter or smart entry remote *, or turn the
ignition switch to ON (w *1. The system, along with the horn and flashing lights, is
deactivated.
■ Setting the security system alarm
Controls
The security system alarm automatically sets when the following conditions have
been met:
• The ignition switch is in LOCK (0 *1.
• The hood is closed.
• All doors and the tailgate are locked from outside with the key, remote
transmitter, or smart entry system *.
Models without smart entry system
• The key has been removed from the ignition switch.
■ When the security system alarm sets
The security system alarm indicator in the instrument panel blinks. When the
blinking interval changes after about 15 seconds, the security system alarm is set.
■ To cancel the security system alarm
The security system alarm is canceled when the vehicle is unlocked using the remote
transmitter or smart entry system *, or when the ignition switch is turned to ON (w *1.
The security system alarm indicator goes off at the same time.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
160
* Not available on all models
1Security System Alarm
Do not set the security system alarm when someone
is in the vehicle or a window is open. The system can
accidentally activate when:
• Unlocking the door with the lock tab.
• Opening the hood with the hood release handle.
• Moving the shift lever out of (P .
If the battery goes dead after you have set the
security system alarm, the security alarm may activate
once the battery is recharged or replaced.
If this occurs, deactivate the security system alarm by
unlocking a door using the key, remote transmitter,
or smart entry system *.
Do not alter the system or add other devices to it.
Doing so may damage the system and make your
vehicle inoperable.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
161 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSecurity SystemuSecurity System Alarm
■ Panic Mode
■ The panic button on the remote
transmitter
If you press the panic button for
approximately one second, the following will
occur for about 30 seconds:
• The horn sounds.
• Some exterior lights flash.
■ Canceling panic mode
• Press any button on the remote transmitter.
• Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
Controls
Panic Button
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
161
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
162 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Opening and Closing the Windows
Opening/Closing the Power Windows
The power windows can be opened and closed when the ignition switch is in ON
(w *1, using the switches on the doors. The driver’s side switches can be used to
open and close all of the windows.
The power window lock button on the driver’s side must be switched off (not
pushed in, indicator off) to open and close the windows from anywhere other than
the driver’s seat.
Controls
When the power window lock button is pushed in, the indicator comes on and you
can only operate the driver’s window. Turn the power window lock button on if a
child is in the vehicle.
■ Opening/Closing Windows with Auto-Open/Close Function
Driver’s
Window
Switch
On
Off
Indicator
Power Window Lock Button
■ Automatic operation
To open: Push the switch down firmly.
To close: Pull the switch up firmly.
The window opens or closes completely. To
stop the window at any time, push or pull the
switch briefly.
■ Manual operation
To open: Push the switch down lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Pull the switch up lightly, and hold it
until the desired position is reached.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
162
1Opening/Closing the Power Windows
3 WARNING
Closing a power window on someone’s
hands or fingers can cause serious injury.
Make sure your passengers are away from
the windows before closing them.
The power windows can be operated for up to 10
minutes after you turn the ignition switch to LOCK
(0 *1. Opening either front door cancels this function.
Auto Reverse
If a power window senses resistance when closing
automatically, it will stop closing and reverse
direction.
The driver’s window auto reverse function is disabled
when you continuously pull up the switch.
The auto reverse function stops sensing when the
window is almost closed to ensure that it fully closes.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
163 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOpening and Closing the WindowsuOpening/Closing the Power Windows
■ Opening/Closing Windows without Auto-Open/Close
Function
To open: Push the switch down.
To close: Pull the switch up.
Close
Open
Release the switch when the window reaches
the desired position.
Controls
163
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
164 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Moonroof *
Opening/Closing the Moonroof
You can only operate the moonroof when the power mode is in ON. Use the switch
in the front of the ceiling to open and close the moonroof.
■ Using the Moonroof Switch
■ Automatic operation
Open
Controls
Close
Tilt
To open: Pull the switch back firmly.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly.
The moonroof will automatically open or close
all the way. To stop the moonroof midway,
touch the switch briefly.
■ Manual operation
To open: Pull the switch back lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Push the switch forward lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
■ Tilting the moonroof up
To tilt: Push on the center of the moonroof
switch.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly,
then release.
164
* Not available on all models
1Opening/Closing the Moonroof
3 WARNING
Opening or closing the moonroof on
someone’s hands or fingers can cause
serious injury.
Make sure all hands and fingers are clear of
the moonroof before opening or closing it.
NOTICE
Opening the moonroof in below freezing
temperature or when it is covered with snow or ice
can damage the moonroof panel or motor.
The moonroof can be operated for up to 10 minutes
after you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF.
Opening either front door cancels this function.
When resistance is detected, the auto reverse
function causes the moonroof to change directions,
then stop. Auto reverse stops sensing when the
moonroof is almost closed to ensure that it fully
closes. Make sure that all objects, including fingers,
are clear of the moonroof.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
165 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel
Models without smart entry system
Ignition Switch
1Ignition Switch
You cannot take the key out unless the shift lever is
in (P .
(0 LOCK: Insert and remove the key in this
position.
(q ACCESSORY: Operate the audio system and
other accessories in this position.
(w ON: This is the position when driving.
Models with multi-information display
When the warning buzzer sounds, the following
messages appear on the multi-information display:
• In LOCK (0 : the symbol
with an Remove
Key From Ignition
• In ACCESSORY (q : the symbol
with a
Return Ignition Switch To Lock (0) Position
Controls
(e START: This position is for starting the engine.
The switch returns to ON (w when you let go of
the key.
If you open the driver’s door when the key is in LOCK
(0 or ACCESSORY (q , a warning buzzer will sound
to remind you to take the key out.
If the key won’t turn from LOCK (0 to ACCESSORY
(q , turn the key while moving the steering wheel left
and right. The steering wheel will unlock, allowing
the key to turn.
165
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
166 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
Models with smart entry system
ENGINE START/STOP Button
1ENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Changing the Power Mode
ENGINE START/STOP Button Operating Range
You can start the engine when the smart entry
remote is inside the vehicle.
Continuously Variable Transmission
*2
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
The button is off.
The steering wheel is locked*1.
The power to all electrical
components is turned off.
Controls
ACCESSORY
The button blinks (in red).
Operate the audio system and
other accessories in this position.
ON
The button blinks (in red).
All electrical components can be used.
Without pressing
the brake pedal
Press the button without the
transmission in (P .
Press the button with the
transmission in (P .
*1: Canadian models
*2: U.S. models
166
Press the button.
Put the transmission into (P *2.
Operating Range
If the battery of the smart entry remote is getting
low, the engine may not start when you push the
ENGINE START/STOP button. If the engine does not
start, refer to the following link.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
P. 592
The engine may also run if the smart entry remote is
close to the door or window, even if it is outside the
vehicle.
ON mode:
The ENGINE START/STOP button is on (in red), if the
engine is running.
Do not leave the power mode in ACCESSORY or ON
when you get out.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
167 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Automatic Power Off
1Changing the Power Mode
If you leave the vehicle for 30 to 60 minutes with the transmission in (P and the
power mode in ACCESSORY, the vehicle automatically goes into the mode similar to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) to avoid draining the battery.
When in this mode:
Canadian models
If the power mode does not change from VEHICLE
OFF to ACCESSORY, press the ENGINE START/STOP
button while moving the steering wheel left and
right. The steering wheel will unlock, allowing the
mode to change.
Canadian models
The steering wheel does not lock.
Controls
All models
You cannot lock or unlock doors with the remote transmitter or the smart entry
system.
Press the ENGINE START/STOP button to switch the mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
2 Changing the Power Mode P. 166
Continued
167
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
168 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Power Mode Reminder
If you open the driver’s door when the power mode is in ACCESSORY, a warning
buzzer sounds.
■ Smart Entry Remote Reminder
Controls
When the power mode is set to any mode
other than OFF and you remove the smart
entry remote from the vehicle and shut the
door, an alarm will sound. If the alarm
continues to sound, place the smart entry
remote in another location.
■ When the power mode is in
ACCESSORY
The alarm will sound from outside the vehicle.
■ When the power mode is in ON
An alarm will sound both inside and outside
the vehicle. In addition, a warning indicator
will appear on the instrument panel.
168
1Smart Entry Remote Reminder
When the smart entry remote is within the system’s
operational range, and all the doors are closed, the
warning function cancels.
If the smart entry remote is taken out of the vehicle
after the engine has been started, you can no longer
change the ENGINE START/STOP button mode or
restart the engine. Always make sure if the remote is
in your vehicle when you operate the ENGINE
START/STOP button.
Removing the smart entry remote from the vehicle
through a window does not activate the warning
buzzer.
Do not put the smart entry remote on the dashboard
or in the glove box. It may cause the warning buzzer
to activate. Under some other conditions that can
prevent the vehicle from locating the remote, the
warning buzzer may also activate even if the remote
is within the system’s operational range.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
169 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluIgnition Switch and Power Mode Comparison
Ignition Switch and Power Mode Comparison
Ignition Switch
Position
LOCK (0
(with/without
the key)
ACCESSORY (q
ON (w
START (e
• Use this position to start
the engine.
• The ignition switch
returns to the ON (w
position when you
release the key.
Power Mode
START
VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK)
ACCESSORY
ON
Button is: Blinking
With Smart Entry
Button-Off
Button-Blinking
System and ENGINE • Engine is turned off and • Engine is turned off.
START/STOP
power is shut down.
• Some electrical
Button
• The steering wheel is
components such as the
locked*1.
audio system and the
• No electrical
accessory power socket
components can be
can be operated.
used.
Controls
Without Smart Entry • Engine is turned off and • Engine is turned off.
• Normal key position
System
power is shut down.
• Some electrical
while driving.
• The steering wheel is
components such as the • All electrical
locked.
audio system and the
components can be
• No electrical
accessory power socket
used.
components can be
can be operated.
used.
On
ButtonBlinking (engine is turned
off)
On (engine is running)
• All electrical
components can be
used.
Button-On
• The mode automatically
returns to ON after the
engine starts.
*1 : Canadian models
169
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
170 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluTurn Signals
Turn Signals
(A)
(B)
The turn signals can be used when the ignition
switch is in ON (w *1.
■ (A): Turn signal
When turning the car, push the lever up or
down based on the direction you want to
turn, and the turn signal will blink.
(B)
■ (B): One-touch turn signal
Controls
(A)
When you lightly push the lever up or down
and release it, the turn signal will blink 3
times.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
170
1Turn Signals
The turn signal indicator on the instrument panel will
blink when the external turn signal blinks.
2 Indicators P. 80
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
171 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
Light Switches
■ Manual Operation
U.S. models
High Beams
1Light Switches
Models without smart entry system
Rotating the light switch turns the lights on
and off, regardless of the power mode setting
or position of the ignition switch.
If you remove the key from the ignition switch while
the lights are on, a chime sounds when the driver’s
door is opened.
■ High beams
Push the lever forward until you hear a click.
If you leave the power mode in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
while the lights are on, a chime sounds when the
driver’s door is opened.
■ Low beams
When in high beams, pull the lever back to
return to low beams.
When the lights are on, the lights on indicator in the
instrument panel will be on.
2 Lights On Indicator P. 92
■ Flashing the high beams
If you sense that the level of the headlights is
abnormal, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
Models with smart entry system
Canadian models
High Beams
Pull the lever back, and release it.
Canadian models
Flashing the high beams
Low Beams
Turns on parking lights, side
marker, tail, and rear license
plate lights
Turns on headlights, side
marker, parking lights, tail, and
rear license plate lights
■ Lights off
Turn the lever to OFF either when:
• The shift lever is in (P .
• The parking brake is applied.
To turn the lights on again, turn the lever to
OFF to cancel the lights off mode. Even if you
do not cancel the lights off mode, the lights
come on automatically when:
• The transmission is moved out of (P and
the parking brake is released.
• The vehicle starts to move.
Continued
Controls
Flashing the high beams
Low Beams
Do not leave the lights on when the engine is off
because it will cause the battery to discharge.
171
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
172 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
■ Automatic Operation (automatic lighting control) *
U.S. models
Automatic lighting control can be used when
the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
U.S. models
Controls
When you turn the light switch to AUTO, the
headlights and other exterior lights will switch
on and off automatically depending on the
ambient brightness.
1Automatic Operation (automatic lighting control) *
We recommend that you turn on the lights manually
when driving at night, in a dense fog, or in dark areas
such as long tunnels or parking facilities.
The light sensor is in the location shown below.
Do not cover this light sensor with anything;
otherwise, the automatic lighting system may not
work properly.
Models without automatic
intermittent wipers
Light Sensor
Canadian models
Canadian models
When the light switch is in AUTO, the
headlights and other exterior lights will switch
on and off automatically depending on the
ambient brightness.
The headlights come on when you unlock a
door in dark areas with the headlight switch in
AUTO.
u Once you lock the door, the headlights
will go off.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
172
* Not available on all models
Models with automatic intermittent
wipers
Light Sensor
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
173 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
■ Headlight Integration with Wipers *
The headlights automatically come on when the wipers are used several times within
a number of certain intervals with the headlight switch in AUTO.
The headlights automatically go off a few minutes later if the wipers are stopped.
■ Automatic Lighting Off Feature
U.S. models
You can adjust the auto light sensitivity as follow:
Setting
The exterior lights come on
when the ambient light is at
Max
High
Mid
Low
Min
Bright
Dark
2 Customized Features P. 123
If you turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1 with the headlight switch on, but do
not open the door, the lights turn off after 10 minutes (3 minutes, if the switch is in
the AUTO * position).
The lights turn on again when you unlock or open the driver’s door. If you unlock
the door, but do not open it within 15 seconds, the lights go off. If you open the
driver’s door, you will hear a lights on reminder chime.
Controls
The headlights, all other exterior lights, and the instrument panel lights turn off 15
seconds after you remove the key or set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK),
take the remote with you, and close the driver’s door.
1Automatic Operation (automatic lighting control) *
1Headlight Integration with Wipers *
This feature activates while the headlights are off in
AUTO.
The instrument panel brightness does not change
when the headlights come on.
At dark ambient light levels, the automatic lighting
control feature turns on the headlights, regardless of
the number of wiper sweeps.
1Automatic Lighting Off Feature
Models with multi-information display
You can change the headlight auto off timer setting.
2 Customized Features P. 123
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
173
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
174 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluFog Lights *
Fog Lights *
When the low beam headlights are on, turn
the fog light switch on to use the fog lights.
Fog Light Switch
Controls
174
* Not available on all models
1Fog Lights *
When the fog lights are on, the indicator in the
instrument panel will be on.
They go off when the headlights turn off, or when
the daytime running lights are on.
2 Fog Light Indicator * P. 92
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
175 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDaytime Running Lights
Daytime Running Lights
The parking/daytime running lights come on when the following conditions have
been met:
• The ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
U.S. models
• The headlight switch is OFF.
1Daytime Running Lights
The daytime running lights come on dimmer when
the headlight switch is in
than when it is in
AUTO *. In AUTO *, if the ambient brightness is dark,
the low beam headlights come on.
Canadian models
• The headlight switch is AUTO.
All models
The lights remain on even if you set the parking brake. Turning off the ignition
switch or setting the power mode to VEHICLE OFF will turn off the daytime running
lights.
Controls
• The parking brake is released.
The daytime running lights are off once the headlight switch is turned on, or when
the head light switch is in AUTO * and it is getting darker outside.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
175
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
176 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAuto High-Beam *
Auto High-Beam *
The front sensor camera detects the light sources ahead of the vehicle such as the
lights of a preceding or oncoming vehicle, or street lights. When you are driving at
night, the system automatically switches the headlights between low beam and high
beam depending on the situation.
Front Sensor Camera
1Auto High-Beam *
The auto high-beam system does not always operate
in every situation. This system is just for assisting the
driver. Always observe your surroundings and switch
the headlights between high beam and low beam
manually if necessary.
If you find the timing of beam changes inconvenient
for driving, change the headlight beams manually.
Controls
The range and the distance at which the camera can
recognize varies depending on conditions
surrounding your vehicle.
■ How to Use the Auto High-Beam
When all of the following conditions have been met, the auto high-beam indicator
comes on and the auto high-beam is activated.
• The ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
Auto High• The light switch is in AUTO.
Beam
•
The lever is in the low beam position.
Indicator
• The headlights have been automatically
activated.
Light Switch
• It is dark outside the vehicle.
If the auto high-beam indicator does not come on even when all the conditions have
been met, carry out the following procedure and the indicator will come on.
• Pull the lever toward you for flashing the high beams then release it while driving.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
176
* Not available on all models
Regarding the handling of the camera mounted to
the inside of the windshield, refer to the following.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
For the auto high-beam to work properly:
• Do not place an object that reflects light on the
dashboard.
• Keep the windshield around the camera clean.
When cleaning the windshield, be careful not to
apply the windshield cleanser to the camera lens.
• Do not attach an object, sticker or film to the area
around the camera.
• Do not touch the camera lens.
If the camera receives a strong impact, or repairing of
the area near the camera is required, consult a dealer.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
177 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAuto High-Beam *
■ Automatic switching between high-beam and low-beam
1How to Use the Auto High-Beam
When auto-high beam is active, the headlights switch between high beam and low
beam based on the following conditions.
Switching to low beam:
All of the following conditions
must be met before the high
beams turn on.
• Your vehicle speed is 45 mph
(72 km/h) or more.
• There are no preceding or
oncoming vehicle with
headlights or taillights turned
on.
• There are few street lights on
the road ahead.
One of the following conditions
must be met before the low beams
turn on.
• Your vehicle speed is 30 mph
(48 km/h) or less.
• There is a preceding or
oncoming vehicle with
headlights or taillights turned
on.
• There are many street lights on
the road ahead.
■ Manual switching between high-beam and low-beam
If you want to manually switch the headlights between high beam and low beam,
follow either of the procedures below. Note that when you do this, the auto highbeam indicator will turn off and the auto high-beam will be deactivated.
Using the lever:
Pull the lever toward you for flashing the high beams then release it within about
one second while driving.
u To reactivate the auto high-beam, pull the lever toward you for flashing the
high beams then release it while driving. The auto high-beam indicator will
come on.
Using the light switch:
Turn the light switch to
.
u To reactivate the auto high-beam, turn the light switch to AUTO when the
lever is in the low beam position, the auto high-beam indicator will come on.
Continued
• The brightness of the lights from the preceding or
oncoming vehicle is intense or poor.
• Visibility is poor due to the weather (rain, snow,
fog, windshield frost, etc.).
• Surrounding light sources, such as street lights,
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
electric billboards and traffic lights are illuminating
the road ahead.
The brightness level of the road ahead constantly
changes.
The road is bumpy or has many curves.
A vehicle suddenly appears in front of you, or a
vehicle in front of you is not in the preceding or
oncoming direction.
Your vehicle is tilted with a heavy load in the rear.
A traffic sign, mirror, or other reflective object
ahead is reflecting strong light toward the vehicle.
The oncoming vehicle frequently disappears under
roadside trees or behind median barriers.
The preceding or oncoming vehicle is a motorcycle,
bicycle, mobility scooter, or other small vehicle.
Controls
Switching to high beam:
In the following cases, the auto high-beam system
may not switch the headlights properly or the
switching timing may be changed. In case of the
automatic switching operation does not fit for your
driving habits, please switch the headlights manually.
The auto high-beam system keeps the headlight low
beam when:
• Windshield wipers are operating.
• The camera has been detected a dense fog.
177
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
178 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAuto High-Beam *
■ How to Turn Off the Auto High-Beam
Controls
You can turn the auto high-beam system off. If you want to turn the system off or
on, turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then carry out the following procedures
while the vehicle is stationary.
To turn the system off:
AUTO Position
With the light switch is in AUTO, pull the lever
toward you and hold it for at least 40 seconds.
After the auto high-beam indicator light blinks
twice, release the lever.
To turn the system on:
With the light switch is in AUTO, pull the lever
toward you and hold it for at least 30 seconds.
After the auto high-beam indicator light blinks
once, release the lever.
1How to Use the Auto High-Beam
If the Some Driver Assist Systems Cannot
Operate: Camera Temperature Too High message
appears:
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, also use defroster mode
with the airflow directed toward the camera.
• Start driving the vehicle to lower the windshield
temperature, which cools down the area around
the camera.
If the Some Driver Assist Systems Cannot
Operate: Clean Front Windshield message
appears:
• Park your vehicle in a safe place, and clean the
windshield. If the message does not disappear after
you have cleaned the windshield and driven for a
while, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
1How to Turn Off the Auto High-Beam
If you turn the auto high-beam system off, the system
does not operate until you turn the system on.
Park in a safe place before turning the system off or
on.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
178
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
179 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
Wipers and Washers
■ Windshield Wiper/Washer
1Wipers and Washers
The windshield wipers and washers can be
used when the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
Pull to
use
washer.
MIST
OFF
INT*2/AUTO*3
LO: Low speed wipe
■ Wiper switch (OFF, INT*2/AUTO*3, LO,
HI)
Change the wiper switch setting according to
the amount of rain.
NOTICE
In cold weather, the blades may freeze to the
windshield.
Operating the wipers in this condition may damage
the wipers. Use the defroster to warm the
windshield, then turn the wipers on.
Controls
Intermittent Time
Adjustment Ring *
■ MIST
The wipers run at high speed until you release
the lever.
NOTICE
Do not use the wipers when the windshield is dry.
The windshield will get scratched, or the rubber
blades will get damaged.
Models with intermittent time adjustment ring
■ Adjusting wiper operation *
Turn the adjustment ring to adjust the wiper
delay.
Lower speed, fewer sweeps
HI: High speed wipe
Higher speed, more sweeps
If the vehicle speeds up while the wipers are
operating intermittently, the length of the wipe
interval shortens.
When the vehicle speeds up, the wiper operation’s
shortest delay setting ( ) and the LO setting become
the same.
All models
■ Washer
Sprays while you pull the lever toward you.
When you release the lever for more than one
second, the spray stops, the wipers sweep two
or three more times to clear the windshield,
then stop.
Turn the washers off if no washer fluid comes out.
The pump may get damaged.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
*2: Models with manual intermittent operation
*3: Models with automatic intermittent operation
* Not available on all models
Continued
179
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
180 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
■ Automatic Intermittent Wipers *
When you push the lever down to AUTO, the
windshield wipers sweep once, and go into
the automatic mode.
Controls
Adjustment Ring
The wipers operate intermittently, at low
speed, or at high speed and stops in
accordance with the amount of rainfall the
rainfall sensor detects.
■ Auto sensitivity adjustment
When in AUTO, you can also adjust the rainfall sensor sensitivity using the
adjustment ring.
1Wipers and Washers
If the wiper stops operating due to any obstacle such as
the build-up of snow, park the vehicle in a safe place.
Rotate the wiper switch to OFF, and turn the ignition
switch to ACCESSORY (q or LOCK (0 *1, then
remove the obstacle.
The wiper motor may stop motor operation
temporarily to prevent an overload.
Wiper operation will return to normal within a few
minutes, once the circuit has returned to normal.
1Automatic Intermittent Wipers *
The rainfall sensor is in the location shown below.
Rainfall Sensor
Sensor sensitivity
Low sensitivity
High sensitivity
NOTICE
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
180
* Not available on all models
AUTO should always be turned OFF before the
following situations in order to prevent severe
damage to the wiper system:
• Cleaning the windshield
• Driving through a car wash
• No rain present
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
181 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
■ Rear Wiper/Washer
The rear wiper and washer can be used when
the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
■ Wiper switch (OFF, INT, ON)
Change the wiper switch setting according to
the amount of rain.
OFF
Washer
■ Washer ( )
Sprays while you rotate the switch to this
position.
Controls
ON
INT: Intermittent
Hold it to activate the wiper and to spray the
washer. Once released, it stops operating
after a few more sweeps.
■ Operating in reverse
When you shift the transmission to (R with the windshield wiper activated, the rear
wiper operates automatically as follows even if its switch is off.
Front Wiper Position
Rear Wiper Operation
INT (Intermittent)
AUTO * (Intermittent)
Intermittent
*
LO (Low speed wipe)
HI (High speed wipe)
Continuous
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
181
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
182 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDefogger/Heated Door Mirror */Heated Windshield *
Defogger/Heated Door Mirror */Heated Windshield *
■ Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror * Button
Models with heating and cooling system
Press the rear defogger button or touch the
icon to defog the rear window and mirrors *
when the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
Models with climate control system
Controls
Models with climate control system
The rear defogger and heated door mirrors *
automatically switch off after 10-30 minutes
depending on the outside temperature.
However, if the outside temperature is 32°F
(0°C) or below, they do not automatically
switch off.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
182
* Not available on all models
1Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror * Button
This system consumes a lot of power, so turn it off
when the window has been defogged.
Also, do not use the system for a long time while the
engine is idling. This may weaken the battery, making
it difficult to start the engine.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
183 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDefogger/Heated Door Mirror */Heated Windshield *
Canadian models
1Heated Windshield Button
■ Heated Windshield Button
Press the heated windshield button to deice
the windshield when the ignition switch is
turned to ON (w *1.
This system consumes a lot of power, so turn it off
when the window has been deiced.
Also, do not use the system for a long time while the
engine is idling. This may weaken the battery, making
it difficult to start the engine.
The heated windshield automatically switch
off after 15 minutes.
Controls
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
183
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
184 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluBrightness Control
Brightness Control
When the ignition switch is in ON (w *1, you
can use the
(select/reset) knob to adjust
instrument panel brightness.
Brighten: Turn the knob to the right.
Dim: Turn the knob to the left.
(Select/Reset) Knob
Controls
You will hear a beeper when the brightness
reaches minimum or maximum. Several
seconds after you have adjusted the
brightness, you will be returned to the
previous screen.
1Brightness Control
The brightness of the instrument panel will be
reduced when the following conditions:
• The ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
Models without automatic lighting control
• The parking lights are turned on.
Models with automatic lighting control
• The light switch is in any position other than off
and it is dark outside.
To cancel the reduced instrument panel brightness
when the exterior lights are on, turn the knob to the
right until the brightness display is up to max, the
beeper sounds.
The brightness can be set differently for when the
exterior lights are on, and when they are off.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
184
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
185 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluBrightness Control
Models with information display
Controls
Models with multi-information
display
■ Brightness level indicator
The brightness level is shown on the
information display/multi-information display
while you are adjusting it.
185
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
186 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAdjusting the Steering Wheel
Adjusting the Steering Wheel
Controls
186
The steering wheel height and distance from your body can be adjusted so that you
can comfortably grip the steering wheel in an appropriate driving posture.
1. Pull the steering wheel adjustment lever up.
u The steering wheel adjustment lever is
To adjust
under the steering column.
2. Move the steering wheel up or down, and
in or out.
To lock
u Make sure you can see the instrument
panel gauges and indicators.
3. Push the steering wheel adjustment lever
Lever
down to lock the steering wheel in position.
u After adjusting the position, make sure
you have securely locked the steering
wheel in place by trying to move it up,
down, in, and out.
1Adjusting the Steering Wheel
3 WARNING
Adjusting the steering wheel position while
driving may cause you to lose control of the
vehicle and be seriously injured in a crash.
Adjust the steering wheel only when the
vehicle is stopped.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
187 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror
Adjust the angle of the rearview mirror when you are sitting in the correct driving
position.
■ Rearview Mirror with Day and Night Positions *
Tab
Keep the inside and outside mirrors clean and
adjusted for best visibility.
Adjust the mirrors before you start driving.
2 Front Seats P. 190
Controls
Daytime
Position
Flip the tab to switch the position.
The night position will help to reduce the glare
from headlights behind you when driving
after dark.
1Adjusting the Mirrors
Night
Position
* Not available on all models
Continued
187
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
188 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the MirrorsuInterior Rearview Mirror
■ Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror *
Models without HomeLink buttons
Controls
Indicator
Sensor
Auto Button
Models with HomeLink buttons
Sensor
Auto Button
188
* Not available on all models
When you are driving after dark, the
automatic dimming rearview mirror reduces
the glare from headlights behind you. Press
the auto button to turn this function on and
off. When activated, the auto indicator comes
on.
1Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror *
The auto dimming function cancels when the shift
position is in (R .
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
189 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the MirrorsuPower Door Mirrors
Power Door Mirrors
Selector Switch
Adjustment Switch
You can adjust the door mirrors when the
ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
Controls
■ Mirror position adjustment
L/R selector switch: Select the left or right
mirror. After adjusting the mirror, return the
switch to the center position.
Mirror position adjustment switch: Press
the switch left, right, up, or down to move the
mirror.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
189
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
190 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Adjusting the Seats
Front Seats
Allow sufficient
space.
Move back.
Controls
Adjust the driver’s seat as far back as possible
while allowing you to maintain full control of
the vehicle. You should be able to sit upright,
well back in the seat and be able to
adequately press the pedals without leaning
forward, and grip the steering wheel
comfortably. The passenger’s seat should be
adjusted in a similar manner, so that it is as far
back from the front airbag in the dashboard
as possible.
■ Adjusting the Seat Positions
Horizontal
Position
Adjustment
190
* Not available on all models
3 WARNING
Sitting too close to a front airbag can result
in serious injury or death if the front
airbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from the front
airbags as possible while maintaining
control of the vehicle.
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
and Transport Canada recommend that drivers allow
at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the center of the
steering wheel and the chest.
■ Adjusting the driver’s power seat *
Height
Adjustment
(Driver’s seat
only)
1Adjusting the Seats
Always make seat adjustments before driving.
1Adjusting the Seat Positions
Seat-back
Angle
Adjustment
Once a seat is adjusted correctly, rock it back and
forth to make sure it is locked in position.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
191 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuFront Seats
■ Adjusting the front manual seat(s) *
Height Adjustment
(Driver side only)
Pull up or push down the lever
to raise or lower the seat.
Seat-back Angle Adjustment
Pull up on the bar to move the
seat, then release the bar.
Pull up the lever to change the
angle.
Controls
Horizontal Position
Adjustment
Driver’s seat is shown.
* Not available on all models
Continued
191
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
192 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuFront Seats
■ Adjusting the Seat-Backs
1Adjusting the Seat-Backs
Adjust the driver’s seat-back to a comfortable,
upright position, leaving ample space
between your chest and the airbag cover in
the center of the steering wheel.
Controls
192
The front seat passenger should also adjust
their seat-back to a comfortable, upright
position.
Reclining a seat-back so that the shoulder part of the belt no longer rests against the
occupant’s chest reduces the protective capability of the belt. It also increases the
chance of sliding under the belt in a crash and being seriously injured. The farther a
seat-back is reclined, the greater the risk of injury.
3 WARNING
Reclining the seat-back too far can result in
serious injury or death in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to an upright position,
and sit well back in the seat.
Do not put a cushion, or other object, between the
seat-back and your back.
Doing so may interfere with proper seat belt or airbag
operation.
If you cannot get far enough away from the steering
wheel and still reach the controls, we recommend
that you investigate whether some type of adaptive
equipment may help.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
193 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
Rear Seats
■ Adjusting the Rear Seat-Backs
Pull the lever on the right to change the angle
of the right half of the seat-back, and left for
the left half.
Controls
Release Lever
Continued
193
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
194 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
■ Folding Down the Rear Seats
1Folding Down the Rear Seats
The rear seats can be folded down separately to allow for additional storage space.
■ To fold down the seat
Controls
1. Store the center seat belt first. Insert the
latch plate into the slot on the side of the
anchor buckle.
2. Retract the seat belt into the holder on the
ceiling.
Anchor
Buckle
Release Lever
194
Make sure all items in the cargo area or items
extending to the rear seats are properly
secured. Loose items can fly forward if you have
to brake hard.
Remove any items from the rear seat cushion and
floor before you fold down the rear seat.
To lock the seat-back upright, push it backwards until
it locks.
2 Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor P. 47
Latch Plate
3. Lower the head restraint to its lowest
position.
4. Pull the release lever and fold down the
seat-back.
Make sure the seat-back, head restraints and seat
cushion are securely latched back into place before
driving. Also, make sure all rear shoulder belts are
positioned in front of the seat-back, and the center
shoulder belt is re-positioned in the holding slot.
To return the seat to the original position, pull
up the seat-back in the upright position.
Make sure that the folded seat-back does not press
against the front passenger seat, as this can cause the
weight sensors in the front passenger seat to work
improperly.
2 Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator P. 62
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
195 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
■ Folding the Rear Seat Up
1Folding the Rear Seat Up
Separately lift up the left and right halves of
the rear seat cushions to make room for cargo
area.
Loop
■ Lifting up the seat cushion
1. Make sure the seat belt buckles are in their
loops on the seat.
Check if there are any items on the seat before you
pull the seat cushion up. Check if there are any
obstacles around the floor guide before you put the
seat back in the original position.
Controls
2. Pull up the rear seat cushion.
3. Fold the seat leg down while pushing the
seat cushion firmly against the seat-back to
lock it.
After you fold the seat up, or put it back in the
original position, make sure the seat is firmly secured
by rocking it forward and back.
Seat Leg
Seat Leg
Latch
Floor Guide
■ Putting the seat in the original position
1. Hold the seat cushion in the upright
position, and pull up the seat leg fully.
u The seat cushion can abruptly fall down
once you pull up the seat leg.
2. Slowly put down the seat cushion and set
the seat leg in the floor guide.
u A latch comes out when the leg is set
properly.
195
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
196 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuMaintain a Proper Sitting Position
Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
After all occupants have adjusted their seats and head restraints, and put on their
seat belts, it is very important that they continue to sit upright, well back in their
seats, with their feet on the floor, until the vehicle is safely parked and the engine is
off.
Sitting improperly can increase the chance of injury during a crash. For example, if
an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward, leans forward or
sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of injury during a crash is greatly
increased.
Controls
196
In addition, an occupant who is out of position in the front seat can be seriously or
fatally injured in a crash by striking interior parts of the vehicle or being struck by an
inflating front airbag.
1Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
3 WARNING
Sitting improperly or out of position can
result in serious injury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back in the seat,
with your feet on the floor.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
197 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuHead Restraints
Head Restraints
Your vehicle is equipped with head restraints in all seating positions.
1Adjusting the front head restraint positions
3 WARNING
■ Adjusting the front head restraint positions
Position head in the center
of the head restraint.
To raise the head restraint:
Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint:
Push it down while pressing the release
button.
Continued
Improperly positioning head restraints
reduces their effectiveness and increases
the likelihood of serious injury in a crash.
Make sure head restraints are in place and
positioned properly before driving.
In order for the head restraint system to work
properly:
• Do not hang any items on the head restraints, or
from the restraint legs.
• Do not place any objects between an occupant and
the seat-back.
• Install each restraint in its proper location.
Controls
Head restraints are most effective for
protection against whiplash and other rearimpact crash injuries when the center of the
back of the occupant’s head rests against the
center of the restraint. The tops of the
occupant’s ears should be level with the
center height of the restraint.
197
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
198 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuHead Restraints
■ Changing the Rear Seat Head Restraint Positions
Outer
Controls
198
Center
A passenger sitting in a back seating position
should adjust the height of their head restraint
to an appropriate position before the vehicle
begins moving.
To raise the head restraint:
Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint:
Push it down while pressing the release
button.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
199 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuHead Restraints
■ Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
Head restraints can be removed for cleaning or repair.
To remove a head restraint:
Pull the restraint up as far as it will go. Then push the release button, and pull the
restraint up and out.
3 WARNING
Failure to reinstall, or correctly reinstall, the
head restraints can result in severe injury
during a crash.
Always replace the head restraints before
driving.
To remove and install the rear outer head restraint,
recline the seat-back slightly forward as the space
between the ceiling and the seat-back is limited.
Controls
To reinstall a head restraint:
Insert the legs back in place, then adjust the head restraint to an appropriate height
while pressing the release button. Pull up on the restraint to make sure it is locked
in position.
1Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
199
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
200 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuArmrest
Armrest
■ Using the Front Seat Armrest
The console lid can be used as an armrest.
To adjust:
Slide the armrest to the desired position.
Controls
■ Using the Rear Seat Armrest *
Pull down the armrest in the center backrest.
200
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
201 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items
Interior Lights
■ Interior Light Switches
1Interior Light Switches
■ ON
Front *
Off
Models without smart entry system
Rear
Door Activated Position
On
Off
Models without smart entry system
• When you remove the key from the ignition switch
but do not open a door.
Models with smart entry system
• You remove the key from the ignition
switch.
Models with smart entry system
• When you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
Controls
Door Activated Position
The interior lights come on regardless of
whether the doors are open or closed.
■ Door activated
The interior lights come on in the following
situations:
• When any doors are opened.
• You unlock the driver’s door.
In the door activated position, the interior lights fade
out and go off about 30 seconds after the doors are
closed.
The lights go off after about 30 seconds in the
following situations:
• When you unlock the driver’s door but do not open
it.
(LOCK) but do not open a door.
Models with multi-information display
• When the power mode is set to VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK).
You can change the interior lights dimming time.
2 Customized Features P. 123
■ OFF
The interior lights remain off regardless of
whether the doors are open or closed.
The interior lights go off immediately in the following
situations:
• When you lock the driver’s door.
• When you turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
Models without smart entry system
• When you close the driver’s door with the key in
the ignition switch.
Models with smart entry system
• When you close the driver’s door in ACCESSORY
mode.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
201
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
202 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Lights
■ Map Lights
Models with moonroof
1Interior Light Switches
The map lights can be turned on and off by
pressing the lenses.
To avoid draining the battery, do not leave the
interior light on for an extended length of time when
the engine is off.
If you leave any of the doors open in VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) mode, or without the key in the ignition
switch, the interior lights go off after about 15
minutes.
Controls
1Map Lights
Models without moonroof
Models with moonroof
When the front interior light switch is in the door
activated position and any door is open, the map
light will not go off when you press the lens.
■ Cargo Area Light
■ ON
On
Off
The light comes on when you open the
tailgate, and goes off when closed.
■ OFF
The light stays off with or without opening the
tailgate.
202
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
203 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Interior Convenience Items
■ Glove Box
1Glove Box
Pull the handle to open the glove box.
3 WARNING
An open glove box can cause serious injury
to your passenger in a crash, even if the
passenger is wearing the seat belt.
Always keep the glove box closed while
driving.
Controls
■ Console Compartment
Pull the handle to open the console
compartment.
Continued
203
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
204 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Beverage Holders
1Beverage Holders
■ Front seat beverage holders
Front Door
NOTICE
Spilled liquids can damage the upholstery, carpeting,
and electrical components in the interior.
Be careful when you are using the beverage holders.
Hot liquid can scald you.
Controls
■ Center console beverage holders
Center Console
To put a short-size beverage: Push down
the bottom plate.
Bottom plate
To put a tall-size beverage: Pull up the
bottom plate.
204
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
205 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Rear Door
■ Rear seat beverage holders
Controls
At the Back of the Center Console
Continued
205
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
206 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Cargo Floor Box
Pull up the cargo area floor lid.
2WD models
Controls
Cargo Floor Box
AWD models
Cargo Floor Box
206
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
207 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Accessory Power Sockets
1Accessory Power Sockets
The accessory power socket can be used when the ignition switch is in ACCESSORY
(q or ON (w *1.
■ Accessory power socket (console panel)
Open the cover to use it.
NOTICE
Do not insert an automotive type cigarette lighter
element.
This can overheat the power socket.
Each accessory power socket is designed to supply
power for 12 volt DC accessories that are rated 180
watts (15 amps) or less.
Cover
■ Accessory power socket (rearward of
center console)
Open the cover to use it.
Controls
To prevent battery drain, only use the power socket
with the engine running.
When both sockets are being used, the combined
power rating of the accessories should not exceed
180 watts (15 amps).
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
207
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
208 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Canadian models
■ Accessory power socket (cargo area)
Open the cover to use it.
Controls
■ Coat Hook
1Coat Hook
There is a coat hook on the rear left grab
handle. Pull it down to use it.
208
The coat hook is not designed for large or heavy
items.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
209 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Tie-down Anchors
The tie-down anchors on the cargo area floor
can be used to install a net for securing items.
Front Anchors
Controls
Rear Anchors
Continued
209
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
210 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Canadian models
1Cargo Cover
■ Cargo Cover
The cargo cover can be used to conceal your
items and protect them from direct sunlight.
■ To remove:
Pull out the cargo cover rearwards and
remove it.
Controls
■ To fold:
The cargo cover is collapsible.
1. Take the opposite sides, fold the cover
halfway, then twist into opposite ways.
2. Curl to narrow the cover as shown.
210
Do not let anyone access items in the cargo area
while driving. Loose items can cause injury if you have
to brake hard.
Do not stack objects higher than the top of the seat
in the cargo area. They could block your view and be
thrown about the vehicle during a sudden stop.
To prevent cargo cover damage, do not:
• Place items on the cargo cover.
• Put weight on the cargo cover.
When reinstalling the cargo cover, put the tagged
side first.
Tag
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
211 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Seat Heaters *
1Seat Heaters *
The ignition switch must be in ON (w *1 to use
the seat heaters.
3 WARNING
Heat induced burns are possible when
using seat heaters.
Touch the seat heater icon.
Once - The HI setting (two indicators on)
Twice - The LO setting
Three times - The OFF setting (no indicator on)
Controls
Persons with a diminished ability to sense
temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes,
lower-limb nerve damage, or paralysis) or
with sensitive skin should not use seat
heaters.
Do not use the seat heaters even in LO when the
engine is off. Under such conditions, the battery may
be weakened, making the engine difficult to start.
In the LO setting, the heater runs continuously and
does not automatically turn off.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
211
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
212 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Heating and Cooling System *
Using Vents, Heating and A/C
Dashboard
vents
Dashboard
and floor
vents
Floor vents
Floor and
defroster
vents
Defroster
vents
Controls
Fan Control Dial
Mode Control Dial
Adjusts the fan speed. Rotate the dial all
the way to OFF to turn everything off.
Changes airflow.
Temperature Control Dial
Adjusts the interior temperature.
A/C Button
Press to cool the interior or dehumidify
while heating.
(Recirculation) Button
Press the
button and switch the mode depending on
environmental conditions.
Recirculation mode (indicator on):
Recirculates air from the vehicle’s interior through the system.
Fresh air mode (indicator off):
Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system in fresh air mode in
normal situations.
212
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
213 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHeating and Cooling System * uUsing Vents, Heating and A/C
■ Passenger Side Vents
Three separate front passenger side air vents allow for different air flow rates
through the vehicle. Passengers can separately:
• Adjust each vent to optimize airflow
Adjust from side to side or up and
throughout the vehicle.
down
Low
High
Controls
Mid
• Close individual vents to adjust passenger
comfort levels.
Continued
213
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
214 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHeating and Cooling System * uUsing Vents, Heating and A/C
■ Heating
1Heating
The heater uses heat from the engine coolant
to warm the air.
1. Adjust the fan speed using the fan control
dial.
2. Select
.
3. Adjust the temperature using the
temperature control dial.
Controls
■ To rapidly warm up the interior
1. Set the fan to the maximum speed.
2. Select
.
3. Set the temperature to maximum warm.
4. Press the
button (the indicator on).
■ To dehumidify the interior
When used in combination with the heater, the air conditioning system makes the
interior warm and dry and can prevent the windows from fogging up.
1. Turn the fan on.
2. Press the A/C button to turn on the air conditioning.
214
When you select
, the mode automatically
switches to fresh air.
1To rapidly warm up the interior
Change to fresh air mode as soon as the interior gets
warm enough. The windows may fog up if kept in
recirculation mode.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
215 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHeating and Cooling System * uUsing Vents, Heating and A/C
■ Cooling
1. Adjust the fan speed using the fan control
dial.
2. Select
.
3. Adjust the temperature using the
temperature control dial.
4. Press the A/C button (indicator on).
1. Set the fan to the maximum speed.
2. Set the temperature to maximum cool.
3. Press the
button (the indicator on).
■ Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
Selecting
turns the air conditioning
system on and automatically switches the
system to fresh air mode.
■ To rapidly defrost the windows
1. Set the fan to the maximum speed.
2. Select
.
3. Press the
button.
4. Set the temperature to maximum warm.
If the interior is very warm, you can cool it down
more rapidly by partially opening the windows.
While ECON mode is active, the system may have
reduced performance.
Controls
■ To rapidly cool down the interior
1To rapidly cool down the interior
1Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
For your safety, make sure you have a clear view
through all the windows before driving.
Do not set the temperature near the upper or lower
limit.
When cold air hits the windshield, the outside of the
windshield may fog up.
If the side windows fog up, adjust the vents so that
the air hits the side windows.
1To rapidly defrost the windows
After defrosting the windows, switch over to fresh air
mode.
If you keep the system in recirculation mode, the
windows may fog up from humidity. This impedes
visibility.
215
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
216 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Climate Control System *
Using Automatic Climate Control
The automatic climate control system maintains the interior temperature you select.
The system also selects the proper mix of heated or cooled air that raises or lowers
the interior temperature to your preference as quickly as possible.
Models without SYNC icon
1Using Automatic Climate Control
If any icons are selected while using the climate
control system in auto, the function of the icon that
was selected will take priority.
The AUTO indicator will go off, but functions
unrelated to the icon that was selected will be
controlled automatically.
To prevent cold air from blowing in from outside, the
fan may not start immediately when the AUTO icon
is selected.
Controls
Dashboard
vents
Temperature Control
Icons
Dashboard
and floor
vents
Floor vents Floor and
defroster
vents
Mode Control Icon
Fan Control Icons
If the interior is very warm, you can cool it down
more rapidly by partially opening the windows,
turning the system on auto, and setting the
temperature to low. Change the fresh air mode to
recirculation mode until the temperature cools down.
When you set the temperature to the lower or upper
limit, Lo or Hi is displayed.
You can raise or lower the temperature or fan speed
setting flicking either control icon.
AUTO Icon
(On/Off) Icon
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
(Windshield Defroster)
Icon
(Fresh Air) Icon
(Recirculation) Icon
Use the system when the engine is running.
1. Select the AUTO icon.
2. Adjust the interior temperature using the temperature control icons.
3. Select the
icon to cancel.
216
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
217 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
Models with SYNC icon
1Using Automatic Climate Control
Selecting the
icon switches the climate control
system between on and off. When turned on, the
system returns to your last selection.
Dashboard
vents
AUTO Icon
(On/Off) Icon
SYNC Icon
Floor vents Floor and
defroster
vents
Mode Control Icon
Passenger Side
Temperature
Control Icons
Controls
Driver Side
Temperature
Control Icons
Dashboard
and floor
vents
While ECON mode is active, the system may have
reduced performance.
(Windshield Defroster)
Icon
(Recirculation) Icon
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
Use the system when the engine is running.
1. Select the AUTO icon.
2. Adjust the interior temperature using the driver side temperature control icons.
3. Select the
icon to cancel.
Continued
217
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
218 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Switching between the recirculation and fresh air modes
Models without SYNC icon
Select the
(recirculation) or
(fresh air) icon to switch the mode
depending on environmental conditions.
Recirculation mode (indicator on): Recirculates air from the vehicle’s interior
through the system.
Fresh air mode (indicator on): Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system
in fresh air mode in normal situations.
Models with SYNC icon
Controls
218
Select the
(recirculation) icon to switch the mode depending on
environmental conditions.
Recirculation mode (indicator on): Recirculates air from the vehicle’s interior through
the system.
Fresh air mode (indicator off): Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system in
fresh air mode in normal situations.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
219 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
Models without SYNC icon
1Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
Select the
icon to turn the air conditioning
system on and automatically switch the
system to fresh air mode.
Select the
icon again to turn off, the
system returns to the previous settings.
For your safety, make sure you have a clear view
through all the windows before driving.
Do not set the temperature near the upper or lower
limit.
When cold air hits the windshield, the outside of the
windshield may fog up.
Controls
If the side windows fog up, adjust the vents so that
the air hits the side windows.
Models with SYNC icon
Continued
219
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
220 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
Models without SYNC icon
■ To rapidly defrost the windows
1. Select the
2. Select the
Controls
220
Models with SYNC icon
icon.
icon.
1To rapidly defrost the windows
After defrosting the windows, switch over to fresh air
mode. If you keep the system in recirculation mode,
the windows may fog up from humidity. This
impedes visibility.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
221 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Turning On and Off the Touch Screen Beep
1Turning On and Off the Touch Screen Beep
If you touch any other icons during this procedure,
the setting may fail. In this case, once you turn the
ignition switch to OFF (0 *1, then follow this
procedure again.
Controls
You hear the beep when operating the climate control system on the touch screen.
This can be turned on and off.
To turn off the beep:
Models without SYNC icon
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Touch the
of the temperature control
icon five times while pressing and holding
the
.
3. Release the
, after -- blinks five times
and OF is displayed.
Models with SYNC icon
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
221
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
222 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
Models without SYNC icon
To turn on the beep:
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Touch the
of the temperature control
icon five times while pressing and holding
the
.
3. Release the
, after OF blinks five times
and -- is displayed.
Controls
Models with SYNC icon
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
222
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
223 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Touch Panel Sensitivity Setting
1Touch Panel Sensitivity Setting
If you touch any other icons during this procedure,
the setting may fail. In this case, once you turn the
ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1, then follow this
procedure again.
Controls
You can set the level of sensitivity of the touch control panel to high, normal, or low.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
Models without SYNC icon
2. Press and hold the AUTO icon, then press
Temperature display area
any of the following icons five times to set
the level.
•
: High (Hi)*2.
u Previous setting blinks five times and Hi
will be displayed in the temperature
display area.
•
: Normal (--)
u Previous setting blinks five times and -will be displayed in the temperature
display area.
•
: Low (Lo)
Models with SYNC icon
u Previous setting blinks five times and Lo
Temperature display area
will be displayed in the temperature
display area.
3. Release the AUTO icon.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an
ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition
switch.
*2: Default setting
Continued
223
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
224 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuClimate Control System * uUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Synchronization Mode *
Controls
Driver Side
Temperature
Control Icon
1Synchronization Mode *
When the system is in dual mode, the driver side
temperature and the passenger side temperature can
be set separately.
Passenger Side
Temperature
Control Icon
SYNC Icon
You can set the temperature synchronously for the driver side and the passenger
side in synchronization mode.
1. Select the SYNC icon.
u The system switches to synchronization mode.
2. Adjust the temperature using the driver’s side temperature control icon.
Select the SYNC icon to return to dual mode.
224
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
225 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuClimate Control System * uAutomatic Climate Control Sensors
Automatic Climate Control Sensors
Sensor
The automatic climate control system is
equipped with sensors. Do not cover or spill
any liquid on them.
Controls
Sensor
225
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
226
226 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
227 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Features
This chapter describes how to operate technology features.
Audio System
About Your Audio System.................... 228
USB Port(s) ........................................... 229
Audio System Theft Protection ............. 230
Audio Remote Controls........................ 231
Models with color audio system
Audio System Basic Operation............. 234
Audio/Information Screen .................... 235
Adjusting the Sound ............................ 239
Display Setup ....................................... 240
Playing AM/FM Radio ........................... 241
Playing a CD ........................................ 243
Playing an iPod..................................... 246
Playing a USB Flash Drive...................... 249
Playing Bluetooth® Audio..................... 252
* Not available on all models
Models with display audio system
Audio System Basic Operation ............ 255
Audio/Information Screen .................... 256
Adjusting the Sound ............................ 271
Display Setup ....................................... 272
Voice Control Operation ...................... 274
Playing AM/FM Radio........................... 278
Playing SiriusXM® Radio * ..................... 282
Playing an iPod .................................... 290
Song By VoiceTM (SBV).......................... 293
Playing Pandora® ................................. 297
Playing a USB Flash Drive ..................... 299
Playing Bluetooth® Audio..................... 302
HondaLink® ......................................... 304
Wi-Fi Connection..................................309
Siri® Eyes Free.......................................311
Apple CarPlayTM ....................................312
Android AutoTM ....................................316
Audio Error Messages ...........................323
General Information on the Audio System ..... 329
Models with color audio system
Customized Features.............................345
Models with display audio system
Customized Features.............................352
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver *.......367
Models with color audio system
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®..................370
Models with display audio system
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®..................393
227
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
228 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Audio System
About Your Audio System
The audio system features AM/FM radio and SiriusXM® Radio service *. It can also
play audio CDs *, WMA/MP3/AAC files, USB flash drives, and iPod, iPhone and
Bluetooth® devices.
You can operate the audio system from the buttons and switches on the panel, the
remote controls on the steering wheel, or the icons on the touchscreen interface *.
Features
USB Port
Remote Controls
*1:Models with display audio system
*2:Models with color audio system
228
* Not available on all models
USB
Flash
Drive
USB Port*1
Video CDs, DVDs, and 3-inch (8-cm) mini CDs are not
supported.
iPod, iPhone and iTunes are trademarks of Apple Inc.
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a
vehicle.
SiriusXM® Radio * is available on a subscription basis
only. For more information on SiriusXM® Radio *,
contact a dealer.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 329
iPod
*1, *2
1About Your Audio System
SiriusXM® Radio * is available in the United States and
Canada, except Hawaii, Alaska, and Puerto Rico.
SiriusXM® * is a registered trademark of SiriusXM
Radio, Inc.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
229 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio SystemuUSB Port(s)
USB Port(s)
*
*
1. Open the cover.
2. Install the iPod USB connector or the USB
flash drive to the USB port.
u The USB port (1.0A) is for playing audio
files on a USB flash drive, connecting a
cellular phone and charging devices.
u The USB port (1.5 A) * is for charging
devices, playing audio files and
connecting compatible phones with
Apple CarPlayTM or Android AutoTM.
1USB Port(s)
• Do not leave the iPod or USB flash drive in the
•
•
•
•
If the audio system does not recognize the iPod, try
reconnecting it a few times or reboot the device. To
reboot, follow the manufacturer’s instructions
provided with the iPod or visit www.apple.com/ipod.
Features
•
vehicle. Direct sunlight and high temperatures may
damage it.
We recommend using an extension cable with the
USB port.
Do not connect the iPod or USB flash drive using a
hub.
Do not use a device such as a card reader or hard
disk drive, as the device or your files may be
damaged.
We recommend your data backed up before using
the device in your vehicle.
Displayed messages may vary depending on the
device model and software version.
USB charge
The USB port can supply up to 1.0A/1.5A * of power.
It does not output 1.0A/1.5A unless the device
requests. For amperage details, read the operating
manual of the device that needs to be charged.
Turn the ignition switch to ACCESSORY (q or ON
(w *1 first.
Under certain conditions, a device connected to the
port may generate noise in the radio you are listening
to.
*1 : Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
229
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
230 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio SystemuAudio System Theft Protection
Audio System Theft Protection
The audio system is disabled when it is disconnected from the power source, such as
when the battery is disconnected or goes dead. In certain conditions, the system
may display a code entry screen. If this occurs, reactivate the audio system.
■ Reactivating the audio system
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Turn on the audio system.
3. Press and hold the audio system power button for more than two seconds.
u The audio system is reactivated when the audio control unit establishes a
connection with the vehicle control unit. If the control unit fails to recognize
the audio unit, you must go to a dealer and have the audio unit checked.
Features
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
230
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
231 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio SystemuAudio Remote Controls
Audio Remote Controls
Allow you to operate the audio system while driving.
SOURCE Button
Button
Cycles through the audio modes as follows:
Button
Models with color audio system
Button
SOURCE
Button
(Menu)
Button *
Models with display audio system
FMAMSirius XM® *USBiPod
Bluetooth® AudioPandora® *Apps/Apple
CarPlayTM/Android AutoTM
(Volume) Buttons
: To increase the volume.
: To decrease the volume.
Features
Press
Press
Some modes appear only when an appropriate
device or medium is used.
Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect,
some functions may not be operated.
FMAMCDUSBiPod
Bluetooth® Audio
Button
1Audio Remote Controls
Button
• When listening to the radio
Press : To select the next preset radio station.
Press : To select the previous preset radio station.
Press and hold : To select the next strong radio station.
Press and hold : To select the previous strong radio station.
• When listening to the SiriusXM® radio *
Press : To select the next preset radio station.
Press : To select the previous preset radio station.
Press and hold : To select the next channel.
Press and hold : To select the previous channel.
* Not available on all models
Continued
231
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
232 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio SystemuAudio Remote Controls
Features
• When listening to a CD *, iPod, USB flash drive, or Bluetooth® Audio
Press : To skip to the next song.
Press : To go back to the beginning of the current or previous song.
• When listening to a CD * or USB flash drive
Press and hold : To skip to the next folder.
Press and hold : To go back to the previous folder.
• When listening to a Bluetooth® Audio
Press and hold : To go to the group up.*1
Press and hold : To go to the group down.*1
• When listening to Internet radio *
Press : To skip to the next song.
Press and hold : To select the next station.
Press and hold : To select the previous station.
*1: Available on specific phones only.
232
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
233 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio SystemuAudio Remote Controls
Models with display audio system
* Not available on all models
1Audio Remote Controls
The
button is available only when the audio
mode is FM, AM, USB, iPod, Pandora® *, or
Bluetooth® Audio.
Features
Steering Wheel
(Menu) Button
• When listening to the radio
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Scan, Save Preset, or
Seek.
• When listening to the SiriusXM® radio *
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Scan, Save Preset,
Channel, or Category.
• When listening to a USB flash drive
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Scan, Repeat, or Random.
• When listening to an iPod
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Repeat or Shuffle.
• When listening to a Bluetooth® Audio
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Pause or Play.
• When listening to a Pandora® *
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Bookmark, or Play/Pause.
233
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
234 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Audio System Basic Operation
Models with color audio system
1Audio System Basic Operation
To use the audio system, the ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or ON (w .
Use the selector knob or MENU/CLOCK
(Sound)
(Day/Night)
button to access some audio functions.
Button
Button
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate
Press
Press
to switch between the normal and
extended display for some functions.
(Back)
Button
Features
234
MENU/
CLOCK
Button
Selector Knob
Selector knob: Rotate left or right to scroll
through the available choices. Press
to set
your selection.
MENU/CLOCK button: Press to select any
mode.
The available mode includes the wallpaper,
display, clock, language setup, and play
modes. Play modes can be also selected from
scan, random, repeat, and so on.
(Back) button: Press to go back to the previous display.
(Sound) button: Press to select the sound setting mode.
(Day/Night) button: Press to change the audio/information screen
brightness.
Press
, then adjust the brightness using
.
u Each time you press
, the mode switches between the daytime mode,
nighttime mode and OFF mode.
to select.
to enter.
Menu Items
2 Adjust Clock P. 134
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 237
2 Display Setup P. 240
2 Scan P. 242, 245, 251
2 Play Mode P. 245, 248, 251
2 RDS Settings P. 242
2 Bluetooth P. 349, 376
Press the SOURCE,
,
,
or
button on the
steering wheel to change any audio setting.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 231
One of the operating system used in this unit is eCos.
For software license terms and conditions, visit their
website (eCos license URL: http://
ecos.sourceware.org/license-overview.html)
For source code disclosure and other details
regarding eCos, visit: http://
www.hondaopensource2.com
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
235 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Audio/Information Screen
Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this screen, you can go to various
setup options.
■ Switching the Display
Audio/Information Screen
Audio
Features
Clock/Wallpaper
Continued
235
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
236 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Audio
Shows the current audio information.
■ Clock/Wallpaper
Shows a clock screen or an image you import.
■ Change display
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Display Change, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
u If you want to return to the audio display, select Audio.
Features
236
午後3時52分
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
237 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Wallpaper Setup
1Wallpaper Setup
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
■ Import wallpaper
You can import up to three images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash
drive.
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB
port.
• When importing wallpaper files, the image must be
•
•
•
•
2 USB Port(s) P. 229
Continued
•
•
Features
2. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
3. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press
.
5. Rotate
to select Import, then press .
u The picture name is displayed on the list.
6. Rotate
to select a desired picture, then
press .
u The selected picture is displayed.
7. Press
to save the picture.
8. Press
to select OK.
9. Rotate
to select a location to save the
picture, then press .
u The display will return to the wallpaper
setting screen.
in the USB flash drive’s root directory. Images in a
folder cannot be imported.
The file name must be fewer than 64 characters.
The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
The individual file size limit is 2 MB.
The maximum image size is 1,920 x 936 pixels. If
the image size is less than 480 × 234 pixels, the
image is displayed in the middle of the screen with
the extra area appearing in black.
Up to 255 files can be selected.
If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures,
the No compatible images were found. See
Owner’s Manual. message appears.
237
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
238 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Select wallpaper
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Select, then press .
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
5. Rotate
to select a desired wallpaper, then press
1Wallpaper Setup
To go back to the previous screen, press the
(Back) button.
When the file size is large, it takes a while to be
previewed.
.
■ To view wallpaper once it is set
Features
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Display Change, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
5. Rotate
to select a wallpaper that you want to set, then press
.
■ Delete wallpaper
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Delete, then press .
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
5. Rotate
to select a wallpaper that you want to delete, then press
6. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
u The display will return to the wallpaper setting screen.
238
.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
239 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAdjusting the Sound
Adjusting the Sound
(sound) Button
Press the
(sound) button, and rotate
to scroll through the following choices:
1Adjusting the Sound
The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High.
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
LIST/SELECT (Selector) Knob
TRE is selectable.
Bass
TRE
Treble
FAD
Fader
BAL
Balance
SVC
Speed-sensitive
Volume
Compensation
Features
BAS
Rotate
to adjust the sound setting, then
press .
239
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
240 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
Display Setup
You can change the brightness or color theme of the audio/information screen.
■ Changing the Screen Brightness
Features
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Display Adjustment,
then press .
4. Rotate
to select Brightness, then press
.
5. Rotate
to adjust the setting, then press
.
■ Changing the Screen’s Color Theme
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Color Theme, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select the setting you want,
then press .
240
1Changing the Screen Brightness
You can change the Contrast and Black Level
settings in the same manner.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
241 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
Playing AM/FM Radio
RADIO Button
Press to select a band.
Audio/Information Screen
Selector Knob
Turn to tune the radio frequency.
Press, and then turn to select an
item. After that, press again to
make your selection.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to search up and down
the selected band for a station with a strong
signal.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
Preset Buttons (1-6)
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Pick a preset button and hold it until you hear a beep.
To listen to a stored station, select a band, then press the preset button.
Features
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
Continued
241
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
242 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Radio Data System (RDS)
1Playing AM/FM Radio
Provides text data information related to your selected RDS capable FM station.
■ To find an RDS station from Station List
1. Press
while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate
to select the station, then press
You can store 6 AM stations and 12 FM stations into
the preset memory.
.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 231
■ Update List
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Press
while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate
to select Update List, then press
.
Features
■ Radio text
1Radio Data System (RDS)
Displays the radio text information of the selected RDS station.
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select RDS Settings, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Radio Text, then press .
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Scan, then press .
To turn off scan, press
242
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
.
When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS
automatically turns on, and the frequency display
changes to the station name. However, when the
signals of that station become weak, the display
changes from the station name to the frequency.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
243 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
Playing a CD
Your audio system supports audio CDs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs in either MP3 or WMA,
or AAC*1 format. With the CD loaded, press the MEDIA button.
Audio/Information Screen
CD Slot
Insert a CD about halfway into the CD slot.
(CD Eject) Button
Press to eject a CD.
Features
MEDIA Button
Press to play a CD.
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to change tracks
(files in MP3, WMA, or AAC).
Press and hold to move rapidly within a
track/file.
Play Mode Buttons (1-6)
Press to select a play mode.
Selector Knob
Turn to change tracks/files. Press
to display a track/folder list.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
Continued
243
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
244 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob
(MP3/WMA/AAC)
1Playing a CD
NOTICE
1. Press
to switch the display to a folder list.
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can
cause the CD to jam in the unit.
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, then
skips to the next file.
Features
Folder
Selection
to select a folder.
If you eject the CD but do not remove it from the slot,
the system reloads the CD automatically after several
seconds.
Track
Selection
244
2. Rotate
Text data appears on the display under the following
circumstances:
• When you select a new folder, file, or track.
• When you change the audio mode to CD.
• When you insert a CD.
3. Press
to display a list of tracks in that
folder.
4. Rotate
to select a track, then press .
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
245 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat, random, and scan modes when playing a track or file.
Available mode icons appear above the play
mode buttons.
Press the button corresponding to the mode
you want to select.
Play Mode Buttons
Press the selected button.
Play Mode Menu Items
Repeat
Repeat One Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC):
Repeats all files in the current folder.
Repeat One Track: Repeats the current
track/file.
Random
Random in Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Plays
all files in the current folder in random order.
Random All: Plays all tracks/files in random
order.
Scan
Scan Folders (MP3/WMA/AAC): Provides
10-second sampling of the first file in each of the
main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of
all tracks on the CD (all files in the current folder in
MP3, WMA, or AAC).
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
You can also select a play mode by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press
.
Rotate
to select a mode, then press
.
To turn it off, rotate
to select Normal Play, then
press
.
245
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
246 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your USB connector to the USB port, then press the MEDIA
button.
2 USB Port(s) P. 229
USB Indicator
Appears when an iPod is connected.
Features
MEDIA Button
Press to select iPod (if connected).
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Selector Knob
Turn to change songs.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to change songs.
Press and hold to move rapidly within a song.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
Album Art
Play Mode Buttons
Press to select a play mode.
246
Audio/Information Screen
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
247 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Song from the iPod Music List with the
Selector Knob
1. Press
to display the iPod music list.
1Playing an iPod
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle’s audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio display.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 324
Item
Selection
2. Rotate
to select a category.
Features
Category
Selection
3. Press
to display a list of items in the
category.
4. Rotate
to select an item, then press .
u Press
and rotate
repeatedly until a
desired item you want to listen is
displayed.
Continued
247
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
248 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a song.
Available mode icons appear above the play
mode buttons.
Press the button corresponding to the mode
you want to select.
Play Mode Buttons
Features
248
■ To turn off a play mode
Press the selected button.
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Shuffle Album: Plays all available albums in
a selected category (playlists, artists, albums, songs,
genres, or composers) in random order.
Shuffle All: Plays all available songs in a
selected category (playlists, artists, albums, songs,
genres, or composers) in random order.
Repeat One Track: Repeats the current
song.
You can also select a play mode by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press
.
Rotate
to select a mode, then press
.
To turn it off, rotate
to select Normal Play, then
press
.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
249 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays sound files on a USB flash drive in either MP3,
WMA or AAC*1 format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then press the MEDIA button.
2 USB Port(s) P. 229
USB Indicator
Appears when a USB flash drive is connected.
Audio/Information Screen
Features
MEDIA Button
Press to select USB flash drive
(if connected).
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Selector Knob
Turn to change files.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to change files.
Press and hold to move rapidly within a file.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
Play Mode Buttons (1-6)
Press to select a play mode.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous display.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
Continued
249
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
250 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob
1. Press
to display a folder list.
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 329
Files in WMA format protected by digital rights
management (DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, and then
skips to the next file.
Folder
Selection
2. Rotate
to select a folder.
Features
Track
Selection
250
3. Press
to display a list of files in that
folder.
4. Rotate
to select a file, then press .
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 324
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
251 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat, random, and scan modes when playing a file.
Available mode icons appear above the play
mode buttons.
Press the button corresponding to the mode
you want to select.
Play Mode Buttons
Play Mode Menu Items
Repeat
Repeat One Folder: Repeats all files in the
current folder.
Repeat One Track: Repeats the current file.
Random
Random in Folder: Plays all files in the
current folder in random order.
Random All: Plays all files in random order.
Scan
Scan Folders: Provides 10-second sampling
of the first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of
all files in the current folder.
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
Press the selected button.
1How to Select a Play Mode
You can also select a play mode by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press
.
Rotate
to select a mode, then press
.
To turn it off, rotate
to select Normal Play, then
press
.
251
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
252 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle’s
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) system.
2 Phone Setup P. 376
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your phone is connected to HFL.
MEDIA Button
Press to select
Bluetooth® Audio.
Audio/Information Screen
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible with the system.
For a list of compatible phones:
• U.S.: Visit automobiles.honda.com/handsfreelink/,
or call 1-888-528-7876.
• Canada: For more information on smartphone
compatibility, call 1-888-528-7876.
In some states, it may be illegal to perform some data
device functions while driving.
Features
Only one phone can be used with HFL at a time.
When there are more than two paired phones in the
vehicle, the first paired phone the system finds is
automatically connected.
If more than one phone is paired to the HFL system,
there will be a delay before the system begins to play.
VOL/
(Volume/
Power) Knob
Press to turn
the audio
system on and
off.
Turn to adjust
the volume.
Pause Button (Preset 2)
Press to pause playing a
file.
Play Button (Preset 1)
Press to resume playing a file.
/
Press
252
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
or
to change files.
MENU/CLOCK
Button
Press to display
the menu
items.
In some cases, the name of the artist, album, or track
may not appear correctly.
Some functions may not be available on some
devices.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
253 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
MEDIA Button
Pause Button
Play Button
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
connected to HFL.
2. Press the MEDIA button until the Bluetooth
Audio Source is selected.
If the phone is not recognized, another HFLcompatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be
connected.
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone maker's operating
instructions.
The pause function may not be available on some
phones.
If any audio device is connected to the auxiliary input
jack or USB port, you may need to press the MEDIA
button repeatedly to select the Bluetooth® Audio
system.
■ To pause or resume a file
Press a Play or Pause button to select a mode.
Continued
Features
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
253
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
254 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ How to Select a Song from the Music Search List with the
Selector Knob
1. Press
Features
Category
Selection
Item
Selection
254
2. Rotate
to display the music search list.
to select a category.
3. Press
to display a list of items in the
category.
4. Rotate
to select an item, then press .
u Press
and rotate
repeatedly until a
desired item you want to listen is
displayed.
1How to Select a Song from the Music Search List with the Selector
Knob
Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect,
some or all of the categories may not be displayed.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
255 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Audio System Basic Operation
Models with display audio system
1Audio System Basic Operation
To use the audio system function, the ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or
ON (w *1.
(Home): Select to go to the home screen.
(Home)
(Day/Night) Button
(Menu): Select to display available options
including Sound, View Radio Text, Music
Search, and playback modes.
(Back): Select to go back to the previous
display when it is displayed.
(Day/Night) button: Press to change the
audio/information screen brightness.
Press
once and select (- or (+ to make
an adjustment.
u Each time you press
, the mode
switches among the daytime mode,
nighttime mode and off mode.
Features
(Menu)
(Back)
2 Switching the Display P. 256
Audio Menu Items
2 Station List P. 279, 280
2 Music Search P. 291, 300, 303
2 Scan P. 280, 281, 289
2 How to Select a Play Mode P. 292, 301
*1 : Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
255
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
256 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Audio/Information Screen
Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this display, you can go to various
setup options.
■ Switching the Display
■ Using the
Press the
button
(display) button to change the display.
Features
(Display) Button
256
Audio/Information Screen
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
257 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Using the audio/information screen
Home Screen
Features
Select
to go to the home screen.
Select Audio, Phone, Info, Settings, Smartphone Connection (Apple CarPlay,
Android Auto), Navigation *, HondaLink, or App List.
■ Audio
Displays the current audio information.
■ Phone
Displays the HFL information.
2 Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 393
* Not available on all models
Continued
257
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
258 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Info
Displays Trip Computer, Voice Info, Clock/Wallpaper, or System/Device
Information. Select
on the Info Menu screen to see all available options: Trip
Computer, Voice Info, Clock/Wallpaper and System/Device Information.
Features
Trip Computer:
• Current Drive tab: Displays the current trip information.
• History of Trip A tab: Displays information for the three previous drives. The
information is stored every time you reset Trip A.
To delete the history manually, select Delete History on the History of Trip A
tab. The confirmation message appears on the screen, then select Yes.
Voice Info: Displays the all commands list.
Clock/Wallpaper: Displays the clock and wallpaper.
System/Device Information:
• System Info: Displays the software version of the audio system.
• USB Info: Displays the memory usage of the USB device.
• Switch USB Device: Connects or disconnects USB device to this audio system.
■ Settings
Enters the customizing menu screen.
2 Customized Features P. 352
■ Smartphone Connection
Displays the Apple CarPlayTM or Android AutoTM.
2 Apple CarPlayTM P. 312
2 Android AutoTM P. 316
258
1Audio/Information Screen
Touchscreen operation
• Use simple gestures - including touching, swiping
and scrolling - to operate certain audio functions.
• Some items may be grayed out during driving to
reduce the potential for distraction.
• You can select them when the vehicle is stopped or
use voice commands.
• Wearing gloves may limit or prevent touchscreen
response.
You can change the touchscreen sensitivity setting.
2 Customized Features P. 352
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
259 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Navigation *
Displays the navigation screen.
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
■ HondaLink
Displays the HondaLink® screen.
2 HondaLink® P. 304
■ App List
Adds or removes apps or widgets on the Home screen.
2 Home Screen P. 263
Features
* Not available on all models
Continued
259
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
260 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Changing the Home Screen Icon Layout
1. Select
.
2. Select and hold an icon.
u The screen switches to the customization
screen.
3. Drag and drop the icon to where you want
it to be.
4. Select OK.
u The screen will return to the home
screen.
Features
260
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
261 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Wallpaper Setup
1Wallpaper Setup
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
■ Import wallpaper
You can import up to five images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash
drive.
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB
port.
2 USB Port(s) P. 229
Continued
in the USB flash drive’s root directory.
Images in a folder cannot be imported.
• The file name must be fewer than 64 characters.
• The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
• The individual file size limit is 5 MB.
• The maximum image size is 4,096 x 4,096 pixels. If
the image size is less than 800 × 480 pixels, the
image is displayed in the middle of the screen with
the extra area appearing in black.
• If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures,
the No files detected message appears.
Features
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Clock/Info.
4. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then open
the Wallpaper tab.
5. Select Add New Wallpaper.
u The picture name is displayed on the list.
6. Select a desired picture.
u The preview is displayed on the left side
on the screen.
7. Select Start Import to save the data.
u The display will return to the wallpaper
list.
• When importing wallpaper files, the image must be
261
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
262 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Select wallpaper
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Clock/Info.
3. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then open the Wallpaper tab.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
4. Select a desired wallpaper.
u The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. Select Set.
u The display will return to the wallpaper list.
1Wallpaper Setup
From the pop-up menu, select Preview to see a
preview at full-size screen.
■ To view wallpaper once it is set
Features
1. Select
.
2. Select Info.
3. Select
.
4. Select Clock/Wallpaper.
■ Delete wallpaper
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Clock/Info.
3. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then open the Wallpaper tab.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
4. Select a wallpaper that you want to delete.
u The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. Select Delete.
u A confirmation message appears on the screen.
6. Select Yes to delete completely.
u The display will return to the wallpaper list.
262
To go back to the previous screen, select OK, or
select
(Back).
When the file size is large, it takes a while to be
previewed.
To delete all wallpapers you add, select Delete All,
then Yes.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
263 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Home Screen
1Home Screen
The home screen has 5 pages (fixed). You cannot add
any more pages.
■ To change to a next screen
Swipe
Icon
or
Current page position
, or swiping the screen left or right changes to the next screen.
Continued
Features
Selecting
Icon
263
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
264 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To use apps or widgets
1To use apps or widgets
1. Select
.
2. Select
or App List.
u The APPS screen appears.
3. Select the app or widget you want to use.
(APPS)
Icon
Features
Preinstall app list:
• Browser: Displays the web browser utilized
by smartphone and Wi-Fi connection.
• Calculator: Displays Calculator.
• Downloads: Displays the data
downloaded from the web browser and so
on.
• App Installer: Check with a Honda dealer
for apps that are available for installation.
• Search: Displays various retrieval screens.
Select and hold a selected app or widget to add that
app’s or widget’s shortcut on the home screen.
Pre-installed apps may not start up normally. If this
occurs, you need to reset the system.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 366
If you perform Factory Data Reset, it may reset all
the settings to their factory default.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 366
In case those apps still do not startup normally even
after Factory Data Reset, contact your dealer.
There is a possibility that a browser is shut down in
the situation of the use. In that situation, the screen
will return to before the browser startup.
Do not install apps other than those confirmed by a
Honda dealer. Installation of unauthorized apps may
introduce data corruption risks to your vehicle’s
information and your privacy.
You can delete user installed apps by the following
procedure.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Others tab.
5. Select Detail Information.
6. Select an App that you want to delete.
7. Select Delete.
Pre-installed apps cannot be deleted.
264
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
265 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To add app or widget icons on the home screen
App or widget icons can be added on the home screen.
1. Select
.
Select and hold.
2. Select .
3. Select and hold empty space on the home
screen.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
4. Select Add App or Add Widget.
u The Add app/widget screen appears.
Features
Continued
265
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
266 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Select and hold.
Features
Drag and drop.
266
5. Select and hold an app or widget icon you
want to add.
u The screen switches to the customization
screen.
6. Drag and drop the icon to where you want
it to be.
7. Select OK.
u The screen will return to the home
screen.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
267 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To move icons on the home screen
You can change location on the home screen.
1. Select and hold an icon.
u The screen switches to the customization
screen.
2. Drag and drop the icon to where you want it
to be.
3. Select OK.
Select and hold.
u The screen will return to the home
screen.
1To move icons on the home screen
You can also move the Audio, Phone, Info,
Settings, Smartphone Connection (Apple
CarPlay, Android Auto), Navigation *,
HondaLink, and App List icons in the same manner.
Features
Drag and drop.
* Not available on all models
Continued
267
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
268 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To remove icons on the home screen
You can delete the icons on the home screen.
1. Select and hold an icon.
u The screen switches to the customization
screen.
2. Drag and drop the icon you want to remove
to the trash icon.
u The icon is removed from the home
Select and hold.
screen.
3. Select OK.
u The screen will return to the home
screen.
Features
Drag and drop to
trash icon.
268
* Not available on all models
1To remove icons on the home screen
You cannot delete the Audio, Phone, Info,
Settings, Smartphone Connection (Apple
CarPlay, Android Auto), Navigation *,
HondaLink, and App List icons.
Apps or widgets will not be deleted by deleting the
icon on the home screen.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
269 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Status Area
Swipe
1. Swipe the upper area of the screen.
u The status area appears.
2. Select an item to see the details.
3. Select
or swipe up the bottom bar to
close the area.
Features
Bar
Status Area
Continued
269
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
270 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Closing Apps
You can close specific apps running in the background on the system.
1. Select and hold
.
2. Select the Active tab.
u If you select the Active/History tab, you
can close the apps that are currently
running and delete the app activity
history simultaneously.
3. Select an app you want to close.
4. Select Clear.
u The display will return to the app list.
Features
270
* Not available on all models
1Closing Apps
If you leave the apps used open in the background,
some apps may stop operating properly next time
using them.
If this happens close unused apps.
To close all apps on the system, select Clear All, then
Yes.
You cannot close the HondaLink® and Garmin * apps.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
271 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAdjusting the Sound
Adjusting the Sound
1. Select
.
2. Select Audio.
3. Select
.
4. Select Sound.
Select a tab from the following choices:
• BAS-MID-TRE: Bass, Middle, Treble
• FAD-BAL: Fader, Balance
• SVC: Speed Volume Compensation
1Adjusting the Sound
The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High.
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
You can also adjust the sound the following
procedure.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Audio, then the Common tab.
4. Select Sound.
Features
271
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
272 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
Display Setup
You can change the brightness or color theme of the audio/information screen.
■ Changing the Screen Brightness
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Display tab.
5. Select Display Settings.
6. Select the setting you want.
7. Select OK.
Features
■ Changing the Screen’s Color Theme
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Display tab.
5. Select Background Color.
6. Select the setting you want.
7. Select OK.
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Yes to reboot the system.
272
1Changing the Screen Brightness
You can change the Contrast and Black Level
settings in the same manner.
1Changing the Screen’s Color Theme
Reboot may take a few minutes.
If you default the System settings when the color
theme is changed from its default color, the system
reboots.
2 Customized Features P. 352
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
273 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
■ Selecting an Audio Source
Select the source icon.
1Selecting an Audio Source
Source Select Screen
If you startup preinstalled audio apps,
is
displayed on the lower right of the screen.
These preinstalled apps cannot be displayed on the
source select screen.
You can startup those audio apps from
.
Source List Icons
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Features
Select the current source icon, then select an icon on the source list to switch the
audio source.
Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a greyed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.
273
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
274 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuVoice Control Operation
Voice Control Operation
Your vehicle has a voice control system that allows hands-free operation.
The voice control system uses the
(Talk) and
(hang-up/back) buttons on the
steering wheel and a microphone near the map lights on the ceiling.
1Voice Control Operation
■ Voice Recognition
1Voice Recognition
To achieve optimum voice recognition when using the voice control system:
• Make sure the correct screen is displayed for the voice command that you are
using.
The system recognizes only certain commands. Available voice commands.
Features
274
2 Voice Portal Screen P. 275
• Close the windows and moonroof *.
• Adjust the dashboard and side vents so air does not blow onto the microphone
on the ceiling.
• Speak clearly in a natural speaking voice without pausing between words.
• Reduce any background noise if possible. The system may misinterpret your
command if more than one person is speaking at the same time.
* Not available on all models
When you press the
button, a helpful prompt asks
what you would like to do. Press and release the
button again to bypass this prompt and give a
command.
The voice control system can only be used from the
driver’s seat because the microphone unit removes
noises from the front passenger’s side.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
275 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuVoice Control Operation
■ Voice Portal Screen
You can also see the list of commands by
selecting Info,
, and Voice Info.
The system only recognizes the commands
on the following pages, at certain screens.
Free form voice commands are not
recognized.
■ Audio*1
This can be only used when the phone is
connected. When the system recognizes the
Phone call command, the screen will
change to the voice recognition screen for
the phone commands.
• Dial by number
• Call history
• Redial
• Call
• Call
Phone Call commands are not available if
using Apple CarPlayTM.
When the system recognizes the Audio
command, the screen will change to the
audio voice recognition screen.
• Audio On
• Audio Off
• Radio FM
• Radio AM
• Radio SXM *
• iPod
• USB
■ Music Search*1
This can be only used when the iPod or USB
device is connected.
■ Navigation*1
The screen changes to the navigation voice
recognition screen.
Features
When the
(Talk) button is pressed,
available voice commands appear on the
screen.
For a complete list of commands, say “Voice
Help” after the beep or select Voice Help.
■ Phone Call
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
■ Voice Settings
The screen changes to the Voice Recog tab
on the System settings screen.
*1: Models with navigation system
* Not available on all models
Continued
275
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
276 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuVoice Control Operation
■ Voice Help
You can see a list of the available
commands on the screen.
• Phone Commands
• Audio Commands *
• On Screen Commands
• Music Search Commands *
• General Commands *
• All Commands
• Voice Settings
• Getting Started
■ Phone Commands
The system accepts these commands on the
dedicated screen for the voice recognition
of the phone.
• Dial by Number
• Call by Name
• Dial
• Call
■ Audio Commands*1
Features
The system accepts these commands on the
dedicated screen for the voice recognition
of the audio.
■ Radio FM Commands
• Radio tune to <87.7-107.9> FM
• Radio tune to <87.7 -107.9> HD <1-8>
FM
• Radio FM preset <1-12>
■ Radio AM Commands
• Radio tune to <530-1710> AM
• Radio AM preset <1-6>
■ Radio SXM Commands *
*1: Models with navigation system
276
* Not available on all models
• SXM channel <1-255>
• SXM channel
• Radio SXM preset <1-12>
■ iPod Commands
•
•
•
•
•
iPod play
iPod play track <1-30>
Music Search
What album is this?
What am I listening to?
■ USB Commands
•
•
•
•
•
USB play
USB play track <1-30>
Music Search
What album is this?
What am I listening to?
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
277 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuVoice Control Operation
■ On Screen Commands
When On Screen Commands is selected,
the explanation screen is displayed.
■ Music Search Commands*1
The system accepts these commands on the
Music Search screen.
■ Using Song By Voice
■ Song By Voice Commands
•
•
•
•
•
•
What am I listening to?
Who am I listening to?
Who is this?
What’s playing?
Who’s playing?
What album is this?
•
•
•
•
•
•
Play artist
Play track/song
Play album
Play genre/category
Play playlist
Play composer
■ List Commands
•
•
•
•
•
List artist
List album
List genre/category
List playlist
List composer
Features
Song By Voice is a feature that allows you
to select music from your iPod or USB device
using Voice Commands. To activate this
mode, you must push the talk switch and
say: “Music search”.
TM
■ Play Commands
■ General Commands *
• What time is it?
• What is today’s date?
*1: Models with navigation system
* Not available on all models
277
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
278 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
Playing AM/FM Radio
Features
(Menu)
Select to display the menu items.
(Back)
Select to go back to the previous display.
VOL/ (Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Scan Icon
Select to scan each station with a strong signal.
Tune Icons
Select
or
to tune the radio frequency.
*1:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
278
Preset Icons
Tune the radio frequency for
preset memory.
Select and hold the preset
icon to store that station.
Select
to display preset 7
onwards.
Seek Icons
Select
or
to search up and
down the selected band for a
station with a strong signal.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
279 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Preset Memory
1Preset Memory
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Select and hold the preset number for the station you want to store.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel or
select SOURCE on the screen.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 231
You can also store a preset station by the following procedure.
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Select the open/close icon to display a list.
3. Select the Preset tab.
4. Select and hold the preset number for the station you want to store.
You can store 6 AM stations and 12 FM stations into
preset memory.
Models with HD RadioTM
HD Radio Technology manufactured under license
from iBiquity Digital Corporation. U.S. and Foreign
Patents. For patents see http://dts.com/patents. HD
Radio, Artist Experience, and the HD, HD Radio, and
“ARC” logos are registered trademarks or
trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corporation in the
United States and/or other countries.
Lists the strongest stations on the selected band.
1. Select the open/close icon to display a list.
2. Select the Station List tab.
3. Select the station.
■ Manual update
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Select the open/close icon to display a list.
2. Select the Station List tab.
3. Select Refresh.
Continued
Features
■ Station List
279
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
280 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds. To turn
off scan, select Cancel or
.
Models with HD RadioTM
■ HD Subchannel
Features
Displays the subchannel list when an HD RadioTM station is selected while listening to
an FM station.
1. Select
.
2. Select HD Subchannel.
3. Select the channel number.
■ Radio Data System (RDS)
Provides text data information related to your selected RDS-capable FM station.
■ To find an RDS station from Station List
1. Select the open/close icon to display a list while listening to an FM station.
2. Select the Station List tab.
3. Select the station.
■ Manual update
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Select the open/close icon to display a list while listening to an FM station.
2. Select the Station List tab.
3. Select Refresh.
280
1Radio Data System (RDS)
When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS
automatically turns on, and the frequency display
changes to the station name. However, when the
signals of that station become weak, the display
changes from the station name to the frequency.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
281 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Radio text
Displays the radio text information of the selected RDS station.
1. Select
.
2. Select View Radio Text.
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
To turn off scan, select Cancel or
.
Features
281
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
282 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
Playing SiriusXM® Radio *
Album Art
Audio/Information Screen
Features
(Menu)
Select to display the menu items.
Station Art
(Back)
Select to go back to the previous display.
Open/Close Icon*1
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
VOL/ (Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Skip Icons
Select
or
to
change section in the
channel.
Select and hold to move
rapidly within the section.
Scan Icon
Select to scan each channel.
Category Icons
Select
or
to display and select a
SiriusXM® Radio category.
*1:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
282
* Not available on all models
Channel Icons
Select
or
to the
previous or next channel.
Select and hold to rapidly
skip 10 channels at a time.
Preset Icons
Tune the radio frequency
for preset memory. Select
and hold the preset icon to
store that station. Select
to display preset 7
onwards.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
283 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ To Change the Tune Mode
1Playing SiriusXM® Radio *
In the channel mode, all available channels are
selectable. In the category mode, you can select a
channel within a category (Jazz, Rock, Classical, etc.).
1. Select
.
2. Select Tune Mode.
3. Select Channel Mode or Category Mode.
There may be instances when SiriusXM® Radio does
not broadcast all the data fields (artist name, title).
This does not indicate a problem with your audio
system.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel or
select SOURCE on the screen.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 231
Features
SiriusXM® Radio stations load in ascending order,
which can take about a minute. Once they have
loaded you will be able to scroll up or down to make
your selections.
Tune Start:
When you change to a preset channel, a song being
played on that channel restarts from the beginning
with this function. This can be turned on or off from
the Audio Settings screen.
2 Customized Features P. 352
* Not available on all models
Continued
283
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
284 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Preset Memory
To store a channel:
1. Tune to the selected channel.
2. Select to hold the preset number for the station you want to store.
3. Select Replace.
You can also store a channel by the following procedure.
1. Tune to the selected channel.
2. Select the open/close icon to display a list.
3. Select the Preset tab.
4. Select and hold the preset number for the station you want to store.
Features
■ Multi-channel preset (for music channels only)
284
* Not available on all models
You can store up to four of your preferred music channels per preset.
1. Tune a station.
2. Select the open/close icon to display a list.
3. Select the Preset tab.
4. Select and hold the preset number you
want to add a music channel.
u A message appears if there are no
available presets.
5. Select Combine.
1Playing SiriusXM® Radio *
You can store 12 SiriusXM® channels into the preset
memory.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
285 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Listening to Featured Channels
1Listening to Featured Channels
Suggested channel listing received from SiriusXM® can be displayed and selected.
1. Select the open/close icon to display a channel list.
2. Select the Channel List tab.
3. Select the featured channel list title you want to listen to.
u The selected channel list of the title is displayed.
4. Select the channel.
Up to three featured channels by SiriusXM® can be
displayed.
Featured channel lists are at the top of the channel
list.
Features
Continued
285
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
286 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Replay Function
The system can record up to the last 60 minutes of your currently tuned channel’s
broadcast, as well as the last 30 minutes of your preset channel’s broadcast, starting
from the moment you turn the vehicle on. If you tuned to preset channel, the system
records up to 60 minutes of a broadcast instead of up to 30 minutes. You can
rewind and replay the last 30 or 60 minutes of a broadcast.
1. Select
.
2. Select Playback.
3. Move the gauge to the position you want to replay.
Features
The following items are available on the pop-up screen:
(Skip Down): Skips to the previously stored channel. Select and hold to fastrewind the current selection.
(Skip Up): Skips to the next channel. Select and hold to fast-forward the
current selection.
(15sec Back): Select to skip back 15 seconds in the current selection. Select and
hold to fast-rewind the current selection.
(15sec Skip): Select to skip forward 15 seconds in the current selection. Select
and hold to fast-forward the current selection.
u Select OK or
to close the pop-up menu. Replay in playback mode
continues.
To play or pause on playback mode:
1. Select
.
2. Select Play/Pause.
■ Returning to real-time broadcast
1. Select
.
2. Select Go to Live.
286
1Replay Function
The system starts storing broadcast in memory when
the power mode is turned ON. You can go back to
the program from that point.
You can no longer replay any program once the
power mode is turned off as it erases memory.
You can check how long the program has been
stored in memory from the audio/information screen.
After 30 or 60 minutes of recording the system will
automatically start deleting the oldest data.
Audio/Information Screen
(A)
(B)
(C)
(A): Shows how much time the replayed segment is
behind the real-time broadcast
(B): Replayed segment
(C): Length stored in memory
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
287 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Live Sports Alert
1Live Sports Alert
While listening to other channel, you can receive sports alerts such as scores from
your favorite teams.
■ To set up a favorite team
The sports alert function at SiriusXM® mode only.
1To set up a favorite team
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Audio.
4. Select the SXM tab.
5. Select SportsFlash Setup.
6. Select a team.
Sports alerts cut in only when SiriusXM® mode is on.
Selecting On(one time) from the customize settings
disables the alert feature next time you turn the
power mode to ON.
2 Customized Features P. 352
■ To set up a alert message
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Audio.
4. Select the SXM tab.
5. Select SportsFlash Setup.
6. Select Interrupt.
7. Select On(one time) or On(continue).
Continued
Features
You can also set up a favorite team by the following
procedure.
1. Select Audio.
2. Select
.
3. Select Settings.
4. Select the SXM tab.
287
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
288 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ To set up a alert beep
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Audio.
4. Select the SXM tab.
5. Select SportsFlash Setup.
6. Select Interrupt Beep.
7. Select On.
■ Receiving a sports alert
Features
288
1. A pop-up appears and notifies you of a sports alert.
2. Select Listen.
u You can use the same items as the playback mode pop-up screen.
2 Replay Function P. 286
To go back to the previous screen, select Back.
1To set up a alert beep
You can also set up a alert beep by the following
procedure.
1. Select Audio.
2. Select
.
3. Select Settings.
4. Select the SXM tab.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
289 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Traffic and Weather Information
You can receive traffic and weather information.
■ To set up a traffic & weather information
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Audio.
4. Select the SXM tab.
5. Select Traffic & Weather Setup.
6. Select the region.
u When you do not want to receive the information, select Unregistered.
1Traffic and Weather Information
The traffic and weather information function at
SiriusXM® mode only.
You can also set up the traffic and weather
information by the following procedure.
1. Select Audio.
2. Select
.
3. Select Settings.
4. Select the SXM tab.
Features
■ Listening to traffic and weather information
1. Select
.
2. Select Traffic & Weather.
u Play mode can also use the any items same as playback mode.
2 Replay Function P. 286
To go back to the previous screen, select OK.
■ Scan
Sample each channel on the selected mode for 10 seconds.
1. Select Scan.
2. Select Scan Channels.
u You can select the desired channel by songs using Scan Song in Presets.
To turn off scan, select Cancel Scan.
1Scan
The “Scan Songs in Presets” function is based on
TuneScanTM technology of SiriusXM®.
The “Featured Channels” function is based on
Featured FavoritesTM technology of SiriusXM®.
TuneScanTM and Featured FavoritesTM are registered
trademarks of SiriusXM® Radio, Inc.
289
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
290 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your USB connector to the USB port, then select the iPod
mode.
2 USB Port(s) P. 229
Audio/Information Screen
Features
(Menu)
Select to display the menu items.
(Back)
Select to go back to the previous display.
USB Indicator
Appears when an iPod is connected.
Open/Close Icon*1
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
VOL/ (Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Cover Art
*1:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
290
Song Icons
Select
or
to change songs.
Select and hold to move rapidly within a song.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
291 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Song from the Music Search List
1. Select
1Playing an iPod
and select Music Search.
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle’s audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 324
Category Selection
2. Select the items on that menu.
Select Switch USB Device in the Audio Menu
screen to switch to another USB device.
Features
If you operate the music app on your iPhone/iPod
while the phone is connected to the audio system,
you may no longer be able to operate the same app
on the audio/information screen.
Reconnect the device if necessary.
If an iPhone is connected via Apple CarPlay, the iPod/
USB source will be unavailable and audio files on the
phone will be playable only within Apple CarPlay.
Item Selection
Continued
291
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
292 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a file.
Select a mode.
Features
292
■ To turn off a play mode
Select the mode you want to turn off.
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Shuffle Albums: Plays all available albums in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs,
podcasts, genres, composers, or audiobooks) in
random order.
Shuffle All Songs: Plays all available files in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs,
podcasts, genres, composers, or audiobooks) in
random order.
Repeat Song: Repeats the current track.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
293 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSong By VoiceTM (SBV)
Models with navigation system
TM
Song By Voice
(SBV)
Use SBV to search for and play music from your USB flash drive or iPod using voice
commands.
1Song By VoiceTM (SBV)
Setting options:
• On (factory default): Song By VoiceTM commands
■ To enable SBV
are available.
• Off: Disable the feature.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Voice Recog tab.
5. Select Song by Voice.
6. Select On or Off.
Features
Continued
293
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
294 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSong By VoiceTM (SBV)
■ Searching for music using SBV
1Searching for music using SBV
Features
1. Set the Song by Voice setting to On.
2. Press the
(Talk) button and say “Music
Search” to activate the SBV feature for the
USB flash drive and iPod.
3. Press the
button and say a command.
u Example 1: Say “(List) ‘Artist A’“ to view
a list of songs by that artist. Select the
desired song to start playing.
u Example 2: Say “Play ‘Artist A’“ to start
playing songs by that artist.
4. To cancel SBV, press the
(hang-up/
back) button on the steering wheel. The
selected song continues playing.
Once you have canceled this mode, you need
to press the
button and say “Music
Search” again to re-activate this mode.
294
Song By VoiceTM Commands List
2 Song By VoiceTM (SBV) P. 293
NOTE:
Song By VoiceTM commands are available for tracks
stored on the USB flash drive or iPod.
You can add phonetic modifications of difficult
words so that it is easier for SBV to recognize artists,
songs, albums, and composers in voice commands.
2 Phonetic Modification P. 295
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
295 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSong By VoiceTM (SBV)
■ Phonetic Modification
1Phonetic Modification
Continued
Song by Voice Phonetic Modification is grayed
out when Song By Voice is set to Off.
You can store up to 2,000 phonetic modification
items.
Features
Add phonetic modifications of difficult or foreign words so that it is easier for SBV
to recognize artists, songs, albums, and composers in voice commands when
searching for music on the USB flash drive or iPod.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Voice Recog tab.
5. Select Song by Voice Phonetic
Modification.
6. Select New Modification.
7. Select USB or iPod.
295
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
296 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSong By VoiceTM (SBV)
Features
296
8. Select the item to modify (e.g., Artist).
u The list of the selected item appears on
the screen.
9. Select an entry to modify.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
u The listen to the current phonetic
modification, select Play.
u To delete the current phonetic
modification, select Delete.
10.Select Modify.
11.Select the phonetic spelling you want to
use (e.g., ”Artist A”) when prompted.
12.Select OK.
u The artist “No Name” is phonetically
modified to “Artist A.” When in the SBV
mode, you can press the
(Talk) button
and use the voice command “Play ‘Artist
A’” to play songs by the artist “No
Name.”
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
297 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Pandora®
U.S. models
Playing Pandora®
1Playing Pandora®
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from the Pandora® app on a
compatible smartphone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle’s
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) system, or with an iPhone, you can connect using
your USB cable to the USB port.
2 Phone Setup P. 400
2 USB Port(s) P. 229
Pandora®, the Pandora logo, and the Pandora trade
dress are trademarks or registered trademarks of
Pandora Media, Inc., used with permission. Pandora
is only available in certain countries. Visit the Pandora
website for more information.
To find out if your phone is compatible with this
feature, visit automobiles.honda.com/handsfreelink/,
or call 1-888-528-7876.
Station List
Displays/
hides the
Station List.
(Menu)
Select to display
the menu items.
(Back)
Select to go back to
the previous display.
VOL/ (Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Station Up/Down Icons
Select to change a station.
Bookmark
Select to bookmark
a track.
Like/Dislike Icons
Select to evaluate a track.
Play/Pause Icon
Select to resume or play a track.
Skip Icon
Select to skip a track.
Find the music you love and let the music you love
find you. Pandora® gives you a personalized music
experience that continually evolves with your tastes.
Create personalized stations from songs, artists or
genres. Not sure where to start? Use our voice search
to easily find stations that match your mood or
activity.
Features
To use this service in your vehicle, the Pandora® app
must first be installed on your phone. Visit
www.pandora.com. for more information.
If you cannot operate Pandora® through the audio
system, it may be streaming through Bluetooth®
Audio. Make sure Pandora® mode on your audio
system is selected.
If your phone is connected to Android AutoTM,
Pandora is only available through the Android AutoTM
interface. Visit the Android AutoTM website to check
compatibility.
*1:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
Continued
297
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
298 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Pandora®
■ Pandora® Menu
1Pandora® Menu
You can operate some of the Pandora® menu items from your vehicle’s audio
system. The available items are:
• Station List
• Manage Station
• Sound
• Setting
■ Operating a menu item
1. Select
.
2. Select an item.
Manage Station Items
Genre: Add the selected genre to the station list.
Current Artist: Add the current artist to station list.
Current Track: Add the current track to station list.
Delete: Delete the selected Station from the Station
list.
Available operating functions vary on software
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle’s audio system.
Features
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 Pandora® P. 326
Pandora® may limit the total number of skips allowed
on the service. If you dislike a track after the skip limit
has been reached, your feedback will be saved but
the current track will continue to play.
To change stations, activate the Pandora® menu,
select Station List, and then select a new station. It
also changes stations on the main Pandora® screen.
298
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
299 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays sound and video files on a USB flash drive in
either MP3, WMA, or AAC*1 format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then select the USB mode.
2 USB Port(s) P. 229
Audio/Information Screen
USB Indicator
Appears when a USB flash
drive is connected.
Features
(Menu)
Select to display the menu items.
(Back)
Select to go back to the previous display.
Open/Close Icon*2
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
VOL/ (Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Folder Icons
Select
to skip to the next folder, and
to the beginning of the previous folder.
to skip
Track Icons
Select
or
to change
files.
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a track.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
*2:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
Continued
299
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
300 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a File from the Music Search List
1. Select
and select Music Search.
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 329
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, then
skips to the next file.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 324
Folder Selection
Features
2. Select a folder.
Select Switch USB Device in the Audio Menu
screen to switch to another USB device.
Track Selection
3. Select a track.
300
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
301 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a file.
1. Select
.
2. Select Scan.
3. Select a mode.
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Folders: Provides 10-second sampling of the
first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all files
in the current folder.
Random/Repeat
Repeat Folder: Repeats all files in the current folder.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current file.
Random in Folder: Plays all files in the current
folder in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all files in random order.
Features
■ Random/Repeat
Select a play mode.
1How to Select a Play Mode
Random/Repeat is selected.
■ To turn off a play mode
To turn off Scan, select
or Cancel Scan.
To turn off Random/Repeat, select the mode again.
301
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
302 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle’s
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) System.
2 Phone Setup P. 400
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your phone is
connected to HFL.
Open/Close Icon*1
Displays/hides the
detailed information.
Audio/Information Screen
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible.
To check if your phone is compatible, visit
automobiles.honda.com/handsfreelink/.
It may be illegal to perform some data device
functions while driving.
Only one phone can be used with HFL at a time.
When there are more than two paired phones in the
vehicle, the first paired phone the system finds is
automatically connected.
Features
If more than one phone is paired to the HFL system,
there may be a delay before the system begins to play.
In some cases, the name of the artist, album, or track
may not appear correctly.
(Menu)
Select to display the
menu items.
Some functions may not be available on some
devices.
(Back)
Select to go back to
the previous display.
VOL/ (Power/volume)
Knob
Press to turn the audio
system on and off.
Turn to adjust the
volume.
Play Icon
Pause Icon
Track Icons
Select
or
change tracks.
Group Icons
Select
or
group.
to
to change
*1 : Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect, some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
302
If a phone is currently connected via Apple CarPlayTM
or Android AutoTM, Bluetooth® Audio from that
phone is unavailable. However, a second previously
paired phone can stream Bluetooth® Audio by
selecting Connect
from Bluetooth Device List.
2 Phone Setup P. 400
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
303 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
connected to the system.
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone maker’s operating
instructions.
2 Phone Setup P. 400
2. Select the Bluetooth® Audio mode.
If the phone is not recognized, another HFLcompatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be
connected.
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
You can change the connected phone in the
Bluetooth® settings on the Audio Menu screen by
the following procedure.
1. Select
.
2. Select Setting.
■ Searching for Music
1Searching for Music
1. Select
.
2. Select Music Search.
3. Select a search category (e.g., Albums).
4. Select an item.
u The selection begins playing.
Features
■ To pause or resume a file
Select the play icon or pause icon.
Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect,
some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
303
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
304 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuHondaLink®
HondaLink®
HondaLink® connects you to the latest information from Honda. You can connect
your phone wirelessly through Wi-Fi or Bluetooth®.
2 Wi-Fi Connection P. 309
2 Phone Setup P. 400
■ HondaLink® Menu
1HondaLink®
The HondaLink® connect app is compatible with most
iPhone and Android phones.
Some cell phone carriers charge for tethering and
smartphone data use. Check your phone’s data
subscription package.
If there is an active connection to Apple CarPlayTM or
Android AutoTM, HondaLink® can only be connected
through Wi-Fi.
Features
■ Places *
Displays restaurants, gas stations, Honda dealer, and so on. You can also navigate to
the found locations via the navigation.
■ Vehicle
Displays instruction messages when the vehicle needs service.
■ Help & Support
Displays tips for vehicle usage, and get support via road side or customer service
center.
304
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
305 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuHondaLink®
■ Messages from Honda
Displays helpful and important information from Honda.
■ Weather *
Displays a weekly five-day weather forecast for any location you want. You can
change the ZIP Code at any time.
■ To Set Up to Connect HondaLink® Service
Use the following procedure to connect to HondaLink® service.
■ To enable the HondaLink® service
Features
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Clock/Info.
4. Select the HondaLink tab.
5. Select Diagnostics & Location Data.
6. Select On.
You need to allow the consent of the location
service to enable the HondaLink® service.
Enable once: Allows only one time. (Prompt
shows again next time.)
Always Enable: Allows anytime. (Prompt
does not show again.)
Cancel: Does not allow this consent.
* Not available on all models
Continued
305
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
306 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuHondaLink®
■ To link with HondaLink®
You can see the Connection Guide screen
after launching HondaLink®. If you do not
need this guide, select check-box and select
OK.
Features
306
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
307 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuHondaLink®
■ Vehicle Information and Message from Honda Tips
You can check the messages that are received quickly in the shortcut operation.
1. A message appears and notifies you of a
new message on the header area.
u When the message is received, a
notification ring can be heard.
2. A message icon is continuously displayed in
the header area until the new message is
read.
Continued
Features
Message
Icon
(yellow)
307
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
308 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuHondaLink®
3. From the top of the screen, swipe down to
see the messages.
Features
308
4. Select a new message to open.
u If you have selected the update option
for HondaLink®, follow the directions on
the screen to complete the process.
1Vehicle Information and Message from Honda Tips
When you update HondaLink®, you must keep the
engine running and maintain a constant connection
with HondaLink®.
If the update is interrupted, the system will
automatically resume the process. If, however, a
week has elapsed since the process was first
interrupted, you must repeat the process from the
beginning.
You can update HondaLink® by selecting Message
from Honda on the HondaLink® menu.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
309 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuWi-Fi Connection
Wi-Fi Connection
You can connect the display audio system to the Internet using Wi-Fi and browse
websites or use online services on the audio/information screen. If your phone has
wireless hotspot capabilities, the system can be tethered to the phone. Use the
following steps to setup.
■ Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time)
Continued
You cannot go through the setting procedure while a
vehicle is moving. Park in a safe place to set the audio
system in Wi-Fi mode.
Some cell phone carriers charge for tethering and
smartphone data use. Check your phone’s data
subscription package.
Check your phone manual to find out if the phone
has Wi-Fi connectivity.
You can confirm whether Wi-Fi connection is on or
off with the
icon on Wi-Fi Device List.
Transmission speed and others will not be displayed
on this screen.
Features
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Bluetooth / Wi-Fi.
4. Select the Wi-Fi tab.
5. Select Wi-Fi On/Off Status, then On.
6. Select Wi-Fi Device List.
u Make sure your phone’s Wi-Fi setting is
in access point (tethering) mode.
u Select the phone you want to connect to
the system.
u If you do not find the phone you want to
connect in the list, select Scan.
1Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time)
309
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
310 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuWi-Fi Connection
7. Select Connect.
u Enter a password for your phone, and
select Done.
u When the connection is successful, the
icon is displayed on the list.
8. Select
to go back to the home screen.
■ Wi-Fi mode (after the initial setting has been made)
Features
310
Make sure your phone's Wi-Fi setting is in access point (tethering) mode.
1Wi-Fi mode (after the initial setting has been made)
iPhone users
You may need to go through an initial setup for WiFi connection again after you boot your phone.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
311 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSiri® Eyes Free
Siri® Eyes Free
You can talk to Siri® using the
(Talk) button on the steering wheel when your
iPhone is paired to the Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) System.
1Siri® Eyes Free
Siri® is a trademark of Apple Inc.
2 Phone Setup P. 400
Check Apple Inc. website for features available for
Siri®.
We recommend against using Siri® other than in Siri®
Eyes Free while operating a vehicle.
■ Using Siri® Eyes Free
1Using Siri® Eyes Free
Some commands work only on specific phone
features or apps.
Features
Appears
when Siri®
is activated
in Siri® Eyes
Free
While in Siri® Eyes Free:
The display remains the same.
No feedback or commands
appear.
(Talk) Button
Press and hold until the display changes as shown.
(Hang-up/back) Button
Press to deactivate Siri®.
311
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
312 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuApple CarPlayTM
Apple CarPlayTM
If you connect an Apple CarPlayTM-compatible iPhone to the system via the 1.5A USB
port, you can use the audio/information touch screen, instead of the iPhone display,
to make a phone call, listen to music, view maps (navigation), and access messages.
1Apple CarPlayTM
Only iPhone5 or newer versions with iOS 8.4 or later
are compatible with Apple CarPlayTM.
2 USB Port(s) P. 229
Park in a safe place before connecting your iPhone to
Apple CarPlayTM and when launching any compatible
apps.
To use Apple CarPlayTM, connect the USB cable to the
1.5A USB port. The USB port located in the center
console storage will not enable Apple CarPlayTM
operation.
2 USB Port(s) P. 229
Features
To directly access the Apple CarPlayTM phone
function, select Phone on the home screen. While
connected to Apple CarPlayTM, calls are only made
through Apple CarPlayTM. If you want to make a call
with Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®, turn Apple
CarPlayTM OFF or detach the USB cable from your
iPhone.
2 Setting Up Apple CarPlayTM P. 314
When your iPhone is connected to Apple CarPlayTM, it
is not possible to use the Bluetooth® Audio or
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®. However, other
previously paired phones can stream audio via
Bluetooth® while Apple CarPlayTM is connected.
2 Phone Setup P. 400
For details on countries and regions where Apple
CarPlayTM is available, as well as information
pertaining to function, refer to the Apple homepage.
312
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
313 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuApple CarPlayTM
■ Apple CarPlayTM Menu
Home Screen
Apple CarPlayTM Icon
1Apple CarPlayTM
Apple CarPlay
TM
Apple CarPlayTM Operating Requirements &
Limitations
Apple CarPlayTM requires a compatible iPhone with an
active cellular connection and data plan. Your
carrier’s rate plans will apply.
Menu
Select the
Honda
Icon to
return to
the Home
Go back to the Apple
CarPlayTM menu screen. screen.
It is possible to use 3rd party apps if they are
compatible with Apple CarPlayTM. Refer to the Apple
homepage for information on compatible apps.
■ Messages
Check and reply to text messages, or have messages read to you.
Features
■ Phone
Access the contact list, make phone calls, or listen to voice mail.
Changes in operating systems, hardware, software,
and other technology integral to providing Apple
CarPlayTM functionality, as well as new or revised
governmental regulations, may result in a decrease or
cessation of Apple CarPlayTM functionality and
services. Honda cannot and does not provide any
warranty or guarantee of future Apple CarPlayTM
performance or functionality.
■ Music
Play music stored on your iPhone.
■ Maps
Display Apple Maps and use the navigation function just as you would on your
iPhone.
Models with navigation system
Only one navigation system (pre-installed navigation or Apple CarPlayTM map) can
give directions at a time. When you are using one system, directions to any prior
destination set on the other system will be canceled, and the system you are
currently using will direct you to your destination.
Continued
313
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
314 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuApple CarPlayTM
■ Setting Up Apple CarPlayTM
After you have connected your iPhone to the system via USB, use the following
procedure to set up Apple CarPlayTM. Use of Apple CarPlayTM will result in the
transmission of certain user and vehicle information (such as vehicle location, speed,
and status) to your iPhone to enhance the Apple CarPlayTM experience. You will need
to consent to the sharing of this information on the audio/information touch screen.
■ Enabling Apple CarPlayTM
Features
• Enable once: Allows only once. (Prompt
shows again next time.)
• Always Enable: Allows anytime. (Prompt
does not show again.)
• Cancel: Does not allow this consent.
You may change the consent settings under
the Smartphone settings menu.
314
1Setting Up Apple CarPlayTM
You can also use the method below to set up Apple
CarPlayTM:
Select HOMESettingsSmartphoneApple
CarPlay.
Use of user and vehicle information
The use and handling of user and vehicle information
transmitted to/from your iPhone by Apple CarPlayTM
is governed by the Apple iOS terms and conditions
and Apple’s Privacy Policy.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
315 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuApple CarPlayTM
■ Operating Apple CarPlayTM with Siri®
Press and hold the talk button to activate Siri®.
1Operating Apple CarPlayTM with Siri®
Below are examples of questions and commands for
Siri®.
• What movies are playing today?
• Call dad at work.
• What song is this?
• How's the weather tomorrow?
• Read my latest email.
• Find a table for four tonight in Chicago.
For more information, please visit
www.apple.com/ios/siri.
Features
(Talk) button:
Press and hold to activate Siri®.
Press again to deactivate Siri®.
Press and release to activate standard voice recognition system.
315
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
316 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAndroid AutoTM
Android AutoTM
When you connect an Android phone to the Display Audio system via the 1.5A USB
port, Android AutoTM is automatically initiated. When connected via Android
AutoTM, you can use the audio/information touch screen to access the Phone,
Google Maps (Navigation), Google Play Music, and Google Now functions. When
you first use Android AutoTM, a tutorial will appear on the screen. We recommend
that you complete this tutorial while safely parked before using Android AutoTM.
2 USB Port(s) P. 229
2 Auto Pairing Connection P. 318
1Android AutoTM
To use Android AutoTM, you need to download the
Android AutoTM app from Google Play to your
smartphone.
Only Android 5.0 (Lollipop) or later versions are
compatible with Android AutoTM. Bluetooth A2DP
cannot be used with Android AutoTM phone.
Park in a safe place before connecting your Android
phone to Android AutoTM and when launching any
compatible apps.
Features
To use Android AutoTM, connect the USB cable to the
1.5A USB port. The USB port in the center console
storage will not enable Android AutoTM operation.
2 USB Port(s) P. 229
To directly access the Android AutoTM phone function,
select Phone on the home screen. While connected to
Android AutoTM, calls are only made through Android
AutoTM. If you want to make a call with Bluetooth®
HandsFreeLink®, turn Android AutoTM OFF or detach the
USB cable from your Android phone.
2 Auto Pairing Connection P. 318
When your Android phone is connected to Android
AutoTM, it is not possible to use Bluetooth® Audio or
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®. However, other
previously paired phones can stream audio via
Bluetooth® while Android AutoTM is connected.
2 Phone Setup P. 400
316
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
317 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAndroid AutoTM
■ Android AutoTM Menu
1Android AutoTM
6
For details on countries and regions where Android
AutoTM is available, as well as information pertaining
to function, refer to the Android AutoTM homepage.
Android AutoTM Operating Requirements &
Limitations
Android AutoTM requires a compatible Android phone
with an active cellular connection and data plan.
Your carrier’s rate plans will apply.
: Go back to
the home screen.
Android AutoTM Icon
Models with navigation system
Only one navigation system (pre-installed navigation or Android AutoTM) can give
directions at a time. When you are using one system, directions to any prior
destination set on the other system will be canceled, and the system you are
currently using will direct you to your destination.
The audio/Information screen shows you turn-by-turn driving directions to your
destination.
b Phone (Communication)
Make and receive phone calls as well as listen to voicemail.
c Google Now (Home screen)
Display useful information organized by Android AutoTM into simple cards that
appear just when they’re needed.
d Music and audio
Play Google Play Music and music apps that are compatible with Android AutoTM. To
switch between music apps, press this icon.
e Go back to the home screen
f Voice
Operate Android AutoTM with your voice.
Continued
Features
Maps (Navigation)
Display Google Maps and use the navigation function just as you would with your
Android phone. When the vehicle is in motion, it is not possible to make keyboard
entries. Stop the vehicle in a safe location to undertake a search or provide other inputs.
a
Changes in operating systems, hardware, software,
and other technology integral to providing Android
AutoTM functionality, as well as new or revised
governmental regulations, may result in a decrease or
cessation of Android AutoTM functionality and
services. Honda cannot and does not provide any
warranty or guarantee of future Android AutoTM
performance or functionality.
It is possible to use 3rd party apps if they are
compatible with Android AutoTM. Refer to the
Android AutoTM homepage for information on
compatible apps.
317
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
318 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAndroid AutoTM
■ Auto Pairing Connection
1Enabling Android AutoTM
When you connect an Android phone to the unit via USB, Android AutoTM is
automatically initiated.
■ Enabling Android AutoTM
• Enable once: Allows only once. (Prompt
shows again next time.)
• Always Enable: Allows anytime. (Prompt
does not show again.)
• Cancel: Does not allow this consent.
Features
318
You may change the consent settings under
the Smartphone settings menu.
Only initialize Android AutoTM when you are safely
parked. When Android AutoTM first detects your
phone, you will need to set up your phone so that
auto pairing is possible. Refer to the instruction
manual that came with your phone.
You can use the method below to change Android
AutoTM settings after you have completed the initial
setup:
Select HOMESettingsSmartphoneAndroid
Auto.
Use of user and vehicle information
The use and handling of user and vehicle information
transmitted to/from your phone by Android AutoTM is
governed by Google’s Privacy Policy.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
319 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAndroid AutoTM
■ Operating Android AutoTM with Voice Recognition
Press and hold the talk button to operate Android AutoTM with your voice.
1Operating Android AutoTM with Voice Recognition
Below are examples of commands you can give with
voice recognition:
• Reply to text.
• Call my wife.
• Navigate to Honda.
• Play my music.
• Send a text message to my wife.
• Call flower shop.
For more information, please refer to the Android
AutoTM homepage.
Features
(Talk) button:
Press and hold to operate Android AutoTM with your voice.
Press and release to activate standard voice recognition system.
You can also activate the voice recognition function
by pressing the
icon in the upper-right corner of
the screen.
(Hang-up/back) button:
Press to deactivate voice recognition.
319
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
320 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuLegal Information on Apple CarPlayTM/Android AutoTM
Legal Information on Apple CarPlayTM/Android AutoTM
■ OWNER’S MANUAL LICENSE/LIABILITY STATEMENTS
USE OF APPLE CARPLAY IS SUBJECT TO YOUR AGREEMENT TO THE CARPLAY TERMS OF USE, WHICH ARE INCLUDED AS PART OF THE
APPLE iOS TERMS OF USE. IN SUMMARY, THE CARPLAY TERMS OF USE DISCLAIM APPLE AND ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS’ LIABILITY IF THE
SERVICES FAIL TO PERFORM CORRECTLY OR ARE DISCONTINUED, STRICTLY LIMIT APPLE AND ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS’ OTHER
LIABILITIES, DESCRIBE THE KINDS OF USER INFORMATION (INCLUDING, FOR EXAMPLE, VEHICLE LOCATION, VEHICLE SPEED, AND
VEHICLE STATUS) BEING GATHERED AND STORED BY APPLE AND ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS, AND DISCLOSE CERTAIN POSSIBLE RISKS
ASSOCIATED WITH THE USE OF CARPLAY, INCLUDING THE POTENTIAL FOR DRIVER DISTRACTION. SEE APPLE’S PRIVACY POLICY FOR
DETAILS REGARDING APPLE’S USE AND HANDLING OF DATA UPLOADED BY CARPLAY.
Features
320
USE OF ANDROID AUTO IS SUBJECT TO YOUR AGREEMENT TO THE ANDROID AUTO TERMS OF USE WHICH MUST BE AGREED TO WHEN
THE ANDROID AUTO APPLICATION IS DOWNLOADED TO YOUR ANDROID PHONE. IN SUMMARY, THE ANDROID AUTO TERMS OF USE
DISCLAIM GOOGLE AND ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS’ LIABILITY IF THE SERVICES FAIL TO PERFORM CORRECTLY OR ARE DISCONTINUED,
STRICTLY LIMIT GOOGLE AND ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS’ OTHER LIABILITIES, DESCRIBE THE KINDS OF USER INFORMATION (INCLUDING,
FOR EXAMPLE, VEHICLE LOCATION, VEHICLE SPEED, AND VEHICLE STATUS) BEING GATHERED AND STORED BY GOOGLE AND ITS
SERVICE PROVIDERS, AND DISCLOSE CERTAIN POSSIBLE RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH THE USE OF ANDROID AUTO, INCLUDING THE
POTENTIAL FOR DRIVER DISTRACTION. SEE GOOGLE’S PRIVACY POLICY FOR DETAILS REGARDING GOOGLE’S USE AND HANDLING OF
DATA UPLOADED BY ANDROID AUTO.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
321 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuLegal Information on Apple CarPlayTM/Android AutoTM
■ DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTIES; LIMITATION ON LIABILITY
Features
YOU EXPRESSLY ACKNOWLEDGE AND AGREE THAT USE OF APPLE CARPLAY OR ANDROID AUTO (“THE APPLICATIONS”) IS AT YOUR
SOLE RISK AND THAT THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO SATISFACTORY QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, ACCURACY AND EFFORT IS WITH YOU TO THE
MAXIMUM EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, AND THAT THE APPLICATIONS AND INFORMATION ON THE APPLICATIONS IS
PROVIDED “AS IS” AND “AS AVAILABLE,” WITH ALL FAULTS AND WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, AND HONDA HEREBY
DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES AND CONDITIONS WITH RESPECT TO THE APPLICATIONS AND INFORMATION ON THE APPLICATIONS,
EITHER EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES AND/OR CONDITIONS OF
MERCHANTABILITY, SATISFACTORY QUALITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ACCURACY, QUIET ENJOYMENT, AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. NO ORAL OR WRITTEN INFORMATION OR ADVICE GIVEN BY HONDA OR AN AUTHORIZED
REPRESENTATIVE SHALL CREATE A WARRANTY. AS EXAMPLES, AND WITHOUT LIMITATION, HONDA DISCLAIMS ANY WARRANTY
REGARDING THE ACCURACY OF DATA PROVIDED BY THE APPLICATIONS, SUCH AS THE ACCURACY OF DIRECTIONS, ESTIMATED
TRAVEL TIME, SPEED LIMITS, ROAD CONDITIONS, NEWS, WEATHER, TRAFFIC, OR OTHER CONTENT PROVIDED BY APPLE, GOOGLE, THEIR
AFFILIATES, OR THIRD PARTY PROVIDERS; HONDA DOES NOT GUARANTEE AGAINST LOSS OF APPLICATION DATA, WHICH MAY BE LOST
AT ANY TIME; HONDA DOES NOT GUARANTEE THAT THE APPLICATIONS OR ANY SERVICES PROVIDED THROUGH THEM WILL BE
PROVIDED AT ALL TIMES OR THAT ANY OR ALL SERVICES WILL BE AVAILABLE AT ANY PARTICULAR TIME OR LOCATION. FOR EXAMPLE,
SERVICES MAY BE SUSPENDED OR INTERRUPTED WITHOUT NOTICE FOR REPAIR, MAINTENANCE, SECURITY FIXES, UPDATES, ETC.,
SERVICES MAY BE UNAVAILABLE IN YOUR AREA OR LOCATION, ETC. IN ADDITION, YOU UNDERSTAND THAT CHANGES IN THIRD PARTY
TECHNOLOGY OR GOVERNMENT REGULATION MAY RENDER THE SERVICES AND/OR APPLICATIONS OBSOLETE AND/OR UNUSABLE.
TO THE EXTENT NOT PROHIBITED BY LAW, IN NO EVENT SHALL HONDA OR ITS AFFILIATES BE LIABLE FOR PERSONAL INJURY, OR ANY
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WHATSOEVER, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR
LOSS OF PROFITS, CORRUPTION OR LOSS OF DATA, FAILURE TO TRANSMIT OR RECEIVE ANY DATA, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION OR ANY
OTHER COMMERCIAL DAMAGES OR LOSSES, ARISING OUT OF OR RELATED TO THE APPLICATIONS OR YOUR USE OF OR INABILITY TO
USE THE APPLICATIONS OR INFORMATION ON THE APPLICATIONS, HOWEVER CAUSED, REGARDLESS OF THE THEORY OF LIABILITY
(CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE) AND EVEN IF HONDA WERE ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. SOME STATES AND
JURISDICTIONS DISALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF LIABILITY FOR DAMAGES, SO THESE LIMITATIONS AND EXCLUSIONS MAY
NOT APPLY TO YOU. IN NO EVENT SHALL HONDA’S TOTAL LIABILITY TO YOU FOR ALL DAMAGES (OTHER THAN AS MAY BE REQUIRED
BY APPLICABLE LAW IN CASES INVOLVING PERSONAL INJURY) EXCEED THE AMOUNT OF FIVE DOLLARS ($5.00). THE FOREGOING
LIMITATIONS WILL APPLY EVEN IF THE ABOVE STATED REMEDY FAILS OF ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE.
321
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
322 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAbout Open Source Licenses
About Open Source Licenses
To see the open source license information, follow these steps.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Others tab.
5. Select Detail Info.
6. Select About device.
7. Select Legal information.
8. Select Open source licenses.
1About Open Source Licenses
LICENCE: Copyright © 2001 Bob Trower, Trantor
Standard Systems Inc.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a copy of this software and
associated documentation files (the “Software”), to
deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to
whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to
the following conditions:
Features
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included in all copies or substantial
portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR
OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
322
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
323 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Audio Error Messages
CD Player *
If a disc error occurs, you may see the following error messages.
Error Message
Unplayable File
Bad Disc
Please check
owners manual.
Push Eject
Cause
Track/file format not supported
Mechanical error
• Current track/file will be skipped. The next supported track/file
plays automatically.
• Press the
(eject) button and remove the disc, and check that
the error message is cleared.
• Check that the disc is not damaged or deformed, and insert the
disc again.
2 Protecting CDs P. 331
Mecha Error
Servo error
Check Disc
Disc error
Heat Error
High temperature
• If the error message reappears, press the
button, and pull out
the disc.
• Insert a different disc.
If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc.
• If the error message repeats, or the disc cannot be removed,
contact a dealer.
Do not try to force the disc out of the player.
Features
Bad Disc
Please check
owners manual.
* Not available on all models
Solution
• Check that the disc is not damaged or deformed.
2 Protecting CDs P. 331
• Turn the audio system off and allow the player to cool down until
the error message is cleared.
323
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
324 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio Error MessagesuiPod/USB Flash Drive
iPod/USB Flash Drive
If an error occurs while playing an iPod or USB flash drive, you may see the following
error messages. If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message
Features
USB Error
Appears when there is a problem with the USB adapter unit. Check if the device is compatible
with the USB adapter unit.
A charging error has occurred with
the connected USB device.
When safe please check the
compatibility of the device and USB
cable and try again*1
Bad USB Device*2
Appears when an incompatible device is connected. Disconnect the device. Then turn the
audio system off, and turn it on again. Do not reconnect the device that caused the error.
Unsupported Version*1
Unsupported Ver*2
Appears when an unsupported iPod is connected. If it appears when a supported iPod is
connected, update the iPod software to the newer version.
Connect Retry*1
Retry Connection*2
Appears when the system does not acknowledge the iPod. Reconnect the iPod.
Unplayable File
Appears when the files in the USB flash drive are DRM or an unsupported format. This error
message appears for about 3 seconds, then plays the next song.
*1:Display audio system
*2:Color audio system
324
Solution
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
325 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio Error MessagesuiPod/USB Flash Drive
Error Message
Solution
iPod
Appears when the iPod is empty.
No Data*1, *2
USB No Song*2
iPod No Song*2
USB flash drive
Appears when the USB flash drive is empty or there are no MP3, WMA, or AAC files in the
USB flash drive.
iPod and USB flash drive
Check that compatible files are stored on the device.
Unsupported
Features
*1:Display audio system
*2:Color audio system
Appears when an unsupported device is connected. If it appears when a supported device is
connected, reconnect the device.
325
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
326 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio Error MessagesuPandora®
U.S. models
Models with display audio system
Pandora®
If an error occurs while playing Pandora®, you may see the following error messages.
If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message
Solution
No active station. Please select one.
Unable to rate this track. Please try again.
You've reached your skip limit.
Oops! Your station list is full.
Please delete an existing station in order to add more.
• Appears when the number of stations that can be created is
exceeded. Follow the message.
Features
Unable to create new station. Please try again.
Unable to play Pandora. Please try again later.
Unable to save bookmark.
Try again later.
326
• Appears when there is no station list on the device. Use the
device to create a station.
• Appears when the commanded operation is failed. Try again
later.
This Pandora station is currently not available. Please select
another station.
• Appears when the station you selected is not available. Change a
station, or try again later.
Unable to play Pandora. When stopped, log-in to Pandora.
• Appears when you have not logged into Pandora®. Follow the
message.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
327 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio Error MessagesuPandora®
Error Message
Solution
Unable to connect to Pandora. When stopped, check your
mobile phone.
No Internet Connection. Pandora will automatically resume
when the connection is restored.
• Appears when failed to connect. Check your device and try
again.
Unable to play Pandora. Please try again later.
Connect Retry
• Appears when you travel outside the Pandora® service coverage
areas. Pandora® can only be played in U.S. and will not work in
other countries.
Unsupported
• Appears when the device is not supported. Use another device.
Features
Unable to play Pandora in this country.
Unsupported Version
Pandora app version is unsupported. When stopped, please
update the app.
• Appears when Pandora® version is not supported. Update
Pandora® to the latest version.
Unable to connect to the device. Please make sure the
phone’s Bluetooth setting is ON and try again.
• Appears when Pandora® is unable to play music. Check the
Bluetooth status on your device.
No Data
• Appears when no data is available with Pandora® activated.
Reboot the app and reconnect the device.
A charging error has occurred with the connected USB
device.
When safe please check the compatibility of the device and
USB cable and try again.
• Appears when an incompatible device is connected. Disconnect
the device. Then turn the audio system off, and turn it again. Do
not reconnect the device that caused the error.
327
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
328 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAudio Error MessagesuAndroid/Apps
Models with display audio system
Android/Apps
If an error occurs while using the audio system or apps, you may see the following error messages. If you cannot clear the error message,
contact a dealer.
Error Message*1
Unfortunately, **** has
stopped.
Solution
Error has occurred within app, select OK on the screen to close the app. Unless it is a fatal error, it would
return to normal if you startup the app.
If it does not return to normal even after starting up the app, press and hold the
(power) button to
perform the forced reset. If it still does not get back to normal, you need Factory Data Reset.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 366
Features
**** is not responding.
Would you like to close it?
App is in a busy state.
Select Wait if you can wait for a response from app a little longer. If it does not respond even if you keep
waiting, select OK to close the app and start it up. When it does not return to normal, press and hold
the
(power) button to perform the forced reset. You also need Factory Data Reset.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 366
*1:****part is variable characters, and will change depending upon where an error occurs.
328
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
329 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
General Information on the Audio System
SiriusXM® Radio Service *
■ Subscribing to SiriusXM® Radio
1. You need your radio ID ready before registering for subscription. To see the ID in
the display: Select Channel 000.
2. Have your radio ID and credit card number ready, and either call or visit the
SiriusXM® website to subscribe.
■ Receiving SiriusXM® Radio
■ SiriusXM® Radio Display Messages
Check antenna:
The SiriusXM® antenna is disconnected or shorted. Contact a dealer.
No Signal:
The signal is too weak in the current location.
Channel Not Subscribed:
You are not subscribed to the channel selected.
Subscription Updated:
SiriusXM® radio is receiving information update from the network.
Replay Memory Almost Full:
The recording memory is nearly full.
Replay Memory Full:
The recording memory is full.
* Not available on all models
Contact Information for SiriusXM® Radio:
• U.S.: SiriusXM® Radio at www.siriusxm.com/
subscribenow or 1-866-635-2349
• Canada: SiriusXM® Canada at www.siriusxm.ca/
subscribe-now, or 1-877-209-0079
1Receiving SiriusXM® Radio
The SiriusXM® satellites are in orbit over the equator;
therefore, objects south of the vehicle may cause
satellite reception interruptions. Satellite signals are
more likely to be blocked by tall buildings and
mountains the farther north you travel from the
equator.
You may experience reception problems under the
following circumstances:
• In a location with an obstruction to the south of
your vehicle.
• In tunnels
• On the lower level of a multi-tiered road
• Large items carried on the roof rack
Features
Switch to the SiriusXM® mode by using the SOURCE button on the steering wheel,
or through the audio/informations screen, and stay in this mode for about 30
minutes until the service is activated. Make sure your vehicle is in an open area with
good reception.
1Subscribing to SiriusXM® Radio
329
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
330 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuRecommended CDs *
Recommended CDs *
• Use only high-quality CD-R or CD-RW discs labeled for audio use.
• Use only CD-R or CD-RW discs on which the recordings are closed.
• Play only standard round-shaped CDs.
The CD packages or jackets should have one of these marks.
■ CDs with MP3, WMA, or AAC files
Features
330
• Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
• Some versions of MP3, WMA, or AAC formats may be unsupported.
* Not available on all models
1Recommended CDs *
A Dual-disc cannot play on this audio unit. If recorded
under certain conditions, a CD-R or CD-RW may not
play either.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
331 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuRecommended CDs *
■ Protecting CDs
Follow these precautions when handling or storing CDs:
• Store a CD in its case when it is not being played.
• When wiping a CD, use a soft clean cloth from the center to the outside edge.
• Handle a CD by its edge. Never touch either surface.
• Never insert foreign objects into the CD player.
• Keep CDs out of direct sunlight and extreme heat.
• Do not place stabilizer rings or labels on the CD.
• Avoid fingerprints, liquids, and felt-tip pens on the CD.
1Protecting CDs
NOTICE
Do not insert a damaged CD. It may be stuck inside
and damage the audio unit.
Examples:
●
Bubbled, wrinkled, labeled, and
excessively thick CDs
Bubbled/
Wrinkled
●
Using
Printer Label
Kit
Sealed
With Plastic Ring
● Poor quality
Damaged CDs
CDs
Chipped/
Cracked
Small CDs
Warped
Features
●
With Label/
Sticker
Burrs
3-inch (8-cm)
CD
331
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
332 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuCompatible iPod, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives
Compatible iPod, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives
■ iPod and iPhone Model Compatibility
Model
iPod (5th generation)
iPod classic 80GB/160GB (launch in 2007)
iPod classic 120GB (launch in 2008)
iPod classic 160GB (launch in 2009)
iPod nano (1st to 7th generation) released between 2005 and 2012
iPod touch (1st to 5th generation) released between 2007 and 2012
iPhone 3G/iPhone 3GS/iPhone 4/iPhone 4S/iPhone 5/iPhone 5s*1/iPhone 5c*1/
iPhone 6*1/iPhone 6 plus*1/iPhone 6s*1/iPhone 6s plus*1
This system may not work with all software versions
of these devices.
Features
*1:Display audio system
■ USB Flash Drives
•
•
•
•
•
332
1iPod and iPhone Model Compatibility
A USB flash drive of 256 MB or higher is recommended.
Some digital audio players may not be compatible.
Some USB flash drives (e.g., a device with security lockout) may not work.
Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
Some versions of MP3, WMA, or AAC formats may be unsupported.
1USB Flash Drives
Files on the USB flash drive are played in their stored
order. This order may be different from the order
displayed on your PC or device.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
333 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
Honda App License Agreement
■ END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT
PLEASE CAREFULLY READ THIS END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT (THIS “AGREEMENT”) WHICH GOVERNS YOUR USE OF THE SOFTWARE
INSTALLED ON YOUR HONDA OR ACURA VEHICLE (YOUR “VEHICLE”) AS WELL AS THE APPLICATIONS, SERVICES, FUNCTIONS, AND
CONTENT PROVIDED THROUGH THE SOFTWARE (COLLECTIVELY, THE “SERVICES”). YOUR USE OF THE SOFTWARE OR SERVICES WILL
SERVE AS YOUR CONSENT TO THE TERMS OF THIS AGREEMENT. THE SOFTWARE IS OWNED (OR LICENSED), PROVIDED, AND/OR
OPERATED BY AMERICAN HONDA MOTOR CO. INC., (“HONDA,” “US,” “WE,” OR “OUR”), WITH ITS BUSINESS ADDRESS AT 1919
TORRANCE BLVD., TORRANCE, CA 90501. REFERENCE TO “HONDA” IN THIS AGREEMENT INCLUDES HONDA’S PARENT COMPANY AND
ITS AFFILIATES AND DESIGNATED AGENTS. THE SERVICES ARE OWNED (OR LICENSED), PROVIDED, AND/OR OPERATED BY HONDA OR A
THIRD-PARTY SERVICE PROVIDER (A “PROVIDER”). REFERENCE TO A “PROVIDER” IN THIS AGREEMENT INCLUDES SUCH PROVIDER’S
PARENT COMPANY, AFFILIATES, AND DESIGNATED AGENTS.
Features
A. Description of the Software. The SOFTWARE includes the software, firmware and the like, installed and executing on your VEHICLE
during manufacture, and thereafter updated from time to time by HONDA, you or an authorized HONDA dealer (a “DEALER”). The
SOFTWARE allows you to access and use a variety of SERVICES, including but not limited to: (a) HONDA applications, services, and content
provided through the SOFTWARE (together, “HONDA SERVICES”); and (b) PROVIDER applications, services, and content provided through
the SOFTWARE (together, “PROVIDER SERVICES”), each of which may provide access to various information, media, content, and services.
B. SOFTWARE Licensing and Intellectual Property.
1. SOFTWARE. This AGREEMENT grants you a non-exclusive, limited, and revocable license to use the SOFTWARE and SERVICES solely (a)
as installed on your VEHICLE by HONDA, (b) as updated on your Vehicle by HONDA, you (but only as and when directed by HONDA), or a
DEALER and (c) as permitted under the terms of this AGREEMENT.
2. HONDA Services. The SOFTWARE may provide you with access to various HONDA SERVICES. Installation, activation, or use of HONDA
SERVICES may require your consent to additional terms, conditions, and privacy policies applicable to those HONDA SERVICES (the
“HONDA TERMS”). You acknowledge and agree that any collection, use, sharing of data generated by your VEHICLE or your use of your
VEHICLE, and your use of the HONDA SERVICES shall be subject to this AGREEMENT and any additional HONDA TERMS that may be
specifically applicable to such HONDA SERVICES or data generation. The HONDA SERVICES may collect, use, and share such data while
you are using the SOFTWARE.
Continued
333
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
334 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
3. Open-Source Software. The SOFTWARE and SERVICES may incorporate software licensed to HONDA under free or open-source
licenses which govern HONDA’s distribution and your use of such software. HONDA and the third-party authors, licensors, and distributors
of such software disclaim all warranties and all liability arising from any and all use or distribution of the software. To the extent such
software is provided under terms that differ from the applicable free or open-source licenses, those terms are offered by HONDA alone.
Additional information regarding free and open-source software incorporated in the SOFTWARE and SERVICES is available in this manual
or within the SOFTWARE.
Features
4. Provider Services. The SOFTWARE may provide you with access to various PROVIDER SERVICES. Installation or use of such PROVIDER
SERVICES may require your consent to additional terms, conditions, and privacy policies of the applicable PROVIDER (the “PROVIDER
TERMS”). This AGREEMENT restricts the manner in which you can install and use PROVIDER SERVICES but does not grant you a license or
permission to use such PROVIDER SERVICES. Your permission to use PROVIDER SERVICES is limited and subject to any license grants,
conditions, and limitations included in the PROVIDER TERMS. You acknowledge that any collection, use, sharing of your information,
targeted advertising practices by PROVIDERS, and your use of the PROVIDER SERVICES shall be subject to both this AGREEMENT and any
applicable PROVIDER TERMS. The PROVIDER SERVICES may collect, use, and share such information while you are using the SOFTWARE.
5. License Limitations and Restrictions on Use.
(a) Limited License. You understand and agree that the SOFTWARE and SERVICES are licensed, not sold, to you solely for use in accordance
with this AGREEMENT and any applicable PROVIDER TERMS, and any documentation for the VEHICLE made available to you by HONDA
(any “DOCUMENTATION”). HONDA and its licensors reserve all rights in the SOFTWARE and HONDA SERVICES not expressly granted to
you under this AGREEMENT. PROVIDERS and their licensors reserve all rights in the PROVIDER SERVICES not expressly granted to you under
the applicable PROVIDER TERMS.
334
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
335 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
Features
(b) Restrictions on Use. The licenses granted under this AGREEMENT do not permit you to use the SOFTWARE or SERVICES on a device
other than your VEHICLE. As a condition of using the SOFTWARE and SERVICES, you agree that you may not and will not:
(1) copy, download, distribute, modify, publish, sell, rent, lease, lend, license, sublicense, reuse, or create derivative works of the
SOFTWARE or SERVICES or any of the content or other material within the SOFTWARE or SERVICES, including without limitation,
HONDA or PROVIDER names, logos, or any other trademarks of HONDA or PROVIDERS or used in association with the SOFTWARE or
any SERVICES, except as required to use the SOFTWARE or SERVICES in accordance with this AGREEMENT, any applicable PROVIDER
TERMS, and the DOCUMENTATION;
(2) access or use the SOFTWARE or SERVICES in any manner intended to damage or impair the operation of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES
or interfere with anyone else’s use and enjoyment of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES;
(3) access or attempt to access any system or server on which the SOFTWARE or SERVICES is hosted or modify or alter the SOFTWARE
or SERVICES in any way;
(4) use the SOFTWARE or SERVICES for any unlawful purpose, or in violation of any third party rights;
(5) use the SOFTWARE or SERVICES in violation of any applicable traffic regulations, rules or laws, including but not limited to any driver
distraction laws, rules or regulations;
(6) violate the terms of this AGREEMENT, any HONDA TERMS, any PROVIDER TERMS or other applicable third-party terms, conditions,
and privacy policies; or
(7) reverse engineer, decompile, disassemble, attempt to derive the source code of, nor permit others to reverse engineer, decompile,
or disassemble, or attempt to derive the source code of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES, except and only to the extent that such activity is
expressly permitted (a) by applicable law notwithstanding this limitation or (b) the terms of applicable free or opensource software
licenses.
6. Intellectual Property Rights. All title and intellectual property rights in and to the SOFTWARE and SERVICES, the accompanying
DOCUMENTATION, and all copies of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES are owned by HONDA, PROVIDERS, or their suppliers or licensors. This
AGREEMENT does not grant you any rights in connection with any trademarks or service marks of HONDA, PROVIDERS, or their licensors,
affiliates, or suppliers.
Continued
335
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
336 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
7. Export Restrictions: You acknowledge that the SOFTWARE and SERVICES are subject to U.S., European Union, and other export
jurisdictions. You agree to comply with all applicable international and national laws that apply to the SOFTWARE and SERVICES, including
the U.S. Export Administration Regulations, as well as end-user, end-use, and destination restrictions issued by the U.S. and other
governments.
C. SOFTWARE Operation
1. HONDA reserves the right to suspend or terminate your access to and use of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES if you are found to be in
violation of this AGREEMENT or as reasonably deemed necessary by HONDA.
Features
2. Eligibility/Registration/Activation. The SOFTWARE is intended for and available to individuals who (a) are of legal age of majority in their
jurisdiction of residence (and at least 18 years of age), or are younger than 18 years of age and possess a valid driver’s license issued by
their jurisdiction of residence, and (b) own or have permissive access to a compatible VEHICLE. We do not knowingly collect any
information, including personal information, from children under 13. If we learn or are notified that we have collected personal
information of a child under 13, we will immediately take steps to delete such information.
3. Use of PROVIDER SERVICES through the SOFTWARE. Certain PROVIDER SERVICES made available through the SOFTWARE may require
that you register or otherwise have an account with the PROVIDER and agree to PROVIDER TERMS. Any use of any of such PROVIDER
SERVICES within the SOFTWARE is subject to this AGREEMENT and the applicable PROVIDER TERMS. HONDA does not exercise control
over such PROVIDER SERVICES and is not responsible or liable for the availability, security, or content of such PROVIDER SERVICES, and the
inclusion of any PROVIDER SERVICES does not imply a referral from, the approval of, or the endorsement by HONDA of such PROVIDER
SERVICES. HONDA is not responsible or liable, directly or indirectly, for any damage relating to or resulting from your use of the PROVIDER
SERVICES.
4. Links to Third Party Sites: The SOFTWARE may provide you with the ability to access third-party sites and content through the use of the
SOFTWARE or SERVICES. The third-party sites and content are not under the control of HONDA. HONDA is not responsible or liable,
directly or indirectly, for such third-party websites and their content or for any damage relating to or resulting from your access or use of
such websites and content.
336
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
337 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
5. Unauthorized Use and Abuse. You are responsible for ensuring your (and any authorized third parties’) use of the SOFTWARE and
SERVICES remains in compliance with this AGREEMENT and all other applicable HONDA TERMS and PROVIDER TERMS. You acknowledge
and agree that any use of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES occurring through your VEHICLE will be deemed your actions and that HONDA and
PROVIDERS may rely upon such actions. You agree to immediately notify us if you suspect fraudulent or abusive activity involving the
SOFTWARE or SERVICES. If you so notify us or if we otherwise suspect fraudulent or abusive activity, you agree to cooperate with us in any
fraud investigation and to use any fraud prevention measures we prescribe. Your failure to immediately notify us or cooperate to use such
measures will result in your liability for all fraudulent usage or abusive activity associated with your VEHICLE.
7. Uninstalling, Removing, and Replacing the SOFTWARE. Replacing SOFTWARE or HONDA SERVICES with software or firmware not
provided and installed by HONDA or a DEALER will render all representations and warranties for the SOFTWARE, HONDA SERVICES, and
VEHICLE functionality reliant upon the SOFTWARE or HONDA SERVICES null and void.
Features
6. SOFTWARE Updates. The SOFTWARE and SERVICES may be updated when your VEHICLE is serviced by a DEALER or remotely, over-theair, by HONDA from time to time; such updates may occur with or without further notice or your future consent. The SOFTWARE may be
updated at HONDA’s discretion and for any purpose including, without limitation, to patch or otherwise improve the SOFTWARE or
SERVICES functionality, security, or stability. All updates to the SOFTWARE and SERVICES are subject to this AGREEMENT and any other
applicable HONDA TERMS and PROVIDER TERMS.
D. SOFTWARE Operational Notices and Warnings
1. Vehicle Geolocation Information. You acknowledge that your VEHICLE may be equipped with certain traffic and map features. The
traffic feature will automatically collect and transmit, through GPS technology, your Vehicle’s current location (longitude and latitude),
travel direction and speed (“VEHICLE GEOLOCATION INFORMATION”) to HONDA and PROVIDERS. The VEHICLE GEOLOCATION
INFORMATION is used by HONDA and PROVIDERS to provide traffic and navigation-related information to you, but may also be used to
provide other SERVICES or offers to you. HONDA will not use such VEHICLE GEOLOCATION INFORMATION for its own marketing efforts,
or provide such information to unaffiliated third parties for their own purposes, without your express consent.
Continued
337
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
338 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
2. Potential Map Inaccuracy and Route Safety. Maps used by this system may be inaccurate because of changes in roads, traffic controls,
routing, or driving conditions. Always use good judgment and common sense when following suggested routes. Do not follow the route
suggestions if doing so would result in an unsafe or illegal driving maneuver, if you would be placed in an unsafe situation, or if you would
be directed into an area that you consider unsafe. Do not rely on any navigation features included in the system to route you to emergency
services. Not all emergency services such as police, fire stations, hospitals, or clinics are likely to be contained in the map database for such
navigation features. Ask local authorities or an emergency services operator for such locations and routes. The driver is ultimately
responsible for the safe operation of the vehicle and therefore, must evaluate whether it is safe to follow the suggested directions. Any
navigation features are provided only as an aid. Make your driving decisions based on your observations of local conditions and existing
traffic regulations. Navigation features are not a substitute for your personal judgment. Any route suggestions made by the SOFTWARE or
SERVICES should never replace any local traffic regulations or your personal judgment or knowledge of safe driving practices.
Features
3. Speech Recognition: You acknowledge and understand that HONDA and PROVIDERS may record, retain, and use voices commands
when you use the speech recognition components of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. You and all VEHICLE operators and passengers (a)
consent to the recording and retention of voice commands in support of providing speech recognition components and (b) release HONDA
and PROVIDERS from all claims, liabilities, and losses that may result from any use of such recorded voice commands. Recognition errors
are inherent in speech recognition. It is your responsibility to monitor any speech recognition functions included in the system and address
any errors. Neither HONDA nor PROVIDERS will be liable for any damages arising out of errors in the speech recognition process.
4. Distraction Hazards. Navigation features may require manual (non-verbal) input or setup. Attempting to perform such set-up or insert
data while driving can seriously distract your attention and could cause a crash or other serious consequences; the ability to undertake such
interactions may also be limited by state or local law, which laws you are responsible to know and follow. Even occasional short scans of
the screen may be hazardous if your attention has been diverted away from your driving at a critical time. Pull over and stop the vehicle in
a safe and legal manner before attempting to access a function of the system requiring prolonged attention. Do not raise the volume
excessively. Keep the volume at a level where you can still hear outside traffic and emergency signals while driving. Driving while unable
to hear these sounds could result in a crash.
338
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
339 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
E. Information Collection and Storage
1. Information Collection, Use, Transmission and Storage of Data. Consent to Use of Data: You agree that HONDA and PROVIDERS may
collect and use your information gathered in any manner as part of product support services related to the SOFTWARE or related services.
HONDA may share such information with third parties, including, without limitation, PROVIDERS, third party software and services
suppliers, their affiliates and/or their designated agents, solely to improve their products or to provide services or technologies to you.
HONDA, third party software and systems suppliers, their affiliates and/or their designated agent may disclose this information to others,
but not in a form that personally identifies you.
2. Information Storage. Depending on the type of multimedia system you have in your VEHICLE, certain information may be stored for ease
of use of the SOFTWARE including, without limitation, search history, location history in certain applications, previous and saved
destinations, map locations within certain applications, and device numbers and contact information.
Features
(a) Vehicle Health Information. Your VEHICLE may remotely transmit information regarding the status and health of your VEHICLE
(“VEHICLE INFORMATION”) to HONDA without notification to you. VEHICLE INFORMATION may contain VEHICLE maintenance and
malfunction status that is derived from VEHICLE diagnostic data and includes, but is not limited to, status of powered doors and windows,
battery life data, battery charging data, VEHICLE speed, coolant temperature, air compressor revolution, output power, warning codes,
diagnostic trouble codes, fuel injection volume, and engine rotations per minute. VEHICLE HEALTH INFORMATION may be used by HONDA
for research and development, to deliver HONDA SERVICES and information to you, and to contact you, and is retained only for a period
of time necessary to fulfill these goals.
(b) VEHICLE Geolocation Data (non-navigation/map based). If you opt-in to geolocation-based SERVICES, your vehicle’s geolocation data
(latitude and longitude) will be automatically sent from your VEHICLE to HONDA and PROVIDERS.
(c) You understand that the inputting or uploading of information to your VEHICLE’s multimedia system or the SOFTWARE or SERVICES is
at your own risk and that HONDA is not responsible for unauthorized access to or use of any personal or other information. All information
uploaded to the SOFTWARE and SERVICES may be stored on your VEHICLES’s multimedia system and you understand that the security and
safety of your VEHICLE’s multimedia system is your sole responsibility.
Continued
339
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
340 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
Features
F. NO WARRANTY. You understand and agree that your use of the SOFTWARE and SERVICES are solely at your own risk and that you
will be solely responsible for any damage to your VEHICLE’s multimedia system or any other equipment or any loss of data that may result
from your use of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. THE SOFTWARE AND SERVICES ARE PROVIDED ON AN “AS IS” AND “AS AVAILABLE” BASIS
WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESSED, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY. WE SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. HONDA makes no warranties that the
SOFTWARE or SERVICES will meet your requirements, or that the SOFTWARE or SERVICES will be uninterrupted, timely, secure, noninfringing or error free. You understand and agree that you are responsible for any and all charges, costs or expenses associated with your
use of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. Advice or information, whether oral or written, obtained by you from us or through the SOFTWARE
or SERVICES are provided for informational purposes only and will not create any warranty not expressly made herein. You should not rely
on any such information or advice. We assume no liability or responsibility for any errors or omissions in the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. We
do not make any warranty or representation that your use of the material displayed on, or obtained through, the SOFTWARE or SERVICES
is non-infringing of any rights of any third party. Any decision or action taken by you on the basis of information or content provided via
the application is at your sole discretion and risk. HONDA and PROVIDERS are not responsible or liable for any such decision, or for the
accuracy, completeness, usefulness, or availability of any content or information displayed, transmitted, or otherwise made available via
the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. To the extent jurisdictions do not allow the exclusion of certain warranties, some of the above exclusions may
not apply to you.
G. LIMITATIONS ON LIABILITY. You and HONDA are each waiving important rights.
1. Limitations on YOUR liability. HONDA cannot recover from you any consequential, indirect, incidental, or special damages, or attorney’s
fees in connection with your use of the SOFTWARE or HONDA SERVICES. HONDA WAIVES TO THE FULLEST EXTENT ALLOWED BY LAW
ANY CLAIM FOR DAMAGES OTHER THAN DIRECT, COMPENSATORY DAMAGES AS LIMITED IN THIS AGREEMENT.
340
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
341 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
2. Limitation on HONDA and PROVIDER liability. Neither HONDA nor PROVIDERS will be liable to you or any other party for consequential,
indirect, incidental, special, or punitive damages (including without limitation lost profits) in connection with your use of the SOFTWARE
or SERVICES, even if HONDA or PROVIDERS are aware of the possibility of such damages. These limitations apply to all claims, including,
without limitation, claims in contract and tort (such as negligence, product liability and strict liability). To the extent that a jurisdiction does
not permit the exclusion or limitation of liability as set forth herein our liability is limited to the maximum extent permitted by law in such
states. If HONDA or PROVIDERS are found liable to you for any reason, you agree that the aggregate liability of all these parties to you for
any claim is limited to ten U.S. dollars (US $10.00). Neither HONDA nor any PROVIDER would have agreed to provide the SOFTWARE or
SERVICES to you if you did not agree to this limitation. This amount is the sole and exclusive liability of HONDA and PROVIDERS to you,
and is payable as liquidated damages and not as a penalty. Except where prohibited by law, you may not bring any claim against HONDA
or any third-party beneficiary more than two (2) years after the claim arises. We do not have any liability for SOFTWARE or SERVICES
interruptions of any length.
Features
(a) Release of HONDA and PROVIDERS For yourself and anyone else claiming under you, you agree to release and discharge HONDA,
PROVIDERS, their respective officers, directors, and employees, and each third-party beneficiary from all claims, liabilities and losses in
connection with the SOFTWARE or SERVICES, including, but not limited to claims for personal injury or property damage arising from the
total or partial failure of performance of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES, even if caused by or based upon the negligence, gross negligence,
strict products liability, Deceptive Trade Practices Act violations, bad faith, or breach of warranty of us or the malfunction of the SOFTWARE
or SOFTWARE SERVICES. YOU AGREE TO WAIVE TO THE FULLEST EXTENT ALLOWED BY LAW, ANY CLAIM FOR DAMAGES OTHER THAN
DIRECT, COMPENSATORY DAMAGES AS LIMITED IN THIS AGREEMENT. YOU HEREBY RELEASE AND DISCHARGE HONDA AND ITS
LICENSORS AND CONTRACTORS (INCLUDING ANY THIRD PARTIES PROVIDING ALL OR PART OF THE SOFTWARE OR SERVICES) FROM AND
AGAINST ANY CLAIMS, DAMAGES, EXPENSES AND LIABILITY ARISING FROM OR RELATED TO ANY INJURIES, DAMAGES, OR LOSSES TO
ANY PERSON (INCLUDING DEATH) OR PROPERTY OF ANY KIND RESULTING IN WHOLE OR PART, DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY, FROM YOUR
USE OF THE SOFTWARE OR SERVICES.
H. Survival. You agree that the limitations of liability and indemnities in this AGREEMENT will survive even after the AGREEMENT has
ended. These limitations of liability apply not only to you, but to anyone using the SOFTWARE or SERVICES via your VEHICLE, to anyone
making a claim on your behalf, and to any claims made by your family, employees, customers, or others arising out of or relating to your
VEHICLE, the SOFTWARE, or SERVICES.
Continued
341
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
342 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
I. Availability/Interruption. The SOFTWARE and certain SERVICES are made available through your VEHICLE’s compatible multimedia
system when the VEHICLE is turned on. Certain SERVICES may be available only through your compatible mobile device when it is within
the operating range of the VEHICLE and a wireless carrier. The availability of the SOFTWARE and SERVICES may be subject to transmission
limitation or interruption, including but not limited to technical obsolesce or sunsetting of the hardware, software or firmware, inside of
or external to the Vehicle, required for data transmission or receipt. HONDA does not guarantee that the SOFTWARE, SERVICES, or any
portion thereof will be available at all times or in all areas. You acknowledge and agree that HONDA is not responsible for performance
degradation, interruption or delays. You acknowledge that HONDA shall not be liable to you if the SOFTWARE or SERVICES in a given
location are not available. If the SOFTWARE or SERVICES are not available within your intended location, you agree that your sole remedy
shall be to cease using the SOFTWARE and SERVICES.
Features
J. PRODUCT SUPPORT: Product support for the SOFTWARE is provided by HONDA. For product support, please refer to HONDA
instructions provided in the DOCUMENTATION. Should you have any questions concerning this AGREEMENT, or if you desire to contact
HONDA for any other reason, please refer to the HONDA contact information provided in the DOCUMENTATION.
K. Termination and Transfer.
1. Termination. This AGREEMENT is effective until terminated by you or US. WE may terminate this AGREEMENT for any or no reason,
and with or without notice to you. Your rights under this AGREEMENT will terminate automatically without notice from US if you fail to
comply with any term of this AGREEMENT. Upon termination of this AGREEMENT, you shall cease all use of the SOFTWARE and SERVICES.
2. Transfer: You may permanently transfer your rights under this AGREEMENT only as part of a sale or transfer of the VEHICLE, provided
you retain no copies, you transfer all of the SOFTWARE and HONDA SERVICES (including all component parts, the media and printed
materials, and any upgrades), and the recipient agrees to the terms of this AGREEMENT. You agree to notify HONDA upon the sale or
transfer of the VEHICLE. To contact HONDA, please refer to the HONDA contact information provided in the DOCUMENTATION.
342
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
343 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
L. Changes to the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. WE may change, modify, or update the SOFTWARE or SERVICES from time to time. Unless
explicitly stated otherwise, any new features or services that augment or enhance the SOFTWARE or SERVICES in the future shall
respectively be considered part of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES and subject to this AGREEMENT. WE reserve the right at any time and from
time to time to interrupt, restrict, modify, suspend, discontinue, temporarily or permanently, the SOFTWARE or SERVICES (or any portion
thereof), with or without notice to you, and you agree that HONDA shall not be liable to you or to any third party for any modification,
suspension or discontinuance of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES.
Continued
Features
M. ARBITRATION:
PLEASE READ THIS ARBITRATION PROVISION CAREFULLY TO UNDERSTAND YOUR RIGHTS. YOU AGREE THAT ANY CLAIM THAT YOU
MAY HAVE IN THE FUTURE MUST BE RESOLVED THROUGH BINDING ARBITRATION. YOU WAIVE THE RIGHT TO HAVE YOUR DISPUTE
HEARD IN COURT AND WAIVE THE RIGHT TO BRING CLASS CLAIMS. YOU UNDERSTAND THAT DISCOVERY AND APPEAL RIGHTS ARE
MORE LIMITED IN ARBITRATION.
Arbitration is a method of resolving a claim, dispute or controversy without filing a lawsuit. By agreeing to arbitrate, the right to go to
court is waived and instead claims, disputes or controversies are submitted to binding arbitration. This provision sets forth the terms and
conditions of our agreement. YOU and HONDA agree and acknowledge that this Agreement affects interstate commerce and the
Federal Arbitration Act (“FAA”) applies. By using the Software, Vehicle, or Services, YOU elect to have disputes resolved by arbitration.
YOU, HONDA or any involved third party may pursue a Claim. “Claim” means any dispute between YOU, HONDA, or any involved third
party relating to your use of the Software, the Vehicle, or the Services, this Agreement, or our relationship, including any
representations, omissions or warranties. “Claim” does not include personal injury or wrongful death claims. YOU or HONDA may seek
remedies in small claims court or provisional judicial remedies without arbitrating. In addition, notwithstanding anything herein to the
contrary, YOU or HONDA may seek equitable relief in a court of competent jurisdiction.
YOU or HONDA may select arbitration with American Arbitration Association, JAMS or National Arbitration and Mediation. Contact
these sponsors for their rules. The hearing will be in the federal district where YOU reside. If agreed, it may be by telephone or written
submissions. Filing and arbitrator fees to be paid per the sponsor rules. You may contact the sponsor for a fee waiver. If no fee waivers,
HONDA will pay filing and arbitrator fees up to $5,000, unless law requires more. Each party is responsible for other fees. Arbitrator
may award costs or fees to prevailing party, if permitted by law. HONDA will not seek fees, unless the claims are frivolous.
343
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
344 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
Arbitrator shall be an attorney or current or retired judge familiar with automotive or consumer software. The arbitrator shall follow
substantive law, statute of limitations and decide all issues relating to the interpretation, construction, enforceability and applicability of
this provision. The arbitrator may order relief permitted by law. This provision is governed and enforceable by the FAA. An award shall
include a written opinion and be final, subject to appeal by the FAA.
This provision survives termination of this Agreement or relationship, bankruptcy, assignment or transfer. If part of this provision is
unenforceable, the remainder remains in effect. If unenforceability allows arbitration as a class action, then this provision is entirely
unenforceable. YOU may opt out within 30 days of your initial use of the Software by sending a signed, written notice to HONDA at
Honda Financial Services, P.O. Box 165007, Irving, TX 75016. HONDA reserves the right to make changes to this provision after
providing written notice and an opportunity to opt out.
Features
344
N. Miscellaneous: You may not assign this AGREEMENT without HONDA’s prior written consent. This AGREEMENT and any additional
HONDA TERMS and PROVIDER TERMS represents the entire agreement between you and US. HONDA may amend the terms of this
AGREEMENT by providing you with notices of such updated terms. If you do not consent to be bound by the updated terms, your sole
remedy will be to cease using the SOFTWARE and SERVICES. If any part of this AGREEMENT is found invalid, void, or unenforceable, the
balance of the AGREEMENT will remain valid and enforceable according to its terms. To the fullest extent permitted by law, and except as
explicitly provided otherwise, this AGREEMENT and any disputes arising out of or relating to it will be governed by the laws of the State of
California, except that California laws concerning choice of law or conflicts shall not apply if they would cause the substantive law of
another jurisdiction to apply. Notwithstanding the foregoing, Section M shall be governed by the Federal Arbitration Act and the laws of
the State of California, as applicable, as set forth therein. The failure to enforce any term of this AGREEMENT on one occasion shall not
prevent enforcement on any other occasion or the enforcement of any other term. Headings and captions shall not be considered included
for purposes of interpretation or application hereof, but are for convenience only.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
345 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Customized Features
Models with color audio system
1Customized Features
Use the audio/information screen to customize certain features.
■ How to customize
While the vehicle is at a complete stop with the ignition switch in ON (w , press the
MENU/CLOCK button, then select Settings. To customize the phone settings,
press the
button, then select Phone Setup.
Audio/Information Screen
When you customize settings:
• Make sure that the vehicle is at a complete stop.
• Shift to (P .
1How to customize
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate
to select.
Press
to enter.
(Phone) Button
Features
To customize other features, select Settings, rotate
, then press
.
2 List of customizable options P. 349
MENU/CLOCK Button
Selector Knob
Continued
345
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
346 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ Customization Flow
Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
Adjust Clock
Settings
Bluetooth
Add New Device
Connect an Audio Device
Display Adjustment
Features
Contrast
Black Level
Rear Camera
346
Brightness
Camera Guideline
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
347 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Display Change
Audio
Wallpaper
Wallpaper
Select
Import
Delete
Features
Color Theme
Blue
Red
Amber
Gray
Language
Clock Format
12h
24h
Continued
347
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
348 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Press the
button and rotate
to select Phone Setup, then press
Bluetooth Setup
.
Add New Device
Connect a Phone
Connect an Audio Device
Disconnect All Devices
Delete Device
Pass-Key
Features
Speed Dial
Ringtone
Fixed
Mobile Phone
Caller ID Info
Name Priority
Number Priority
System Clear
348
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
349 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ List of customizable options
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Description
Selectable Settings
Adjusts the clock.
Adjust Clock
—
2 Clock P. 134
Add New Device
Bluetooth
Display
Contrast
Adjustment
Black Level
Camera Guideline
Connects, disconnects or pairs a Bluetooth®
Audio device to HFL.
Changes the brightness of the audio/
information screen.
Changes the contrast of the audio/
information screen.
Changes the black level of the audio/
information screen.
Selects whether the guidelines come on the
audio/information screen.
—
—
Features
Brightness
Rear
Camera
—
2 Phone Setup P. 376
Connect an Audio
Device
Settings
Pairs a new phone to HFL, edits and deletes a
paired phone, and create a code for a paired
phone.
—
—
On*1/Off
*1:Default Setting
Continued
349
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
350 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Display Change
Select
Wallpaper
Delete
Settings
Color Theme
Language
Features
350
Import
Clock Format
*1:Default Setting
Description
Changes the display type.
Changes the wallpaper type.
Selectable Settings
Audio*1/Wallpaper
Clock*1/Image1/Image2/
Image3
Imports an image file for a new wallpaper.
—
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 237
Deletes an image file for a wallpaper.
Changes the background color of the audio/
information screen.
Changes the display language.
Selects the digital clock display from 12H to
24H.
Image1*1/Image2/Image3
Blue*1/Red/Amber/Gray
English*1/Français/Español
12h*1/24h
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
351 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Add New Device
Connect a Phone
Bluetooth
Setup
Phone
Setup
Ringtone
Caller ID Info
System Clear
Selectable Settings
Pairs a new phone to HFL.
—
2 Phone Setup P. 376
Pairs a new phone or connects a paired phone
to HFL.
—
2 Phone Setup P. 376
Connect an Audio
Device
Disconnect All Devices
Delete Device
Pass-Key
Connects a Bluetooth® Audio device to HFL.
—
Disconnects a paired phone from HFL.
Deletes a paired phone.
Inputs and changes a code for a paired phone.
Edits, adds or deletes a speed dial entry.
—
—
—
—
2 Speed Dial P. 383
Selects the ring tone.
Fixed /Mobile Phone
Prioritizes the caller’s name or phone number Name Priority*1/Number
as the caller ID.
Priority
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
—
Phone Setup group as default.
*1
Features
Speed Dial
Description
*1:Default Setting
351
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
352 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Customized Features
Models with display audio system
1Customized Features
Use the audio/information screen to customize certain features.
■ How to customize
With the ignition switch in ON (w *1, select Settings, then select a setting item.
Features
Audio/Information Screen
*1 : Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
352
When you customize settings:
• Make sure that the vehicle is at a complete stop.
• Shift to (P .
To customize other features, select Settings.
2 List of customizable options P. 358
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
353 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ Customization Flow
Select
.
Clock/Info
Clock/Wallpaper Type
Clock Adjustment
Auto Time Zone *
Manual Time Zone
Auto Daylight Saving Time
Clock Format
Clock Display
Overlay Clock Location
Clock Reset
HondaLink
Diagnostic & Location Data
Other
Info Screen Preference
Select Settings.
Clock
Wallpaper
Features
Clock
Default
Phone
Phone
Bluetooth Device List
Ring Tone
Automatic Phone Sync
Auto Phone Call Transfer
HondaLink Assist
Text Messages
Enable Text Messages
New Message
Notification
Default
* Not available on all models
Continued
353
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
354 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Audio
Common
Bluetooth Device List
Sound
CoverArt
Audio Source Pop-Up
FM/AM
HD Radio Mode (FM) *
HD Radio Mode (AM) *
RDS INFO
SXM *
TuneStart
SportsFlash Setup
Features
Traffic & Weather Setup
Multiple Channel Mix Preset
Default
Camera
Rear Camera
Fixed Guideline
Dynamic Guideline
LaneWatch *
Show with Turn Signal
Display Time after Turn Signal Off
Reference Line
Default
*1 : May change depending on your currently selected source.
354
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
355 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
System
HOME
Home Screen Edit Order
Display
Display Settings
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Background Color
Blue
Amber
Red
Violet
Blue Green
Features
Sound/Beep
Guidance Volume
Text Message Volume
Voice Recog. Volume
Verbal Reminder
Beep Volume
Voice Recog.
* Not available on all models
Voice Prompt
Voice Recog. Volume
Song by Voice *
Song by Voice Phonetic Modification *
Phone book Phonetic Modification
Automatic Phone Sync
One Press Voice Operation
Continued
355
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
356 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
System
Clock
Clock/Wallpaper Type
Clock Adjustment
Auto Time Zone *
Manual Time Zone
Auto Daylight Saving Time
Clock Format
Clock Display
Features
Overlay Clock Location
Clock Reset
Other
Language
Remember Last Screen
Memory Refresh
Refresh Time Adjustment
Touch Panel Sensitivity
Detail Information
Factory Data Reset
Default
356
* Not available on all models
Clock
Wallpaper
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
357 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi
Bluetooth
Bluetooth On/Off Status
Bluetooth Device List
Edit Pairing Code
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi On/Off Status
Wi-Fi Device List
Default
Smartphone
Features
Wi-Fi Information
Apple CarPlay
Android Auto
Continued
357
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
358 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ List of customizable options
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Description
Clock
Changes the clock display type.
Selectable Settings
Analog/Digital*1/Small
Digital/Off
Clock/Wallpaper
Type
• Changes the wallpaper type.
Galaxy*1/Metallic/Time
• Imports an image file for a new
Wallpaper
Zone/Blank
wallpaper.
• Deletes an image file for a wallpaper.
Adjusts clock.
Clock Adjustment
—
2 Adjusting the Clock P. 134
Features
Auto Time Zone
Clock
Clock/Info
Manual Time
Zone
Auto Daylight
Saving Time
HondaLink
*1:Default Setting
358
* Not available on all models
Clock Format
Clock Display
Overlay Clock
Location
Clock Reset
Diagnostic &
Location Data
*
Automatically adjusts the clock when driving through
On*1/Off
different time zones.
Changes the time zone manually.
Select On to have the GPS automatically adjust the
clock to daylight savings time. Select Off to cancel
this function.
Selects the digital clock display from 12H to 24H.
Selects whether the clock display comes on.
—
On*1/Off
Resets the clock settings to the factory default.
12H*1/24H
On*1/Off
Upper Right*1/Upper Left/
Lower Right/Lower Left/Off
Yes/No
Turns HondaLink® on and off.
On/Off*1
Changes the clock display layout.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
359 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Other
Clock/Info
Info Screen
Preference
Default
Bluetooth Device
List
Phone
Phone
Text
Messages
Default
Selectable Settings
Selects the top menu when the
button is
pressed.
Info Top/Info Menu/Off*1
• Info Top- A brief menu pops up.
• Info Menu- A full menu pops up.
• Off- A menu does not pop up.
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Clock/
Yes/No
Info settings group as default.
Pairs a new phone to HFL, connects or disconnects a
—
paired phone.
2 Phone Setup P. 400
Selects the ring tone.
Sets a phonebook and call history data to be
Automatic Phone
automatically imported when a phone is paired to
Sync
HFL.
Auto Phone Call
Sets calls to automatically transfer from your phone
Transfer
to HFL when you enter the vehicle.
HondaLink Assist Turns HondaLink Assist on and off.
Enable Text
Turns the text message function on and off.
Messages
New Message
Selects whether a pop-up alert comes on the screen
Notification
when HFL receives a new text message.
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Phone
settings group as default.
Fixed/Mobile Phone*1
On*1/Off
Features
Ring Tone
Description
On*1/Off
On/Off*1
On*1/Off
On/Off
Yes/No
*1:Default Setting
Continued
359
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
360 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Bluetooth Device
List
Sound
Description
Selectable Settings
Pairs a new phone to HFL, edits or deletes a paired
phone.
—
2 Phone Setup P. 400
Adjusts the settings of the audio speaker’s sound.
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 271
Common
-6 ~ 0*1 ~ +6 (BASS,
MIDDLE, and TREBLE),
RR9~0*1~FR9 (FADER),
L9~0*1~R9 (BALANCE), Off/
Low/Mid*1/High (SVC)
iPod, USB mode
Features
[Your selected
media]
Cover Art
Audio
Audio Source
Pop-Up
HD Radio Mode
(FM) *
FM/AM mode
FM/AM
HD Radio Mode
(AM) *
RDS Info
*1:Default Setting
360
* Not available on all models
Turns the cover art display on and off.
Selects whether the list of selectable audio source
comes on when Audio is selected on the home
screen.
Selects whether the FM radio automatically switches
to the digital radio waves or receives the analog
waves only.
Selects whether the AM radio automatically switches
to the digital radio waves or receives the analog
waves only.
Turns on and off the RDS information.
On*1/Off
On/Off*1
Auto *1/Analog Only
Auto*1/Analog Only
On/Off*1
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
361 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Description
SiriusXM®
mode
Audio
SXM *
Default
Camera
Rear
Camera
Default
On*1/Off
Off/On(one time)/
On(continue)*1
—
On*1/Off
—
Features
Turns on and off, starts the song from the beginning
as you change preset stations.
Turns on and off the sports alert
Interrupt
function.
Favorite
Selects your favorite sports teams.
SportsFlash Setup
2 Live Sports Alert P. 287
Team
Interrupt Causes the system to beep when the
Beep
sports alert is notified.
Traffic & Weather Selects the region you want to receive the
Setup
information.
Multiple Channel
Turns multiple channel mix preset on and off.
Mix Preset
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Audio
settings group as default.
Selects whether the fixed guidelines come on the rear
Fixed Guideline
camera monitor.
TuneStart
Selectable Settings
On/Off*1
Yes/No
On*1/Off
2 Multi-View Rear Camera P. 511
Dynamic
Guideline
Selects whether the guidelines adjust to the
movement of the steering wheel.
On*1/Off
2 Multi-View Rear Camera P. 511
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Rear
Camera setting group as default.
Yes/No
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
361
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
362 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Selects whether the LaneWatch display comes on
when you move the turn signal lever to indicate a
right turn.
Changes the length of time the LaneWatch display
Display Time after
stays on after the turn signal lever returns to the
Turn Signal Off
center.
Selects whether the reference lines come on the
Reference Line
LaneWatch monitor.
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
LaneWatch group as default.
Home Screen Edit
Changes the HOME screen icon layout.
Order
Changes the brightness of the audio/
Brightness
information screen.
Changes the contrast of the audio/
Display Settings
Contrast
information screen.
Black
Changes the black level of the audio/
Level
information screen.
Changes the background color of the audio/
Background Color
information screen.
Show with Turn
Signal
LaneWatch *
Camera
Default
Features
HOME
System
Display
*1:Default Setting
362
* Not available on all models
Description
Selectable Settings
On*1/Off
0 second*1/2 seconds
On*1/Off
Yes/No
—
—
—
—
Blue*1/Amber/Red/Violet/
BlueGreen
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
363 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Sound/
Beep
Voice
Recog.
Changes the sound volume.
Guidance Volume Adjusts the guidance volume of the navigation
system.
Text Message
Changes the text message reading volume.
Volume
Voice Recog.
Changes the volume of the voice prompt.
Volume
Verbal Reminder Turns the verbal reminders on and off.
Beep Volume
Changes the beep volume.
Voice Prompt
Turns the voice prompt on and off.
Voice Recog.
Changes the volume of the voice prompt.
Volume
Song by Voice *
Turns the Song By VoiceTM on and off.
Song by Voice
Modifies a voice command for music stored in the
Phonetic
system or an iPod/iPhone.
2 Phonetic Modification P. 295
Modification*
Phone book
Modifies a voice command for the phonebook.
Phonetic
2 Phonebook Phonetic Modification P. 409
Modification
Sets phonebook and call history data to be
Automatic Phone
automatically imported when a phone is paired to
Sync
HFL.
One Press Voice
Changes the setting of the
(Talk) button
Operation
operation when using the voice operation.
Selectable Settings
1~6*1~11
1~6*1~11
1~6*1~11
On*1/Off
Off/1/2*1/3
On*1/Off
Features
System
Description
1~6*1~11
On*1/Off
—
—
On*1/Off
On*1/Off
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
363
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
364 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Clock
Features
System
Clock/Wallpaper
Type
Clock Adjustment
Auto Time Zone *
Manual Time Zone
Auto Daylight
Saving Time
Clock Format
Clock Display
Overlay Clock
Location
Clock Reset
Language
Remember Last
Screen
Memory Refresh
Other
Refresh Time
Adjustment
Touch Panel
Sensitivity
Detail
Information
Description
Selectable Settings
Clock
Wallpaper
See Clock/Info on P. 358
Change the display language.
English*1/Francais/Espanol
Selects whether the device remembers the last
On/Off*1
screen.
Turns on the audio system automatically and restores
the fragmentation of a memory when the ignition
On*1/Off
switch is LOCK (0 *2.
Sets the time for Memory Refresh.
Sets the sensitivity of the touch panel screen.
—
High/Low*1
Displays the details of the head unit and operating
system information.
*1:Default Setting
*2: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch
364
* Not available on all models
—
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
365 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Other
System
Factory Data
Reset
Resets all the settings to their factory default.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 366
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the System
group as default.
Default
Bluetooth
Description
Bluetooth On/Off
Changes the Bluetooth® status.
Status
Pairs a new phone to HFL, edits or deletes a paired
Bluetooth Device
phone.
List
Selectable Settings
Yes/No
Yes/No
On*1/Off
—
2 Phone Setup P. 400
Edit Pairing Code
Edits a pairing code.
2 To change the pairing code setting P. 401
Wi-Fi On/Off
Changes the Wi-Fi mode.
Status
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi Device List Connects, disconnects, or deletes the Wi-Fi device.
Wi-Fi Information Shows the Wi-Fi information of the head unit.
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
Default
Bluetooth/Wi-Fi group as default.
Apple CarPlay
Sets up the Apple CarPlayTM connection.
Smartphone
Android Auto
Sets up the Android AutoTM connection.
Random/Fixed*1
On/Off*1
Features
Bluetooth/
Wi-Fi
—
—
Yes/No
—
—
*1:Default Setting
365
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
366 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomized FeaturesuDefaulting All the Settings
Defaulting All the Settings
Features
366
Reset all the menu and customized settings as the factory defaults.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Others tab.
5. Select Factory Data Reset.
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen.
6. Select Yes to reset the settings.
7. Select Yes again to reset the settings.
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select OK.
u After selecting OK, the system will
reboot.
1Defaulting All the Settings
When you transfer the vehicle to a third party, reset
all settings to default and delete all personal data.
If you perform Factory Data Reset, it will reset the
preinstalled apps to their factory default.
If you perform Factory Data Reset, you cannot use
the HondaLink® because it becomes off line.
2 HondaLink® P. 304
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
367 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver *
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver can be programmed to operate up to three
remote controlled devices around your home, such as garage doors, lighting, or
home security systems.
■ Important Safety Precautions
1HomeLink® Universal Transceiver *
Before programming HomeLink to operate a garage
door opener, confirm that the opener has an external
entrapment protection system, such as an “electronic
eye,” or other safety and reverse stop features. If it
does not, HomeLink may not be able to operate it.
Refer to the safety information that came with your garage door opener to test that
the safety features are functioning properly. If you do not have the safety
information, contact the manufacturer.
Before programming HomeLink, make sure that people and objects are out of the
way of the garage or gate to prevent potential injury or damage.
* Not available on all models
Features
When programming a garage door opener, park just outside the garage door’s
path.
367
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
368 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHomeLink® Universal Transceiver * uTraining HomeLink
Training HomeLink
If it is necessary to erase a previously entered
learned code:
• Press and hold the I and III HomeLink
buttons for about 10 seconds, until the
green indicator blinks. Release the buttons,
and proceed to step 1.
• If you are training the second or third
button, go directly to step 1.
Indicator
I HomeLink
Button
III HomeLink Button
Features
368
The instructions on the next page should work for most gate or garage openers, but
may not work for all. For detailed instructions about your specific remote opener,
visit http://www.homelink.com or call (800) 355-3515.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
369 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHomeLink® Universal Transceiver * uTraining HomeLink
■ Programming a Button
1Training HomeLink
1. Position the remote transmitter you wish to link 1 to 3 inches (3 - 8 cm) from the
HomeLink® button you want to program.
2. Press and hold the desired HomeLink button. Is the HomeLink indicator (LED) slowly
flashing orange?
NO
YES
4. Press and hold the programmed HomeLink
button for about a second. Does the device
(garage door opener) work?
YES
3b. Canadian Garage Door Opener
A. Press and release the HomeLink
button. Press, hold and release the
button on the remote every 2 secs.
Does the HomeLink indicator (LED)
change from slowly flashing orange to
rapidly flashing or continuously on
green? The process should take less
than 60 seconds.
NO
5. Press and hold the HomeLink button again.
Training
Complete
HomeLink LED is
continuously on green.
6. Press and hold the HomeLink button
again.
The remote-controlled device should
operate.
Training Complete
HomeLink indicator rapidly flashes
green.
5a. The remote has a rolling code. Press the
“learn” button on the remote-controlled
device (e.g. garage door opener).
5b. Within 30 secs, press and hold the
programmed HomeLink button for 2
secs.
1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink button until
the HomeLink indicator begins to slowly flash
orange. This should take about 20 seconds.
2. Release the HomeLink button and position the
remote transmitter you wish to link 1 - 3 inches
(3 - 8 cm) from the HomeLink button you want to
program, then follow steps 3 - 6 under
“programming a button.”
Erasing Button Memory
To erase programming from the buttons, press and hold
the two outside HomeLink buttons until the HomeLink
indicator changes from orange to rapidly flashing green.
This should take about 10 seconds. You should erase all
programming before selling the vehicle.
Features
3a. Hold the button on the remote
transmitter. Does HomeLink indicator
(LED) change from slowly flashing
orange to rapidly flashing green or
continuously on green? The process
should take less than 60 seconds.
Reprogramming a Button
If you want to retrain a programmed button for a
new device, you do not have to erase all button
memory. You can replace the existing memory code
using this procedure:
Operating
To operate, simple press and release the
programmed HomeLink button. Activation will now
occur for the trained device.
Questions
For questions or comments, visit
www.HomeLink.com, www.youtube.com/
HomeLinkGentex, or by calling the HomeLink Hotline
(North America only) at (800) 355-3515.
HomeLink® is a registered trademark of Gentex
Corporation.
369
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
370 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Models with color audio system
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) allows you to place and receive phone calls using
your vehicle’s audio system, without handling your cell phone.
Using HFL
■ HFL Buttons
To use HFL, you need a Bluetooth-compatible cell
phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing
procedures, and special feature capabilities:
• U.S.: Visit automobiles.honda.com/handsfreelink/,
or call 1-888-528-7876.
• Canada: For more information on smartphone
compatibility, call 1-888-528-7876.
Voice control tips
Volume up
Volume down
• Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the
Microphone
Features
(Phone) Button
(Talk) Button
(Hang-up/Back) Button
(Pick-up) Button
Selector Knob
(Pick-up) button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen or to answer an
incoming call.
(Hang-up/Back) button: Press to end a call or to cancel a command.
(Talk) button: Press to call a number with a stored voice tag.
(Phone) button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen.
Selector knob: Rotate
to select an item on the screen, then press .
windows, as noise coming from them may interfere
with the microphone.
• Press and release the
button when you want to
call a number using a stored voice tag. Speak
clearly and naturally after a beep.
• If the microphone picks up voices other than yours,
the command may be misinterpreted.
• To change the volume level, use the audio system’s
volume knob or the remote audio controls on the
steering wheel.
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a
vehicle.
If you receive a call while using the audio system, the
system resumes its operation after ending the call.
Up to 20 speed dial entries can be stored. If there is
no entry in the system, Speed Dial is disabled.
2 Speed Dial P. 383
Up to 20 call histories can be stored. If there is no call
history, Call History is disabled.
370
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
371 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uUsing HFL
■ HFL Status Display
Battery Level Status
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
The audio/information screen notifies you
when there is an incoming call.
Signal Strength
Roam Status
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your
phone is connected
to HFL.
HFL Mode
Call Name
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any
use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd., is under
license. Other trademarks and trade names are those
of their respective owners.
HFL Limitations
An incoming call on HFL will interrupt the audio
system when it is playing. It will resume when the call
is ended.
The information that appears on the audio/
information screen varies between phone models.
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Features
1HFL Status Display
You can change the system language to English,
French, or Spanish.
2 Customized Features P. 345
Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a grayed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.
Only previously stored speed dial entries can be called using voice commands while
the vehicle is in motion.
2 Speed Dial P. 383
371
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
372 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
HFL Menus
The ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or ON (w to use HFL.
To use HFL, you must first pair your Bluetoothcompatible cell phone to the system while the vehicle
is parked.
or
Phone
Speed Dial*1
Some functions are limited while driving. A message
appears on the screen when the vehicle is moving
and the operation is canceled.
Add New
Features
(Existing entry list)
Call History*1
Call History
Select a phone number from the call history to
store as a speed dial number.
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook to
store as a speed dial number.
Phone Number
Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial
number.
Dialed Calls
Display the last 20 outgoing calls.
Received Calls
Display the last 20 incoming calls.
Missed Calls
Display the last 20 missed calls.
Phonebook*1
Display the paired phones’s phonebook.
Dial*1
Enter a phone number to dial.
*1 : Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
372
1HFL Menus
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
373 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Redial*1
Redial the last number dialed in the phone’s history.
Phone Setup
Bluetooth Setup
Pair a phone to the system.
Connect a Phone
Connect a phone to the system.
Connect an Audio Device
Connect a Bluetooth® Audio device to the
system.
Disconnect All Devices
Disconnect a paired phone from the system.
Delete Device
Delete a previously paired phone.
Pass-Key
Create a code for a paired phone.
Features
Add New Device
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Continued
373
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
374 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Speed Dial*1
Select a phone number from the call history
to store as a speed dial number.
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook
to store as a speed dial number.
Phone Number
Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial
number.
Features
Existing entry list
Change Speed Dial
*1 : Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
374
Add New
Call History
Change a previously stored speed dial
number.
Delete Speed Dial
Delete a previously stored speed dial number.
Store Voice Tag
Create a voice tag for a speed dial number.
Change Voice Tag
Change a voice tag for a speed dial number.
Delete Voice Tag
Delete a voice tag for a speed dial number.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
375 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Ringtone
Caller ID Info
Select the ring tone stored in HFL.
Mobile Phone
Select the ring tone stored in the connected
cell phone.
Name Priority
Prioritize the caller’s name as the caller ID.
Number Priority
Prioritize the caller’s phone number as the
caller ID.
Features
System Clear
Fixed
Clear the system of all paired phones, phonebook entries,
and security codes.
Continued
375
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
376 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Phone Setup
1Phone Setup
■ To pair a cell phone (No phone has
Features
been paired to the system)
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
3. Make sure your phone is in search or
discoverable mode, then press .
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth® device.
4. When your phone appears on the list, select
it by pressing .
u If your phone doesn’t appear, select
Phone Not Found? and search for
Bluetooth® devices using your phone.
From your phone, select
HandsFreeLink.
5. The system gives you a pairing code on the
audio/information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by phone.
6. A notification appears on the screen if
pairing is successful.
376
Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to
HFL before you can make and receive hands-free
calls.
Phone Pairing Tips:
• You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is
moving.
• Up to six phones can be paired.
• Your phone’s battery may drain faster when it is
connected to HFL.
• If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found
by the system within three minutes, the system will
time out and returns to idle.
Once you have paired a phone, you can see it
displayed on the screen with one or two icons on the
right side.
These icons indicate the following:
: The phone can be used with HFL.
: The phone is compatible with Bluetooth® Audio.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
377 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To Change the currently paired phone
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth Setup, then
press .
You can pair a phone in the following steps.
Phone Setup Bluetooth Setup Add New
Device confirmation message Yes
confirmation message OK Select a Phone
pairing code.
Features
4. Rotate
to select Connect a Phone,
then press .
u The screen changes to a device list.
1Phone Setup
5. Rotate
to select a desired device name,
then press .
u HFL disconnects the connected phone
and starts searching for another paired
phone.
Continued
377
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
378 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To change the pairing code setting
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth Setup, then
press .
4. Rotate
.
to select Pass-Key, then press
Features
5. Input a new pairing code, then press
378
.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
379 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To delete a paired phone
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth Setup, then
press .
Features
4. Rotate
to select Delete Device, then
press .
u The screen changes to a device list.
5. Rotate
to select a phone you want to
delete, then press .
6. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then press
.
Continued
379
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
380 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Ring Tone
You can change the ring tone setting.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Ringtone, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select Fixed or Mobile
Phone, then press .
Features
380
■ Caller’s ID Information
You can select a caller’s information to be displayed when you have an incoming
call.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Caller ID Info, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select a mode you want, then
press .
1Ring Tone
Fixed: The fixed ring tone sounds from the speakers.
Mobile Phone: For certain connected phones, the
ring tone stored in the phone sounds from the
speakers.
1Caller’s ID Information
Name Priority: A caller’s name is displayed if it is
stored in the phonebook.
Number Priority: A caller’s phone number is
displayed.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
381 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To Clear the System
Pairing codes, paired phones, all stored voice tags, all speed dial entries, all call
history data, and all imported phonebook data are erased.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select System Clear, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
Features
5. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then press
.
6. A notification appears on the screen. Press
.
Continued
381
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
382 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When your phone is paired, the contents of its phonebook and call history are
automatically imported to HFL.
1Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When you select a person from the list in the cellular
phonebook, you can see up to three category icons.
The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored
for that name.
Pref
Fax
Home
Car
Mobile
Other
Work
Voice
Features
Pager
If a name has four or more numbers, ... appears
instead of category icons.
On some phones, it may not be possible to import the
category icons to HFL.
The phonebook is updated after every connection.
Call history is updated after every connection or call.
382
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
383 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Speed Dial
1Speed Dial
Cha
Change
hange
ge Sp
Speed
eed Dial
Delete
Speed
Dial
D lete
Del
ete
t Sp
S
eed
d Di
ia
all
You can use the audio preset buttons during a call to
store a speed dial number:
1. Press and hold the desired audio preset button
during a call.
2. The contact information for the active call will be
stored for the corresponding speed dial.
When a voice tag is stored, you can press the
button and call the number using voice commands.
Features
Up to 20 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.
To store a speed dial number:
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Add New, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select a place to choose a
number from, then press .
From Call History:
u Select a number from the call history.
From Phonebook:
u Select a number from the connected cell
phone’s imported phonebook.
From Phone Number:
u Input the number manually.
5. When the speed dial is successfully stored,
you are asked to create a voice tag for the
number. Rotate
to select Yes or No,
then press .
6. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
say the name for the speed dial entry.
Continued
383
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
384 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To edit a speed dial
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Change Speed Dial,
then press .
6. Select a new speed dial number, then press
.
Features
384
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
385 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To add a voice tag to a stored speed
Change Speed Dial
Delete Speed Dial
Store Voice Tag
Delete
Speed
Del
ete Sp
peed
ee Di
Dial
al
■ To change a voice tag
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Change Voice Tag,
then press .
6. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
Continued
1Speed Dial
Avoid using duplicate voice tags.
Avoid using “home” as a voice tag.
It is easier for HFL to recognize a longer name. For
example, use “John Smith” instead of “John.”
Features
Change
Cha
nge
e Sp
Speed
peed
ee Di
Dial
al
dial number
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Store Voice Tag, then
press .
6. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
385
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
386 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To delete a voice tag
Features
Change Speed Dial
Delete Speed Dial
Store Voice Tag
386
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Delete Voice Tag,
then press .
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then
press .
■ To delete a speed dial number
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Delete Speed Dial,
then press .
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then
press .
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
387 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Making a Call
1Making a Call
You can make calls by inputting any phone number, or by using the imported
phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or redial.
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from any screen.
Press the
button and follow the prompts.
The maximum range between your phone and
vehicles is 30 feet (10 meters).
Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of
the person you are calling through the audio
speakers.
Features
Continued
387
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
388 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using the imported
Features
phonebook
When your phone is paired, the contents of its
phonebook are automatically imported to
HFL.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phonebook, then
press .
3. The phonebook is stored alphabetically.
Rotate
to select the initial, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select a name, then press .
5. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
■ To make a call using a phone number
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Dial, then press .
3. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select
, then press .
u Dialing starts automatically.
388
1To make a call using the imported phonebook
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number using voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 371
2 Speed Dial P. 383
1To make a call using a phone number
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number using voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 371
2 Speed Dial P. 383
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
389 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using redial
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Redial, then press
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using redial
.
Continued
1To make a call using the call history
The call history appears only when a phone is
connected to HFL, and displays the last 20 dialed,
received, or missed calls.
Features
■ To make a call using the call history
Call history is stored by Dialed Calls,
Received Calls, and Missed Calls.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Call History, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Dialed Calls, Received
Calls, or Missed Calls, then press .
4. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
Press and hold the
button to redial the last
number dialed in your phone’s call history.
389
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
390 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using a speed dial entry
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using a speed dial entry
On the Phone screen, the first six speed dials on the
list can be directly selected by pressing the
corresponding audio preset buttons (1-6).
Select Others to view another paired phone’s speed
dial list.
When a voice tag is stored, press the
button and
call the number using voice commands.
2 Speed Dial P. 383
Features
390
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from any screen. Press the
button and
follow the prompts.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
391 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Receiving a Call
HFL Mode
1Receiving a Call
When there is an incoming call, an audible
notification sounds and the Incoming Call
screen appears.
Press the
Press the
button to answer the call.
button to decline or end the call.
Caller’s Name
Call Waiting
Press the
button to put the current call on hold to
answer the incoming call.
Press the
button again to return to the current
call.
Select Ignore to ignore the incoming call if you do
not want to answer it.
Press the
button if you want to hang up the
current call.
Continued
Features
You can select the icons on the audio/information
screen instead of the
and
buttons. Rotate
to select the icon, then press .
391
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
392 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Options During a Call
Features
392
The following options are available during a call.
Swap Call: Put the current call on hold to answer the incoming call.
Mute: Mute your voice.
Transfer Call: Transfer a call from HFL to your phone.
Dial Tones: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menu-driven
phone system.
1. To view the available options, press the
button.
2. Rotate
to select the option, then press
.
u The check box is checked when Mute is
selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.
1Options During a Call
Dial Tones: Available on some phones.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
393 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Models with display audio system
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
The Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) allows you to place and receive phone calls
using your vehicle’s audio system, without handling your cell phone.
Place your phone where you can get good reception.
To use HFL, you need a Bluetooth-compatible cell
phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing
procedures, and special feature capabilities:
• U.S.: Visit automobiles.honda.com/handsfreelink/,
or call 1-888-528-7876.
• Canada: For more information on smartphone
compatibility, call 1-888-528-7876.
Using HFL
■ HFL Buttons
(Menu) Button
Volume down
Volume up
SOURCE Button
Button
Voice control tips
• Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the
windows, as noise coming from them may interfere
with the microphones.
• Press the
button when you want to call a
number using a stored voice tag. Speak clearly and
naturally after a beep.
• If the microphones pick up voices other than yours,
the command may be misinterpreted.
• To change the volume level, use the audio system's
volume knob or the remote audio controls on the
steering wheel.
(Talk) Button
Up to five speed dial entries can be displayed among
a total of 20 that can be entered. If there is no entry
in the system, Speed Dial is disabled.
2 Speed Dial P. 406
(Hang-up/Back) Button
(Pick-up) Button
Continued
Features
To use the system, the Bluetooth On/Off Status
setting must be On. If there is an active connection to
Apple CarPlayTM, HFL is unavailable.
2 Customized Features P. 352
Microphone
393
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
394 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uUsing HFL
Features
394
(Pick-up) button: Press to go directly to the phone screen, or to answer an
incoming call.
(Hang-up/back) button: Press to end a call, go back to the previous
command, or cancel a command.
(Talk) button: Press to call a number with a stored voice tag.
(Menu) button: Press and hold to display Speed Dial, Call History, or Redial
on the phone screen.
button: Press to select an item displayed on the phone screen.
SOURCE button: Press to call a number listed in the selected item on the phone
screen.
To go to the Phone Menu screen:
1. Select
.
2. Select Phone to switch the display to the phone screen.
3. Select
.
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Up to five call histories can be displayed among a
total of 20 that can be entered. If there is no call
history, Call History is disabled.
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any
use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd., is under
license. Other trademarks and trade names are those
of their respective owners.
HFL Limitations
An incoming call on HFL will interrupt the audio
system when it is playing. It will resume when the call
is ended.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
395 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uUsing HFL
■ HFL Status Display
1HFL Status Display
The audio/information screen notifies you when there is an incoming call.
Battery Level Status
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your phone
is connected to HFL.
The information that appears on the audio/
information screen varies between phone models.
You can change the system language.
2 Customized Features P. 352
Roaming Status
HFL Mode
Caller’s Name
Signal Strength
Caller’s Number
Features
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a grayed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.
Only previously stored speed dial entries with voice tags, phonebook names, or
numbers can be called using voice commands while the vehicle is in motion.
2 Speed Dial P. 406
395
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
396 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
HFL Menus
The ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or ON (w *1 to use the system.
To use HFL, you must first pair your Bluetoothcompatible cell phone to the system while the vehicle
is parked.
■ Phone settings screen
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Phone.
Some functions are limited while driving.
Features
Phone
Bluetooth Device List
Connect:
Connect:
Connect:
(Existing entry list)
Add Bluetooth Device
Connect a paired device to
the system.
Disconnect
Disconnect a paired phone
from the system.
Delete
Delete a previously paired
phone.
Pair a new phone to the system.
*1 : Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
396
1HFL Menus
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
397 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Ring Tone
Automatic Phone Sync
Auto Phone Call Transfer
HondaLink Assist
Set phonebook and call history data to be automatically imported when a phone is paired to HFL.
Set calls to automatically transfer from your phone to HFL when you enter the vehicle.
Turn HondaLink Assist on and off.
Enable Text Messages
New Message Notification
Default
Features
Text Messages
Select the fixed or cell phone.
Turn the text message function on and off.
Select whether a pop-up alert comes on the screen when HFL
receives a new text message.
Cancel/Reset all customized items in the Phone settings group as default.
Continued
397
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
398 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Phone Menu screen
1. Select
.
2. Select Phone.
3. Select
.
Speed Dial
(Existing entry list)
Features
New Entry
Dial the selected number in the speed dial list.
Manual Input
Import from Call History
Edit Speed Dial
New Entry
Import from Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook
to store as a speed dial number.
Manual Input
Enter a phone number to store as a speed
dial number.
Select a phone number from the call history to
store as a speed dial number.
Import from Call History
Import from Phonebook
(Existing entry list)
Delete All
398
Enter a phone number to store as a speed
dial number.
Select a phone number from the call history to
store as a speed dial number.
Select a phone number from the phonebook
to store as a speed dial number.
Dial the selected number in the speed dial list.
Delete all of the previously stored speed dial number.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
399 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Phonebook
Display the paired phone’s phonebook.
Redial
Redial the last number dialed.
Dial
Enter a phone number to dial.
Call History
All
Display the last outgoing calls.
Received
Display the last incoming calls.
Features
Missed
Text Messages
Display the last outgoing, incoming and missed calls.
Dialed
Display the last missed calls.
(Existing message list)
Read/Stop
System reads received message aloud, or
stop message from being read.
See the previous message.
See the next message.
Reply
Call
Reply to a received message using one of six
fixed phrases.
Make a call to the sender.
Continued
399
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
400 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Phone Setup
1Phone Setup
■ To pair a cell phone (when there is no
Features
400
phone paired to the system)
1. Select Phone.
2. Select Yes.
3. Make sure your phone is search or
discoverable mode, then select Continue.
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth® device.
4. Select your phone when it appears on the
list.
u If your phone does not appear, you can
select Refresh to search again.
u If your phone still does not appear, select
Phone Not Found and search for
Bluetooth® devices using your phone.
From your phone, search for
HandsFreeLink.
5. The system gives you a pairing code on the
audio/information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by phone.
Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to
the system before you can make and receive handsfree calls.
Phone Pairing Tips:
• You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is
moving.
• Up to six phones can be paired.
• Your phone’s battery may drain faster when it is
paired to the system.
• If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found
by the system within three minutes, the system will
time out and returns to idle.
Once you have paired a phone, you can see it
displayed on the screen with one or two icons on the
right side.
These icons indicate the following:
: The phone can be used with HFL.
: The phone is compatible with Bluetooth® Audio.
If there is an active connection to Apple CarPlayTM,
pairing of additional Bluetooth-compatible devices is
unavailable and Add Bluetooth Device is grayed
out from the Bluetooth Device List screen.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
401 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To change the currently paired phone
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 396
If no other phones are found or paired when trying to
switch to another phone, HFL will inform you that the
original phone is connected again.
To pair other phones, select Add Bluetooth Device
from the Bluetooth Device List screen.
1To change the pairing code setting
The default pairing code is 0000 until you change the
setting.
To create your own, select Fixed, and delete the
current code, then enter a new one.
Features
2. Select Bluetooth Device List.
3. Select a phone to connect.
u HFL disconnects the connected phone
and starts searching for another paired
phone.
4. Select Connect
, Connect , or
Connect .
■ To change the pairing code setting
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Bluetooth / Wi-Fi.
4. Select the Bluetooth tab.
5. Select Edit Pairing Code.
1To change the currently paired phone
For a randomly generated pairing code each time you
pair a phone, select Random.
6. Select Random or Fixed.
Continued
401
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
402 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To delete a paired phone
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 396
2. Select Bluetooth Device List.
3. Select a phone you want to delete.
Features
402
4. Select Delete.
5. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Yes.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
403 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To Set Up Text Message Options
1To Set Up Text Message Options
■ To turn on or off the text message
function
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
To use the text message function, it may be necessary
to set up on your phone.
2 Phone settings screen P. 396
2. Select Enable Text Messages.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
3. Select On or Off.
■ To turn on or off the text message
2 Phone settings screen P. 396
2. Select New Message Notification.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
3. Select On or Off.
Continued
1To turn on or off the text message notice
On: A pop-up notification comes on every time you
receive a new message.
Off: The message you receive is stored in the system
without notification.
Features
notice
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
403
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
404 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Ring Tone
1Ring Tone
You can change the ring tone setting.
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 396
2. Select Ring Tone.
3. Select Fixed or Mobile Phone.
Features
■ Automatic Transferring
If you get into the vehicle while you are on the phone, the call can be automatically
transferred to HFL.
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 396
2. Select Auto Phone Call Transfer.
3. Select On or Off.
404
Fixed: The fixed ring tone sounds from the speakers.
Mobile Phone: For certain connected phones, the
ring tone stored in the phone sounds from the
speakers.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
405 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
■ When Automatic Phone Sync is set to
On:
When your phone is paired, the contents of its
phonebook and call history are automatically
imported to the system.
1Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When you select a name from the list in the cellular
phonebook, you can see up to three category icons.
The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored
for that name.
Fax
Home
Car
Mobile
Other
■ Changing the Automatic Phone Sync
Work
Voice
setting
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
Pager
2 Phone settings screen P. 396
On some phones, it may not be possible to import the
category icons to the system.
2. Select Automatic Phone Sync.
Features
Pref
The phonebook is updated after every connection.
Call history is updated after every connection or call.
3. Select On or Off.
Continued
405
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
406 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Speed Dial
1Speed Dial
Up to 20 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.
To store a speed dial number:
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 398
Features
2. Select Speed Dial.
3. Select New Entry.
4. Select a place to choose a number.
From Import from Call History:
u Select a number from the call history.
From Manual Input:
u Input the number manually.
From Import from Phonebook:
u Select a number from the connected cell
phone’s imported phonebook.
5. When the speed dial is successfully stored,
you are asked to create a voice tag for the
number. Select Yes or No.
6. Select Record to store a voice tag for the
speed dial entry.
u Using the
button, follow the prompts
to store a voice tag for the speed dial
entry.
406
When a voice tag is stored, press the
button to
call the number using the voice tag. Say the voice tag
name.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
407 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To add a voice tag to a stored speed
dial number
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 398
2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, select Edit.
4. Select Voice Tag.
u From the pop-up menu, select Record.
5. Select Record, or use the
button,
follow the prompts to complete the voice
tag.
1Speed Dial
Avoid using duplicate voice tags.
Avoid using “home” as a voice tag.
It is easier for the system to recognise a longer name.
For example, use “John Smith” instead of “John.”
Features
■ To delete a voice tag
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 398
2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, select Edit.
4. Select Voice Tag.
u From the pop-up menu, select Clear.
5. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Yes.
Continued
407
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
408 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To edit a speed dial
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
AAAAA
BBBBB
CCCCC
DDDDD
EEEEE
FFFFF
2 Phone Menu screen P. 398
2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, select Edit.
4. Select a setting you want.
■ To delete a speed dial
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 398
Features
408
2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, select Delete.
4. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Yes.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
409 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Phonebook Phonetic Modification
1Phonebook Phonetic Modification
Continued
You can store up to 20 phonetic modification items.
Features
Add phonetic modifications or a new voice tag to the phone’s contact name so that
it is easier for HFL to recognize voice commands.
■ To add a new voice tag
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Voice Recog tab.
5. Select Phonebook Phonetic
Modification.
6. Select the phone you want to add
phonetic modification to.
409
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
410 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
7. Select New Voice Tag.
8. Select a contact name you want to add to.
u The pop-up menu appears on the
screen.
9. Select Modify.
10. Using Record or the
button, follow
the prompts to complete the voice tag.
11. You will receive a confirmation message
on the screen, then select OK.
Features
410
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
411 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To modify a voice tag
1Phonebook Phonetic Modification
Continued
You can only modify or delete contact names for the
currently connected phone.
Features
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Voice Recog tab.
5. Select Phonebook Phonetic
Modification.
6. Select the phone you want to modify
phonetic modification.
7. Select a contact name you want to
modify.
u The pop-up menu appears on the
screen.
8. Select Modify.
9. Using Record or the
button, follow
the prompts to complete the voice tag.
10. You will receive a confirmation message
on the screen, then select OK.
411
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
412 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To delete a modified voice tag
Features
412
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Voice Recog tab.
5. Select Phonebook Phonetic
Modification.
6. Select the phone you want to delete
phonetic modification.
7. Select a contact name you want to delete.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
8. Select Delete.
u The selected contact name has been
selected.
9. Select OK.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
413 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
1Making a Call
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from most screens.
Press the
button and say the voice tag name.
Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of
the person you are calling through the audio
speakers.
While there is an active connection with Apple
CarPlayTM, phone calls cannot be made with
HandsFreeLink® and are only made from Apple
CarPlayTM.
Features
■ To delete all modified voice tags
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Voice Recog tab.
5. Select Phonebook Phonetic
Modification.
6. Select the phone you want to delete
phonetic modification.
u The contact name list appears.
7. Select Delete All.
8. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen, then select Yes.
■ Making a Call
You can make calls by inputting any phone
number, or by using the imported
phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or
redial.
Continued
413
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
414 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using the imported
phonebook
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 398
1To make a call using the imported phonebook
You can call a stored voice-tagged speed dial number
using voice commands.
2 Speed Dial P. 406
2. Select Phonebook.
3. Select a name.
u You can also search by letter. Select
Search.
u Use the keyboard on the touch screen for
entering letters.
4. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
Features
■ To make a call using a phone number
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 398
2. Select Dial.
3. Select a number.
u Use the keyboard on the touch screen for
entering numbers.
4. Select
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
414
1To make a call using a phone number
You can call a stored voice-tagged speed dial number
using voice commands.
2 Speed Dial P. 406
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
415 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using redial
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
1To make a call using redial
Press and hold the
number dialed.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 398
button to redial the last
2. Select Redial.
u Dialing starts automatically.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 398
1To make a call using the Call History
The call history displays the last 20 all, dialed,
received, or missed calls.
(Appears only when a phone is connected to the
system.)
Features
■ To make a call using the Call History
Call history is stored by All, Dialed,
Received, and Missed.
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2. Select Call History.
3. Select All, Dialed, Received, or Missed.
4. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
■ To make a call using a Speed Dial entry
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 398
2. Select Speed Dial.
3. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using a Speed Dial entry
When a voice tag is stored, press the
call the number using the voice tag.
2 Speed Dial P. 406
button to
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from any screen.
Press the
button and follow the prompts.
Continued
415
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
416 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Receiving a Call
1Receiving a Call
When there is an incoming call, an audible
notification sounds (if activated) and the
Incoming call screen appears.
Press the
Press the
button to answer the call.
button to decline or end the call.
Call Waiting
Press the
button to put the current call on hold to
answer the incoming call.
Press the
button again to return to the current
call.
Select Ignore to ignore the incoming call if you do
not want to answer it.
Press the
button if you want to hang up the
current call.
You can select the icons on the audio/information
screen instead of the
and
buttons.
Features
■ Options During a Call
1Options During a Call
The following options are available during a call.
Mute: Mute your voice.
Transfer: Transfer a call from the system to your phone.
Touch Tones: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menudriven phone system.
The available options are shown on the lower
Mute Icon
half of the screen.
Select the option.
u The mute icon appears when Mute is
selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.
416
Touch Tones: Available on some phones.
You can select the icons on the audio/information
screen.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
417 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Receiving a Text Message
1Receiving a Text Message
The system does not display any received messages
while you are driving. You can only hear them read
aloud.
The system can only receive messages that are sent as
text (SMS) messages. The message sent using the
data services will not be displayed in the list.
With some phones, you may be able to display up to
20 most recent text messages.
State or local laws may limit your use of the HFL text
message feature. Only use the text message feature
when conditions allow you to do so safely.
When you receive a text message for the first time
since the phone is paired to HFL, you are asked to
turn the New Message Notification setting to On.
2 To turn on or off the text message notice
P. 403
Continued
Features
HFL can display newly received text messages as well as 20 of the most recently
received messages on a linked cell phone. Each received message can be read aloud
and replied to using a fixed common phrase.
1. A pop-up appears and notifies you of a new
text message.
2. Select Read to listen to the message.
u The text message is displayed. The
system automatically starts reading out
the message.
3. To discontinue the message read-out, select
Stop.
417
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
418 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Displaying Messages
Message List
1Displaying Messages
■ Displaying text messages
The
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
If you delete a message on the phone, the message is
also deleted in the system. If you send a message
from the system, the message goes to your phone’s
outbox.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 398
2. Select Text Messages.
3. Select a message.
u The text message is displayed. The
system automatically starts reading the
message aloud.
Text Message
Features
418
icon appears next to an unread message.
To see the previous or next message, select
(previous) or
(next) on the message screen.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
419 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Read or Stop reading a message
1. Go to the text message screen.
u The system automatically starts reading
the message aloud.
2 Displaying Messages P. 418
2. Select Stop to stop reading.
Select Read again to start reading the
message from the beginning.
2 Displaying Messages P. 418
2. Select Reply.
3. Select the reply message.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
4. Select Send to send the message.
u Complete appears on the screen when
the reply message was successfully sent.
Continued
1Reply to a message
The available fixed reply messages are as follows:
• Talk to you later, I’m driving.
• I’m on my way.
• I’m running late.
• OK
• Yes
• No
Features
■ Reply to a message
1. Go to the text message screen.
u The system automatically starts reading
the message aloud.
You cannot add, edit, or delete reply messages.
Only certain phones receive and send messages when
paired and connected. For a list of compatible
phones:
• U.S.: Visit automobiles.honda.com/handsfreelink/,
or call 1-888-528-7876.
• Canada: For more information on smartphone
compatibility, call 1-888-528-7876.
419
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
420 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Making a call to a sender
1. Go to the text message screen.
2. Select Dial.
Features
420
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
421 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ In Case of Emergency
1In Case of Emergency
■ Automatic collision notification
If your vehicle’s airbags deploy or if the unit
detects that the vehicle is severely impacted,
your vehicle automatically will attempt to
connect to the HondaLink® operator. If
connected, information about your vehicle, its
location, and its condition can be sent to the
operator*1; you also can speak to the operator
when connected.
Honda reserves the right to terminate HondaLink Assist services at any time or for
any reason, and in the future may not be able to provide services due to changes in,
or obsolescence of, technology integral to the service or changes in governmental
regulation.
You cannot use this emergency service when:
• You travel outside the HondaLink® service coverage
areas.
• There is a problem with the connecting devices,
such as the microphones, speakers, or the unit
itself.
You cannot operate other phone-related functions
using the screen while talking to the operator.
Select Hang Up to terminate the connection to your
vehicle.
Features
IMPORTANT: For vehicles equipped with HondaLink Assist, owner activation
constitutes authorization for Honda to collect information from your vehicle needed
to provide the service, and agreement to the Terms of Use at www.hondalink.com/
TermsAndConditions. In a crash, HondaLink Assist will attempt to notify emergency
services but NEITHER Honda-PRO NOR ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS GUARANTEE THAT
SUCH NOTIFICATION WILL OCCUR.
Your vehicle may not be able to connect to the
operator if the battery level is low, the line is
disconnected, or you do not have adequate cellular
coverage.
1Automatic collision notification
If the unit fails to connect to the operator, it
repeatedly tries until it succeeds.
*1 : Depending on your phone and adequate cellular coverage, your vehicle’s location may not be sent to
the operator.
Continued
421
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
422 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To enable notification
1To enable notification
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 396
2. Select HondaLink Assist.
u A pop-up menu appears on the screen.
3. Select On or Off.
Features
422
Setting options:
• On: Notification is available.
• Off: Disable the feature.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
423 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Driving
This chapter discusses driving and refueling.
Before Driving
Driving Preparation .......................... 424
Maximum Load Limit........................ 427
Towing a Trailer
Towing Your Vehicle ........................ 429
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines ..... 430
When Driving
Starting the Engine .................. 432, 435
Precautions While Driving................. 438
Continuously Variable Transmission ..... 439
Shifting .................................... 440, 442
ECON Button ................................... 446
Cruise Control * ................................ 447
* Not available on all models
Vehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®), aka Electronic
Stability Control (ESC), System .............. 450
LaneWatchTM * .................................. 452
Real Time AWD with Intelligent Control
SystemTM * ...................................... 454
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) ...... 455
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation ......... 458
Honda Sensing® * .............................. 460
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) ....................................... 463
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)......... 473
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)...... 486
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System....495
Front Sensor Camera ....................... 500
Radar Sensor ................................... 502
Braking
Brake System ................................... 503
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) ........... 508
Brake Assist System ......................... 509
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped ................................ 510
Multi-View Rear Camera.................. 511
Refueling
Fuel Information .............................. 513
How to Refuel ................................. 514
Fuel Economy and CO2 Emissions.... 515
423
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
424 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Before Driving
Driving Preparation
Check the following items before you start driving.
■ Exterior Checks
• Make sure there are no obstructions on the windows, door mirrors, exterior
lights, or other parts of the vehicle.
u Remove any frost, snow, or ice.
u Remove any snow on the roof, as this can slip down and obstruct your field of
vision while driving. If frozen solid, remove ice once it has softened.
u When removing ice from around the wheels, be sure not to damage the wheel
or wheel components.
• Make sure the hood is securely closed.
u If the hood opens while driving, your front view will be blocked.
• Make sure the tires are in good condition.
u Check air pressure, and check for damage and excessive wear.
Driving
424
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 555
• Make sure there are no people or objects behind or around the vehicle.
u There are blind spots from the inside.
1Exterior Checks
NOTICE
When doors are frozen shut, use warm water around
the door edges to melt any ice. Do not try to force
them open, as this can damage the rubber trim
around the doors. When done, wipe dry to avoid
further freezing.
Do not pour warm water into the key cylinder.
You will be unable to insert the key if the water
freezes in the hole.
Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite
flammable materials left under the hood, causing a
fire. If you've parked your vehicle for an extended
period, inspect and remove any debris that may have
collected, such as dried grass and leaves that have
fallen or have been carried in for use as a nest by a
small animal. Also check under the hood for leftover
flammable materials after you or someone else has
performed maintenance on your vehicle.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
425 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
■ Interior Checks
1Interior Checks
• Store or secure all items on board properly.
u Carrying too much cargo, or improperly storing it, can affect your vehicle’s
handling, stability, stopping distance, and tires, and make it unsafe.
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the cargo area, have the aiming
readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified technician.
2 Maximum Load Limit P. 427
2 Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside P. 148
• Adjust your seating position properly.
u Adjust the head restraint, too.
Driving
• Do not pile items higher than the seat height.
u They can block your view and may be thrown forward in the event of sudden
braking.
• Do not place anything in the front seat footwells. Make sure to secure the floor
mat.
u An object or unsecured floor mat can interfere with your brake and accelerator
pedal operation while driving.
• If you have any animals on board, do not let them move around in the vehicle.
u They may interfere with driving and a crash could occur.
• Securely close and lock all doors and the tailgate.
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 190
2 Adjusting the front head restraint positions P. 197
• Adjust the mirrors and steering wheel properly for your driving.
u Adjust them while sitting in the proper driving position.
2 Adjusting the Mirrors P. 187
2 Adjusting the Steering Wheel P. 186
Continued
425
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
426 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
• Be sure items placed on the floor behind the front seats cannot roll under the
seats.
u They can interfere with the driver’s ability to operate the pedals, the operation
of the seats, or the operation of the sensors under the seats.
• Everyone in the vehicle must fasten their seat belt.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 44
• Make sure that the indicators in the instrument panel come on when you start the
vehicle, and go off soon after.
u Always have a dealer check the vehicle if a problem is indicated.
2 Indicators P. 80
Driving
426
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
427 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBefore DrivinguMaximum Load Limit
Maximum Load Limit
The maximum load for your vehicle is 850 lbs (385 kg).
See the Tire and Loading Information label attached to the driver’s
doorjamb.
1Maximum Load Limit
3 WARNING
Overloading or improper loading
can affect handling and stability
and cause a crash in which you
can be hurt or killed.
Label Example
Follow all load limits and other
loading guidelines in this manual.
This figure includes the total weight of all occupants, cargo, and
accessories, and the tongue load if you are towing a trailer.
Continued
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR):
The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle axle.
2 Specifications P. 614
Driving
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit (1) Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and
cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.” on your
vehicle’s placard.
(2) Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers
that will be riding in your vehicle.
(3) Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers
from XXX kg or XXX lbs.
(4) The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and
luggage load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount equals
1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the
amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs.
(1,400 - 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.)
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR):
The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle, all
occupants, all accessories and all cargo.
2 Specifications P. 614
427
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
428 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBefore DrivinguMaximum Load Limit
(5) Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being
loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the
available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.
(6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will
be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to
determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage
load capacity of your vehicle.
In addition, the total weight of the vehicle, all occupants,
accessories, cargo, and trailer tongue load must not exceed the
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight
Rating (GAWR). Both are on a label on the driver’s doorjamb.
Load Limits Example
Driving
Example1
Max Load
850 lbs
(385 kg)
Passenger Weight
150 lbs x 2 = 300 lbs
(68 kg x 2 = 136 kg)
Cargo Weight
550 lbs
(249 kg)
Max Load
850 lbs
(385 kg)
Passenger Weight
150 lbs x 5 = 750 lbs
(68 kg x 5 = 340 kg)
Cargo Weight
100 lbs
(45 kg)
Example2
428
1Maximum Load Limit
Towing a Trailer:
See Towing a Trailer to determine whether your
vehicle is designed to tow a trailer.
2 Towing a Trailer P. 429
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
429 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Towing a Trailer
Your vehicle is not designed to tow a trailer. Attempting to do so can void your
warranties.
Towing Your Vehicle
Your vehicle is not designed to be towed behind a motorhome. If your vehicle needs
to be towed in an emergency, refer to the emergency towing information.
2 Emergency Towing P. 609
Driving
429
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
430 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
General Information
Your vehicle has been designed primarily for use on pavement, however, its higher
ground clearance allows you to occasionally travel on unpaved roads. It is not
designed for trail-blazing, or other challenging off-highway activities.
If you decide to drive on unpaved roads, you will find that it requires somewhat
different driving skills and that your vehicle will handle somewhat differently than it
does on pavement. Pay attention to the precautions and tips in this section, and get
acquainted with your vehicle before leaving the pavement.
Important Safety Precautions
To avoid loss of control or rollover, be sure to follow all precautions and
recommendations:
• Be sure to store cargo properly and do not exceed your cargo load limits.
2 Maximum Load Limit P. 427
Driving
430
• Whenever you drive, make sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts.
• Keep your speed low, and never go faster than the conditions allow.
• It’s up to you to continually assess the situation and drive within the limits.
1Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
3 WARNING
Improperly operating this vehicle on or offpavement can cause a crash or rollover in
which you and your passengers could be
seriously injured or killed.
• Follow all instructions and guidelines in
this owner’s manual.
• Keep your speed low, and don’t drive
faster than conditions permit.
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
2 Important Handling Information P. 36
2 Precautions While Driving P. 438
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
431 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOff-Highway Driving GuidelinesuAvoiding Trouble
Avoiding Trouble
Driving
• Check Out Your Vehicle before you leave the pavement and make sure that all
scheduled maintenance has been completed. Pay special attention to the
condition of the tires, and check the tire pressures.
• Remember the route you choose presents limits (too steep or bumpy), you have
limits (driving skill and comfort), and your vehicle has limits (traction, stability, and
power). Failing to recognize these limits will likely put you and your passengers in
a hazardous situation.
• Accelerating and Braking should be done slowly and gradually. Trying to start
or stop too fast can cause a loss of traction and you could lose control.
• Avoiding Obstacles and Debris in the road reduces the likelihood of a rollover
or damage to your suspension or other components.
• Driving on Slopes increases your risk of a rollover, particularly if you attempt to
drive across a slope that is too steep. Going straight up or down a slope is usually
the safest. If you can’t clearly see all conditions or obstacles on a slope, walk it
before you drive it. If there is any doubt whether you can safely pass, don’t try it.
Find another route. If you get stuck when climbing, do not try to turn around.
Back down slowly following the same route you took up the hill.
• Crossing a Stream - Avoid driving through deep water. If you encounter water
in your route (a small stream or large puddle, for example), evaluate it carefully
before going ahead. Make sure it is shallow, flowing slowly, and has firm ground
underneath. If you are not sure of the depth or the ground, turn around and find
another route. Driving through deep water can also damage your vehicle. The
water can get into the transmission and differential, diluting the lubricant and
causing an eventual failure. It can also wash the grease out of the wheel bearings.
• If You Get Stuck, carefully go in the direction that you think will get you
unstuck. Do not spin the tires as this will only make things worse and could
damage the transmission. If you are unable to free yourself, your vehicle will need
to be towed.
431
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
432 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
When Driving
Models without smart entry system
Starting the Engine
1Starting the Engine
1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
u The electric parking brake indicator
comes on for 15 seconds when you pull
up to electric parking brake switch.
Electric Parking Brake Switch
Brake Pedal
Driving
432
2. Check that the transmission is in (P , then
depress the brake pedal.
u Although it is possible to start the vehicle
in (N , it is safer to start it in (P .
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when
starting the engine.
The engine is harder to start in cold weather and in
thinner air found at altitudes above 8,000 feet (2,400
meters).
When starting the engine in cold weather, turn off all
electrical accessories such as the lights, heating and
cooling system */climate control system *, and rear
defogger in order to reduce battery drain.
If you live in a region where winter is extremely cold,
an engine block heater will improve starting and
warming of the engine. Consult a dealer for details.
If the exhaust system sounds abnormal or you can
smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer. There may be a problem with
the engine or exhaust system.
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
433 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
3. Turn the ignition switch to START (e
without depressing the accelerator pedal.
1Starting the Engine
Do not hold the key in START (e for more than 10
seconds.
• If the engine does not start right away, wait for at
least 30 seconds before trying again.
• If the engine starts, but then immediately stops,
wait at least 30 seconds before repeating step 3
while gently depressing the accelerator pedal.
Release the accelerator pedal once the engine starts.
The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from
theft. If an improperly coded device is used, the
engine’s fuel system is disabled.
2 Immobilizer System P. 159
1Starting to Drive
1. Keeping your right foot on the brake pedal, put the shift lever in (D . Select (R
when reversing.
2. With the parking brake applied, release the brake pedal and gently depress the
accelerator pedal.
u Make sure the electric parking brake indicator goes off.
2 Parking Brake P. 503
Continued
You can also release the parking brake by pressing
the electric parking brake switch while depressing the
brake pedal.
When facing downhill, you can start your vehicle
more smoothly by manually releasing it with the
electric parking brake switch than by releasing it with
the accelerator pedal.
Driving
■ Starting to Drive
433
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
434 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Hill start assist system
Hill start assist keeps the brake engaged briefly to help prevent the vehicle from
rolling on inclines as you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator.
Put the transmission into (D , (S , or (L when facing uphill, or (R when facing
downhill, then release the brake pedal.
1Hill start assist system
Hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from
rolling downhill on a very steep or slippery slope, and
will not operate on small inclines.
Hill start assist will operate even when VSA® is
switched off.
Hill start assist is not a replacement for the parking
brake.
Driving
434
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
435 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
Models with smart entry system
Starting the Engine
1Starting the Engine
1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
u The electric parking brake indicator
comes on for 15 seconds when you pull
up to electric parking brake switch.
Electric Parking Brake Switch
Brake Pedal
2. Check that the transmission is in (P , then
depress the brake pedal.
u Although it is possible to start the vehicle
in (N , it is safer to start it in (P .
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when
starting the engine.
The engine is harder to start in cold weather and in
thinner air found at altitudes above 8,000 feet (2,400
meters).
When starting the engine in cold weather, turn off all
electrical accessories such as the lights, climate
control system, and rear defogger in order to reduce
battery drain.
If you live in a region where winter is extremely cold,
an engine block heater will improve starting and
warming of the engine. Consult a dealer for details.
Driving
If the exhaust system sounds abnormal or you can
smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer. There may be a problem with
the engine or exhaust system.
The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from
theft.If an improperly coded device is used, the
engine’s fuel system is disabled.
2 Immobilizer System P. 159
Continued
435
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
436 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
3. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button
without depressing the accelerator pedal.
1Starting the Engine
Bring the smart entry remote close to the ENGINE
START/STOP button if the battery in the smart entry
remote is weak.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
P. 592
The engine may not start if the smart entry remote is
subjected to strong radio waves.
■ Stopping the Engine
You can turn the engine off when the vehicle is completely stopped.
1. Put the transmission into (P .
2. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button.
Driving
436
Do not hold the ENGINE START/STOP button to
start the engine.
If the engine does not start, wait at least 30 seconds
before trying again.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
437 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Starting to Drive
1. Keeping your right foot on the brake pedal, put the transmission into (D . Select
(R when reversing.
2. With the parking brake applied, release the brake pedal and gently depress the
accelerator pedal.
u Make sure the electric parking brake indicator goes off.
2 Parking Brake P. 503
■ Hill start assist system
Hill start assist keeps the brake engaged briefly to help prevent the vehicle from
rolling on inclines as you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator.
Put the transmission into (D or (S when facing uphill, or (R when facing downhill,
then release the brake pedal.
1Starting to Drive
You can also release the parking brake by pressing
the electric parking brake switch while depressing the
brake pedal.
When facing downhill, you can start your vehicle
more smoothly by manually releasing it with the
electric parking brake switch than by releasing it with
the accelerator pedal.
1Hill start assist system
Hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from
rolling downhill on a very steep or slippery slope, and
will not operate on small inclines.
Hill start assist is not a replacement for the parking
brake.
Driving
Hill start assist will operate even when VSA® is
switched off.
437
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
438 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguPrecautions While Driving
Precautions While Driving
■ Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles.
To prevent rollovers or loss of control:
• Take corners at slower speeds than you would with a passenger vehicle.
• Avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers whenever possible.
• Do not modify your vehicle in any way that you would raise the center of gravity.
• Do not carry heavy cargo on the roof.
Never carry more than 165 lbs (75 kg) of cargo on the roof rack (Honda accessory).
■ In Rain
Avoid driving in deep water and on flooded roads. This can damage the engine or
driveline, or cause electrical component failure.
1Precautions While Driving
NOTICE
Do not operate the shift lever while pressing the
accelerator pedal. You could damage the
transmission.
NOTICE
If you repeatedly turn the steering wheel at an
extremely low speed, or hold the steering wheel in
the full left or right position for a while, the electric
power steering (EPS) system heats up. The system
goes into a protective mode, and limits its
performance. The steering wheel becomes harder
and harder to operate. Once the system cools down,
the EPS system is restored. Repeated operation under
these conditions can eventually damage the system.
Driving
If the ignition switch is turned to ACCESSORY (q *1
while driving, the engine will shut down and all
steering and brake power assist functions will stop,
making it difficult to control the vehicle.
Do not put the shift lever in (N , as you will lose
engine braking (and acceleration) performance.
During the first 600 miles (1,000 km) of operation,
avoid sudden acceleration or full throttle operation so
as to not damage the engine or powertrain.
Avoid hard braking for the first 200 miles (300 km).
You should also follow this when the brake pads are
replaced.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an
ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition
switch.
438
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
439 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguContinuously Variable Transmission
■ Other Precautions
If there is a strong impact with something under the vehicle, stop in a safe location.
Check the underside of the vehicle for damage or any fluid leaks.
1Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
2 Important Handling Information P. 36
2 Precautions While Driving P. 438
Continuously Variable Transmission
■ Creeping
The engine runs at a higher idle speed and creeping increases.
Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed when stopped.
■ Kickdown
Driving
Quickly depressing the accelerator pedal while driving uphill may cause the
transmission to drop to a lower ratio, unexpectedly increasing vehicle speed.
Depress the accelerator pedal carefully, especially on slippery roads and curves.
439
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
440 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Continuously variable transmission models without paddle shifters
Shifting
1Shifting
Change the shift position in accordance with your driving needs.
■ Shift lever positions
Park
Used when parking or starting the
engine
Reverse
Used when reversing
Neutral
Transmission is not locked
Driving
Drive
Used for normal driving
Release Button
Drive (S)
Used:
● For better acceleration
● To increase engine braking
● When going up or down hills
Low
Used to further increase engine
braking
● Used when going up or down hills
●
440
You cannot turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 and
remove the key unless the shift lever is in (P .
The vehicle may move forward very slightly even in
(N while the engine is cold.
Depress the brake pedal firmly and, when necessary,
apply the parking brake.
When shifting positions in extremely low
temperatures (-22°F/-30°C), there may be a short
delay before the shift position is displayed. Always
confirm you are in the correct shift position before
driving.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
441 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Shift Lever Operation
1Shift Lever Operation
NOTICE
Models with information display
Models with multi-information display
Tachometer’s red zone
When you change the shift lever from (D to (R and
vice versa, come to a complete stop and keep the
brake pedal depressed.
Operating the shift lever before the vehicle has come
to a complete standstill can damage the transmission.
Use the shift lever position indicator to check the
lever position before pulling away.
If the transmission indicator blinks when driving, in
any shift position, there is a problem with the
transmission.
Avoid sudden acceleration and have the transmission
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
Depress the brake pedal and press
the shift lever release button to shift.
Shift without pressing the shift lever
release button.
The fuel supply may be cut off if you drive at engine
speeds in or over the tachometer red zone (engine
speed limit). If this happens, you may experience a
slight jolt.
Driving
Shift Lever Position Indicator
(Transmission indicator)
It may not be possible to operate the shift lever if the
brake pedal is applied while the shift lever release
button is held down.
Depress the brake pedal first.
Press the shift lever release button
and shift.
441
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
442 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Continuously variable transmission models with paddle shifters
Shifting
1Shifting
Change the shift position in accordance with your driving needs.
■ Shift lever positions
Park
Used when parking or starting the
engine
Reverse
Used when reversing
Neutral
Transmission is not locked
Driving
Drive
Used:
● For normal driving
● When temporarily driving in the
7-speed manual shift mode
Release Button
442
Drive (S)
Used for:
● For better acceleration
● To increase engine braking
● When going up or down hills
● When driving in the 7-speed manual
shift mode
You cannot change the power mode from ON to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) unless the shift lever is in (P .
The vehicle may move forward very slightly even in
(N while the engine is cold.
Depress the brake pedal firmly and, when necessary,
apply the parking brake.
When shifting positions in extremely low
temperatures (-22°F/-30°C), there may be a short
delay before the shift position is displayed. Always
confirm you are in the correct shift position before
driving.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
443 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Shift Lever Operation
1Shift Lever Operation
NOTICE
Models with information display
Models with multi-information display
Shift Lever Position Indicator (Transmission indicator)
Tachometer’s red zone
When you change the shift lever from (D to (R and
vice versa, come to a complete stop and keep the
brake pedal depressed.
Operating the shift lever before the vehicle has come
to a complete standstill can damage the transmission.
Use the shift lever position indicator to check the
lever position before pulling away.
If the transmission indicator blinks when driving, in
any shift position, there is a problem with the
transmission.
Avoid sudden acceleration and have the transmission
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
Shift Lever Position Indicator
(Transmission indicator)
M (7-Speed Manual Shift Mode)
Indicator/Shift Indicator
Depress the brake pedal and press
the shift lever release button to shift.
Driving
The fuel supply may be cut off if you drive at engine
speeds in or over the tachometer red zone (engine
speed limit). If this happens, you may experience a
slight jolt.
It may not be possible to operate the shift lever if the
brake pedal is applied while the shift lever release
button is held down.
Depress the brake pedal first.
Shift without pressing the shift lever
release button.
Press the shift lever release button
and shift.
Continued
443
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
444 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ 7-Speed Manual Shift Mode
Use the paddle shifters to change between 1st and 7th speeds without removing
your hands from the steering wheel. The transmission switches to the 7-speed
manual shift mode when you pull a paddle shifter while driving. This mode is useful
when engine braking is needed.
■ When the shift lever is in (D :
The shift mode goes into the 7-speed manual shift mode temporarily, and the
number is displayed in the shift indicator.
The 7-speed manual shift mode is canceled automatically if you drive at constant
speed or accelerate, and the number in the shift indicator goes off.
You can cancel this mode by pulling the
paddle shifter for a few seconds.
The 7-speed manual shift mode is especially useful when reducing the vehicle speed
temporarily before making a turn.
Driving
■ When the shift lever is in (S :
The shift mode goes into the 7-speed manual shift mode. The M indicator and the
speed number are displayed in the shift indicator. As the vehicle speed slows down,
the transmission automatically shifts down accordingly. When the vehicle comes to
a stop, it automatically shifts down into 1st.
If the vehicle speed increases and the engine speed reaches near the tachometer’s
red zone, the transmission automatically shifts up.
You can only pull away in 1st speed.
When canceling the 7-speed manual shift mode, move the shift lever from (S to
(D . When the 7-speed manual shift mode is canceled, the M indicator and shift
indicator go off.
444
17-Speed Manual Shift Mode
In the 7-speed manual shift mode, the transmission
shifts up or down by operating either paddle shifter
under the following conditions:
Shift Up: The engine speed reaches the lowest
threshold of the higher speed position.
Shift Down: The engine speed reaches the highest
threshold of the lower speed position.
When the engine speed reaches near the
tachometer’s red zone, the transmission shifts up
automatically.
When the engine speed reaches the lowest threshold
of the selected speed position, the transmission shifts
down automatically.
Operating the paddle shifters on slippery surfaces
may cause the tires to lock up. In this case, the 7speed manual shift mode is canceled and goes back
to the normal (D driving mode.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
445 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ 7-Speed Manual Shift Mode Operation
(- Paddle Shifter
(Shift down)
17-Speed Manual Shift Mode Operation
(+ Paddle Shifter
(Shift up)
Each paddle shift operation makes a single speed
change.
To change continuously, release the paddle shifter
before pulling it again for the next speed.
The shift indicator blinks when you cannot shift up or
down. It indicates that your vehicle speed is not in its
allowable shifting range.
Slightly accelerate to shift up and decelerate to shift
down while the indicator is blinking.
Upshifting when pulling
the (+ paddle shifter
(Changes to higher speed
number)
Driving
Downshifting when pulling
the (- paddle shifter
(Changes to lower speed
number)
445
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
446 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguECON Button
ECON Button
Models with information display
Models with multi-information display
Driving
446
* Not available on all models
The ECON button turns the ECON mode on
and off. The ECON mode helps you improve
your fuel economy by adjusting the
performance of the engine, transmission,
heating and cooling system */climate control
system *, and cruise control *.
1ECON Button
Models with climate control system
While in ECON mode, the climate control system has
greater temperature fluctuations.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
447 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control *
Cruise Control *
Maintains a constant vehicle speed without having to keep your foot on the
accelerator. Use cruise control on freeways or open roads where you can travel at a
constant speed with little acceleration or deceleration.
Desired speed in a range above
roughly 25 mph (40 km/h) ~
Always keep sufficient distance
between you and the vehicle in
front of you.
Use the cruise control only when traveling
on open highways in good weather.
■ Shift positions for cruise control:
It may not be possible to maintain a constant speed
when driving uphill or downhill.
In (D or (S
How to use
CRUISE MAIN is on in
the instrument panel.
■ Press the CRUISE
button on the
steering wheel.
Continued
When not using cruise control:
Turn off cruise control by pressing the CRUISE
button.
While in ECON mode, it may take relatively more time
to accelerate to maintain the set speed.
Driving
Cruise control is ready to
use.
* Not available on all models
3 WARNING
Improper use of the cruise control can lead
to a crash.
When to use
■ Vehicle speed for cruise control:
1Cruise Control *
447
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
448 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control *
■ To Set the Vehicle Speed
–/SET Button
On
On
Press and release
On when cruise control begins
Driving
Take your foot off the pedal and press the –/SET button when you reach the desired
speed.
The moment you release the –/SET button, the set speed is fixed, and cruise control
begins. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator comes on.
448
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
449 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control *
■ To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
1To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
Increase or decrease the vehicle speed using the RES/+ or –/SET buttons on the
steering wheel.
You can set the vehicle speed using the –/SET button
on the steering wheel when adjusting the speed with
the accelerator and brake pedals.
To increase speed
To decrease speed
■ To Cancel
CRUISE Button
To cancel cruise control, do any of the following:
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the CRUISE button.
• Depress the brake pedal.
The CRUISE CONTROL indicator goes off.
CANCEL
Button
1To Cancel
Driving
• Each time you press the button, the vehicle speed is increased or decreased by
about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
• If you keep the button pressed, the vehicle speed increases or decreases until you
release it. This speed is then set.
Resuming the prior set speed:
After cruise control has been canceled, you can still
resume the prior set speed by pressing the RES/+
button while driving at a speed of at least 25 mph (40
km/h) or more.
You cannot set or resume in the following situations:
• When vehicle speed is less than 25 mph (40 km/h)
• When the CRUISE button is turned off
At vehicle speeds of 22 mph (35 km/h) or less, cruise
control is canceled automatically.
449
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
450 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
Vehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®), aka Electronic
Stability Control (ESC), System
VSA® helps to stabilize the vehicle during cornering if the vehicle turns more or less
than what was intended. It also assists in maintaining traction on slippery surfaces.
It does so by regulating engine output and selectively applying the brakes.
■ VSA® Operation
VSA® System
Indicator
Driving
450
When VSA® activates, you may notice that the
engine does not respond to the accelerator.
You may also notice some noise from the
hydraulic system. You will also see the
indicator blink.
1Vehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control
(ESC), System
The VSA® may not function properly if tire type and
size are mixed. Make sure to use the same size and
type of tire, and the air pressures as specified.
When the VSA® system indicator comes on and stays
on while driving, there may be a problem with the
system. While this may not interfere with normal
driving, have your vehicle checked by a dealer
immediately.
VSA® cannot enhance stability in all driving situations
and does not control the entire braking system. You
still need to drive and corner at speeds appropriate
for the conditions and always leave a sufficient
margin of safety.
The main function of the VSA® system is generally
known as Electronic Stability Control (ESC). The
system also includes a traction control function.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
451 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
■ VSA® On and Off
VSA® OFF Indicator
This button is on the driver side control panel.
To partially disable VSA® functionality/
features, press and hold it until you hear a
beep.
1Vehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control
(ESC), System
In certain unusual conditions when your vehicle gets
stuck in shallow mud or fresh snow, it may be easier
to free it with the VSA® temporarily switched off.
To restore VSA® functionality/features, press
the
(VSA® OFF) button until you hear a
beep.
Immediately after freeing your vehicle, be sure to
switch VSA® on again. We do not recommend driving
your vehicle with the VSA® system switched off.
VSA® is turned on every time you start the
engine, even if you turned it off the last time
you drove the vehicle.
You may hear a motor sound coming from the
engine compartment while system checks are being
performed immediately after starting the engine or
while driving. This is normal.
Driving
Your vehicle will have normal braking and
cornering ability, but traction control function
will be less effective.
When the
button is pressed, the traction control
function becomes less effective. This allows for the
wheels to spin more freely at low speed. You should
only attempt to free your vehicle with the VSA® off if
you are not able to free it when the VSA® is on.
451
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
452 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguLaneWatchTM *
LaneWatchTM *
LaneWatch is an assistance system that allows you to check the passenger side rear
areas displayed on the audio/information screen when the turn signal is activated to
the passenger’s side. A camera in the passenger side door mirror monitors these
areas and allows you to check for vehicles, in addition to your visual check and use
of the passenger door mirror. You can also keep the system on for your convenience
while driving.
The system activates when you:
Move the turn
signal lever to the
passenger side.
The passenger side view
display appears on the
audio/information
screen.
Press the
LaneWatch
button.
Driving
Press the LaneWatch
button again.
452
* Not available on all models
Failure to visually confirm that it is safe to
change lanes before doing so may result in
a crash and serious injury or death.
Do not rely only on LaneWatch while
driving.
Always look in your mirrors, to either side
of your vehicle, and behind you for other
vehicles before changing lanes.
The LaneWatch function can be affected by weather,
lighting (including headlights and low sun angle),
ambient darkness, camera condition, and loading.
Camera
Audio/Information Screen
3 WARNING
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, LaneWatch has
limitations. Over reliance on LaneWatch may result in
a collision.
The system deactivates when you:
Pull the turn signal
lever back.
1LaneWatchTM *
The LaneWatch may not provide the intended display
of traffic to the side and rear under the following
conditions:
• Your vehicle’s suspension has been altered,
changing the height of the vehicle.
• Your tires are over or under inflated.
• Your tires or wheels are of varied size or
construction.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
453 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguLaneWatchTM *
■ Customizing the LaneWatch settings
You can customize the following items using the audio/information screen.
• Show with Turn Signal: Selects whether LaneWatch monitor comes on when
you operate the turn signal lever.
• Display Time after Turn Signal Off: Changes the remaining LaneWatch
display time after you pull the turn signal lever back.
• Reference Line: Selects whether the reference lines appear on the LaneWatch
monitor.
• Next Maneuver Pop up *: Selects whether a turn direction screen of the
navigation system interrupts the LaneWatch display.
• Display: Adjusts display settings.
2 Customized Features P. 345
The LaneWatch camera view is restricted. Its unique
lens makes objects on the screen slightly look
different from what they are.
LaneWatch display does not come on when the shift
lever is in (R .
For proper LaneWatch operation:
• The camera is located in the passenger side door
mirror. Always keep this area clean. If the camera
lens is covered with dirt or moisture, use a soft,
moist cloth to keep the lens clean and free of
debris.
• Do not cover the camera lens with labels or stickers
of any kind.
• Do not touch the camera lens.
1Reference Lines
Three lines that appear on the screen can give
an idea of how far the vehicles or objects on
the screen are from your vehicle, respectively.
If an object is near line 1 (in red), it indicates
that it is close to your vehicle whereas an
object near line 3 is farther away.
The area around the reference line 1 (red) is very close
to your vehicle. As always, make sure to visually
confirm the safety of a lane change before changing
lanes.
Driving
■ Reference Lines
1LaneWatchTM *
The distance between your vehicle and lines 1, 2 and
3 on the screen vary depending on road conditions
and vehicle loading. For example, the reference lines
on the screen may seem to appear closer than the
actual distances when the rear of your vehicle is more
heavily loaded.
Consult a dealer if:
• The passenger side door mirror, or area around it is
severely impacted, resulting in changing the
camera angle.
• The LaneWatch display does not come on at all.
* Not available on all models
453
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
454 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguReal Time AWD with Intelligent Control SystemTM *
Real Time AWD with Intelligent Control SystemTM *
Your vehicle is equipped with the AWD system. When the system senses a loss of
front wheel traction, it automatically transfers some power to the rear wheels. This
allows you to utilize all available traction and may increase mobility.
You still need to exercise the same care when accelerating, steering, and braking
that you would in a two wheel drive vehicle.
If you excessively spin all four wheels and overheat the AWD system, only the front
wheels receive power. Stop until the system cools down.
Driving
454
* Not available on all models
1Real Time AWD with Intelligent Control SystemTM *
NOTICE
Do not continuously spin the front tires of your
vehicle. Continuously spinning the front tires can
cause transmission or rear differential damage.
The AWD system may not function properly if tire
type and size are mixed. Make sure to use the same
size and type of tire, and the air pressures as
specified.
2 Tire and Wheel Replacement P. 562
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
455 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
U.S. models only
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
1Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Instead of directly measuring the pressure in each tire, the TPMS on this vehicle monitors and
compares the rolling radius and rotational characteristics of each wheel and tire while you are
driving to determine if one or more tires are significantly under-inflated.
This will cause the low tire pressure/TPMS
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
indicator to come on and a message to appear
*
on the multi-information display *.
Conditions such as low ambient temperature and
altitude change directly affect tire pressure and can
trigger the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator to come
on.
You must start TPMS calibration every time you:
• Adjust the pressure in one or more tires.
• Rotate the tires.
• Replace one or more tires.
Driving
Tire pressure checked and inflated in:
• Warm weather can become under-inflated in
colder weather.
• Cold weather can become over-inflated in warmer
weather.
The low tire pressure/TPMS indicator will not come
on as a result of over inflation.
The TPMS may not function properly if tire type and
size are mixed. Make sure to use the same size and
type of tire.
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 555
■ TPMS Calibration
The low tire pressure/TPMS indicator may come on
with a delay or may not come on at all when:
• You rapidly accelerate, decelerate, or turn the
steering wheel.
• You drive on snowy or slippery roads.
• Snow chains are used.
Before calibrating the TPMS:
• Set the cold tire pressure in all four tires.
2 Checking Tires P. 555
Make sure:
• The vehicle is at a complete stop.
• The shift lever is in (P .
• The ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
The system does not monitor the tires when driving
at low speed.
Continued
The low tire pressure/TPMS indicator may come on
under the following conditions:
• A compact spare tire is used.
• There is a heavier and uneven load on the tires than
the condition at calibration.
• Snow chains are used.
455
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
456 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
Models with information display
Press and hold the TPMS button until the low
tire pressure/TPMS indicator blinks twice,
indicating the calibration process has begun.
• If the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator does
not blink, confirm the above conditions
then press and hold the TPMS button again.
• The calibration process finishes
automatically.
1TPMS Calibration
• TPMS cannot be calibrated if a compact spare tire is
installed.
• The calibration process requires approximately 30
minutes of cumulative driving at speeds between
30-60 mph (48-97 km/h).
• During this period, if the ignition is turned on*1 and
the vehicle is not moved within 45 seconds, you
may notice the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator
comes on briefly. This is normal and indicates that
the calibration process is not yet complete.
TPMS Button
If the snow chains are installed, remove them before
calibrating the TPMS.
Driving
If the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator comes on even
when the properly inflated specified regular tires are
installed, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
We recommend that the tires be replaced with the
same brand, model, and size as the originals. Ask a
dealer for details.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
456
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
457 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Models with multi-information display
Driving
You can calibrate the system from the
customized features on the multi-information
display.
1. Press the
button to select Vehicle
Settings, then press the SEL/RESET
button.
u TPMS Calibration appears on the
display.
2. Press the SEL/RESET button.
u The display switches to the
customization setup screen, where you
can select Cancel or Calibrate.
3. Press the
button and select
Calibrate, then press the SEL/RESET
button.
u Calibration Started screen appears,
then the display returns to the
customization menu screen.
• If the Calibration Failed To Start message
appears, repeat steps 2-3.
• The calibration process finishes
automatically.
457
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
458 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required Federal Explanation
U.S. models
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required
Federal Explanation
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked
monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure
recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard
or tire inflation pressure label.
(If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low
tire pressure telltale
Driving
when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you
should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate
them to the proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s
handling and stopping ability.
458
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
459 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required Federal Explanation
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire
maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain
correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the
level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction
indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly.
The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire
pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the
telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain
continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including
the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the
vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly.
Driving
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may
not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended.
Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or
more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the
replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to
continue to function properly.
459
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
460 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Honda Sensing® *
Honda Sensing® is a driver support system which employs the use of two distinctly
different kinds of sensors: a radar sensor located in the front grille and a front sensor
camera mounted to the interior side of the windshield, behind the rearview mirror.
Honda Sensing® has following functions.
■ The functions which do not require switch operations to activate
• Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) 2 P. 463
• Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System 2 P. 495
■ The functions which require switch operations to activate
• Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) 2 P. 473
• Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) 2 P. 486
Driving
460
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
461 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * u
■ Operation Switches for the ACC and LKAS
MAIN button
CANCEL
Button
Interval
Button
LKAS Button
−/SET
Button
■ LKAS Button
Press to activate or cancel the LKAS.
■ RES/+ and −/SET Button
Press RES/+ to resume the ACC or increase
the vehicle speed.
Press −/SET to set the ACC or decrease the
vehicle speed.
■ Interval Button
Press the (interval) button to change the
ACC following-interval.
Driving
RES/+
Button
■ MAIN Button
Press to activate standby mode for ACC and
LKAS. Or press to cancel these systems.
■ CANCEL Button
Press to cancel ACC.
Continued
461
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
462 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * u
■ Multi-Information Display Content
You can see the current state of ACC and
LKAS.
a Indicates
that ACC and LKAS are ready to
be activated.
b Indicates
that LKAS is activated and
whether or not traffic lane lines are
detected.
c Indicates
whether or not a vehicle is
detected ahead.
Driving
462
d Shows
the set vehicle speed.
e Shows
the set vehicle interval.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
463 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
Can assist you when there is a possibility of your vehicle colliding with a vehicle or a
pedestrian detected in front of yours. The CMBSTM is designed to alert you when a
potential collision is determined, as well as to reduce your vehicle speed to help
minimize collision severity when a collision is deemed unavoidable.
■ How the system works
When to use
The camera is
located behind
the rearview
mirror.
1Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
Important Safety Reminder
The CMBSTM is designed to reduce the severity of an
unavoidable collision. It does not prevent a collision
nor stop the vehicle automatically. It is still your
responsibility to operate the brake pedal and steering
wheel appropriately according to the driving
conditions.
The CMBSTM may not activate or may not detect a
vehicle in front of your vehicle under certain
conditions:
2 CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations P. 467
For directions on the proper handling of the radar
sensor, refer to the following page.
2 Radar Sensor P. 502
The radar sensor is
in the front grille.
Driving
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
1How the system works
The system starts monitoring the roadway ahead when your vehicle speed is about
3 mph (5 km/h) and there is a vehicle in front of you.
The CMBSTM activates when:
The speed difference between your vehicle and a vehicle or pedestrian detected
in front of you becomes about 3 mph (5 km/h) and over with a chance of a
collision.
● Your vehicle speed is about 62 mph (100 km/h) or less and there is a chance of a
collision with an oncoming detected vehicle or a pedestrian in front of you.
●
Continued
Rapid vibrations on the steering wheel alert you
when your vehicle speed is between 19 and 62 mph
(30 and 100 km/h) with an oncoming vehicle
detected in front of you.
When the CMBSTM activates, it may automatically
apply the brake. It will be canceled when your vehicle
stops or a potential collision is not determined.
463
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
464 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ When the system activates
1When the system activates
The system provides visual, audible and tactile alerts of a possible collision, and
stops if the collision is avoided.
● Take appropriate action to prevent a collision (apply the brakes, change lanes,
etc.)
Visual Alerts
The camera in the CMBSTM is also designed to detect
pedestrians.
However, this pedestrian detection feature may not
activate or may not detect a pedestrian in front of
your vehicle under certain conditions.
Refer to the ones indicating the pedestrian detection
limitations from the list.
2 CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations P. 467
Beep
Driving
Audible Alert
Tactile Alert
At system’s earliest collision alert stage, you can change the distance (Long/
Normal/Short) between vehicles at which alerts will come on through audio/
information screen setting options.
2 List of customizable options P. 358
■ Vibration alert on the steering wheel
When a potential collision to an oncoming detected vehicle is determined, the
system alerts you with rapid vibration on the steering wheel, in addition to visual and
audible alerts.
u Take appropriate action to prevent a collision (apply the brakes, operate the
steering wheel, etc.).
464
1Vibration alert on the steering wheel
Vibration alert function is disabled when the electric
power steering (EPS) system indicator comes on.
2 Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator P. 90
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
465 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ Collision Alert Stages
The system has three alert stages for a possible collision. However, depending on circumstances, the CMBSTM may not go through all of
the stages before initiating the last stage.
CMBSTM
Distance between vehicles
Stage
one
Normal
Long Short
Vehicle
Ahead
The sensors detect a
vehicle
There is a risk of a
collision with the
vehicle ahead of you.
Your Vehicle
Your
Vehicle
Vehicle
Ahead
When in Long, visual and audible alerts
come on at a longer distance from a
vehicle ahead than in Normal setting,
and in Short, at a shorter distance than
in Normal.
The risk of a collision
has increased, time to
respond is reduced.
Steering Wheel
In case of an
oncoming vehicle
detected, rapid
vibration is
provided.
Braking
—
—
Lightly
applied
—
Forcefully
applied
Driving
Stage
two
Audible & Visual WARNINGS
Visual and audible alerts.
Stage
three
Your
Vehicle
Vehicle
Ahead
The CMBSTM
determines that a
collision is
unavoidable.
Continued
465
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
466 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ CMBSTM On and Off
1CMBSTM On and Off
Press and hold the button until the beeper
sounds to switch the system on or off.
When the CMBSTM is off:
• The CMBSTM indicator in the instrument
panel comes on.
• A message on the multi-information display
reminds you that the system is off.
The CMBSTM is turned on every time you start
the engine, even if you turned it off the last
time you drove the vehicle.
Driving
466
The CMBSTM may automatically shut off, and the
CMBSTM indicator will come and stay on under certain
conditions:
2 CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations P. 467
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
467 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations
1CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations
The system may automatically shut off and the CMBSTM indicator will come on under
certain conditions. Some examples of these conditions are listed below. Other
conditions may reduce some of the CMBSTM functions.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if you find any
unusual behavior of the system (e.g., the warning
message appears too frequently).
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
■ Environmental conditions
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
There is little contrast between objects and the background.
Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
Driving in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
Roadway objects or structures are misinterpreted as vehicles and pedestrians.
Reflections on the interior of the windshield.
Driving at night or in a dark condition such as a tunnel.
Driving
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
■ Roadway conditions
• Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks,
reflected lights, road spray, high contrast).
• The road is hilly or the vehicle is approaching the crest of a hill.
• Driving on curvy, winding, or undulating roads.
Continued
467
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
468 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ Vehicle conditions
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Driving
468
Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
The outside of the windshield is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
The inside of the windshield is fogged.
An abnormal tire or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tire, etc.).
When tire chains are installed.
The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
The camera temperature gets too high.
Driving with the parking brake applied.
When the radar sensor in the front grille gets dirty.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
469 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
Driving
■ Detection limitations
• A vehicle or pedestrian suddenly crosses in front of you.
• The distance between your vehicle and the vehicle or pedestrian ahead of you is
too short.
• A vehicle cuts in front of you at a slow speed, and it brakes suddenly.
• When you accelerate rapidly and approach the vehicle or pedestrian ahead of you
at high speed.
• The vehicle ahead of you is a motorcycle, bicycle, mobility scooter or other small
vehicle.
• When there are animals in front of your vehicle.
• When you drive on a curved, winding or undulating road that makes it difficult for
the sensor to properly detect a vehicle in front of you.
• The speed difference between your vehicle and a vehicle or pedestrian in front of
you is significantly large.
• An oncoming vehicle suddenly comes in front of you.
• Another vehicle suddenly comes in front of you at an intersection, etc.
• Your vehicle abruptly crosses over in front of an oncoming vehicle.
• When driving through a narrow iron bridge.
• When the lead vehicle suddenly slows down.
Limitations applicable to pedestrian detection only
• When there is a group of people in front of your vehicle walking together side by
side.
• Surrounding conditions or belongings of the pedestrian alter the pedestrian’s
shape, preventing the system from recognizing that the person is a pedestrian.
• When the pedestrian is shorter than about 3.3 feet (1 meter) or taller than about
6.6 feet (2 meters) in height.
• When a pedestrian blends in with the background.
• When a pedestrian is bent over or squatting, or when their hands are raised or
they are running.
• When several pedestrians are walking ahead in a group.
• When the camera cannot correctly identify that a pedestrian is present due to an
unusual shape (holding luggage, body position, size).
Continued
469
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
470 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ Automatic shutoff
CMBSTM may automatically shut itself off and the CMBSTM indicator comes and stays
on when:
• The temperature inside the system is high.
• You drive off-road or on a mountain road, or curved and winding road for an
extended period.
• An abnormal tire condition is detected (wrong tire size, flat tire, etc.).
• The camera behind the rearview mirror, or the area around the camera, including
the windshield, gets dirty.
Once the conditions that caused CMBSTM to shut off improve or are addressed (e.g.,
cleaning), the system comes back on.
Driving
470
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
471 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ With Little Chance of a Collision
The CMBSTM may activate even when you are aware of a vehicle ahead of you, or
when there is no vehicle ahead. Some examples of this are:
■ When passing
Your vehicle approaches another vehicle ahead of you and you change lanes to pass.
■ At an intersection
Your vehicle approaches or passes another vehicle that is making a left or right turn.
Driving
Continued
471
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
472 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ On a curve
When driving through curves, your vehicle comes to a point where an oncoming
vehicle is right in front of you.
■ Through a low bridge at high speed
You drive under a low or narrow bridge at high speed.
Driving
472
■ Speed bumps, road work sites, train tracks, roadside objects, etc.
You drive over speed bumps, steel road plates, etc., or your vehicle approaches train
tracks or roadside objects [such as a traffic sign and guard rail] on a curve or, when
parking, stationary vehicles and walls.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
473 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Helps maintain a constant vehicle speed and a set following-interval behind a vehicle
detected ahead of yours, without you having to keep your foot on the brake or the
accelerator.
1Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
3 WARNING
Improper use of ACC can lead to a crash.
When to use
The camera is located
behind the rearview
mirror.
Use ACC only when driving on expressways
or freeways and in good weather
conditions.
3 WARNING
ACC has limited braking capability.
When your vehicle speed drops below 22
mph (35 km/h), ACC will automatically
cancel and no longer will apply your
vehicle’s brakes.
Always be prepared to apply the brake
pedal when conditions require.
Driving
The radar sensor is in the front
grille.
■ Vehicle speed for adaptive cruise control: Desired speed in
a range above roughly 25 mph (40 km/h) ~
■ Shift positions for adaptive cruise control: In (D or (S
Continued
473
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
474 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ How to activate the system
1Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
How to use
ACC is on in the multiinformation display.
Adaptive cruise control is
ready to use.
Important Reminder
As with any system, there are limits to ACC. Use the
brake pedal whenever necessary, and always keep a
safe interval between your vehicle and other vehicles.
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
For directions on the proper handling of the radar
sensor, refer to the following page.
2 Radar Sensor P. 502
Driving
474
■ Press the MAIN button on
the steering wheel.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
475 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ To Set the Vehicle Speed
1Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
ACC may not work properly under certain conditions.
2 ACC Conditions and Limitations P. 478
–/SET Button
When not using ACC: Turn off adaptive cruise by
pressing the MAIN button. This also will turn off the
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS).
When the MAIN button is pressed, both ACC and
the Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) are either
turned on or off.
On when adaptive cruise control begins
Press and release
Continued
Driving
Take your foot off the pedal and press down the –/SET button when you reach the
desired speed. The moment you release the button, the set speed is fixed, and ACC
begins.
Set Vehicle
Set Vehicle When ACC starts operating, the vehicle icon,
Speed
Interval interval bars and set speed appear on the
multi-information display.
Do not use ACC under the following conditions:
• On roads with heavy traffic or while driving in
continuous stop and go traffic.
• On roads with sharp turns.
• On roads with steep downhill sections, as the set
vehicle speed can be exceeded by coasting. In such
cases, ACC will not apply the brakes to maintain
the set speed.
• On roads with toll collection facilities or other
objects between lanes of traffic, or in parking
areas, or facilities with drive through access.
475
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
476 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ When in Operation
1When in Operation
■ There is a vehicle ahead
ACC monitors if a vehicle ahead of you enters the ACC range. If a vehicle is detected
doing so, the ACC system maintains or decelerates your vehicle’s set speed in order
to keep the vehicle’s set following-interval from the vehicle ahead.
If the vehicle ahead of you slows down abruptly, or if
another vehicle cuts in front of you, the beeper
sounds, a message appears on the multi-information
display.
2 To Set or Change Following-interval P. 481
ACC Range: 394 ft. (120 m)
Driving
When a vehicle whose speed is slower than
your set speed is detected in front of you, your
vehicle starts to slow down.
A vehicle icon appears on the
multi-information display.
476
Depress the brake pedal, and keep an appropriate
interval from the vehicle ahead.
Beep
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
477 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ There is no vehicle ahead
1When in Operation
Your vehicle maintains the set speed without
having to keep your foot on the brake or
accelerator pedal.
If there previously was a vehicle detected
ahead that kept your vehicle from traveling at
the set speed, ACC accelerates your vehicle to
the set speed, and then maintains it.
A vehicle icon with dotted-line
contour appears on the multiinformation display.
Continued
You can also set the system to beep when a vehicle in
front of you comes in and goes out of the ACC
detecting range. Change the ACC Forward Vehicle
Detect Beep setting.
2 Customized Features P. 123
Limitations
You may need to use the brake to maintain a safe
interval when using ACC. Additionally, ACC may not
work properly under certain conditions.
2 ACC Conditions and Limitations P. 478
Driving
■ When you depress the accelerator pedal
You can temporarily increase the vehicle speed. In this case, there is no audible or
visual alert even if a vehicle is in the ACC range.
ACC stays on unless you cancel it. Once you release the accelerator pedal, the
system resumes an appropriate speed for keeping the following-interval while a
vehicle ahead is within the ACC range.
Even if the interval between your vehicle and the
vehicle detected ahead is short, ACC may start
accelerating your vehicle under the following
circumstances:
• The vehicle ahead of you is going at almost the
same speed as, or faster than, your vehicle.
• A vehicle that cuts in front of you is going faster
than your vehicle, gradually increasing the interval
between the vehicles.
477
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
478 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ ACC Conditions and Limitations
The system may automatically shut off and the ACC indicator will come on under
certain conditions. Some examples of these conditions are listed below. Other
conditions may reduce some of the ACC functions.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
■ Environmental conditions
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
■ Roadway conditions
Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks, reflected
lights, road spray, high contrast).
■ Vehicle conditions
Driving
478
• The outside of the windshield is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
• An abnormal tire or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tire, etc.).
• The camera temperature gets too high.
• The parking brake is applied.
• When the front grille is dirty.
• The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
• When tire chains are installed.
1ACC Conditions and Limitations
If you need the radar sensor to be repaired, or
removed, or the radar sensor cover is strongly
impacted, turn off the system by pressing the MAIN
button and take your vehicle to a dealer.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
479 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ Detection limitations
•
•
•
•
A vehicle suddenly crosses in front of you.
The interval between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead of you is too short.
A vehicle cuts in front of you at a slow speed, and it brakes suddenly.
When you accelerate rapidly and approach the vehicle ahead of you at high
speed.
• The vehicle ahead of you is a motorcycle, bicycle, mobility scooter, or other small
vehicle.
• When there are animals in front of your vehicle.
• When you drive on a curved or winding or undulating road that makes it difficult
for the sensor to properly detect a vehicle in front of you.
Driving
• The speed difference between your vehicle and a vehicle in front of you is
significantly large.
• An oncoming vehicle suddenly comes in front of you.
• Your vehicle abruptly crosses over in front of an oncoming vehicle.
Continued
479
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
480 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
• When driving through a narrow iron bridge.
• When the vehicle ahead of you brakes suddenly.
• When the vehicle ahead of you has a unique shape.
Radar detects upper section of
an empty carrier truck.
Panel truck,
tanker truck, etc.
Driving
• When your vehicle or the vehicle ahead of you is driving on one edge of the lane.
480
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
481 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
1To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
Increase or decrease the vehicle speed using the RES/+ or –/SET buttons on the
steering wheel.
If a vehicle detected ahead is going at a speed slower
than your increased set speed, ACC may not
accelerate your vehicle. This is to maintain the set
interval between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead.
To increase speed
You can switch the displayed set speed
measurements on the multi-information display
between mph and km/h.
2 Customized Features P. 123
To decrease speed
Driving
• Each time you press the button, the vehicle speed is increased or decreased by
about 1 mph or 1 km/h accordingly.
• If you keep the button pressed, the vehicle speed increases or decreases by about
5 mph or 5 km/h accordingly.
■ To Set or Change Following-interval
Interval Button
Press the (interval) button to change the
ACC following-interval.
Each time you press the button, the followinginterval (the interval behind a vehicle detected
ahead of you) setting cycles through short,
middle, long, and extra long followingintervals.
Continued
481
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
482 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Determine the most appropriate following-interval setting based on your specific
driving conditions. Be sure to adhere to any following-interval requirements set by
local regulation.
The higher your vehicle’s following-speed is, the longer the short, middle, long or
extra long following-interval becomes. See the following examples for your
reference.
When the Set Speed is:
Vehicle Interval
Driving
482
50 mph (80 km/h)
65 mph (104 km/h)
Short
86.7 feet
26.4 meters
1.2 sec
100.5 feet
30.6 meters
1.1 sec
Middle
112.9 feet
34.4 meters
1.5 sec
137.4 feet
41.9 meters
1.5 sec
Long
157.2 feet
47.9 meters
2.2 sec
200.0 feet
61.0 meters
2.1 sec
Extra
Long
220.2 feet
67.1 meters
3.0 sec
282.7 feet
86.2 meters
3.0 sec
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
483 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ To Cancel
1To Cancel
MAIN
Button
To cancel ACC, do any of the following:
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the MAIN button.
u ACC indicator (green) goes off.
• Depress the brake pedal.
CANCEL
Button
Continued
The set speed cannot be set or resumed when ACC
has been turned off using the MAIN button. Press
the MAIN button to activate the system, then set the
desired speed.
1Automatic cancellation
Even though ACC has been automatically canceled,
you can still resume the prior set speed. Wait until the
condition that caused ACC to cancel improves, then
press the RES/+ button.
Driving
■ Automatic cancellation
The beeper sounds and a message appears on the multi-information display when
ACC is automatically canceled. Any of these conditions may cause the ACC to
automatically cancel:
• Bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
• When the radar sensor in the front grille gets dirty.
• The vehicle ahead of you cannot be detected.
• An abnormal tire condition is detected, or the tires are skidding.
• Driving on a mountainous road, or driving off road for extended periods.
• Abrupt steering wheel movement.
• When the ABS or VSA® or CMBSTM is activated.
• When the ABS or VSA® system indicator comes on.
• When you manually apply the parking brake.
• When the detected vehicle within the ACC range is too close to your vehicle.
• The camera behind the rearview mirror, or the area around the camera, including
the windshield, gets dirty.
Resuming the prior set speed: After you have
canceled ACC, you can resume the prior set speed
while it is still displayed. Press the RES/+ button
when driving at a speed of at least 25 mph (40 km/h)
or more.
483
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
484 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ To Switch ACC to Cruise Control
ACC ON
Cruise
Control ON
Press and hold the
(interval) button for one
second. Cruise Mode Selected appears on
the multi-information display for two seconds,
and then the mode switches to Cruise.
To switch back to ACC, press and hold the
(interval) button again for one second. ACC
Mode Selected appears on the multiinformation display for two seconds.
■ When to use
Desired speed in a range above roughly 25 mph (40 km/h) ~.
Driving
484
1To Switch ACC to Cruise Control
Always be aware which mode you are in. When you
are driving in Cruise mode, the system will not assist
you to maintain a following interval from a vehicle
ahead of you.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
485 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ To Set the Vehicle Speed
1To Cancel
Take your foot off the pedal and press the –/SET button when you reach the desired
speed.
The moment you release the –/SET button, the set speed is fixed, and cruise control
begins. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator comes on.
Resuming the prior set speed:
After cruise control has been canceled, you can still
resume the prior set speed by pressing the RES/+
button while driving at a speed of at least 25 mph (40
km/h) or more.
■ To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
You cannot set or resume in the following situations:
• When vehicle speed is less than 25 mph (40 km/h)
• When the MAIN button is turned off.
Each time you press the RES/+ or –/SET button, the vehicle speed is increased or
decreased by about 1 mph (1 km/h).
If you keep the RES/+ or –/SET button pressed, the vehicle speed increases or
decreases by about 5 mph or 5 km/h accordingly.
At vehicle speeds of 22 mph (35 km/h) or less, cruise
control canceled automatically.
■ To Cancel
Driving
To cancel cruise control, do any of the following:
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the MAIN button.
• Depress the brake pedal.
The CRUISE CONTROL indicator goes off.
485
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
486 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
Provides steering input to help keep the vehicle in the middle of a detected lane and
provides tactile and visual alerts if the vehicle is detected drifting out of its lane.
■ Steering input assist
The system applies torque to the steering to keep the vehicle between the left and
right lane lines. The applied torque becomes stronger as the vehicle gets closer to
either of the lane lines.
■ Front sensor camera
Monitors the lane lines
■ Tactile and visual alerts
Rapid vibrations on the steering wheel
and a warning display alert you that the
vehicle is drifting out of a detected lane.
1Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
Important Safety Reminders
The LKAS is for your convenience only. It is not a
substitute for your vehicle control. The system does
not work if you take your hands off the steering
wheel or fail to steer the vehicle.
2 Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages * P. 100
Do not place objects on the instrument panel.
Objects may reflect on the front windshield and
prevent correct detection of the traffic lanes.
Driving
The LKAS only alerts you when lane drift is detected
without a turn signal in use. The LKAS may not detect
all lane markings or lane departures; accuracy will
vary based on weather, speed, and lane marker
condition. It is always your responsibility to safely
operate the vehicle and avoid collisions.
The LKAS is convenient when it is used on freeways.
The LKAS may not work properly or may work
improperly under the certain conditions:
2 LKAS Conditions and Limitations P. 492
When you operate the turn signals to change lanes, the system is suspended, and
resumes after the signals are off.
If you make a lane change without operating the turn signals, the LKAS alerts
activate, and torque is applied to the steering.
486
* Not available on all models
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
When it fails to detect lanes, the system will
temporarily be canceled. When lane is detected,
system will recover automatically.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
487 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ Lane Keep Support Function
1Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
Provides assistance to keep the vehicle in the center of the lane. When the vehicle
nears a white or yellow line, steering force of the electric power steering will become
stronger.
When the vehicle enters the warning area, the LKAS alerts you with slight steering
wheel vibration as well as a warning display.
Driving
■ Lane Departure Warning Function
The LKAS may not function as designed while driving
in frequent stop and go traffic, or on roads with
sharp curves.
Warning Area
Warning Area
Continued
487
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
488 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ When the System can be Used
The system can be used when the following conditions are met.
• The lane in which you are driving has detectable lane markers on both sides, and
your vehicle is in the center of the lane.
• The vehicle speed is traveling between about 45 and 90 mph (72 and 145 km/h).
• You are driving on a straight or slightly curved road.
• The turn signals are off.
• The brake pedal is not depressed.
• The wipers are not in high speed operation.
■ How to activate the system
MAIN Button
Driving
LKAS
Button
488
1. Press the MAIN button.
u The LKAS indicator comes on in the
multi-information display.
The system is ready to use.
2. Press the LKAS button.
u Lane outlines appear on the multiinformation display.
The system is activated.
1Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
If the vehicle drifts toward either left or right lane line
due to the system applying torque, turn off the LKAS
and have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
489 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
3. Keep your vehicle near the center of the
lane while driving.
u The dotted outer lines change to solid
ones once the system starts operating
after detecting the left and right lane
markings.
1To Cancel
Pressing the MAIN button also turns ACC on and off.
■ To Cancel
MAIN Button
The LKAS is turned off every time you stop the
engine, even if you turned it on the last time
you drove the vehicle.
Continued
Driving
LKAS Button
To cancel the LKAS:
Press the MAIN or LKAS button.
489
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
490 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ The system operation is suspended if
When the LKAS is suspended,
the lane lines on the multiinformation display change to
contour lines, and the beeper
sounds (if activated).
Driving
490
you:
• Set the wipers to HI.
u Turning the wipers off or setting it to LO
resumes the LKAS.
• Decrease the vehicle speed to about 40
mph (64 km/h) or less.
u Increasing the vehicle speed to about 45
mph (72 km/h) or more resumes the
LKAS.
• Depress the brake pedal.
u The LKAS resumes and starts detecting
the lane lines again once you release the
brake pedal.
Models with automatic intermittent wipers
• Set the wiper switch to AUTO and the
wipers operate at high speed.
u The LKAS resumes when the wipers stop
or operate at low speed.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
491 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ The LKAS may automatically be suspended when:
•
•
•
•
•
The system fails to detect lane lines.
The steering wheel is quickly turned.
You fail to steer the vehicle.
Driving through a sharp curve.
Driving at a speed in excess of approximately 90 mph (145 km/h).
Once these conditions no longer exist, the LKAS automatically resumes.
■ The LKAS may automatically be canceled when:
• The camera temperature gets extremely high.
• The camera behind the rearview mirror, or the area around the camera, including
the windshield, gets dirty.
• The ABS or VSA® system engages.
Driving
The beeper sounds if the LKAS is automatically canceled.
Continued
491
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
492 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ LKAS Conditions and Limitations
The system may not detect lane markings and therefore may not keep the vehicle in
the middle of a lane under certain conditions, including the following:
■ Environmental conditions
Driving
492
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
There is little contrast between lane lines and the roadway surface.
Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
Driving in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
Shadows of adjacent objects are parallel to lane markings.
Roadway objects or structures are misinterpreted as lane markers.
Reflections on the interior of the windshield.
Driving at night or in a dark condition such as a tunnel.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
493 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ Roadway conditions
• Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks,
reflected lights, road spray, high contrast).
• Driving on a road with temporary lane markings.
• Faint, multiple, or varied lane markings are visible on the roadway due to road
repairs or old lane markings.
Faded lines
Duplicate lines
Tire tracks
Driving
• The roadway has merging, split, or crossing lines (e.g., such as at an intersection
or crosswalk).
• The lane markings are extremely narrow, wide, or changing.
Very wide or narrow traffic lane
Continued
493
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
494 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
•
•
•
•
The vehicle in front of you is driving near the lane lines.
The road is hilly or the vehicle is approaching the crest of a hill.
Driving on rough or unpaved roads, or over bumpy surfaces.
When objects on the road (curb, guard rail, pylons, etc.) are recognized as white
lines (or yellow lines).
• Driving on roads with double lines.
Lane void of lines at junction
Driving
494
■ Vehicle conditions
• Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
• The outside of the windshield is streaked or blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet
snow, etc.
• The inside of the windshield is fogged.
• The camera temperature gets too high.
• An abnormal tire or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tire, etc.).
• The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
495 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uRoad Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
Alerts and helps to assist you when the system detects a possibility of your vehicle
unintentionally crossing over detected lane markings and/or leaving the roadway
altogether.
■ How the System Works
The front camera behind the rearview mirror
monitors left and right lane markings (in white
or yellow). If your vehicle is getting too close
to detected lane markings without a turn
signal activated, the system, in addition to a
visual alert, applies steering torque and alerts
you with rapid vibrations on the steering
wheel, to help you remain within the detected
lane.
2 Customized Features P. 123
If the system determines that its steering input
is insufficient to keep your vehicle on the
roadway, it may apply braking.
u Braking is applied only when the lane
markings are solid continuous lines.
The system cancels assisting operations when you turn the steering wheel to avoid
crossing over detected lane markings.
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, the RDM system has
limitations.
Over-reliance on the RDM system may result in a
collision. It is always your responsibility to keep the
vehicle within your driving lane.
The RDM system only alerts you when lane drift is
detected without a turn signal in use. The RDM
system may not detect all lane markings or lane or
roadway departures; accuracy will vary based on
weather, speed and lane marker condition. It is
always your responsibility to safely operate the
vehicle and avoid collisions.
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 500
Driving
As a visual alert, the Lane Departure
message appears on the multi-information
display.
1Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
The RDM system may not work properly or may work
improperly under the certain conditions:
2 RDM Conditions and Limitations P. 498
There are times when you may not notice RDM
functions due to your operation of the vehicle, or
road surface conditions.
If the system operates several times without detecting driver response, the system
beeps to alert you.
Continued
495
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
496 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uRoad Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
■ How the System Activates
The system becomes ready to start searching for lane markings when all the
following conditions are met:
• The vehicle is traveling between about 45 and 90 mph (72 and 145 km/h).
• The vehicle is on a straight or slightly curved road.
• The turn signals are off.
• The brake pedal is not depressed.
• The wipers are not in continuous operation.
• The vehicle is not accelerating or braking, and the steering wheel is not being
turned.
• The system makes a determination that the driver is not actively accelerating,
braking or steering.
1Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
If LKAS is off and you have selected Narrow from the
customized options using the multi-information
display, the message below will appear in case the
system determines a possibility of your vehicle
crossing over detected lane markings.
2 Customized Features P. 123
Driving
1How the System Activates
The RDM system may automatically shut off and the
indicator comes and stays on.
2 Indicators P. 80
RDM system function can be impacted when the
vehicle is:
• Not driven within a traffic lane.
• Driven on the inside edge of a curve, or outside of
a lane.
• Driven in a narrow lane.
496
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
497 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uRoad Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
■ RDM On and Off
RDM Button
1RDM On and Off
Press the RDM button to turn the system on
and off.
u The indicator in the button comes on and
the message appears on the multiinformation display when the system is
on.
When you have selected Warning Only from the
customized options using the multi-information
display, the system does not operate the steering
wheel and braking.
2 Customized Features P. 123
Indicator
Driving
Continued
497
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
498 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uRoad Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
■ RDM Conditions and Limitations
The system may not properly detect lane markings and the position of your vehicle
under certain conditions. Some examples of these conditions are listed below.
■ Environmental conditions
Driving
498
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
There is little contrast between lane lines and the roadway surface.
Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
Driving in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
Shadows of adjacent objects are parallel to lane markings.
Roadway objects or structures are misinterpreted as lane markers.
Reflections on the interior of the windshield.
Driving at night or in a dark condition such as a tunnel.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
499 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uRoad Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
■ Roadway conditions
• Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks,
reflected lights, road spray, high contrast).
• Driving on a road with temporary lane markings.
• Faint, multiple, or varied lane markings are visible on the roadway due to road
repairs or old lane markings.
• The roadway has merging, split, or crossing lines (e.g., such as at an intersection
or crosswalk).
• The lane markings are extremely narrow, wide, or changing.
• The vehicle in front of you is driving near the lane lines.
• The road is hilly or the vehicle is approaching the crest of a hill.
• Driving on rough or unpaved roads, or over bumpy surfaces.
• When objects on the road (curb, guard rail, pylons, etc.) are recognized as white
lines (or yellow lines).
• Driving on roads with double lines.
Driving
■ Vehicle conditions
• Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
• The outside of the windshield is streaked or blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet
snow, etc.
• The inside of the windshield is fogged.
• The camera temperature gets too high.
• An abnormal tire or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tire, etc.).
• The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
• When tire chains are installed.
499
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
500 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uFront Sensor Camera
Front Sensor Camera
The camera, used in systems such as LKAS, RDM, ACC, and CMBSTM, is designed to
detect an object that triggers any of the systems to operate its functions.
■ Camera Location and Handling Tips
Front Sensor
Camera
Driving
500
This camera is located behind the rearview
mirror.
To help reduce the likelihood that high interior
temperatures will cause the camera’s sensing
system to shut off, when parking, find a shady
area or face the front of the vehicle away from
the sun. If you use a reflective sun shade, do
not allow it to cover the camera housing.
Covering the camera can concentrate heat on
it.
1Front Sensor Camera
Never apply a film or attach any objects to the
windshield, the hood, or the front grille that could
obstruct the camera’s field of vision and cause the
system to operate abnormally.
Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the windshield
within the camera’s field of vision can cause the
system to operate abnormally. If this occurs, we
recommend that you replace the windshield with a
genuine Honda replacement windshield. Making
even minor repairs within the camera’s field of vision
or installing an aftermarket replacement windshield
may also cause the system to operate abnormally.
After replacing the windshield, have a dealer
recalibrate the camera. Proper calibration of the
camera is necessary for the system to operate
properly.
Do not place an object on the top of the instrument
panel. It may reflect onto the windshield and prevent
the system from detecting lane lines properly.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
501 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uFront Sensor Camera
1Front Sensor Camera
If the Some Driver Assist Systems Cannot
Operate: Camera Temperature Too High message
appears:
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, also use defroster mode
with the airflow directed towards the camera.
• Start driving the vehicle to lower the windshield
temperature, which cools down the area around
the camera.
Driving
If the Some Driver Assist Systems Cannot
Operate: Clean Front Windshield message
appears:
• Park your vehicle in a safe place, and clean the
windshield. If the message does not disappear after
you have cleaned the windshield and driven for a
while, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
501
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
502 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuHonda Sensing® * uRadar Sensor
Radar Sensor
The radar sensor is in the front grille.
1Radar Sensor
Avoid strong impacts to the radar sensor cover.
Radar
Sensor
The radar sensor is in
the front grille.
For the CMBSTM to work properly:
• Always keep the radar sensor cover clean.
• Never use chemical solvents or polishing powder
for cleaning the sensor cover. Clean it with water
or a mild detergent.
• Do not put a sticker on the radar sensor cover or
replace the radar sensor cover.
If you need the radar sensor to be repaired, or
removed, or the radar sensor cover is strongly
impacted, turn off the system by using the CMBS OFF
button and take your vehicle to a dealer.
2 CMBSTM On and Off P. 466
Driving
502
If the vehicle is involved in any of the following
situations, the radar sensor may not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer:
• Your vehicle is involved in a frontal collision.
• Your vehicle drives through deep water or is
submerged in deep water.
• Your vehicle strongly strikes a bump, curb, chock,
or embankment that could jar the radar sensor.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
503 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Braking
Brake System
■ Parking Brake
1Parking Brake
Use the parking brake to keep the vehicle stationary when parked. When the
parking brake is applied, you can manually or automatically release it.
■ To apply
The electric parking brake can be applied any
time the vehicle has battery, no matter which
position the ignition switch*1 is in.
Electric Parking
Brake Switch
Manually releasing the parking brake using
the switch helps your vehicle start slowly and
smoothly when facing downhill on steep hills.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
The brake pedal may slightly move due to the electric
parking brake system operation when you apply or
release the parking brake. This is normal.
You cannot apply or release the parking brake if the
battery goes dead.
2 Jump Starting P. 594
If you pull up and hold the electric parking brake
switch while driving, the brakes on all four
wheels are applied by the VSA system until the
vehicle comes to a stop. The electric parking
brake then applies, and the switch should be
released.
Driving
Electric Parking
Brake Switch
Pull the electric parking brake switch up gently
and securely.
u The electric parking brake indicator
comes on.
■ To release
The ignition switch must be ON (w *1 in order
to release the electric parking brake.
1. Depress the brake pedal.
2. Press the electric parking brake switch.
u The electric parking brake indicator goes
off.
You may hear the electric parking brake system
operating from the rear wheel area when you apply
or release the parking brake. This is normal.
In the following situations, the parking brake
automatically operates.
• When the vehicle stops with the automatic brake
hold system activated for more than 10 minutes.
• When the driver’s seat belt is unfastened while
your vehicle is stopped and the brake hold system
is applied.
• When the engine is turned off while the brake hold
system is applied.
• When there is a problem with the brake hold
system.
503
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
504 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBrakinguBrake System
■ To release automatically
Use the accelerator pedal to release the brake when you are starting the vehicle
facing uphill, or in a traffic jam.
Depressing the accelerator pedal releases the parking brake.
Gently depress the accelerator pedal.
When on a hill, it may require more
accelerator input to release.
u The electric parking brake indicator goes
off.
Accelerator Pedal
Driving
504
1Parking Brake
If the parking brake cannot be released
automatically, release it manually.
When the vehicle is traveling uphill, the accelerator
pedal may need to be pressed farther to
automatically release the electric parking brake.
The parking brake cannot be released automatically
while the following indicators are on:
• Malfunction indicator lamp
• Transmission indicator
The parking brake may not be released automatically
while the following indicators are on:
• Electric parking brake system indicator
• VSA® system indicator
• ABS indicator
• Supplemental restraint system indicator
The parking brake is applied while the vehicle is
moving with the electric parking brake switch being
pulled.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
505 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBrakinguBrake System
You can release the parking brake automatically when:
• You are wearing the driver’s seat belt.
• The engine is running.
• The transmission is not in (P or (N .
1Foot Brake
Check the brakes after driving through deep water,
or if there is a buildup of road surface water. If
necessary, dry the brakes by lightly depressing the
pedal several times.
■ Foot Brake
Your vehicle is equipped with disc brakes at all four wheels. A vacuum power assist
helps to reduce the effort needed on the brake pedal. The brake assist system
increases the stopping force when you depress the brake pedal hard in an
emergency situation. The anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps you retain steering
control when braking very hard.
2 Brake Assist System P. 509
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 508
If you hear a continuous metallic friction sound when
applying the brakes, this is caused by the brake wear
indicator rubbing on the brake rotor and indicates
that the brake pads need to be replaced. Have the
vehicle checked by a dealer. If you hear only an
occasional squeak or squeal when you initially apply
the brake pedal, this may be normal and caused by
high frequency vibration of the brake pads against
the rotating brake disc.
Driving
Constantly using the brake pedal while going down a
long hill builds up heat, which reduces the brake
effectiveness. Apply engine braking by taking your
foot off the accelerator pedal and downshifting to a
lower speed position.
Do not rest your foot on the brake pedal while
driving, as it will lightly apply the brakes and cause
them to lose effectiveness over time and reduce pad
life. It will also confuse drivers behind you.
Continued
505
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
506 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBrakinguBrake System
■ Automatic Brake Hold
1Automatic Brake Hold
Keeps the brake applied after releasing the brake pedal until the accelerator pedal is
pressed. You can use this system while the vehicle is temporarily stopped, like at
traffic lights and in heavy traffic.
■ Turning on the system
■ Activating the system
Comes
On
On
On
Comes
On
Goes
Off
U.S.
Automatic Brake
Hold Button
Driving
506
Fasten your seat belt
properly, then start the
engine. Press the
automatic brake hold
button.
● The automatic brake
hold system indicator
comes on. The system
is turned on.
Brake Pedal
■ Canceling the system
Comes
On
Accelerator Pedal
Canada
Depress the brake pedal
to come to a complete
stop. The shift lever must
be in other than (P or (R .
● The automatic brake
hold indicator comes
on. Braking is kept for
up to 10 minutes.
● Release the brake pedal
after the automatic
brake hold indicator
comes on.
Depress the accelerator
pedal while the shift
lever is in other than (P
or (N . The system is
canceled and the vehicle
starts to move.
● The automatic brake
hold indicator goes
off. The system
releases the brake
automatically.
3 WARNING
Activating the automatic brake hold system
on steep hills or slippery roads may still
allow the vehicle to move if you remove
your foot from the brake pedal.
If a vehicle unexpectedly moves, it may
cause a crash resulting in serious injury or
death.
Never activate the automatic brake hold
system or rely on it to keep a vehicle from
moving when stopped on a steep hill or
slippery roads.
3 WARNING
Using the automatic brake hold system to
park the vehicle may result in the vehicle
unexpectedly moving.
If a vehicle moves unexpectedly, it may
cause a crash, resulting in serious injury or
death.
Never leave the vehicle when braking is
temporarily kept by automatic brake hold
and always park the vehicle by putting the
transmission in (P and applying the parking
brake.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
507 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBrakinguBrake System
■ The system automatically cancels when:
• You engage the parking brake.
• You depress the brake pedal and move the shift lever to (P or (R .
■ The system automatically cancels and the parking brake is applied when:
•
•
•
•
Braking is kept for more than 10 minutes.
The driver’s seat belt is unfastened.
The engine is turned off.
There is a problem with automatic brake hold system.
■ Turning off the automatic brake hold system
Automatic Brake
Hold Button
If you want to turn off automatic brake hold
while the system is in operation, press the
automatic brake hold button with the brake
pedal depressed.
While the system is activated, you can turn off the
engine or park the vehicle through the same
procedure as you normally do.
2 When Stopped P. 510
Whether the system is on, or the system is activated,
the automatic brake hold turns off once the engine is
off.
1Turning on the system
Make sure to turn off the automatic brake hold
system before using an automated car wash.
You may hear an operating noise if the vehicle moves
while the automatic brake hold system is in
operation. The system generates sound while holding
the vehicle and it moves.
Driving
Goes
Off
While the system is on, press the automatic
brake hold button again.
u The automatic brake hold system
indicator goes off.
1Automatic Brake Hold
507
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
508 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBrakinguAnti-lock Brake System (ABS)
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
■ ABS
Helps prevent the wheels from locking up, and helps you retain steering control by
pumping the brakes rapidly, much faster than you.
The electronic brake distribution (EBD) system, which is part of the ABS, also
balances the front-to-rear braking distribution according to vehicle loading.
You should never pump the brake pedal. Let the ABS work for you by always
keeping firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. This is sometimes referred to as
“stomp and steer.”
■ ABS operation
Driving
The brake pedal may pulsate slightly when the ABS is working. Depress the brake
pedal and keep holding the pedal firmly down. On dry pavement, you will need to
press on the brake pedal very hard before the ABS activates. However, you may feel
the ABS activate immediately if you are trying to stop on snow or ice.
ABS may activate when you depress the brake pedal when driving on:
• Wet or snow covered roads.
• Roads paved with stone.
• Roads with uneven surfaces, such as potholes, cracks, manholes, etc.
When the vehicle speed goes under 6 mph (10 km/h), the ABS stops.
508
1Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
NOTICE
The ABS may not function correctly if you use a tire of
the wrong size or type.
If the ABS indicator comes on while driving, there
may be a problem with the system.
While normal braking will not be affected, there is a
possibility that the ABS will not be operating. Have
your vehicle checked by a dealer immediately.
The ABS is not designed for the purpose of reducing
the time or distance it takes for a vehicle to stop: It is
designed to limit brake lockup which can lead to
skidding and loss of steering control.
In the following cases, your vehicle may need more
distance to stop than a vehicle without the ABS:
• You are driving on rough or uneven road surfaces,
such as gravel or snow.
• The tires are equipped with snow chains.
The following may be observed with the ABS system:
• Motor sounds coming from the engine
compartment when the brakes are applied, or
when system checks are being performed after the
engine has been started and while the vehicle
accelerates.
• Brake pedal and/or the vehicle body vibration when
ABS activates.
These vibrations and sounds are normal to ABS
systems and are no cause for concern.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
509 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBrakinguBrake Assist System
Brake Assist System
Designed to assist the driver by generating greater braking force when you depress
the brake pedal hard during emergency braking.
■ Brake assist system operation
Press the brake pedal firmly for more powerful braking.
When brake assist operates, the pedal may wiggle slightly and an operating noise
may be heard. This is normal. Keep holding the brake pedal firmly down.
Driving
509
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
510 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped
1. Depress the brake pedal firmly.
2. With the brake pedal depressed, pull up the electric parking brake switch slowly,
but fully.
3. Move the shift lever from (D to (P .
4. Turn off the engine.
u The electric parking brake indicator goes off in about 15 seconds.
Always confirm the electric parking brake is set, in particular if you are parked on an
incline.
1Parking Your Vehicle
Do not park your vehicle near flammable objects,
such as dry grass, oil, or timber.
Heat from the exhaust can cause a fire.
1When Stopped
3 WARNING
The vehicle can roll away if left unattended
without confirming that Park is engaged.
A vehicle that rolls away could cause a crash
resulting in serious injury or death.
Always keep your foot on the brake pedal
until you have confirmed that (P is shown
on the shift position indicator.
Driving
NOTICE
The following can damage the transmission:
• Depressing the accelerator and brake pedals
simultaneously.
• Holding the vehicle in place when facing uphill by
depressing the accelerator pedal.
• Moving the shift lever into (P before the vehicle
stops completely.
In extremely cold temperatures, the parking brake
may freeze up if applied. If such temperatures are
expected, do not apply the parking brake but, if
parking on a slope, either turn the front wheels so
they will contact the curb if the vehicle rolls down the
slope or block the wheels to keep the vehicle from
moving. If you do not take either precaution, the
vehicle may roll unexpectedly, leading to a crash.
510
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
511 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Multi-View Rear Camera
About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
The audio/information screen can display your vehicle’s rear view.
The display automatically changes to a rear view when the transmission is put into
(R .
■ Multi-View Rear Camera Display Area
The rear camera view is restricted. You cannot see
the corner ends of the bumper or what is underneath
the bumper. Its unique lens also makes objects
appear closer or farther than they actually are.
Visually confirm that it is safe to drive before backing
up. Certain conditions (such as weather, lighting, and
high temperatures) may also restrict the rear view. Do
not rely on the rearview display which does not give
you all information about conditions at the back of
your vehicle.
Wide View Mode
Guidelines
Approx. 39 inches (1 m)
Approx. 20 inches (50 cm)
Camera
1About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
Normal View Mode
If the camera lens is covered with dirt or moisture,
use a soft, moist cloth to keep the lens clean and free
of debris.
Top Down View Mode
Bumper
Continued
Driving
Models with display audio system
You can change the Fixed Guideline and Dynamic
Guideline settings.
2 Customized Features P. 352
Fixed Guideline
On: Guidelines appear when you put the
transmission into (R .
Off: Guidelines do not appear.
Dynamic Guideline
On: Guidelines move according to the steering wheel
direction.
Off: Guidelines do not move.
511
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
512 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMulti-View Rear CamerauAbout Your Multi-View Rear Camera
You can view three different camera modes on the rearview display.
Models with color audio system
Press the LIST/SELECT (selector) knob to switch the mode.
Models with display audio system
Touch the appropriate icon to switch the mode.
: Wide view mode
: Normal view mode
: Top down view mode
All models
Driving
• If the last used viewing mode was Wide or Normal, the same mode is selected the
next time you put the transmission into (R .
• If Top down view was last used before you turned off the engine, Wide View
mode is selected next time you turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1 and put the
transmission into (R .
• If Top down view was last used more than 10 seconds after you put the
transmission from (R , Wide View mode is selected the next time you put the
transmission into (R .
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
512
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
513 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Refueling
Fuel Information
■ Fuel recommendation
Unleaded gasoline, pump octane number 87 or higher
Use of lower octane gasoline can cause a persistent, heavy metallic knocking noise
that can lead to engine damage.
■ Top tier detergent gasoline
Because the level of detergency and additives in gasoline vary in the market, Honda
endorses the use of “TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline” where available to help
maintain the performance and reliability of your vehicle. TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline meets a new gasoline standard jointly established by leading automotive
manufacturers to meet the needs of today’s advanced engines.
For further important fuel-related information for your vehicle, or on information on
gasoline that does not contain MMT, visit www.hondacars.com. In Canada, visit
www.honda.ca for additional information on gasoline. For more information on top
tier gasoline, visit www.toptiergas.com.
NOTICE
We recommend quality gasoline containing
detergent additives that help prevent fuel system and
engine deposits. In addition, in order to maintain
good performance, fuel economy, and emissions
control, we strongly recommend the use of gasoline
that does NOT contain harmful manganese-based
fuel additives such as MMT, if such gasoline is
available.
Use of gasoline with these additives may adversely
affect performance, and cause the malfunction
indicator lamp on your instrument panel to come on.
If this happens, contact a dealer for service.
Some gasoline today is blended with oxygenates such
as ethanol. Your vehicle is designed to operate on
oxygenated gasoline containing up to 15% ethanol
by volume. Do not use gasoline containing methanol.
If you notice any undesirable operating symptoms, try
another service station or switch to another brand of
gasoline.
Driving
Qualifying gasoline retailers will, in most cases, identify their gasoline as having met
“TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline” standards at the retail location. This fuel is
guaranteed to contain the proper level of detergent additives and be free of metallic
additives. The proper level of detergent additives, and absence of harmful metallic
additives in gasoline, help avoid build-up of deposits in your engine and emission
control system.
1Fuel Information
■ Fuel tank capacity: 13.2 US gal (50 L)
513
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
514 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuRefuelinguHow to Refuel
How to Refuel
1. Stop your vehicle with the service station
pump on the left side of the vehicle in the
rear.
2. Turn off the engine.
3. Pull on the fuel fill door release handle
under the driver’s side lower outside corner
of the dashboard.
u The fuel fill door opens.
Fuel Fill Door
Release Handle
Pull
4. Remove the fuel fill cap slowly. If you hear a
release of air, wait until this stops, then turn
the knob slowly to open the fuel fill cap.
1How to Refuel
3 WARNING
Gasoline is highly flammable and explosive.
You can be burned or seriously injured
when handling fuel.
• Stop the engine, and keep heat, sparks,
and flame away.
• Handle fuel only outdoors.
• Wipe up spills immediately.
The filler nozzle automatically stops to leave space in
the fuel tank so that fuel does not overflow as a result
of changes in air temperature.
Driving
Cap
Cap
Holder
514
5. Place the fuel fill cap in the holder.
6. Insert the fuel filler nozzle fully.
u When the tank is full, the filler nozzle will
click off automatically. This leaves space
in the fuel tank in case the fuel expands
with a change in the temperature.
7. After filling, replace the fuel fill cap,
tightening it until you hear it click at least
once.
u Shut the fuel fill door by hand.
Do not continue to add fuel after the filler nozzle has
automatically stopped. Additional fuel can exceed
the full tank capacity.
If the filler nozzle keeps turning off when the tank is
not full, there may be a problem with the pump’s fuel
vapor recovery system. Try filling at another pump. If
this does not fix the problem, consult a dealer.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
515 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Fuel Economy and CO2 Emissions
Improving Fuel Economy and Reducing CO2
Emissions
Achieving fuel economy and reducing CO2 emissions is dependent on several
factors, including driving conditions, load weight, idling time, driving habits, and
vehicle condition. Depending on these and other factors, you may not achieve the
rated fuel economy of this vehicle.
1Improving Fuel Economy and Reducing CO2 Emissions
Direct calculation is the recommended method to
determine actual fuel consumed while driving.
Miles driven
Gallons of
fuel
Miles per
Gallon
100
Liter
Kilometers
L per 100 km
■ Maintenance and Fuel Economy
You can optimize your fuel economy with proper maintenance of your vehicle.
Always maintain your vehicle in accordance with the messages displayed on the
information display.
• Use engine oil with the viscosity recommended.
In Canada, posted fuel economy numbers are
established following a simulated test. For more
information on how this test is performed, please visit
http://oee.nrcan.gc.ca/
2 Recommended Engine Oil P. 531
Driving
• Maintain the specified tire pressure.
• Do not load the vehicle with excess cargo.
• Keep your vehicle clean. A buildup of snow or mud on your vehicle’s underside
adds weight and increases wind resistance.
515
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
516
516 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
517 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Maintenance
This chapter discusses basic maintenance.
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance ............ 518
Safety When Performing Maintenance .... 519
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance
Service ........................................... 520
Maintenance MinderTM ..................... 521
Maintenance Under the Hood
Maintenance Items Under the Hood .... 529
Opening the Hood ........................... 530
Recommended Engine Oil ................ 531
Oil Check ......................................... 532
Adding Engine Oil ............................ 533
* Not available on all models
Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter..... 534
Engine Coolant ................................ 536
Transmission Fluid............................ 538
Brake Fluid....................................... 539
Refilling Window Washer Fluid......... 540
Replacing Light Bulbs ....................... 541
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades.... 551
Checking and Maintaining Tires
Checking Tires ................................. 555
Tire and Loading Information Label .. 557
Tire Labeling .................................... 557
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles).. 559
Wear Indicators................................ 561
Tire Service Life................................ 561
Tire and Wheel Replacement ........... 562
Tire Rotation.................................... 563
Winter Tires ..................................... 564
Battery............................................... 566
Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Button Battery ........... 568
Heating and Cooling System */Climate
Control System * Maintenance....... 570
Cleaning
Interior Care .................................... 571
Exterior Care.................................... 573
Accessories and Modifications ........ 576
517
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
518 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance
For your safety, perform all listed inspections and maintenance to keep your vehicle
in good condition. If you become aware of any abnormality (noise, smell, insufficient
brake fluid, oil residue on the ground, etc.), have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
(Note, however, that service at a dealer is not mandatory to keep your warranties in
effect.)
■ Types of Inspection and Maintenance
■ Daily inspections
Perform inspections before long distance trips, when washing the vehicle, or when
refueling.
■ Periodic inspections
• Check the brake fluid level monthly.
2 Brake Fluid P. 539
• Check the tire pressure monthly. Examine the tread for wear and foreign objects.
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 555
• Check the operation of the exterior lights monthly.
Maintenance
518
2 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 541
• Check the condition of the wiper blades at least every six months.
1Inspection and Maintenance
U.S. models
Maintenance, replacement, or repair of
emissions control devices and systems may be
done by any automotive repair establishment or
individuals using parts that are “certified” to
EPA standards.
According to state and federal regulations, failure to
perform maintenance on the maintenance main
items marked with # will not void your emissions
warranties. However, all maintenance services should
be performed in accordance with the intervals
indicated by the information display */multiinformation display *.
2 Maintenance Service Items P. 523, 527
If you want to perform complex maintenance tasks
that require more skills and tools, you can purchase a
subscription to the Service Express website at
www.techinfo.honda.com.
2 Authorized Manuals P. 623
2 Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 551
If you want to perform maintenance yourself, make
sure that you have the necessary tools and skills first.
After performing maintenance, update the records in
the separate maintenance booklet.
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
519 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuSafety When Performing Maintenance
Safety When Performing Maintenance
Some of the most important safety precautions are given here. However, we cannot
warn you of every conceivable hazard that can arise in performing maintenance.
Only you can decide whether you should perform a given task.
■ Maintenance Safety
• To reduce the possibility of fire or explosion, keep cigarettes, sparks, and flames
away from the battery and all fuel related parts.
• Never leave rags, towels, or other flammable objects under the hood.
u Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite them, causing a fire.
• To clean parts, use a commercially available degreaser or parts cleaner, not
gasoline.
• Wear eye protection and protective clothing when working with the battery or
compressed air.
• Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide, which is poisonous and can kill you.
u Only operate the engine if there is sufficient ventilation.
• The vehicle must be in a stationary condition.
u Make sure your vehicle is parked on level ground, the parking brake is set, and
the engine is off.
• Be aware that hot parts can burn you.
u Make sure to let the engine and exhaust system cool thoroughly before
touching vehicle parts.
• Be aware that moving parts can injure you.
u Do not start the engine unless instructed, and keep your hands and limbs away
from moving parts.
3 WARNING
Improperly maintaining this vehicle or
failing to correct a problem before driving
can cause a crash in which you can be
seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspection and
maintenance recommendations according
to the schedules in this owner’s manual.
3 WARNING
Failure to properly follow maintenance
instructions and precautions can cause you
to be seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the procedures and
precautions in this owner’s manual.
Maintenance
■ Vehicle Safety
1Safety When Performing Maintenance
519
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
520 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuParts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
The use of Honda genuine parts and fluids is recommended when maintaining and
servicing your vehicle. Honda genuine parts are manufactured according to the
same high quality standards used in Honda vehicles.
Maintenance
520
1Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
NOTICE
Do not press the engine cover forcibly. This may
damage the engine cover and component parts.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
521 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Maintenance MinderTM
If the engine oil life is less than 15%, you will see the Maintenance Minder messages
appear on the information display or the multi-information display every time you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1. The messages notify you when to change the
engine oil, or when to bring your vehicle to a dealer for indicated maintenance
services.
Models with information display
To Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Displaying the Engine Oil Life
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w .
2. Press the
(select/reset) knob repeatedly
until the engine oil life appears on the
information display.
Based on the engine operating conditions, the
remaining engine oil life is calculated and displayed
as a percentage.
Displayed Engine Oil
Life (%)
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
5
0
Calculated Engine Oil
Life (%)
100 to 91
90 to 81
80 to 71
70 to 61
60 to 51
50 to 41
40 to 31
30 to 21
20 to 16
15 to 11
10 to 6
5 to 1
0
Maintenance
The Maintenance Minder indicator (
) stays
on in the instrument panel after the engine oil
life becomes 0%. Have the indicated
maintenance done by a dealer immediately.
1Displaying the Engine Oil Life
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
521
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
522 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Maintenance Minder Messages on the Information Display
To switch the display, press the
Oil Life Display
(select/reset) knob.
Explanation
Information
The engine oil life indicator starts
to appear along with other due
soon maintenance item codes
when the remaining oil life
becomes 15 percent.
The engine oil is approaching the
end of its service life.
The remaining engine oil life has
passed its service life, and a
negative distance appears after
driving over 10 miles. The negative
distance on the display blinks.
The engine oil life has passed.
The maintenance items must be
inspected and serviced
immediately.
Maintenance Minder Indicator
Starts to come on when the
remaining engine oil life becomes
15 percent.
It goes off when the display is
The SERVICE message also starts The engine oil has almost reached switched.
to appear along with the engine oil the end of its service life, and the
life indicator and the maintenance maintenance items should be
inspected and serviced as soon as
item codes.
possible.
Maintenance
522
Stays on as a reminder even when
the display is switched.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
523 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Maintenance Service Items
Maintenance
Minder Indicator
1Maintenance Service Items
• Independent of the Maintenance Minder
Maintenance Minder Message
Main Item
information, replace the brake fluid every 3 years.
• Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 if
they are noisy.
Sub Items
*1: If a message SERVICE does not appear more than 12 months after the display is reset, change the
engine oil every year.
# : See information on maintenance and emissions warranty.
* Not available on all models
CODE
Maintenance Sub Items
1
• Rotate tires
2
• Replace air cleaner element*2
• Replace dust and pollen filter*3
• Inspect drive belt
3
• Replace transmission fluid*4
4
• Replace spark plugs
• Inspect valve clearance
5
• Replace engine coolant
6
• Replace rear differential fluid *
Maintenance
CODE
Maintenance Main Items
A
• Replace engine oil*1
B
• Replace engine oil*1 and oil filter
• Inspect front and rear brakes
• Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and boots
• Inspect suspension components
• Inspect driveshaft boots
• Inspect brake hoses and lines (Including ABS/VSA®)
• Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids
• Inspect exhaust system#
• Inspect fuel lines and connections#
*2: If you drive in dusty conditions, replace the air cleaner element every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
*3: If you drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and
from diesel-powered vehicles, replace the dust and pollen filter every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
*4: Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehicle speeds results in higher transmission temperatures.
This requires transmission fluid changes more frequently than recommended by the Maintenance
Minder. If you regularly drive your vehicle under these conditions, have the transmission fluid changed
every 25,000 miles (40,000 km).
Continued
523
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
524 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Resetting the Display
Reset the engine oil life display if you have performed the maintenance service.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w .
2. Display the engine oil life by repeatedly
pressing the
(select/reset) knob.
3. Press and hold the
knob for 10 seconds
or more.
u The engine oil life indicator and the
maintenance item codes blink.
4. Press the
knob for five seconds or more.
u The displayed maintenance items
disappear, and the engine oil life display
returns to 100%.
Maintenance
524
1Resetting the Display
NOTICE
Failure to reset the engine oil life after a maintenance
service results in the system showing incorrect
maintenance intervals, which can lead to serious
mechanical problems.
The dealer will reset the engine oil life display after
completing the required maintenance service. If
someone other than a dealer performs maintenance
service, reset the engine oil life display yourself.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
525 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
Models with multi-information display
To Use Maintenance MinderTM
1Displaying the Maintenance Minder Information
■ Displaying the Maintenance Minder Information
Maintenance items, which should be serviced at the same time that you replace the
engine oil, appear on the multi-information display.
You can view them on the engine oil life screen at any time.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Press the
(Information) button repeatedly until the engine oil life appears
on the multi-information display.
Remaining
Engine Oil
Life
Maintenance
Item Codes
Based on the engine operating conditions, the
remaining engine oil life is calculated and displayed
as a percentage.
Calculated Engine Oil
Life (%)
100 to 91
90 to 81
80 to 71
70 to 61
60 to 51
50 to 41
40 to 31
30 to 21
20 to 16
15 to 11
10 to 6
5 to 1
0
There is a list of maintenance main and sub items you
can view on the multi-information display.
2 Maintenance Service Items P. 527
Button
Maintenance
Displayed Engine Oil
Life (%)
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
5
0
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
525
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
526 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Maintenance Minder Messages on the Multi-Information
Display
Maintenance
Maintenance Message
Oil Life Display
Explanation
Information
Maintenance Due Soon
15 %
The remaining engine oil life is 15 to
6 percent. Once you switch the
display by pressing the
(Information) button, this message
will go off.
The engine oil is approaching the end
of its service life, and the maintenance
items should be inspected and serviced
soon.
Maintenance Due Now
5%
The remaining engine oil life is 5 to 1 The engine oil has almost reached the
percent. Press the
button to end of its service life, and the
maintenance items should be inspected
switch to another display.
and serviced as soon as possible.
Maintenance Past Due
Negative Distance
The system message indicator (
526
The remaining engine oil life has
The engine oil life has passed.
passed its service life, and a negative The maintenance items must be
inspected and serviced immediately.
distance appears after driving over
10 miles (U.S. models) or 10 km
(Canadian models). Press the
button to switch to another
display.
) comes on along with the Maintenance Minder message.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
527 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Maintenance Service Items
System Message
Indicator
1Maintenance Service Items
• Independent of the Maintenance Minder
Maintenance Minder
Message
they are noisy.
Main Item
*1: If a message SERVICE does not appear more than 12 months after the display is reset, change the
engine oil every year.
# : See information on maintenance and emissions warranty.
Sub Items
CODE
Maintenance Sub Items
1
• Rotate tires
2
• Replace air cleaner element*2
• Replace dust and pollen filter*3
• Inspect drive belt
3
• Replace transmission fluid*4
4
• Replace spark plugs
• Inspect valve clearance
5
• Replace engine coolant
6
• Replace rear differential fluid *
Maintenance
CODE
Maintenance Main Items
A
• Replace engine oil*1
B
• Replace engine oil*1 and oil filter
• Inspect front and rear brakes
• Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and boots
• Inspect suspension components
• Inspect driveshaft boots
• Inspect brake hoses and lines (Including ABS/VSA®)
• Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids
• Inspect exhaust system#
• Inspect fuel lines and connections#
* Not available on all models
information, replace the brake fluid every 3 years.
• Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 if
*2: If you drive in dusty conditions, replace the air cleaner element every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
*3: If you drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and
from diesel-powered vehicles, replace the dust and pollen filter every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
*4: Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehicle speeds results in higher transmission temperatures.
This requires transmission fluid changes more frequently than recommended by the Maintenance
Minder. If you regularly drive your vehicle under these conditions, have the transmission fluid changed
every 25,000 miles (40,000 km).
Continued
527
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
528 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Resetting the Display
1Resetting the Display
Reset the maintenance minder information display if you have performed the
maintenance service.
Maintenance Item Codes
(Information)
Button
SEL/RESET
Button
Engine Oil Life
Maintenance
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Press the
button to select Maintenance Info., then press the SEL/RESET
button.
3. Select Reset with the
button, then press the SEL/RESET button.
u The displayed maintenance items disappear, and the engine oil life display
returns to 100%.
To cancel the oil life reset mode, select Cancel, then press the SEL/RESET button.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
528
NOTICE
Failure to reset the Maintenance MinderTM display
after a maintenance service results in the system
showing incorrect maintenance intervals, which can
lead to serious mechanical problems.
The dealer will reset the Maintenance MinderTM
display after completing the required maintenance
service. If someone other than a dealer performs
maintenance service, reset the Maintenance
MinderTM display yourself.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
529 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Maintenance Under the Hood
Maintenance Items Under the Hood
Brake Fluid
(Black Cap)
Engine Oil Fill Cap
Engine Oil Dipstick
(Orange)
Battery
Washer Fluid
(Blue Cap)
Maintenance
Radiator Cap
Engine Coolant Reserve Tank
529
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
530 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduOpening the Hood
Opening the Hood
Hood Release Handle
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface, and set
the parking brake.
2. Pull the hood release handle under the
driver’s side lower corner of the dashboard.
u The hood will pop up slightly.
1Opening the Hood
NOTICE
Do not open the hood when the wiper arms are
raised.
The hood will strike the wipers, and may damage
either the hood or the wipers.
NOTICE
3. Push the hood latch lever (located under
the front edge of the hood to the center) to
the side and raise the hood. Once you have
raised the hood slightly, you can release the
lever.
Lever
Maintenance
Grip
Support Rod
530
Clamp
4. Remove the support rod from the clamp
using the grip. Mount the support rod in
the hood.
When closing, remove the support rod, and
stow it in the clamp, then gently lower the
hood. Remove your hand at a height of
approximately 12 inches (30 cm) and let the
hood close.
Do not press the engine cover forcibly. This may
damage the engine cover and component parts.
When closing the hood, check that the hood is
securely latched.
If the hood latch lever moves stiffly, or if you can
open the hood without lifting the lever, the latch
mechanism should be cleaned and lubricated.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
531 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduRecommended Engine Oil
Recommended Engine Oil
Use a genuine engine oil or another commercial engine oil of suitable type and
viscosity (for the ambient temperature) as shown in the image that follows.
Oil is a major contributor to your engine’s performance and longevity. If you drive
the vehicle with insufficient or deteriorated oil, the engine may fail or be damaged.
Genuine Engine Oil
• Genuine Honda Motor Oil
Commercial Engine Oil
• Premium-grade 0W-20 detergent oil
with an API Certification Seal on the
container
1Recommended Engine Oil
Engine Oil Additives
Your vehicle does not require oil additives. In fact,
they may adversely affect the engine performance
and durability.
The following seal indicates the oil is energy
conserving and that it meets the American Petroleum
Institute’s latest requirements.
0W-20
Ambient Temperature
*1:Formulated to improve fuel economy.
■ Synthetic oil
You may also use synthetic motor oil if it is labeled with the API Certification Seal
and is the specified viscosity grade.
Maintenance
Ambient Temperature
531
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
532 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduOil Check
Oil Check
We recommend that you check the engine oil level every time you refuel.
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Wait approximately three minutes after turning the engine off before you check the
oil.
1. Remove the dipstick (orange).
2. Wipe the dipstick with a clean cloth or
paper towel.
3. Insert the dipstick back all the way into its
hole.
4. Remove the dipstick again, and check the
level. It should be between the upper and
lower marks. Add oil if necessary.
Maintenance
532
Upper Mark
Lower Mark
1Oil Check
If the oil level is near or below the lower mark, slowly
add oil, being careful not to overfill.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
533 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduAdding Engine Oil
Adding Engine Oil
1. Unscrew and remove the engine oil fill cap.
2. Add oil slowly.
3. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, and tighten
it securely.
4. Wait for three minutes and recheck the
engine oil dipstick.
1Adding Engine Oil
NOTICE
Do not fill the engine oil above the upper mark.
Overfilling the engine oil may result in leaks and
engine damage.
If any oil spills, wipe it away immediately. Spilled oil
may damage the engine compartment components.
Engine Oil Fill Cap
Maintenance
533
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
534 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduChanging the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
You must change the engine oil and oil filter regularly in order to maintain the
engine’s lubrication. The engine may be damaged if they are not changed regularly.
Change the oil and filter in accordance with the maintenance message on the
information display */multi-information display *.
1. Run the engine until it reaches normal
operating temperature, and then turn the
Under
engine off.
Cover
2. Open the hood and remove the engine oil
fill cap.
2WD models
3. Remove the bolts and clips on the
undercarriage and remove the under
cover.
Bolt
Maintenance
Clip
Washer
Drain Bolt
534
* Not available on all models
All models
4. Remove the drain bolt and washer from
the bottom of the engine, and drain the
oil into a suitable container.
1Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
NOTICE
You may damage the environment if you do not
dispose of the oil in a suitable way. If you are
changing the oil by yourself, appropriately dispose of
the used oil. Put the oil in a sealed container and take
it to a recycling center. Do not throw the oil away
into a garbage can or onto the ground.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
535 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduChanging the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
Oil Filter
1Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
You will need a special wrench to replace the oil
filter. You can buy this wrench from a dealer.
When installing the new oil filter, follow the
instructions supplied with the oil filter.
Reinstall the engine oil fill cap. Start the engine. The
low oil pressure indicator should go off within five
seconds. If it does not, turn off the engine, and check
your work.
Maintenance
5. Remove the oil filter and dispose of the
remaining oil.
6. Check that the filter gasket is not stuck to
the engine contact surface.
u If it is stuck, you must detach it.
7. Wipe away dirt and dust adhering to the
contact surface of the engine block, and
install a new oil filter.
u Apply a light coat of new engine oil to
the filter gasket.
8. Put a new washer on the drain bolt, then
reinstall the drain bolt.
u Tightening torque:
30 lbf∙ft (40 N∙m, 4.0 kgf∙m)
9. Pour the recommended engine oil into the
engine.
u Engine oil change capacity (including
filter):
3.9 US qt (3.7 L)
10. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap securely and
start the engine.
11. Run the engine for a few minutes, and
then check that there is no leak from the
drain bolt or oil filter.
12. Stop the engine, wait for three minutes,
and then check the oil level on the
dipstick.
u If necessary, add more engine oil.
535
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
536 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduEngine Coolant
Engine Coolant
Specified coolant: Honda Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2
This coolant is premixed with 50% antifreeze and 50% water. Do not add any
straight antifreeze or water.
We recommend you check the engine coolant level every time you refuel. Check the
reserve tank first. If it is completely empty, also check the coolant level in the
radiator. Add the engine coolant accordingly.
1Engine Coolant
3 WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
■ Reserve Tank
MAX
MIN
1. Make sure the engine and radiator are
cool.
2. Check the amount of coolant in the reserve
tank.
u If the coolant level is below the MIN
mark, add the specified coolant until it
reaches the MAX mark.
Maintenance
Reserve Tank
3. Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
NOTICE
Genuine Honda engine coolant is a 50/50 mixture of
antifreeze and water that can withstand freezing at
temperatures as low as about -31°F (-35°C). If your
vehicle is consistently subjected to temperatures
below this, the concentration of antifreeze in the
coolant should be increased. Consult a dealer for
details.
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not available, you may
use another major brand of non-silicate coolant as a
temporary replacement. Check that it is a high quality
coolant recommended for aluminum engines.
Continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result
in corrosion, causing the cooling system to
malfunction or fail. Have the cooling system flushed
and refilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as
possible.
Do not add rust inhibitors or other additives to your
vehicle’s cooling system. They may not be compatible
with the coolant or with the engine components.
536
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
537 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduEngine Coolant
■ Radiator
Radiator Cap
1Radiator
1. Make sure the engine and radiator are
cool.
2. Turn the radiator cap 1/8 turn counterclockwise and relieve any pressure in the
cooling system. Do not push the cap down
when turning.
3. Push down and turn the radiator cap
counter-clockwise to remove it.
4. The coolant level should be up to the base
of the filler neck. Add coolant if it is low.
5. Put the radiator cap back on, and tighten it
fully.
NOTICE
Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill
any. Clean up any spills immediately; they can
damage components in the engine compartment.
Maintenance
537
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
538 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduTransmission Fluid
Transmission Fluid
■ Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) Fluid
Specified fluid: Honda HCF-2
Have a dealer check the fluid level and replace if necessary.
Do not attempt to check or change the continuously variable transmission fluid
yourself.
Maintenance
538
1Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) Fluid
NOTICE
Do not mix HCF-2 with other transmission fluids
Using a transmission fluid other than HCF-2 may
adversely affect the operation and durability of your
vehicle's transmission, and damage the transmission.
Any damage caused by using a transmission fluid that
is not equivalent to HCF-2 is not covered by Honda's
new vehicle limited warranty.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
539 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduBrake Fluid
Brake Fluid
Specified fluid: Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3
NOTICE
■ Checking the Brake Fluid
The fluid level should be between the MIN
and MAX marks on the side of the reserve
tank.
MAX
MIN
1Brake Fluid
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is not compatible with your
vehicle’s braking system and can cause extensive
damage.
If the specified brake fluid is not available, you should
use only DOT 3 or DOT 4 fluid from a sealed
container as a temporary replacement.
Using any non-Honda brake fluid can cause corrosion
and decrease the longevity of the system. Have the
brake system flushed and refilled with Honda Heavy
Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 as soon as possible.
If the brake fluid level is at or below the MIN mark,
have a dealer inspect the vehicle for leaks or worn
brake pads as soon as possible.
Maintenance
539
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
540 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduRefilling Window Washer Fluid
Refilling Window Washer Fluid
Window Washer
Reservoir
Models without washer level sensor
Check the amount of window washer fluid by
looking at the reservoir.
If the level is low, fill the washer reservoir.
Canadian models
If the washer fluid is low, a message appears
on the multi-information display.
Pour the washer fluid carefully. Do not overflow the reservoir.
Maintenance
540
1Refilling Window Washer Fluid
NOTICE
Do not use engine antifreeze or a vinegar/water
solution in the window washer reservoir.
Antifreeze can damage your vehicle’s paint. A
vinegar/water solution can damage the window
washer pump.
Use only commercially available windshield washer
fluid.
Avoid prolonged use of hard water to prevent lime
scale build up.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
541 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Replacing Light Bulbs
Headlight Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
1Headlight Bulbs
Models with halogen headlights
Models with halogen headlights
High beam headlight:
Low beam headlight:
NOTICE
60 W (HB3 for halogen bulb type)
55 W (H11 for halogen bulb type)
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit.
Oil, perspiration, or a scratch on the glass can cause
the bulb to overheat and shatter.
Models with LED headlights
High beam headlight:
Low beam headlight:
LED type
LED type
All models
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the cargo area, have the aiming
readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified technician.
■ High Beam Headlights
Models with halogen headlights
1. Push the tab to remove the coupler.
2. Rotate the old bulb counter-clockwise to
remove.
3. Insert a new bulb.
4. Insert the coupler into the connector of the
bulb.
Bulb
Models with halogen headlights
When replacing a halogen bulb, handle it by its base,
and protect the glass from contact with your skin or
hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean it with
denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.
Models with LED headlights
Coupler
High beam headlights are LED type. Have an
authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the light
assembly.
Continued
Maintenance
1High Beam Headlights
Tab
541
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
542 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuHeadlight Bulbs
■ Low Beam Headlights
1Low Beam Headlights
Models with LED headlights
Models with halogen headlights
1. Push the tab to remove the coupler.
2. Rotate the old bulb counter-clockwise to
remove.
3. Insert a new bulb.
4. Insert the coupler into the connector of the
bulb.
Bulb
Tab
Coupler
Maintenance
542
Low beam headlights are LED type. Have an
authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the light
assembly.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
543 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuFront Turn Signal Light Bulbs
Front Turn Signal Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Front Turn Signal Light: 28/8 W (Amber)
Front Turn Signal Light: LED type *
1Front Turn Signal Light Bulbs
*
Models with halogen headlights
Models with LED headlights
Front turn signal lights are LED type. Have an
authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the light
assembly.
1. Turn the socket counter-clockwise and
remove it.
2. Pull the bulb straight out of its holder.
3. Insert a new bulb.
Socket
Bulb
Maintenance
* Not available on all models
543
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
544 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuFront Side Marker Lights
Front Side Marker Lights
Front side marker lights are LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and
replace the light assembly.
Parking/Daytime Running Lights
Parking/daytime running lights are LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer
inspect and replace the light assembly.
Maintenance
544
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
545 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuFog Light Bulbs *
Fog Light Bulbs *
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Fog Light: 35 W (H8 for halogen bulb type)
Fog Light: LED type *
1Fog Light Bulbs *
Models with LED fog lights
*
Fog lights are LED type. Have an authorized Honda
dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.
Models with halogen fog lights
1. Remove the clips using a flat-tip
screwdriver, and push up the under cover.
Under
Cover
Models with halogen fog lights
Insert a flat-tip screwdriver, lift and remove the center
pin to remove the clip.
Clip
Push until the pin
is flat.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Maintenance
Insert the clip with the center pin raised, and push
until it is flat.
545
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
546 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuSide Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator Lights *
Driver side
Bulb
Coupler
Tab
2. Push the tab to remove the coupler.
3. Rotate the old bulb counter-clockwise on
driver side and clockwise on passenger side
to remove.
4. Insert a new bulb into the fog light
assembly and turn it clockwise on driver
side and counter-clockwise on passenger
side.
5. Insert the coupler into the connector of the
bulb.
Passenger side
Bulb
Coupler
Maintenance
Tab
Side Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator Lights *
546
* Not available on all models
Door mirror side turn lights are LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect
and replace the light assembly.
1Fog Light Bulbs *
Models with halogen fog lights
NOTICE
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil, perspiration,
or a scratch on the glass can cause the bulb to
overheat and shatter.
When replacing a halogen bulb, handle it by its
plastic case, and protect the glass from contact with
your skin or hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean
it with denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
547 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuRear Turn Signal Light Bulbs
Rear Turn Signal Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Rear Turn Signal Light: 21 W (Amber)
1. Use a Phillips-head screwdriver to remove
the bolts.
2. Pull the light assembly out of the rear pillar.
Bolt
Bulb
Maintenance
Socket
3. Turn the socket counter-clockwise and
remove it.
4. Remove the old bulb.
5. Insert a new bulb.
6. Slide the light assembly onto the guide on
the body.
547
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
548 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuBack-Up Light Bulbs
Back-Up Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Back-Up Light: 16 W
1. Remove the cover by prying on the edge
using a flat-tip screwdriver.
u Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a cloth
to prevent scratches.
Cover
2. Turn the socket counter-clockwise and
remove it.
3. Remove the old bulb.
4. Insert a new bulb.
Bulb
Maintenance
548
Socket
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
549 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuBrake/Tail/Rear Side Marker Lights
Brake/Tail/Rear Side Marker Lights
Brake/tail/rear side marker lights are the LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer
inspect and replace the light assembly.
High-Mount Brake Light
High-mount brake light is a LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and
replace the light assembly.
Maintenance
549
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
550 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuRear License Plate Light Bulbs
Rear License Plate Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Rear License Plate Light: 5 W
1. Push the lens on the left and pull out the
lens and the socket attached to it.
Lens
Bulb
Maintenance
550
2. Remove the license plate light assembly by
squeezing the tabs on both sides of the
socket.
3. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
551 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades
Checking Wiper Blades
If the wiper blade rubber has deteriorated, it will leave streaks and the hard surfaces
of the blade may scratch the window glass.
Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
1Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
1. Lift the driver side wiper arm first, then the
passenger side.
NOTICE
Avoid dropping the wiper arm onto the windshield, it
may damage the wiper arm and/or the windshield.
2. Press up on and hold the tab, then slide the
holder off the wiper arm.
Maintenance
Tab
Continued
551
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
552 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
3. Slide the wiper blade out of the holder by
pulling the tabbed end out.
Blade
Blade
Tab
Maintenance
552
4. Slide the new wiper blade onto the holder
from the bottom end.
u The tab on the blade should fit in the
indent of the top of the wiper holder.
5. Slide the holder onto the wiper arm
securely.
6. Lower the passenger side wiper arm first,
then the driver side.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
553 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
1. Raise the wiper arm off.
2. Pivot up the bottom end of the wiper blade
until it comes off from the wiper arm.
Wiper Arm
1Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
NOTICE
Avoid dropping the wiper arm; it may damage the
rear window.
3. Slide the wiper blade out of the end with
the indent.
Blade
Maintenance
Continued
553
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
554 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
Retainers
Holder
Maintenance
554
4. Remove the retainers from the rubber blade
that has been removed, and mount to a
new rubber blade.
5. Slide the new wiper blade onto the holder.
u Make sure it is engaged correctly, then
install the wiper blade assembly onto the
wiper arm.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
555 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Checking and Maintaining Tires
Checking Tires
To safely operate your vehicle, your tires must be of the proper type and size, in
good condition with adequate tread, and properly inflated.
■ Inflation guidelines
Properly inflated tires provide the best combination of handling, tread life, and
comfort. Refer to the driver’s doorjamb label or specifications page for the specified
pressure.
Underinflated tires wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and
are more likely to fail from overheating.
Overinflated tires make your vehicle ride harshly, are more prone to road hazards,
and wear unevenly.
Every day before you drive, look at each of the tires. If one looks lower than the
others, check the pressure with a tire gauge.
Continued
3 WARNING
Using tires that are excessively worn or
improperly inflated can cause a crash in
which you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding tire inflation and
maintenance.
Measure the air pressure when tires are cold. This
means the vehicle has been parked for at least three
hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km). If
necessary, add or release air until the specified
pressure is reached.
If checked when hot, tire pressure can be as much as
4–6 psi (30–40 kPa, 0.3–0.4 kgf/cm2) higher than if
checked when cold.
Have a dealer check the tires if you feel a consistent
vibration while driving. New tires and any that have
been removed and reinstalled should be properly
balanced.
Maintenance
At least once a month or before long trips, use a gauge to measure the pressure in
all tires, including the spare. Even tires in good condition can lose 1-2 psi (10-20 kPa,
0.1-0.2 kgf/cm2) per month.
1Checking Tires
555
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
556 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuChecking Tires
■ Inspection guidelines
Every time you check inflation, also examine the tires and valve stems.
Look for:
• Bumps or bulges on the side or in the tread. Replace the tire if you find any cuts,
splits, or cracks in the side of the tire. Replace it if you see fabric or cord.
• Remove any foreign objects and inspect for air leaks.
• Uneven tread wear. Have a dealer check the wheel alignment.
• Excessive tread wear.
2 Wear Indicators P. 561
• Cracks or other damage around valve stem.
Maintenance
556
1Checking Tires
U.S. models
Whenever tire pressure is adjusted, you must
calibrate the TPMS.
2 TPMS Calibration P. 455
Check the spare tire pressure once a month or before
long trips.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
557 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire and Loading Information Label
Tire and Loading Information Label
The label attached to the driver’s doorjamb provides necessary tire and loading
information.
Label
Example
Tire Labeling
Example
1Tire and Loading Information Label
The tire and loading information label attached to the
driver’s doorjamb contains:
a The number of people your vehicle can carry.
b The total weight your vehicle can carry. Do not
exceed this weight.
c The original tire sizes for front, rear, and spare.
d The proper cold tire pressure for front, rear, and
spare.
1Tire Sizes
Tire Size
Tire
Identification
Number (TIN)
The tires that came on your vehicle have a
number of markings. Those you should be
aware of are described below.
Maximum
Tire Pressure
Tire Size
Maintenance
Maximum
Tire Load
Following is an example of tire size with an
explanation of what each component means.
215/55R17 94V
215: Tire width in millimeters.
55: Aspect ratio (the tire’s section height as a
percentage of its width).
R: Tire construction code (R indicates radial).
17: Rim diameter in inches.
94: Load index (a numerical code associated with the
maximum load the tire can carry).
V: Speed symbol (an alphabetical code indicating the
maximum speed rating).
■ Tire Sizes
Whenever tires are replaced, they should be replaced with tires of the same size.
Continued
557
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
558 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire Labeling
■ Tire Identification Number (TIN)
The tire identification number (TIN) is a group of numbers and letters that look like
the example in the side column. TIN is located on the sidewall of the tire.
■ Glossary of Tire Terminology
Maintenance
558
Cold Tire Pressure – The tire air pressure when the vehicle has been parked for at
least three hours or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km).
Load Rating – Means the maximum load that a tire is rated to carry for a given
inflation pressure.
Maximum Inflation Pressure – The maximum tire air pressure that the tire can
hold.
Maximum Load Rating – Means the load rating for a tire at the maximum
permissible inflation pressure for that tire.
Recommended Inflation Pressure – The cold tire inflation pressure recommended
by the manufacturer.
Treadwear Indicators (TWI) – Means the projections within the principal grooves
designed to give a visual indication of the degrees of wear of the tread.
1Tire Identification Number (TIN)
DOT B97R FW6X 2209
DOT: This indicates that the tire meets all
requirements of the U.S. Department of
Transportation.
B97R: Manufacturer’s identification mark.
FW6X: Tire type code.
22 09: Date of manufacture.
Year
Week
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
559 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuDOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
The tires on your vehicle meet all U.S. Federal Safety
Requirements. All tires are also graded for treadwear, traction,
and temperature performance according to Department of
Transportation (DOT) standards. The following explains these
gradings.
■ Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall
between tread shoulder and maximum section width.
Continued
For example:
Treadwear 200
Traction AA
Temperature A
All passenger car tires must conform
to Federal Safety Requirements in
addition to these grades.
Maintenance
■ Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear
rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150
would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the
government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance
of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however,
and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in
driving habits, service practices and differences in road
characteristics and climate.
1Uniform Tire Quality Grading
559
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
560 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuDOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Maintenance
560
■ Traction
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C.
Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement
as measured under controlled conditions on specified
government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked
C may have poor traction performance.
1Traction
■ Temperature
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions
on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high
temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and
reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire
failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which
all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels
of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum
required by law.
1Temperature
Warning: The traction grade
assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests,
and does not include acceleration,
cornering, hydroplaning, or peak
traction characteristics.
Warning: The temperature grade for
this tire is established for a tire that is
properly inflated and not
overloaded. Excessive speed,
underinflation, or excessive loading,
either separately or in combination,
can cause heat buildup and possible
tire failure.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
561 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuWear Indicators
Wear Indicators
Example of a Wear
Indicator mark
The groove where the wear indicator is
located is 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) shallower than
elsewhere on the tire. If the tread has worn so
that the indicator is exposed, replace the tire.
Worn out tires have poor traction on wet
roads.
Tire Service Life
The life of your tires is dependent on many factors, including driving habits, road
conditions, vehicle loading, inflation pressure, maintenance history, speed, and
environmental conditions (even when the tires are not in use).
Maintenance
In addition to regular inspections and inflation pressure maintenance, it is
recommended that you have annual inspections performed once the tires reach five
years old. All tires, including the spare, should be removed from service after 10
years from the date of manufacture, regardless of their condition or state of wear.
561
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
562 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire and Wheel Replacement
Tire and Wheel Replacement
Replace your tires with radials of the same size, load range, speed rating, and
maximum cold tire pressure rating (as shown on the tire’s sidewall). Using tires of a
different size or construction can cause certain vehicle systems such as the ABS and
Vehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®) system to work incorrectly.
It is best to replace all four tires at the same time. If that isn’t possible, replace the
front or rear tires in pairs.
Make sure that the wheel’s specifications match those of the original wheels.
Maintenance
562
1Tire and Wheel Replacement
3 WARNING
Installing improper tires on your vehicle can
affect handling and stability. This can cause
a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or
killed.
Always use the size and type of tires
recommended in this owner’s manual.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
563 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire Rotation
Tire Rotation
Rotating tires according to the maintenance messages on the information display */
multi-information display * helps to distribute wear more evenly and increase tire life.
■ Tires without rotation marks
Rotate the tires as shown here.
Front
1Tire Rotation
Tires with directional tread patterns should only be
rotated front to back (not from one side to the other).
Directional tires should be mounted with the rotation
indication mark facing forward, as shown below.
Front
Direction Mark
■ Tires with rotation marks
Rotate the tires as shown here.
* Not available on all models
Maintenance
Front
U.S. models
Whenever tires are rotated, you must calibrate the
TPMS.
2 TPMS Calibration P. 455
563
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
564 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuWinter Tires
Winter Tires
If driving on snowy or frozen roads, mount all season marked M+S tires, snow tires,
or tire chains; reduce speed; and maintain sufficient distance between vehicles when
driving.
Be particularly careful when operating the steering wheel or brakes to prevent
skidding.
1Winter Tires
3 WARNING
Using the wrong chains, or not properly
installing chains, can damage the brake
lines and cause a crash in which you can be
seriously injured or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding the selection and use of
tire chains.
NOTICE
Traction devices that are the wrong size or improperly
installed can damage your vehicle’s brake lines,
suspension, body, and wheels. Stop driving if they are
hitting any part of the vehicle.
Maintenance
564
When tire chains are mounted, follow the chain
manufacturer’s instructions regarding vehicle
operational limits.
If your vehicle is equipped with summer tires, be
aware that these tires are not designed for winter
driving conditions. For more information, contact a
dealer.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
565 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuChecking and Maintaining Tires uWinter Tires
Use tire chains, snow tires, or all season tires when necessary or according to the
law.
When mounting, refer to the following points.
For winter tires:
• Select the size and load ranges that are the same as the original tires.
• Mount the tires to all four wheels.
For tire chains:
• Install them on the front tires only.
• Because your vehicle has limited tire clearance, we strongly recommend using the
chains listed below:
Models with 215/55R17 tires
Cable-type: SCC Radial Chain SC1036
Models with 225/50R18 tires
Not recommended to use any type of chains
Maintenance
• Follow the chain manufacturer’s instruction when installing. Mount them as
tightly as you can.
• Check that the chains do not touch the brake lines or suspension.
• Drive slowly.
Models with 225/50R18 tires
Your vehicle’s tires are not suitable for mounting any traction device.
565
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
566 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Battery
Checking the Battery
The condition of the battery is monitored by a sensor located on the negative
terminal of the battery. If there is a problem with this sensor, the information
display */multi-information display * will display a warning message. If this happens,
have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
1Battery
3 WARNING
The battery gives off explosive hydrogen
gas during normal operation.
Check the battery terminals for corrosion monthly.
If your vehicle’s battery is disconnected or goes dead:
• The audio system is disabled.
2 Audio System Theft Protection P. 230
• The clock resets.
2 Clock P. 134
When conducting any battery
maintenance, wear protective clothing and
a face shield, or have a skilled technician do
it.
WARNING: Battery post, terminals,
and related accessories contain lead
and lead compounds.
Wash your hands after handling.
Maintenance
566
A spark or flame can cause the battery to
explode with enough force to kill or
seriously hurt you.
When replacing the battery, the replacement must be
of the same specifications.
Consult a dealer for more information.
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
567 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuBatteryuCharging the Battery
Charging the Battery
Disconnect both battery cables to prevent damaging your vehicle’s electrical system.
Always disconnect the negative (–) cable first, and reconnect it last.
1Battery
When you find corrosion, clean the battery terminals
by applying a baking powder and water solution.
Clean the terminals with a damp towel. Cloth/towel
dry the battery. Coat the terminals with grease to
help prevent future corrosion.
Maintenance
567
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
568 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Button Battery
If the indicator does not come on when the button is pressed, replace the battery.
■ Keys with Remote Transmitter *
Screw
Battery type: CR1620
1. Unscrew the cover with a small Phillipshead screwdriver.
2. Open the remote transmitter.
u Wrap the small flat-tip screwdriver with a
cloth to prevent scratching the
transmitter.
Battery
Maintenance
568
3. Remove the button battery with the small
flat-tip screwdriver.
4. Make sure to replace the battery with the
correct polarity.
1Replacing the Button Battery
3 WARNING
CHEMICAL BURN HAZARD
The battery that powers the remote
transmitter can cause severe internal burns
and can even lead to death if swallowed.
Keep new and used batteries away from
children.
If you suspect that a child has swallowed
the battery, seek medical attention
immediately.
NOTICE
An improperly disposed of battery can damage the
environment. Always confirm local regulations for
battery disposal.
Replacement batteries are commercially available or
at a dealer.
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
569 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuRemote Transmitter CareuReplacing the Button Battery
■ Smart Entry Remote *
Battery type: CR2032
1. Remove the built-in key.
Battery
Maintenance
* Not available on all models
2. Remove the upper half of the cover by
carefully prying on the edge with a coin.
u Remove carefully to avoid losing the
buttons.
u Wrap a coin with a cloth to prevent
scratching the smart entry remote.
3. Make sure to replace the battery with the
correct polarity.
569
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
570 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Heating and Cooling System */Climate Control System * Maintenance
Air Conditioning
To ensure proper and safe operation, the Society of Automotive Engineers (SAE
J2845) recommends that the refrigerant system only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
Never repair or replace the air conditioning evaporator (cooling coil) with one
removed from a used or salvaged vehicle.
New replacement mobile air conditioning evaporators must be certified (and
labeled) as meeting SAE Standard J2842.
1Heating and Cooling System */Climate Control System *
Maintenance
NOTICE
Vented refrigerant is harmful to the environment.
To avoid refrigerant from venting, never replace the
evaporator with one removed from a used or
salvaged vehicle.
Refrigerant in your vehicle’s air conditioning system is
flammable and can be ignited during servicing if
proper procedures are not followed.
The air conditioner label is found under the hood:
2 Safety Labels P. 78
2 Specifications P. 614
Canadian models
: Caution
Maintenance
: Flammable Refrigerant
: Requires Registered
Technician to Service
The heating and cooling system */climate control system * is equipped with a dust
and pollen filter that collects pollen, dust, and other debris in the air. The
Maintenance MinderTM messages will let you know when to replace the filter.
We recommend that you replace the dust and pollen filter sooner when using your
vehicle in areas with high concentrations of dust.
570
: Air Conditioning
System
Dust and Pollen Filter
* Not available on all models
1Dust and Pollen Filter
If the airflow from the heating and cooling system */
climate control system * deteriorates noticeably, and
the windows fog up easily, the filter may need to be
replaced. Please contact a dealer for replacement.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
571 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Cleaning
Interior Care
Use a damp cloth with a mixture of mild detergent and warm water to remove dirt.
Use a clean cloth to remove detergent residue.
■ Cleaning Seat Belts
Use a soft brush with a mixture of mild soap and warm water to clean the seat belts.
Let the belts air dry. Wipe the loop of the seat belt anchors using a clean cloth.
Loop
1Interior Care
Do not spill liquids inside the vehicle. Electrical
devices and systems may malfunction if liquids are
splashed on them.
Do not use silicone based sprays on electrical devices
such as audio devices and switches. Doing so may
cause the items to malfunction or cause a fire inside
the vehicle.
If a silicone based spray is inadvertently used on
electrical devices, consult a dealer.
Depending on their composition, chemicals and
liquid aromatics may cause discoloration, wrinkles,
and cracking to resin-based parts and textiles.
Do not use alkali solvents or organic solvents such as
benzene or gasoline.
■ Cleaning the Window
1Cleaning the Window
Wires are mounted to the inside of the rear window.
Wipe along the same direction as the wires with a
soft cloth so as not to damage them.
Wipe using a glass cleaner.
Maintenance
After using chemicals, make sure to gently wipe them
away using a dry cloth.
Do not place used cloths on top of resin based parts
or textiles for long periods of time without washing.
Be careful not to spill fluids, such as water or glass
cleaner, on or around the cover of both the front
sensor camera * and the rainfall/light sensor *.
* Not available on all models
Continued
571
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
572 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCleaninguInterior Care
■ Floor Mats
1Floor Mats
Unlock
Lock
The driver’s floor mat hooks over the floor
anchors, which keep the mat from sliding
forward. To remove a mat for cleaning, turn
the anchor knobs to the unlock position.
When reinstalling the mat after cleaning, turn
the knobs to the lock position.
If you use any floor mats that were not originally
provided with your vehicle, make sure they are
designed for your specific vehicle, fit correctly, and
are securely anchored by the floor anchors.
Position the rear seat floor mats properly. If they are
not properly positioned, the floor mats can interfere
with the front seat functions.
Do not put additional floor mats on top of
the anchored mats.
■ Maintaining Genuine Leather *
Maintenance
572
To properly clean leather:
1. Use a vacuum or soft dry cloth first to remove any dirt or dust.
2. Clean the leather with a soft cloth dampened with a solution comprised of 90%
water and 10% neutral soap.
3. Wipe away any soap residue with a clean damp cloth.
4. Wipe away residual water and allow leather to air dry in the shade.
* Not available on all models
1Maintaining Genuine Leather *
It is important to clean or wipe away dirt or dust as
soon as possible. Spills can soak into leather resulting
in stains. Dirt or dust can cause abrasions in the
leather. In addition, please note that some dark
colored clothing can rub onto the leather seats
resulting in discoloration or stains.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
573 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
Exterior Care
Dust off the vehicle body after you drive.
Regularly inspect your vehicle for scratches on painted surfaces. A scratch on a
painted surface can result in body rust. If you find a scratch, promptly repair it.
■ Washing the Vehicle
1Washing the Vehicle
Wash the vehicle regularly. Wash more frequently when driving in the following
conditions:
• If driving on roads with road salt.
• If driving in coastal areas.
• If tar, soot, bird droppings, insects, or tree sap are stuck to painted surfaces.
Do not spray water into the air intake vents.
It can cause a malfunction.
■ Using an Automated Car Wash
• Make sure to follow the instructions indicated on the automated car wash.
• Fold in the door mirrors.
• For models equipped with automatic intermittent wipers, turn the wipers off.
• Keep sufficient distance between the cleaning nozzle and the vehicle body.
• Take particular care around the windows. Standing too close may cause water to
enter the vehicle interior.
• Do not spray high pressure water directly into the engine compartment. Instead,
use low pressure water and a mild detergent.
Continued
Maintenance
■ Using High Pressure Cleaners
Air Intake Vents
573
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
574 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
■ Applying Wax
A good coat of automotive body wax helps protect your vehicle’s paint from the
elements. Wax will wear off over time and expose your vehicle’s paint to the
elements, so reapply as necessary.
■ Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
If you get gasoline, oil, engine coolant, or battery fluid on resin coated parts, they
may be stained or the coating may peel. Promptly wipe it away using a soft cloth and
clean water.
■ Cleaning the Window
Wipe using a glass cleaner.
■ Maintaining Aluminum Wheels
Maintenance
574
Aluminum is susceptible to deterioration caused by salt and other road
contaminants. When necessary, as early as possible use a sponge and mild detergent
to wipe away these contaminants. Do not use a stiff brush or harsh chemicals
(including some commercial wheel cleaners). These can damage the protective finish
on aluminum alloy wheels, resulting in corrosion. Depending on the type of finish,
the wheels also may lose their luster or appear burnished. To avoid water stains,
wipe the wheels dry with a cloth while they are still wet.
1Applying Wax
NOTICE
Chemical solvents and strong cleaners can damage
the paint, metal, and plastic on your vehicle. Wipe
away spills immediately.
1Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
Ask a dealer about the correct coating material when
you want to repair the painted surface of the parts
made of resin.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
575 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
■ Fogged Exterior Light Lenses
The inside lenses of exterior lights (headlights, brake lights etc.) may fog temporarily
if you have driven in the rain, or after the vehicle has been run through a car wash.
Dew condensation also may build up inside the lenses when there is a significant
enough difference between the ambient and inside lens temperatures (similar to
vehicle windows fogging up in rainy conditions). These conditions are natural
processes, not structural design problems in the exterior lights.
Lens design characteristics may result in moisture developing on the light lens frame
surfaces. This also is not a malfunction.
However, if you see large amounts of water accumulation, or large water drops
building up inside the lenses, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
Maintenance
575
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
576 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Accessories and Modifications
Accessories
When installing accessories, check the following:
• Do not install accessories on the windshield. They can obstruct your view and
delay your reaction to driving conditions.
• Do not install any accessories over areas marked SRS AIRBAG, on the sides or
backs of the front seats, on front or side pillars, or near the side windows.
Accessories installed in these areas may interfere with proper operation of the
vehicle’s airbags or may be propelled into you or another occupant if the airbags
deploy.
• Be sure electronic accessories do not overload electrical circuits or interfere with
proper operation of your vehicle.
2 Fuses P. 604
• Before installing any electronic accessory, have the installer contact a dealer for
assistance. If possible, have a dealer inspect the final installation.
Maintenance
576
1Accessories and Modifications
3 WARNING
Improper accessories or modifications can
affect your vehicle’s handling, stability, and
performance, and cause a crash in which
you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding accessories and
modifications.
Honda Genuine accessories are recommended to
ensure proper operation on your vehicle.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
577 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuAccessories and ModificationsuModifications
Modifications
Do not modify your vehicle in a manner that may affect its handling, stability, or
reliability, or install non-genuine Honda parts or accessories that may have a similar
effect.
Even minor modifications to vehicle systems can affect overall vehicle performance.
Always make sure all equipment is properly installed and maintained, and do not
make any modification to your vehicle or its systems that might cause your vehicle
to no longer meet federal, state, province, territory, and local regulations.
The on-board diagnostic port (OBD-II/SAE J1962 connector) installed on this vehicle
is intended to be used with automobile system diagnostic devices or with other
devices that Honda has approved. Use of any other type of device may adversely
affect the vehicle’s electronic systems or allow them to be compromised, possibly
resulting in a system malfunction, drained battery, or other unexpected problems.
Do not modify or attempt to repair any of the electrical components.
Maintenance
577
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
578
578 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
579 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Handling the Unexpected
This chapter explains how to handle unexpected troubles.
Tools
Types of Tools .................................. 580
If a Tire Goes Flat
Changing a Flat Tire ......................... 582
Engine Does Not Start
Checking the Engine ........................ 591
If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak .. 592
Emergency Engine Stop ................... 593
Jump Starting.................................... 594
Shift Lever Does Not Move .............. 596
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating............. 597
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On....599
If the Charging System Indicator Comes
On ................................................. 599
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes
On or Blinks ................................... 600
If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes
On ................................................. 601
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator Comes On ....................... 601
If the Electric Parking Brake System
Indicator Comes On ....................... 602
If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
Comes On or Blinks ....................... 603
Fuses
Fuse Locations ................................. 604
Inspecting and Changing Fuses........ 608
Emergency Towing........................... 609
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate.....610
579
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
580 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Tools
Types of Tools
1Types of Tools
2WD models
The tools are stored in the cargo area.
Jack
Tool Case
Handling the Unexpected
Wheel Nut Wrench/
Jack Handle
Jack
Jack Handle Bar
580
Detachable Towing Hook
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
581 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuToolsuTypes of Tools
AWD models
Storage Bag
Tool Case
Jack
Detachable Towing Hook
Jack
Handling the Unexpected
Wheel Nut Wrench/
Jack Handle
Jack Handle Bar
Storage Bag
581
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
582 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
If a Tire Goes Flat
Changing a Flat Tire
If a tire goes flat while driving, grasp the steering wheel firmly, and brake gradually
to reduce speed. Then, stop in a safe place. Replace the flat tire with a compact
spare tire. Go to a dealer as soon as possible to have the full-size tire repaired or
replaced.
1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, non-slippery surface and apply the parking brake.
2. Put the transmission into (P .
3. Turn on the hazard warning lights and turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1.
1Changing a Flat Tire
Follow compact spare precautions:
Periodically check the tire pressure of the compact
spare. It should be set to the specified pressure.
Specified Pressure: 60 psi (420 kPa, 4.2 kgf/cm2)
When driving with the compact spare tire, keep the
vehicle speed under 50 mph (80 km/h). Replace with
a full-size tire as soon as possible.
Handling the Unexpected
The compact spare tire and wheel in your vehicle are
specifically for this model. Do not use them with
another vehicle. Do not use another type of compact
spare tire or wheel with your vehicle.
Do not mount tire chains on a compact spare tire.
If a chain-mounted front tire goes flat, remove one of
the full-size rear tires and replace it with the compact
spare tire. Remove the flat front tire and replace it
with the full-size tire that was removed from the rear.
Mount the tire chains on the front tire.
Do not use the jack if it doesn’t work properly. Call
your dealer or a professional towing service.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
582
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
583 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
■ Getting Ready to Replace the Flat Tire
1Getting Ready to Replace the Flat Tire
The wheel nut wrench supplied with your vehicle is
specially adapted to fit the holder shaft. Do not use
any other tool.
1. Open the cargo area floor lid.
The shape of the tool case varies by model.
Floor Lid
2WD models
Spare Tire
Jack
Take the wheel nut wrench, jack handle bar
and jack out of the tool case.
AWD models
Take the wheel nut wrench and jack handle
bar out of the tool case.
Tool Case
AWD models
Spare Tire
All models
Handling the Unexpected
2. Take the tool case out of the cargo area.
2WD models
3. Unscrew the wing bolt, and remove the
spacer cone. Then, remove the spare tire.
Tool Case
Continued
583
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
584 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
AWD models
4. Turn the jack’s end bracket anti-clockwise
to loosen it, then remove the jack.
Jack
All models
Handling the Unexpected
584
5. Place a wheel block or rock in front and rear
of the wheel diagonal to the flat tire.
The tire to be replaced.
Wheel
Blocks
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
585 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
6. Place the compact spare tire (wheel side up)
under the vehicle body, near the tire that
needs to be replaced.
Continued
Handling the Unexpected
7. Loosen each wheel nut about one turn
using the wheel nut wrench.
585
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
586 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
■ How to Set Up the Jack
1How to Set Up the Jack
1. Place the jack under the jacking point
closest to the tire to be changed.
3 WARNING
The vehicle can easily roll off the jack,
seriously injuring anyone underneath.
Follow the directions for changing a tire
exactly, and no person should place any
portion of their body under a vehicle that is
supported by a jack.
Handling the Unexpected
2. Turn the end bracket clockwise as shown in
the image until the top of the jack contacts
the jacking point.
u Make sure that the jacking point tab is
resting in the jack notch.
3. Raise the vehicle, using the jack handle bar
and the jack handle, until the tire is off the
ground.
Do not use the jack with people or luggage in the
vehicle.
Use the jack provided in your vehicle.
Other jacks may not support the weight (“load”) or
may not fit the jacking point.
The following instructions must be followed to use
the jack safely:
• Do not use while the engine is running.
• Use only where the ground is firm and level.
• Use only at the jacking points.
• Do not get in the vehicle while using the jack.
• Do not put anything on top of or underneath the
jack.
Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely before
driving.
Jack
Handle
Bar
586
Wheel Nut
Wrench as Jack Handle
Loose items can fly around the interior in a crash and
can seriously injure the occupants.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
587 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
■ Replacing the Flat Tire
1Replacing the Flat Tire
1. Remove the wheel nuts and flat tire.
Do not over tighten the wheel nuts by applying extra
torque using your foot or a pipe.
Wheel
Nut
Handling the Unexpected
2. Wipe the mounting surfaces of the wheel
with a clean cloth.
3. Mount the compact spare tire.
4. Screw the wheel nuts until they touch the
lips around the mounting holes, then stop
rotating.
5. Lower the vehicle and remove the jack.
Tighten the wheel nuts in the order
indicated in the image. Go around,
tightening the nuts, two to three times in
this order.
Wheel nut torque:
80 lbf∙ft (108 N∙m, 11 kgf∙m)
Continued
587
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
588 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
2WD models
■ Storing the Flat Tire
Wing Bolt
Spacer
Cone
Handling the Unexpected
588
For full-size
tire
For compact
spare tire
1Storing the Flat Tire
1. Remove the center cap.
2. Place the flat tire face down in the spare tire
well.
3. Remove the spacer cone from the wing
bolt, flip it over, and insert it back on the
bolt. Secure the flat tire with the wing bolt.
4. Securely store the wheel nut wrench, jack
handle bar and jack back in the tool case.
Store the case in the cargo area under the
cargo floor lid.
3 WARNING
Loose items can fly around the interior in a
crash and can seriously injure the
occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely
before driving.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
589 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
AWD models
■ Storing the Flat Tire
1Storing the Flat Tire
1. Put the flat tire in the storage bag provided
with your vehicle.
u The storage bag is in the tool case.
2. Knot the top of the storage bag.
3. Store the jack in its holder. Turn the jack’s
end bracket to lock it in place.
4. Securely store the wheel nut wrench and
jack handle bar back in the tool case.
Belt
Rear Anchor
Loose items can fly around the interior in a
crash and can seriously injure the
occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely
before driving.
Handling the Unexpected
5. Bore through the bag, and pass the holding
belt through the hole of the bag and the
wheel of the flat tire as shown.
3 WARNING
6. Place the flat tire in the cargo area, and
thread the belt through the rear anchor as
shown.
7. Pass the belt through the ring, and tighten
the belt to secure the flat tire in place.
Continued
589
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
590 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
U.S. models
■ TPMS and the Compact Spare Tire
If you replace a flat tire with the spare tire, the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator
comes on while you are driving. After driving for a few miles (kilometers), Tire
Pressure Monitor Problem will appear on the multi-information display * and the
indicator will start blinking for a short time and then stay on; however, this is normal
and is no cause for concern.
Calibrate the TPMS when you replace the tire with a specified regular tire.
2 TPMS Calibration P. 455
Handling the Unexpected
590
* Not available on all models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
591 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Engine Does Not Start
Checking the Engine
If the engine does not start, check the starter.
1Checking the Engine
If you must start the vehicle immediately, use an
assisting vehicle to jump start it.
2 Jump Starting P. 594
Checklist
Models with smart entry system
Check for a message on the multi-information display *.
• If the To Start, Hold Remote Near Start Button message appears.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak P. 592
uMake sure the smart entry remote is in its operating range.
2 ENGINE START/STOP Button Operating Range P. 166
Check the brightness of the interior lights.
Turn on the interior lights and check the brightness.
• If the interior lights are dim or do not come on at all
2 Battery P. 566
The starter turns over normally
but the engine doesn’t start.
There may be a problem with the
fuse. Check each of the items on
the right and respond accordingly.
• If the interior lights come on normally 2 Fuses P. 604
Review the engine start procedure.
Follow its instructions, and try to start the engine again. 2 Starting the Engine P. 432, 435
Check the immobilizer system indicator.
When the immobilizer system indicator is blinking, the engine cannot be started.
Handling the Unexpected
Starter condition
Starter doesn’t turn or turns
over slowly.
The battery may be dead. Check
each of the items on the right and
respond accordingly.
2 Immobilizer System P. 159
Check the fuel level.
There should be enough fuel in the tank. 2 Fuel Gauge P. 117, 120
Check the fuse.
Check all fuses, or have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 Inspecting and Changing Fuses P. 608
If the problem continues:
2 Emergency Towing P. 609
* Not available on all models
591
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
592 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuEngine Does Not StartuIf the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
Models with smart entry system
If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
Handling the Unexpected
592
If the beeper sounds, the To Start, Hold Remote Near Start Button message
appears on the multi-information display, the ENGINE START/STOP button flashes,
and the engine won’t start, start the engine as follows:
1. Touch the center of the ENGINE START/
STOP button with the H logo on the smart
entry remote while the ENGINE START/
STOP button is flashing. The buttons on
the smart entry remote should be facing
you.
u The ENGINE START/STOP button
flashes for about 30 seconds.
2. Depress the brake pedal and press the
ENGINE START/STOP button within 10
seconds after the beeper sounds while the
ENGINE START/STOP button changes
from flashing to on.
u If you don’t depress the pedal, the mode
will change to ACCESSORY.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
593 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuEngine Does Not StartuEmergency Engine Stop
Models with smart entry system
Emergency Engine Stop
The ENGINE START/STOP button may be used to stop the engine due to an
emergency situation even while driving. If you must stop the engine, do either of the
following operations:
• Press and hold the ENGINE START/STOP button for about two seconds.
• Firmly press the ENGINE START/STOP button three times.
Canadian models
Then press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice without depressing the brake
pedal.
Do not press the ENGINE START/STOP button while
driving unless it is absolutely necessary for the engine
to be turned off.
If you press the ENGINE START/STOP button while
driving, the beeper sounds.
Handling the Unexpected
The steering wheel will not lock. However, because turning off the engine disables
the power assist the engine provides to the steering and braking systems, it will
require significantly more physical effort and time to steer and slow the vehicle. Use
both feet on the brake pedal to slow down the vehicle and stop immediately in a
safe place.
The power mode is in ACCESSORY when the engine is stopped.
To change the mode to VEHICLE OFF, put the transmission into (P after the vehicle
comes to a complete stop.
1Emergency Engine Stop
593
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
594 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Jump Starting
■ Jump Starting Procedure
1Jump Starting
Turn off the power to electric devices, such as audio and lights. Turn off the engine,
then open the hood.
1. Connect the first jumper cable to your
vehicle’s battery + terminal.
u Remove the cover from the under-hood
fuse box.
2 Engine Compartment Fuse Box P. 604
Handling the Unexpected
594
Booster
Battery
2. Connect the other end of the first jumper
cable to the booster battery + terminal.
u Use a 12-volt booster battery only.
u When using the automotive battery
charger to boost your 12-volt battery,
select a lower charging voltage than 15volt. Check the charger manual for the
proper setting.
3. Connect the second jumper cable to the
booster battery - terminal.
4. Connect the other end of the second
jumper cable to the stud bolt as shown. Do
not connect this jumper cable to any other
part.
5. If your vehicle is connected to another
vehicle, start the assisting vehicle’s engine
and increase its rpm slightly.
6. Attempt to start your vehicle’s engine. If it
turns over slowly, check that the jumper
cables have good metal-to-metal contact.
3 WARNING
A battery can explode if you do not follow
the correct procedure, seriously injuring
anyone nearby.
Keep all sparks, open flames, and smoking
materials away from the battery.
Securely attach the jumper cables clips so that they
do not come off when the engine vibrates. Also be
careful not to tangle the jumper cables or allow the
cable ends to touch each other while attaching or
detaching the jumper cables.
Battery performance degrades in cold conditions and
may prevent the engine from starting.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
595 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuJump Startingu
■ What to Do After the Engine Starts
Once your vehicle’s engine has started, remove the jumper cables in the following
order.
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle’s stud bolt.
2. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery terminal.
3. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle’s battery + terminal.
4. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery +
terminal.
Handling the Unexpected
Have your vehicle inspected by a nearby service station or a dealer.
595
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
596 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Shift Lever Does Not Move
Follow the procedure below if you cannot move the shift lever out of the (P
position.
■ Releasing the Lock
1. Set the parking brake.
Models without smart entry system
2. Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Slot
Cover
Handling the Unexpected
All models
Shift Lock
Release Slot
Release Button
596
Models with smart entry system
2. Remove the built-in key from the smart
entry remote.
3. Wrap a cloth around the tip of a small flattip screwdriver. Put it into the shift lock
release slot as shown in the image, and
remove the cover.
4. Insert the key into the shift lock release slot.
5. While pushing the key down, press the shift
lever release button, and place the shift
lever into (N .
u The lock is now released. Have the shift
lever checked by a dealer as soon as
possible.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
597 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating
Overheating symptoms are as follows:
• The high temperature indicator (red) comes on or the engine suddenly loses
power.
• Steam or spray comes out of the engine compartment.
Continued
3 WARNING
Steam and spray from an overheated
engine can seriously scald you.
Do not open the hood if steam is coming
out.
NOTICE
Continuing to drive with the high temperature
indicator on may damage the engine.
Handling the Unexpected
■ First thing to do
1. Immediately park the vehicle in a safe place.
2. Turn off all accessories and turn on the hazard warning lights.
u No steam or spray present: Keep the engine running and open the hood.
u Steam or spray is present: Turn off the engine and wait until it subsides.
Then open the hood.
1How to Handle Overheating
597
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
598 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuOverheatinguHow to Handle Overheating
■ Next thing to do
MAX
MIN
Reserve Tank
1How to Handle Overheating
Handling the Unexpected
1. Check that the cooling fan is operating and
stop the engine once the high temperature
indicator goes off.
u If the cooling fan is not operating,
immediately stop the engine.
2. Once the engine has cooled down, inspect
the coolant level and check the cooling
system components for leaks.
u If the coolant level in the reserve tank is
low, add coolant until it reaches the
MAX mark.
u If there is no coolant in the reserve tank,
check that the radiator is cool. Cover the
radiator cap with a heavy cloth and open
the cap. If necessary, add coolant up to
the base of the filler neck, and put the
cap back on.
■ Last thing to do
Once the engine has cooled sufficiently, restart it and check the high temperature
indicator.
If the high temperature indicator is off, resume driving. If it stays on, contact a dealer
for repairs.
598
3 WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
If the coolant is leaking, contact a dealer for repairs.
Use water as an emergency/temporary measure only.
Have a dealer flush the system with proper antifreeze
as soon as possible.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
599 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when the engine oil pressure is low.
■ What to do as soon as the indicator comes on
1. Immediately park the vehicle on level ground in a safe place.
2. If necessary, turn the hazard warning lights on.
■ What to do after parking the vehicle
1. Stop the engine and let it sit for about three minutes.
2. Open the hood and check the oil level.
u Add oil as necessary.
1If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On
NOTICE
Running the engine with low oil pressure can cause
serious mechanical damage almost immediately.
2 Oil Check P. 532
If the Charging System Indicator Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when the battery is not being charged.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Turn off the heating and cooling system */climate control system *, rear
defogger, and other electrical systems, and immediately contact a dealer
for repairs.
* Not available on all models
1If the Charging System Indicator Comes On
If you need to stop temporarily, do not turn off the
engine. Restarting the engine may rapidly discharge
the battery.
Handling the Unexpected
3. Start the engine and check the low oil pressure indicator.
u The indicator goes off: Start driving again.
u The indicator does not go off within 10 seconds: Immediately stop
the engine and contact a dealer for repairs.
599
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
600 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or
Blinks
Handling the Unexpected
■ Reasons for the indicator lamp to come on or blink
• Comes on when there is a problem with the engine emissions control
system, or the fuel fill cap is missing, or loose.
• Blinks when engine misfiring is detected.
■ What to do when the indicator lamp comes on
Avoid high speeds and immediately get your vehicle inspected at a
dealer.
■ What to do when the indicator lamp blinks
Park the vehicle in a safe place with no flammable items and wait at least
10 minutes or more with the engine stopped until it cools.
■ Check/Tighten Fuel Cap Message
■ The message appears on when:
An evaporative system leak is detected. This may be caused by the fuel fill cap being
loose or not being installed.
■ What to do when the message appears:
1. Stop the engine.
2. Check that the fuel fill cap is fully installed.
u If not, loosen the cap, and then retighten it until it clicks at least once.
3. Drive for several days of normal driving.
u The message should go off.
■ When the malfunction indicator lamp comes on
The malfunction indicator lamp comes on if the system continues to detect a leak of
gasoline vapor. If this happens, check the fuel fill cap using the procedures described
above.
600
1If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
NOTICE
If you drive with the malfunction indicator lamp on,
the emissions control system and the engine could be
damaged.
If the malfunction indicator lamp blinks again when
restarting the engine, drive to the nearest dealer at
31 mph (50 km/h) or less. Have your vehicle
inspected.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
601 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
U.S.
Canada
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
• The brake fluid is low.
• There is a malfunction in the brake system.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on while driving
Depress the brake pedal lightly to check pedal pressure.
• If normal, check the brake fluid level the next time you stop.
• If abnormal, take immediate action. If necessary, downshift the
transmission to slow the vehicle using engine braking.
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
• Comes on when there is a problem with the EPS system.
• If you depress the accelerator pedal repeatedly to increase the engine
speed while the engine is idling, the indicator comes on, and
sometimes the steering wheel becomes harder to operate.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Stop the vehicle in a safe place and restart the engine.
If the indicator comes on and stays on, immediately have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
Have your vehicle repaired immediately.
It is dangerous to drive with low brake fluid. If there
is no resistance from the brake pedal, stop
immediately in a safe place. If necessary downshift
the gears.
If the brake system indicator and ABS indicator come
on simultaneously, the electronic brake distribution
system is not working. This can result in vehicle
instability under sudden braking.
Have your vehicle inspected by a dealer immediately.
Handling the Unexpected
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator
Comes On
1If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
601
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
602 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Electric Parking Brake System Indicator Comes On
If the Electric Parking Brake System Indicator Comes
On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when there is a problem with the electric parking brake
system.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Avoid using the parking brake and immediately get your vehicle
inspected at a dealer.
■ What to do when the electric parking brake indicator comes on
or blinks at the same time.
Release the parking brake.
Handling the Unexpected
602
2 Parking Brake P. 503
• If the electric parking brake indicator remains on or blinks even after
releasing the parking brake, immediately stop the vehicle in a safe
place and call a dealer.
u To prevent your vehicle from moving, put the transmission into (P .
• If only the electric parking brake indicator goes off, immediately get
your vehicle inspected at a dealer.
1If the Electric Parking Brake System Indicator Comes On
If you apply the parking brake, it may not release.
If the electric parking brake indicator also turns on,
the parking brake is still applied.
When the electric parking brake indicator blinks at
the same time as the electric parking brake system
indicator, the system must be checked. The parking
brake may not operate under these conditions.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
603 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or Blinks
U.S. models
If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or
Blinks
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on or blink
NOTICE
Driving on an extremely underinflated tire can cause
it to overheat. An overheated tire can fail. Always
inflate your tires to the prescribed level.
Handling the Unexpected
A tire pressure is significantly low, or the TPMS has not been calibrated.
If there is a problem with the TPMS or the compact spare tire is installed,
the indicator blinks for about one minute, and then stays on.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Drive carefully and avoid abrupt cornering and hard braking.
Stop your vehicle in a safe place. Check the tire pressure and adjust the
pressure to the specified level. The specified tire pressure is on a label on
the driver side doorjamb.
u Calibrate the TPMS after the tire pressure is adjusted.
■ What to do when the indicator blinks, then remains on
Have the tire inspected by a dealer as soon as possible. If the compact
spare tire causes the indicator to blink, change the tire to a full-size tire.
The indicator goes off after driving for a few miles (kilometers).
1If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or Blinks
603
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
604 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Fuses
Fuse Locations
If any electrical devices are not working,
turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1 and
check to see if any applicable fuse is blown.
■ Engine Compartment Fuse
Box
■ Fuse box A
Handling the Unexpected
Located near the brake fluid reservoir. Push
the tabs to open the box.
Fuse locations are shown on the fuse box
cover. Locate the fuse in question by the
fuse number and box cover number.
Tab
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
604
* Not available on all models
Circuit Protected
Amps
Headlight Low Beam Main
20 A
Driver’s Power Seat Sliding * (20 A)
Hazard
10 A
Drive By Wire
15 A
Wiper *
(30 A)
Stop
10 A
IGP
15 A
IG Coil
15 A
Daytime Running Lights
(10 A)
–
(20 A)
–
(30 A)
Main Fan
30 A
Starter SW *
(30 A)
MG Clutch
7.5 A
Battery Sensor
(7.5 A)
Small Light
10 A
Driver’s Power Seat
(20 A)
Reclining *
Horn
10 A
Fog Light *
(10 A)
Heated Windshield*2
(10 A)
Circuit Protected
21
Back Up
22
Audio
23
Sub Fan
24
–
25
STRLD *
26
IGP CAM *
27
–
28
–
29
–
30
IGP LAF
31
IGPS
32 Right Headlight Low Beam
33 Left Headlight Low Beam
Amps
10 A
(10 A)
(30 A)
(30 A)
(7.5 A)
(7.5 A)
–
–
(30 A)
(7.5 A)
(7.5 A)
10 A
10 A
*1:Models with the smart entry system have
an ENGINE START/STOP button
instead of an ignition switch.
*2:Canadian models
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
605 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Fuse box B
Pull up the cover on the + terminal, then
remove it while pulling out the tab as
shown.
Replacement of engine compartment fuses
should be done by a dealer.
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
a
b
c
d
Circuit Protected
Battery Main
RB Main 1
RB Main 2
CAP Main
Amps
100 A
70 A
80 A
70 A
Tab
Handling the Unexpected
a
b c
d
Continued
605
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
606 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Interior Fuse Boxes
■ Fuse box A
Fuse Label
Handling the Unexpected
606
Located behind the instrument panel.
Fuse locations are shown on the label under
the steering column.
Locate the fuse in question by the fuse
number and label number.
* Not available on all models
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Circuit Protected
Amps
Door Lock
20 A
–
–
Smart *
(10 A)
Driver Side Door Unlock
10 A
Passenger Side Door Unlock
10 A
Driver Door Unlock
10 A
Driver Door Lock
10 A
Driver’s Power Window
20 A
Passenger’s Power Window 20 A
Rear Left Power Window
20 A
Rear Right Power Window
20 A
Driver Side Door Lock
10 A
Passenger Side Door Lock
10 A
–
–
Right Headlight High Beam 10 A
STS *
(7.5 A)
–
(20 A)
Moonroof *
(20 A)
Front Seat Heater *
(20 A)
–
–
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
Circuit Protected
Adaptive Cruise Control *
Washer
Rear Wiper *
A/C
Daytime Running Lights
Starter Cut *
ABS/VSA
SRS
Left Headlight High Beam
ACG
IG Relay
Fuel Pump
SRS
Meter
Mission SOL
Front Accessory Power
Socket
ACC
–
Option
Rear Wiper
−
−
Amps
(7.5 A)
15 A
(10 A)
7.5 A
7.5 A
(7.5 A)
7.5 A
10 A
10 A
10 A
10 A
15 A
(7.5 A)
7.5 A
7.5 A
20 A
(7.5 A)
(7.5 A)
10 A
10 A
−
−
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
607 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Fuse box B
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
Circuit Protected
EPS
IG Main
1
Fuse Label
Cover
Remove the cover by putting the flat-tip
screwdriver into the side slot as shown.
* Not available on all models
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12*1
12*2
13
14
15*1
15*2
Circuit Protected
–
–
AWD *
–
Rear Accessory Power
Socket*3
–
Interior Light
Accessory Power Socket
(Console)
−
−
ACC Key Lock
Heated Door Mirror *
A/C Blower SW *
–
Wiper
Amps
–
–
(20 A)
(10 A)
(20 A)
–
7.5 A
(20 A)
−
−
(7.5 A)
(10 A)
(7.5 A)
–
30 A
Handling the Unexpected
2
Fuse Box Main 2
ABS/VSA Motor
Fuse Box Main 1
Fuse Box Main 3 *
Rear Defogger
Left Electric Parking Brake
IG Main2*1
–*2
Heater Motor
Right Electric Parking Brake
ABS/VSA FSR
Amps
70 A
30 A*1
50 A*2
50 A
40 A
30 A
40 A
30 A
30 A
30 A
30 A
40 A
30 A
30 A
*1:Models with smart entry system
*2:Models without smart entry system
*3:Canadian models
607
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
608 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuFusesuInspecting and Changing Fuses
Inspecting and Changing Fuses
1. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1. Turn
headlights and all accessories off.
2. Check the fuses on the battery in the
engine compartment.
u If the fuse is blown, have it replaced by a
dealer.
Blown
Fuse Box on the Battery
Handling the Unexpected
3. Remove the fuse box cover.
4. Inspect the small fuses in the engine
compartment and the vehicle interior.
u If there is a blown fuse, remove it with
the fuse puller and replace it with a new
one.
Fuse Puller
5. Check the large fuse in the vehicle interior.
u If the fuse is blown, use a Phillips-head
screwdriver to remove the screw and
replace it with a new one.
Combined Fuse
Blown Fuse
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
608
1Inspecting and Changing Fuses
NOTICE
Replacing a fuse with one that has a higher rating
greatly increases the chances of damaging the
electrical system.
Replace fuse with a spare fuse of the same specified
amperage.
Confirm the specified amperage using the charts on
2 Fuse Locations P. 604
There is a fuse puller in the back of the engine
compartment fuse box cover.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
609 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Emergency Towing
Call a professional towing service if you need to tow your vehicle.
All models
■ Flat bed equipment
The operator loads your vehicle on the back of a truck.
This is the best way to transport your vehicle.
1Emergency Towing
NOTICE
Trying to lift or tow your vehicle by the bumpers will
cause serious damage. The bumpers are not designed
to support the vehicle’s weight.
NOTICE
2WD models
Never tow your vehicle with just a rope or chain.
It is very dangerous since ropes or chains may shift
from side to side or break.
2WD models
Make sure the parking brake is released. If you
cannot release the parking brake, your vehicle must
be transported by the flat bed equipment.
2 Parking Brake P. 503
Handling the Unexpected
■ Wheel lift equipment
The tow truck uses two pivoting arms that go under the front tires and lift them off
the ground. The rear tires remain on the ground. This is an acceptable way to
tow your vehicle.
Improper towing such as towing behind a
motorhome or other motor vehicle can damage the
transmission.
609
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
610 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate
■ What to Do When Unable to Open the Tailgate
If you cannot open the tailgate, use the following procedure.
1. Wrap a cloth around the flat-tip
screwdriver. Put it into the cover as shown
in the image, and open it.
Handling the Unexpected
610
Cover
2. Wrap a cloth around the flat-tip
screwdriver. Put it into the lid as shown in
the image, and open the lid.
Lid
1When You Cannot Open the Tailgate
Follow Up:
After taking these steps, contact a dealer to have
your vehicle checked.
When you open the tailgate from inside, make sure
there is enough space around the tailgate, and it
does not hit anyone or any object.
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
611 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWhen You Cannot Open the Tailgateu
3. To open the tailgate, push the tailgate
while sliding the lever to the right.
Lever
Handling the Unexpected
611
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
612
612 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
613 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Information
This chapter includes your vehicle’s specifications, locations of identification numbers, and other
information required by regulation.
Specifications.................................... 614
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN),
Engine Number, and Transmission
Number ......................................... 616
Devices that Emit Radio Waves....... 617
Reporting Safety Defects................. 618
Emissions Testing
Testing of Readiness Codes.............. 619
Warranty Coverages ........................ 621
Authorized Manuals......................... 623
Customer Service Information......... 624
613
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
614 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Specifications
■ Vehicle Specifications
■ Engine Specifications
Model
No. of Passengers:
Front
Rear
Total
Weights:
Gross Vehicle Weight
Rating
Gross Axle Weight
Rating (Front)
Gross Axle Weight
Rating (Rear)
Displacement
HR-V
2
3
5
See the certification label on the driver’s
doorjamb
See the certification label on the driver’s
doorjamb
See the certification label on the driver’s
doorjamb
Spark Plugs
■ Fuel
Fuel:
Type
Fuel Tank Capacity
Refrigerant Type
Charge Quantity
Lubricant Type
Quantity
HFO-1234yf (R-1234yf)
13.9 - 15.7 oz (395 - 445 g)
ND-OIL14 (POE)
4.27-5.00 cu-in (70-82 cm3)
Information
614
■ Light Bulbs
Headlights (Low Beam)
Headlights (High Beam)
Fog Lights *
Unleaded gasoline, Pump octane number
of 87 or higher
13.2 US gal (50 L)
■ Washer Fluid
Tank Capacity
■ Air Conditioning
109.8 cu-in (1,799 cm3)
NGK
DILZKR7B11GS
DENSO
DXU22HCR-D11S
U.S.: 2.6 US qt (2.5 L)
Canada: 4.8 US qt (4.5 L)
Parking/Daytime Running Lights
Front Side Marker Lights
Front Turn Signal Lights
Side Turn Signal Lights *
Brake/Tail/Rear Side Marker Lights
Back-Up Lights
Rear Turn Signal Lights
High-Mount Brake Light
Rear License Plate Lights
Interior Lights
Vanity Mirror Light *
Map Lights
Ceiling Light
Console Panel Light
Cargo Area Light
*1: Models without navigation system
*2: Models with navigation system
* Not available on all models
55W (H11)*1
LED*2
60W (HB3)*1
LED*2
35W (H8)*1
LED*2
LED
LED
28/8W (Amber)*1
LED*2
LED
LED
16W
21W (Amber)
LED
5W
1.4W
8W
8W
LED
5W
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
615 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuSpecificationsu
■ Brake Fluid
Specified
■ Engine Oil
Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3
■ Continuously Variable Transmission
Fluid
Specified
Capacity
Honda HCF-2 Transmission Fluid
3.7 US qt (3.5 L)*1
Change
4.2 US qt (4.0 L)*2
*1: 2WD
*2: AWD
Capacity
■ Engine Coolant
Specified
Ratio
■ Rear Differential Fluid *
Specified
Capacity
Recommended
Honda DPSF-II
Change
Capacity
1.318 US qt (1.247 L)
■ Tire
·Genuine Honda Motor Oil 0W-20
·API Premium-grade 0W-20 detergent oil
Change
3.7 US qt (3.5 L)
Change
including
3.9 US qt (3.7 L)
filter
Honda Long-Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type2
50/50 with distilled water
1.39 US gal (5.25L)
(change including the remaining
0.13 US gal (0.5 L) in the reserve tank)
Size*1
Regular
Compact
Spare
Wheel Size
Front
Pressure
psi (kPa[kgf/cm2]) Rear
Size
Pressure
psi (kPa[kgf/cm2])
Regular
Compact Spare
215/55R17 94V
225/50R18 95V
32 (220 [2.2])
30 (210 [2.1])*2
28 (190 [1.9])*3
T135/90D16 102M
60 (420 [4.2])
17 x 7 1/2J*2
18 x 7 1/2J*3
16 x 4T
*1: Original tire size is mentioned on the tire information label on
the driver’s doorjamb.
*2: Models with 215/55R17
*3: Models with 225/50R18
Information
* Not available on all models
615
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
616 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number,
and Transmission Number
Your vehicle has a 17-digit vehicle identification number (VIN) used to register your
vehicle for warranty purposes, and for licensing and insuring your vehicle.
The locations of your vehicle’s VIN, engine number, and transmission number are
shown as follows.
Engine Number
1Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number, and
Transmission Number
The interior vehicle identification number (VIN) is
located under the cover.
Vehicle Identification Number
Cover
Information
616
Continuously Variable Transmission
Number
Certification Label/
Vehicle Identification
Number
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
617 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Devices that Emit Radio Waves
Each radio frequency device installed in the vehicle conforms to the requirements
and standards of the regulation listed below:
As required by the FCC:
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is
subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not
cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
Information
This device complies with Industry Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s).
Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference
that may cause undesired operation of the device.
617
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
618 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Reporting Safety Defects
In the U.S.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to
notifying American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists
in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved
in individual problems between you, your dealer, or American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-4249153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE.,
Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://
www.safercar.gov.
In Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform Honda Canada Inc. and you may also inform Transport Canada.
Information
If Transport Canada receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety
defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may lead to a recall and remedy campaign. However, Transport Canada
cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Honda Canada Inc.
To contact Transport Canada’s Defect Investigations and Recalls Division, you may call 1-800-333-0510. For
more information on reporting safety defects or about motor vehicle safety, go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety.
618
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
619 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Emissions Testing
Testing of Readiness Codes
Your vehicle has readiness code as part of the onboard self diagnostic system. Some
states use these codes for testing to verify whether your vehicle’s emissions
components are working properly.
The codes may not be read properly if testing is performed just after the battery has
gone dead or been disconnected.
To check if they are set, turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, without starting the
engine. The malfunction indicator lamp will come on for several seconds. If it then
goes off, the readiness codes are set. If it blinks five times, the readiness codes are
not set.
1Testing of Readiness Codes
The readiness codes are erased when the battery is
disconnected, and set again only after several days of
driving under a variety of conditions.
If a testing facility determines that the readiness
codes are not set, you may be requested to return at
a later date to complete the test.
If the testing facility determines the readiness codes
are still not set, see a dealer.
If you are required to have your vehicle tested before the readiness codes are ready,
prepare the vehicle for retesting by doing the following:
Information
1. Fill the gas tank to approximately 3/4 full.
2. Park the vehicle and leave the engine off for 6 hours or more.
3. Make sure the ambient temperature is between 40°F and 95°F (4°C and 35°C).
4. Start the engine without touching the accelerator pedal, and let it idle for 20
seconds.
5. Keep the vehicle in (P . Increase the engine speed to 2,000 rpm, and hold it there
for about three minutes.
6. Let the engine idle with your foot off the accelerator for 20 seconds.
*1: Models with the smart entry system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
619
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
620 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuEmissions TestinguTesting of Readiness Codes
7. Select a nearby, lightly traveled major highway where you can maintain a speed
of 50 to 60 mph (80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20 minutes. Drive on the highway in
(D . Do not use cruise control. When traffic allows, drive for 90 seconds without
moving the accelerator pedal. (Vehicle speed may vary slightly; this is okay.) If you
cannot do this for a continuous 90 seconds because of traffic conditions, drive for
at least 30 seconds, then repeat it two more times (for a total of 90 seconds).
8. Drive in city or suburban traffic for at least 10 minutes. When traffic conditions
allow, let the vehicle coast for several seconds without using the accelerator pedal
or the brake pedal.
9. Park the vehicle and leave the engine off for 30 minutes.
Information
620
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
621 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Warranty Coverages
■ U.S. Owners
Your new vehicle is covered by these warranties:
New Vehicle Limited Warranty – covers your new vehicle, except for the
emissions control systems and accessories, against defects in materials and
workmanship.
Emissions Control Systems Defects Warranty and Emissions Performance
Warranty – these two warranties cover your vehicle’s emissions control systems.
Time, mileage, and coverage are conditional. Please read your warranty booklet for
exact information.
Seat Belt Limited Warranty – a seat belt that fails to function properly is covered
by a limited warranty. Please read your warranty booklet for details.
Rust Perforation Limited Warranty – all exterior body panels are covered against
rusting from the inside out for the specified time period, regardless of mileage.
Information
Accessory Limited Warranty – Honda accessories are covered under this
warranty. Time and mileage limits depend on the type of accessory and other
factors. Please read your warranty booklet for details.
Replacement Parts Limited Warranty – covers all Honda replacement parts
against defects in materials and workmanship.
Continued
621
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
622 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuWarranty Coveragesu
Replacement Battery Limited Warranty – provides prorated coverage for a
replacement battery purchased from your dealer.
Replacement Muffler Lifetime Limited Warranty – provides coverage for as
long as the purchaser of the muffler owns the vehicle.
Restrictions and exclusions apply to all these warranties. Please read the Honda
warranty information booklet that came with your vehicle for precise information on
warranty coverages. Your vehicle’s original tires are covered by their manufacturer.
Tire warranty information is in a separate booklet.
■ Canadian Owners
Please refer to the warranty manual that came with your vehicle.
■ EPA Contact Information
An owner may obtain further information concerning emission warranties or report
violations of the terms of the emission warranties by contacting:
Information
622
Director,
Light-Duty Vehicle Center,
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
Attention: Warranty Claim
2000 Traverwood Drive,
Ann Arbor, MI 48105;
[email protected]
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
623 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Authorized Manuals
■ Service Express
For electronic copies of service publications, you can purchase a subscription to
Service Express. Visit www.techinfo.honda.com for pricing and options.
■ For U.S. Owners
Manuals can be purchased from Helm Incorporated. You can order a manual by
phone at 1 (800) 782-4356 (credit card orders only), or online at www.helminc.com.
■ For Canadian Owners
Please contact a dealer to order any manuals that you may require.
Information
623
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
624 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Customer Service Information
Honda dealership personnel are trained professionals who should be able to deal
with any problems you may encounter with your vehicle. If, however, you are faced
with a problem that they cannot resolve to your satisfaction, contact Honda
Customer Services.
U.S. Owners
American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
Honda Automobile Customer Services
Mail Stop 100-5E-8A
1919 Torrance Blvd.
Torrance, CA 90501-2746
Tel: 1 (800) 999-1009
Information
624
In Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin
Islands
Bella International
P.O. Box 190816
San Juan, PR 00919-0816
Tel: 1 (787) 620-7546
Canadian Owners
Honda Canada Inc.
Customer Relations
180 Honda Boulevard
Markham, ON
L6C 0H9
Tel: 1-888-9-HONDA-9
Fax: 1-877-939-0909
E-mail: [email protected]
1Customer Service Information
When you call or write, please give us the following
information:
• Vehicle Identification Number
2 Vehicle Identification Number (VIN),
Engine Number, and Transmission
Number P. 616
• Date of purchase
• Odometer reading of your vehicle
• Your name, address, and telephone number
• A detailed description of the problem
• Name of the dealer who sold the vehicle to you
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
625 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
uuCustomer Service Informationu
■ Disclaimer of Pandora® *
Requirements to access Pandora®
• Latest version of the Pandora app
installed on your Android, Blackberry, or
iPhone.
• Registered Pandora account (you can
create a free account at
www.pandora.com or on your
smartphone)
• Connection to the internet via WiFi or
cellular data network.
• Android devices must be connected to
the vehicle via Bluetooth, iPhone devices
may be connected via Bluetooth or USB.
Information
* Not available on all models
Limitations
• Access to Pandora requires an active
internet connection
• Ability to access Pandora through this
system is subject to change without
notice
• Certain functionality of Pandora service is
not available when accessing the service
through this system including, but not
limited to, creating new stations, deleting
stations, emailing current stations,
buying songs, viewing additional text
information, logging in to Pandora, and
adjusting Cell Network Audio Quality.
Pandora internet radio is a music service
not affiliated with HONDA. More
information is available at http://
www.pandora.com . Pandora, the
Pandora logo, and the Pandora trade
dress are trademarks or registered
trademarks of Pandora Media, Inc., used
with permission.
• Mobile access requires a smartphone
with an active data plan. Standard data
rates may apply.
• Pandora is only available in the United
States.
625
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
626 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
Index
Index
Numbers
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode .................... 444
A
Index
626
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System)................... 508
Accessories and Modifications ................. 576
Accessory Power Sockets .......................... 207
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Indicator .................................................... 96
Additives
Coolant ................................................... 536
Engine Oil................................................ 531
Washer.................................................... 540
Additives, Engine Oil ................................ 531
Adjusting
Armrest ................................................... 200
Front Seats .............................................. 190
Head Restraints........................................ 197
Mirrors .................................................... 187
Rear Seats................................................ 193
Steering Wheel ........................................ 186
Temperature.................................... 114, 117
Adjusting the Sound......................... 239, 271
Air Conditioning System
Climate Control System ........................... 216
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows ....................................... 215, 219
Dust and Pollen Filter ............................... 570
Heating and Cooling System.................... 212
Air Conditioning System (Climate Control
System)
Synchronization Mode............................. 224
Air Conditioning System (Heating and
Cooling System)
Cooling ................................................... 215
Heating ................................................... 214
Air Pressure....................................... 557, 615
Airbags........................................................ 50
Advanced Airbags ..................................... 56
Airbag Care............................................... 63
Event Data Recorder.................................... 0
Front Airbags (SRS).................................... 53
Indicator.............................................. 61, 87
Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator ......... 62
Sensors ..................................................... 50
Side Airbags .............................................. 57
Side Curtain Airbags.................................. 59
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) ............................ 454
Android Auto ........................................... 316
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................. 508
Indicator.................................................... 87
Apple CarPlay ........................................... 312
Armrest ..................................................... 200
Audio Remote Controls ........................... 231
Audio System............................................ 228
Adjusting the Sound........................ 239, 271
Error Messages........................................ 323
General Information ................................ 329
iPod ................................................ 246, 290
MP3/WMA/AAC...................... 243, 249, 299
Recommended CDs ................................ 330
Recommended Devices ........................... 332
Remote Controls..................................... 231
Security Code ......................................... 230
Theft Protection ...................................... 230
USB Flash Drives...................................... 332
USB Port(s).............................................. 229
Audio/Information Screen ............... 235, 256
Authorized Manuals ................................ 623
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking ................ 152
Customize .............................................. 153
Auto High-Beam ...................................... 176
Automatic Brake Hold ............................. 506
Indicator ........................................... 83, 506
Automatic Brake Hold System
Indicator ........................................... 83, 506
Automatic Climate Control Sensors ........ 225
Average Fuel Economy .................... 116, 121
Average Speed ......................................... 121
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
627 ページ
2019年8月8日
B
午後3時52分
Parking/Daytime Running Lights ..............
Rear License Plate Lights ..........................
Rear Turn Signal Lights ............................
Side Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator
Lights ....................................................
Bulb Specifications ...................................
544
550
547
546
614
C
Carbon Monoxide Gas................................ 77
Cargo Cover .............................................. 210
Cargo Floor Box ........................................ 206
Carrying Cargo.................................. 425, 427
CD Player ................................................... 243
Certification Label .................................... 616
Changing Bulbs......................................... 541
Charging System Indicator ................. 85, 599
Child Safety................................................. 64
Childproof Door Locks ............................. 151
Child Seat .................................................... 64
Booster Seats............................................. 76
Child Seat for Infants ................................. 66
Child Seat for Small Children ..................... 67
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat
Belt.......................................................... 71
Larger Children.......................................... 75
Rear-facing Child Seat ............................... 66
Selecting a Child Seat ................................ 68
Childproof Door Locks ............................. 151
Cleaning the Exterior ............................... 573
Cleaning the Interior ................................ 571
Climate Control System............................ 216
Synchronization Mode............................. 224
Clock.......................................................... 134
Coat Hook................................................. 208
Compact Spare Tire .......................... 582, 615
Continuously Variable Transmission ....... 439
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode.................... 444
Creeping ................................................. 439
Kickdown................................................ 439
Operating the Shift Lever........... 23, 441, 443
Shift Lever Does Not Move ...................... 596
Shifting ........................................... 440, 442
Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT)
Fluid........................................................ 538
Controls..................................................... 133
Coolant (Engine) ...................................... 536
Adding to the Radiator............................ 537
Adding to the Reserve Tank..................... 536
High Temperature Indicator....................... 88
Low Temperature Indicator........................ 88
Overheating ............................................ 597
Creeping (Continuously Variable
Transmission) .......................................... 439
Cruise Control........................................... 447
Indicator.................................................... 93
Cup Holders .............................................. 204
Customer Service Information................. 624
Customized Features................ 123, 345, 352
Index
Battery ...................................................... 566
Charging System Indicator ................ 85, 599
Jump Starting ......................................... 594
Maintenance (Checking the Battery) ....... 566
Maintenance (Replacing)......................... 568
Belts (Seat).................................................. 40
Beverage Holders..................................... 204
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® ............ 370, 393
Booster Seats (For Children)...................... 76
Brake System ............................................ 503
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................. 508
Automatic Brake Hold............................. 506
Brake Assist System................................. 509
Foot Brake .............................................. 505
Indicator (Amber)...................................... 81
Indicator (Red) .................................. 80, 601
Parking Brake.......................................... 503
Brake System Indicator (Amber) ............... 81
Brake System Indicator (Red) .................... 80
Brake/Clutch System
Fluid ....................................................... 539
Brightness Control (Instrument Panel) ... 184
Bulb Replacement.................................... 541
Back-Up Lights........................................ 548
Brake/Tail/Rear Side Marker Lights........... 549
Fog Lights ............................................... 545
Front Side Marker Lights ......................... 544
Front Turn Signal Lights .......................... 543
Headlights .............................................. 541
High-Mount Brake Light.......................... 549
木曜日
627
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
628 ページ
2019年8月8日
D
Index
628
Daytime Running Lights........................... 175
Dead Battery ............................................. 594
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows.......................................... 215, 219
Devices that Emit Radio Waves................ 617
Dimming
Headlights ............................................... 171
Rearview Mirror ............................... 187, 188
Dipstick (Engine Oil) ................................. 532
Directional Signals (Turn Signal).............. 170
Display Setup .................................... 240, 272
Door Mirrors ............................................. 189
Doors ......................................................... 136
Auto Door Locking .................................. 152
Auto Door Unlocking............................... 152
Door and Tailgate Open
Indicator ...................................... 38, 39, 89
Keys ........................................................ 136
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from
the Inside............................................... 148
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from
the Outside............................................ 139
Lockout Prevention System ...................... 147
DOT Tire Quality Grading ........................ 559
Driving....................................................... 423
Braking.................................................... 503
Continuously Variable Transmission ......... 439
Cruise Control ......................................... 447
Shifting Position............................... 440, 442
Starting the Engine .......................... 432, 435
木曜日
午後3時52分
Dust and Pollen Filter............................... 570
E
ECO Assist® System ....................................... 9
ECON Button ............................................ 446
ECON Mode Indicator ................................ 93
Elapsed Time............................................. 121
Electric Parking Brake
Indicator.................................................... 82
Electric Parking Brake System
Indicator............................................ 82, 602
Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator............................................ 90, 601
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)............. 450
Emergency ................................................ 609
Emissions Testing (Readiness Codes)....... 619
Engine
Coolant................................................... 536
Jump Starting.......................................... 594
Number................................................... 616
Oil........................................................... 531
Starting ........................................... 432, 435
Switch Buzzer.......................................... 165
Engine Coolant......................................... 536
Adding to the Radiator............................ 537
Adding to the Reserve Tank..................... 536
High Temperature Indicator....................... 88
Low Temperature Indicator........................ 88
Overheating ............................................ 597
Engine Oil................................................. 531
Adding ................................................... 533
Checking ................................................ 532
Displaying Oil Life ........................... 521, 525
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ................. 85, 599
Recommended Engine Oil ....................... 531
Exhaust Gas Hazard (Carbon
Monoxide) ................................................ 77
Exterior Care (Cleaning) .......................... 573
Exterior Mirrors........................................ 189
F
Features .................................................... 227
Filters
Dust and Pollen....................................... 570
Oil .......................................................... 534
Flat Tire..................................................... 582
Floor Mats ................................................ 572
Fluids
Brake ...................................................... 539
Continuously Variable Transmission
(CVT) .................................................... 538
Engine Coolant ....................................... 536
Windshield Washer ................................. 540
FM/AM Radio ................................... 241, 278
Fog Light Indicator .................................... 92
Folding Down the Rear Seats .................. 194
Folding the Rear Seat Up ........................ 195
Foot Brake ................................................ 505
Front Airbags (SRS) .................................... 53
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
629 ページ
2019年8月8日
Front Seats
Adjusting ................................................ 190
Front Sensor Camera ............................... 500
Fuel ..................................................... 25, 513
Economy................................................. 515
Gauge ............................................ 117, 120
Instant Fuel Economy ...................... 116, 121
Low Fuel Indicator..................................... 87
Range ............................................. 116, 121
Recommendation.................................... 513
Refueling .......................................... 25, 513
Fuel Economy ........................................... 515
Fuel Fill Cap ........................................ 25, 514
Message ................................................. 600
Fuel Fill Door ...................................... 25, 514
Fuel Gauge ....................................... 117, 120
Fuses ......................................................... 604
Inspecting and Changing ........................ 608
Locations ................................................ 604
G
午後3時52分
Glove Box .................................................. 203
H
Halogen Bulbs................................... 541, 546
Handling the Unexpected ........................ 579
HandsFreeLink® (HFL) ....................... 370, 393
Displaying Messages ................................ 418
In Case of Emergency .............................. 421
Menus ............................................. 372, 396
Phone Setup .................................... 376, 400
Phonebook Phonetic Modification ........... 409
To Set Up Text Message Options ............. 403
Hazard Warning Button............................... 4
HD RadioTM ................................................ 279
Head Restraints......................................... 197
Headlights................................................. 171
Aiming .................................................... 541
Auto High-Beam...................................... 176
Dimming ......................................... 171, 175
Operating ................................................ 171
Heated Door Mirrors ................................ 182
Heated Windshield ................................... 183
Heating and Cooling System ................... 212
Cooling ................................................... 215
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows ............................................... 215
Dust and Pollen Filter ............................... 570
Heating ................................................... 214
HFL (HandsFreeLink®) ....................... 370, 393
High Beam Indicator .................................. 91
Hill Start Assist System ..................... 434, 437
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver............ 367
Honda App License Agreement .............. 333
Honda Sensing®.................................. 26, 460
HondaLink®............................................... 304
I
Identification Numbers
Engine and Transmission ......................... 616
Vehicle Identification ............................... 616
Ignition Switch ......................................... 165
Illumination Control
Knob....................................................... 184
Immobilizer System .................................. 159
Indicator.................................................... 92
Important Handling Information .............. 36
Indicators .................................................... 80
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) (Amber)..... 96
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
(Green)................................................... 96
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) .............................. 94
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)..................... 87
Auto High-Beam ....................................... 88
Automatic Brake Hold ....................... 83, 506
Automatic Brake Hold System ........... 83, 506
Brake Depressing....................................... 84
Brake System (Amber) ............................... 81
Brake System (Red)............................ 80, 601
Charging System ............................... 85, 599
Index
Gasoline (Fuel)
Economy................................................. 515
Gauge ............................................ 117, 120
Information............................................. 513
Instant Fuel Economy ...................... 116, 121
Low Fuel Indicator..................................... 87
Refueling ................................................ 513
Gauges...................................................... 113
Glass (care) ....................................... 571, 574
木曜日
629
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
Index
630
630 ページ
2019年8月8日
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) ........................................... 97, 98
CRUISE CONTROL.............................. 93, 448
CRUISE MAIN .................................... 93, 447
Door and Tailgate Open................. 38, 39, 89
ECON Mode .............................................. 93
Electric Parking Brake................................. 82
Electric Parking Brake System............. 82, 602
Electric Power Steering (EPS)
System............................................. 90, 601
Fog Light ................................................... 92
High Beam................................................. 91
High Temperature...................................... 88
Immobilizer System.................................... 92
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
(Amber) .................................................. 96
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
(Green) ................................................... 96
Lights On................................................... 92
Low Fuel.................................................... 87
Low Oil Pressure ................................ 85, 599
Low Temperature ...................................... 88
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS ............. 90, 455, 603
M (7-speed manual shift mode) Indicator/
Shift......................................................... 86
Maintenance Minder ......................... 93, 521
Malfunction Indicator Lamp ............... 85, 600
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM).............. 95
Seat Belt Reminder .............................. 42, 86
Security System Alarm ............................... 93
Shift Lever Position .................................... 86
木曜日
午後3時52分
Smart Entry System ................................... 91
Supplemental Restraint System............ 61, 87
System Message Indicator ......................... 91
Transmission System.................................. 86
Turn Signal................................................ 91
Vehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®)
System ............................................ 89, 450
VSA® OFF .......................................... 89, 451
Information .............................................. 613
Information Display ................................. 115
Instant Fuel Economy....................... 116, 121
Instrument Panel ........................................ 79
Brightness Control................................... 184
Interior Lights ........................................... 201
Interior Rearview Mirror.................. 187, 188
Internet Radio .......................................... 297
J
Jack (Wheel Nut Wrench) ................ 580, 586
Jump Starting ........................................... 594
K
Keyless Lockout Prevention..................... 147
Keys........................................................... 136
Lockout Prevention ................................. 147
Number Tag............................................ 137
Rear Door Won’t Open ........................... 151
Remote Transmitter ................................ 144
Won’t Turn ............................................... 29
Kickdown (Continuously Variable
Transmission).......................................... 439
L
LaneWatchTM ............................................ 452
LATCH (Child Seats) ................................... 69
Lights ........................................................ 171
Auto High-Beam ..................................... 176
Bulb Replacement ................................... 541
Daytime Running Lights .......................... 175
Fog Lights ............................................... 174
High Beam Indicator ................................. 91
Interior.................................................... 201
Light Switches......................................... 171
Lights On Indicator.................................... 92
Turn Signals ............................................ 170
Load Limits ............................................... 427
Locking/Unlocking ................................... 136
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking ................. 152
Childproof Door Locks ............................ 151
From Inside ............................................. 148
From Outside .......................................... 139
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
631 ページ
2019年8月8日
Keys........................................................ 136
Lockout Prevention System ..................... 147
Using a Key............................................. 146
Lockout Prevention System ..................... 147
Low Battery Charge ................................. 599
Low Fuel Indicator ..................................... 87
Low Oil Pressure Indicator................. 85, 599
Lower Anchors ........................................... 69
Lubricant Specifications Chart ................ 615
Luggage (Maximum Load Limit) ............. 427
M
午後3時52分
Malfunction Indicator Lamp .............. 85, 600
Map Lights ................................................ 202
Maximum Load Limit ............................... 427
Meters, Gauges ......................................... 113
Mirrors....................................................... 187
Adjusting................................................. 187
Door........................................................ 189
Exterior.................................................... 189
Interior Rearview ............................. 187, 188
Modifications (and Accessories) .............. 576
Moonroof.................................................. 164
MP3 ........................................... 243, 249, 299
Multi-Information Display ....................... 118
Multi-View Rear Camera .......................... 511
N
Numbers (Identification) .......................... 616
O
Odometer.......................................... 116, 120
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines ............. 430
Oil (Engine) ............................................... 531
Adding .................................................... 533
Checking ................................................. 532
Displaying Oil Life .................................... 521
Displaying the Maintenance Minder
Information ........................................... 525
Low Oil Pressure Indicator.................. 85, 599
Recommended Engine Oil........................ 531
Viscosity .................................................. 531
Open Source Licenses............................... 322
Opening and Closing the Moonroof....... 164
Opening/Closing
Hood....................................................... 530
Moonroof ............................................... 164
Power Windows ...................................... 162
Tailgate ................................................... 156
Outside Temperature Display.......... 114, 117
Overheating.............................................. 597
P
Paddle Shifters (7-Speed Manual Shift
Mode)........................................ 23, 444, 445
Pandora®................................................... 297
Panic Mode ............................................... 161
Parking...................................................... 510
Parking Brake ........................................... 503
Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator ....... 62
Passing Indicators ..................................... 171
Playing Bluetooth® Audio................ 252, 302
Power Windows ....................................... 162
Precautions While Driving
Driving Guidelines for Your Utility
Vehicle .................................................. 438
Rain ........................................................ 438
Pregnant Women ....................................... 48
Puncture (Tire).......................................... 582
Index
Maintenance ............................................ 517
Battery.................................................... 566
Brake Fluid.............................................. 539
Cleaning ................................................. 571
Coolant .................................................. 536
Heating and Cooling System/Climate Control
System .................................................. 570
Maintenance Minder............................... 521
Oil .......................................................... 532
Precautions ............................................. 519
Radiator.................................................. 537
Remote Transmitter ................................ 568
Replacing Light Bulbs .............................. 541
Safety ..................................................... 519
Service Items................................... 523, 527
Tires........................................................ 555
Transmission Fluid................................... 538
Under the Hood...................................... 529
木曜日
631
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
Index
632
632 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
R
S
Radiator..................................................... 537
Radio (FM/AM).................................. 241, 278
Radio (SiriusXM®)...................................... 282
Radio Data System (RDS).................. 242, 280
Range ................................................ 116, 121
RDS (Radio Data System).................. 242, 280
Readiness Codes (Emissions Testing) ....... 619
Real Time AWD with Intelligent Control
SystemTM .................................................. 454
Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror
Button...................................................... 182
Rear Seats (Folding Down)....................... 194
Rearview Mirror................................ 187, 188
Refueling................................................... 513
Fuel Gauge ...................................... 117, 120
Gasoline .......................................... 513, 614
Low Fuel Indicator ..................................... 87
Regulations ............................... 458, 559, 617
Remote Transmitter.................................. 144
Replacement
Battery..................................................... 568
Bulbs ....................................................... 541
Fuses ............................................... 604, 606
Tires ........................................................ 562
Wiper Blade Rubber......................... 551, 553
Reporting Safety Defects ......................... 618
Resetting a Trip Meter ..................... 116, 120
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM)
Indicator .................................................... 95
Safe Driving ................................................ 33
Safety Check ............................................... 38
Safety Labels............................................... 78
Safety Message............................................. 1
Seat Belts .................................................... 40
Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor.................. 46
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners ................. 43
Checking................................................... 49
Detachable Anchor.................................... 47
Fastening .................................................. 44
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat
Belt ......................................................... 71
Pregnant Women ...................................... 48
Reminder .................................................. 42
Warning Indicator ............................... 42, 86
Seat Heaters.............................................. 211
Seats .......................................................... 190
Adjusting ................................................ 190
Front Seats .............................................. 190
Rear Seats ............................................... 193
Security System......................................... 159
Immobilizer System Indicator ..................... 92
Security System Alarm Indicator................. 93
SEL/RESET Button ..................................... 119
Select/Reset Knob............................. 115, 119
Selecting a Child Seat................................. 68
Selector Knob (Audio).............................. 234
Setting the Clock ...................................... 134
Shift Lever .................................. 23, 440, 442
Operation ................................. 23, 441, 443
Releasing ................................................ 596
Won’t Move ........................................... 596
Shift Lever Position Indicator .... 86, 441, 443
Shifting (Transmission) .................... 440, 442
Shoulder Anchor ........................................ 46
Side Airbags ............................................... 57
Side Curtain Airbags .................................. 59
Siri Eyes Free............................................. 311
SiriusXM® Radio ....................................... 282
Snow Tires ................................................ 564
Spare Tire ......................................... 582, 615
Spark Plugs ............................................... 614
Specifications ........................................... 614
Specified Fuel ................................... 513, 614
Speedometer............................................ 114
SRS Airbags (Airbags) ................................ 53
Starting the Engine.......................... 432, 435
Does Not Start ........................................ 591
Engine Switch Buzzer ...................... 165, 168
Jump Starting ......................................... 594
Steering Wheel
Adjusting ................................................ 186
Stopping ................................................... 510
Summer Tires............................................ 564
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) ....... 53
Switches (Around the Steering
Wheel) ............................................ 4, 5, 165
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
633 ページ
2019年8月8日
T
午後3時52分
Towing Your Vehicle ................................ 429
Emergency .............................................. 609
TPMS (Tire Pressure Monitoring
System) .................................................... 455
Indicator ............................................ 90, 603
Transmission ..................................... 440, 442
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode .................... 444
Continuously Variable.............................. 439
Fluid ........................................................ 538
Number ................................................... 616
Shift Lever Position Indicator ...... 86, 441, 443
Trip Meter ......................................... 116, 120
Troubleshooting ....................................... 579
Blown Fuse ...................................... 604, 606
Brake Pedal Vibrates .................................. 30
Buzzer Sounds When Opening Door .......... 30
Emergency Towing .................................. 609
Engine Won’t Start .................................. 591
Noise When Braking .................................. 31
Overheating ............................................ 597
Puncture/Flat Tire..................................... 582
Rear Door Won’t Open ...................... 30, 151
Shift Lever Won’t Move ........................... 596
Warning Indicators .................................... 80
Turn Signals .............................................. 170
Indicators (Instrument Panel)...................... 91
U
Unlocking the Doors ........................ 139, 148
USB Flash Drives ....................................... 332
USB Port(s) ................................................ 229
V
Vanity Mirrors............................................... 7
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)....... 616
Vehicle Stability AssistTM (VSA®) .............. 450
Off Button............................................... 451
Off Indicator.............................................. 89
System Indicator........................................ 89
Viscosity (Oil) .................................... 531, 615
Voice Control Operation.......................... 274
Audio Commands ................................... 276
General Commands ................................ 277
Music Search Commands ........................ 277
On Screen Commands............................. 277
Phone Commands................................... 276
Voice Portal Screen.................................. 275
Voice Recognition ................................... 274
VSA® (Vehicle Stability AssistTM) .............. 450
Index
Tachometer .............................................. 114
Tailgate..................................................... 156
Unable to Open ...................................... 610
Temperature
High Temperature Indicator ...................... 88
Low Temperature Indicator ....................... 88
Outside Temperature Display .......... 114, 117
Temperature Sensor ........................ 114, 117
Tie-down Anchors.................................... 209
Time (Setting)........................................... 134
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)..................................................... 455
Indicator ........................................... 90, 603
Tires .......................................................... 555
Air Pressure..................................... 557, 615
Checking and Maintaining ...................... 555
Inspection ............................................... 556
Labeling.................................................. 557
Puncture (Flat Tire) .................................. 582
Regulations............................................. 559
Rotation.................................................. 563
Spare Tire ....................................... 582, 615
Summer.................................................. 564
Tire Chains.............................................. 564
Wear Indicators....................................... 561
Winter .................................................... 564
Tools ......................................................... 580
Towing a Trailer....................................... 429
木曜日
633
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
634 ページ
2019年8月8日
W
Index
634
Walk away auto lock® .............................. 142
Wallpaper.......................................... 237, 261
Warning and Information
Messages ........................................... 99, 100
Warning Indicator On/Blinking................ 599
Warning Labels ........................................... 78
Warranties (Warranty Manual provided
separately)............................................... 621
Watts ......................................................... 614
Wear Indicators (Tire)............................... 561
Wheel Nut Wrench (Jack Handle).... 580, 586
Wi-Fi Connection ...................................... 309
Window Washers...................................... 179
Adding/Refilling Fluid............................... 540
Switch ..................................................... 179
Windshield ................................................ 179
Cleaning.......................................... 571, 574
Defrosting/Defogging .............. 183, 215, 219
Washer Fluid............................................ 540
Wiper Blades ........................................... 551
Wipers and Washers ................................ 179
Winter Tires
Snow Tires............................................... 564
Tire Chains .............................................. 564
Wipers and Washers ................................. 179
Checking and Replacing Wiper
Blades............................................ 551, 553
WMA ......................................... 243, 249, 299
Worn Tires......................................... 555, 561
木曜日
午後3時52分
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
635 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
20 HR-V HDMC HDMG-31T7A6400.book
636 ページ
2019年8月8日
木曜日
午後3時52分
31T7A640
OM-12569
00X31-T7A-6400
owners.honda.com (U.S.)
honda.ca (Canada)
2020 Honda HR-V Owner’s Manual
© 2019 Honda Motor Co., Ltd. — All Rights Reserved
Printed in U.S.A.